GLS
Vehicle document wallet
Here you can find comprehen‐
sive information about operating
your vehicle and about services
and guarantees in printed form.
Digital – on the Internet
You can find the Operator's Man‐
ual on the Mercedes-Benz home‐
page.
Digital – as an app
The Mercedes-Benz Guides app
is available free-of-charge in
familiar app stores.
Apple® iOS
É1675841213?ËÍ
1675841213
Order no. P167 0234 13 Part no. 167 584 12 13
Edition A 2021
AndroidTM
Mercedes-Benz
Digital – in the vehicle
Familiarize yourself with the con‐
tents of the Operator's Manual
directly via the vehicle's multi‐
media system (menu item "Vehi‐
cle information"). Start with the
quick guide or broaden your
knowledge with practical tips.
GLS
Operator's Manual
Mercedes-Benz
Front passenger airbag warning
Observe the chapter "Children in the vehicle".
Publication details
Internet
Further information about Mercedes-Benz vehi‐
cles and about Mercedes‑Benz AG can be found
on the following websites:
https://www.mbusa.com (USA only)
https://www.mercedes-benz.ca (Canada only)
Documentation team
AG: Not to be reprinted, trans‐
lated or otherwise reproduced, in whole or in
part, without written permission from
Mercedes‑Benz AG.
©Mercedes‑Benz
Example
& WARNING Risk of injury or fatal injuries
if the front passenger airbag is enabled
If the front passenger airbag is enabled, a
child on the front passenger seat may be
struck by the front passenger airbag during
an accident.
NEVER use a rearward facing child restraint
system on a seat protected by an ENABLED
FRONT AIRBAG in front of it, this can result in
DEATH or SERIOUS INJURY to the child.
Vehicle manufacturer
Mercedes‑Benz AG
Mercedesstraße 120
70372 Stuttgart
Germany
As at 24.09.2019
Thank you for purchasing a Mercedes-Benz
Before you first drive off, read this Operator's
Manual carefully and familiarize yourself with
your vehicle. For your own safety and a longer
operating lifespan of the vehicle, follow the
instructions and warning notices in this Opera‐
tor's Manual. Disregarding them may lead to
damage to the vehicle or injury to people.
Damage to the vehicle resulting from the disre‐
gard of the instructions is not covered by the
Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty.
The standard equipment and product description
of your vehicle may vary and depends on the fol‐
lowing factors:
R Model
R Order
R National version
R Availability
Mercedes-Benz reserves the right to introduce
changes in the following areas:
R Design
R Equipment
R
Technical features
The equipment in your vehicle may therefore dif‐
fer from that shown in the descriptions and illus‐
trations.
The following documents are integral parts of
the vehicle:
R Digital Operator's Manual
R Printed Operator's Manual
R Maintenance Booklet
R Equipment-dependent Supplements
Keep these documents in the vehicle at all
times. If you sell the vehicle, always pass all of
the documents on to the new owner.
Mercedes-Benz USA, LLC
Mercedes-Benz Canada, Inc.
A Daimler Company
1675841213
1675841213
2
Contents
Symbols ........................................................ 5
At a glance .................................................... 6
Cockpit ........................................................... 6
Indicator and warning lamps ......................... 10
Overhead control panel ................................ 12
Door control panel and seat adjustment ....... 14
Control settings in the rear passenger
compartment ................................................ 16
Emergencies and breakdowns ...................... 18
Digital Operator's Manual ......................... 20
Calling up the Digital Operator's Manual ...... 20
General notes .............................................
Protecting the environment ..........................
Mercedes-Benz GenuineParts .......................
Operator's Manual ........................................
Service and vehicle operation .......................
Operating safety ...........................................
Declaration of conformity for wireless
vehicle components ......................................
Diagnostics connection ................................
22
22
23
23
24
25
27
27
Qualified specialist workshop .......................
Correct use of the vehicle ............................
Sport Utility Vehicle ......................................
Notes for persons with electronic medi‐
cal aids .........................................................
Problems with your vehicle ...........................
Reporting safety defects ...............................
Limited Warranty ..........................................
QR code for rescue card ...............................
Data storage .................................................
Copyright ......................................................
Occupant safety .........................................
Restraint system ...........................................
Seat belts .....................................................
Airbags .........................................................
PRE-SAFE® system .......................................
Automatic measures after an accident .........
Safely transporting children in the vehi‐
cle .................................................................
Notes on pets in the vehicle .........................
28
28
29
29
29
30
31
31
31
34
36
36
38
42
49
51
51
66
Opening and closing .................................. 67
SmartKey ...................................................... 67
Doors ............................................................
Running boards .............................................
Cargo compartment .....................................
Side windows ................................................
Sliding sunroof .............................................
Roller sun blinds ...........................................
Anti-theft protection .....................................
70
74
75
81
84
89
90
Seats and stowing ...................................... 94
Notes on the correct driver's seat posi‐
tion ............................................................... 94
Seats ............................................................ 94
Steering wheel ............................................ 112
Easy entry and exit feature .......................... 114
Operating the memory function .................. 115
Memory function in the rear passenger
compartment .............................................. 116
Stowage areas ............................................. 119
Cup holder .................................................. 133
Sockets ....................................................... 135
Refrigerator box .......................................... 137
Wireless charging of the mobile phone
and connection with the exterior antenna .. 139
Installing/removing the floor mats .............. 141
Light and visibility ...................................
Exterior lighting ..........................................
Interior lighting ...........................................
Windshield wiper and windshield washer
system ........................................................
Mirrors ........................................................
Area permeable to radio waves on the
windshield ..................................................
Infrared-reflective windshield function ........
143
143
148
150
155
158
158
Climate control ........................................ 159
Overview of climate control systems .......... 159
Operating the climate control system ......... 160
Driving and parking .................................
Driving ........................................................
DYNAMIC SELECT switch ...........................
Automatic transmission ..............................
Transfer case ..............................................
Function of the 4MATIC ..............................
Refueling .....................................................
Parking .......................................................
Driving and driving safety systems ..............
Trailer hitch ................................................
168
168
182
185
189
191
191
194
201
269
Vehicle towing instructions ......................... 273
Instrument Display and on-board
computer ..................................................
Notes on the Instrument Display and onboard computer ..........................................
Instrument Display overview .......................
Overview of the buttons on the steering
wheel ..........................................................
Operating the on-board computer ...............
Overview of what is shown on the multi‐
function display ..........................................
Head-up Display .........................................
MBUX multimedia system .......................
Overview and operation ..............................
System settings ..........................................
Navigation ..................................................
Telephone ...................................................
Mercedes me and apps ..............................
Mercedes-Benz emergency call system ......
Radio & media .............................................
Sound settings ...........................................
274
274
275
276
276
278
278
281
281
289
292
299
302
309
313
320
Contents
3
Maintenance and care .............................
ASSYST PLUS service interval display .........
Engine compartment ..................................
Cleaning and care .......................................
321
321
322
328
Breakdown assistance ............................
Emergency ..................................................
Flat tire .......................................................
Battery (vehicle) .........................................
Tow starting or towing away .......................
Electrical fuses ...........................................
336
336
338
343
349
353
Wheels and tires ......................................
Notes on noise or unusual handling char‐
acteristics ...................................................
Notes on regularly inspecting wheels and
tires ............................................................
Notes on snow chains ................................
Tire pressure ..............................................
Loading the vehicle ....................................
Tire labeling ................................................
Definition of terms for tires and loading .....
Changing a wheel .......................................
Emergency spare wheel ..............................
356
356
356
357
357
363
367
372
375
385
4
Contents
Collapsible spare wheel .............................. 387
Technical data ..........................................
Notes on technical data ..............................
Vehicle electronics .....................................
Vehicle identification plate, VIN and
engine number overview ............................
Operating fluids ..........................................
Vehicle data ................................................
Trailer hitch ................................................
390
390
390
392
394
401
406
Display messages and warning/indi‐
cator lamps .............................................. 408
Display messages ....................................... 408
Warning and indicator lamps ...................... 460
Index .......................................................... 474
Symbols
In this Operator's Manual, you will find the fol‐
lowing symbols:
& DANGER Danger due to not observing
the warning notices
Warning notices draw your attention to haz‐
ards that may endanger your health or life, or
the health or life of others.
# Observe the warning notices.
+ ENVIRONMENTAL NOTE Environmental
damage due to failure to observe envi‐
ronmental notes
Environmental notes include information on
environmentally responsible behavior or envi‐
ronmentally responsible disposal.
# Observe environmental notes.
* NOTE Damage to property due to failure
to observe notes on material damage
Notes on material damage inform you of
risks which may lead to your vehicle being
damaged.
#
Observe notes on material damage.
% These symbols indicate useful instructions
or further information that could be helpful
to you.
#
Instruction
(/ page) Further information on a topic
Information on the multifunction dis‐
Display
play/media display
4
Highest menu level, which is to be
selected in the multimedia system
5
Relevant submenus, which are to be
selected in the multimedia system
*
Indicates a cause
5
6
At a glance – Cockpit
Left-hand-drive vehicles
At a glance – Cockpit
1 Steering wheel gearshift paddles
→
187
2 Combination switch
→
144
3 Instrument Display
→
275
4 DIRECT SELECT lever
→
185
5 Media display
→
281
6 Climate control systems
→
160
7 Hazard warning light system
→
145
8 PASSENGER AIR BAG indicator lamps
→
47
9 Glove box
→
122
A Storage compartment
→
122
B Controller for volume and switching sound
on/off
→
281
Switches the MBUX multimedia system
on/off
→
281
C Calls up navigation
→
283
D Calls up radio or media
→
283
E Calls up the telephone
→
283
F Control panel for:
Individual wheel control (vehicles without offroad package) or
→
240
Manual gearshifting
→
187
AIRMATIC or
→
229
E-ACTIVE BODY CONTROL
→
236
Activates/deactivates ESP®
→
203
Downhill Speed Regulation
→
214
G Calls up favorites
→
283
H Calls up vehicle functions
→
283
I Active Parking Assist
→
257
J DYNAMIC SELECT switch
→
184
K Touchpad
→
283
L Start/stop button
→
169
→
180
→
276
ECO start/stop function
M Control panel for the MBUX multimedia sys‐
tem
7
8
At a glance – Cockpit
N Adjusts the steering wheel mechanically
→
112
O Adjusts the steering wheel electrically
→
113
→
113
Switches the steering wheel heater on/off
P Control panel:
On-board computer
→
276
Cruise control
→
213
→
218
Q Diagnostics connection
→
27
R Opens the hood
→
322
S Electric parking brake
→
198
T Light switch
→
143
Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC
10
At a glance – Indicator and warning lamps
Instrument Display
At a glance – Indicator and warning lamps
1 #! Turn signal light
→
144
D h Tire pressure monitor
→
472
2 6 Restraint system
→
462
→
464
3 å ESP® OFF
E 8 Reserve fuel with fuel filler flap location
indicator
F Fuel level
→
275
G Electric parking brake (red)
→
467
→
467
I ü Seat belt
→
462
J ; Check Engine
→
464
K ä Suspension (red)
→
469
→
469
→
470
ESP®
→
470
4 R Rear fog lamp
→
144
5 K High beam
→
144
L Low beam
→
143
T Parking lamps
→
143
6 ÿ Coolant temperature
→
464
7 Coolant temperature display
→
275
8 ! Electric parking brake (yellow)
→
467
9 # Electrical malfunction
→
464
A L Distance warning
→
469
B ! ABS
→
470
C Ù Electric power steering
→
463
÷
F USA only
! Canada only
H Brakes (red)
$ USA only
J Canada only
ä Suspension (yellow)
11
12
At a glance – Overhead control panel
At a glance – Overhead control panel
1 Sun visors
6 p Switches the right-hand reading lamp
on/off
→
148
7 ; me button
→
304
2 p Switches the left-hand reading lamp
on/off
→
148
3 | Switches automatic interior lighting con‐
trol on/off
→
148
8 G SOS button
→
304
4 c Switches the front interior lighting
on/off
→
148
9 3 Opens closes the panorama roof with
power tilt/sliding panel
→
84
5 u Switches the rear interior lighting
on/off
→
148
3 Opens/closes the roller sunblind
→
84
→
156
A Inside rearview mirror
13
14
At a glance – Door control panel and seat adjustment
At a glance – Door control panel and seat adjustment
1 Opens the door
→
70
A Opens/closes the rear right side window
→
81
2 Locks/unlocks the vehicle
→
71
B Child safety lock for the rear side windows
→
65
3 Sets the memory function
→
115
C Opens/closes the rear left side window
→
81
4 Adjusts the seats electrically
→
94
D Opens/closes the left side window
→
81
5 Switches the seat heating on/off
→
109
E Operates the outside mirrors
→
155
6 Switches the seat ventilation on/off
→
111
F Adjusts the 4-way lumbar support
→
98
7 Adjusts the front passenger seat from the
driver's seat
→
96
G Seat adjustment using the multimedia system
→
107
8 Opens/closes the tailgate
→
75
H Adjusts the head restraints
→
103
9 Opens/closes the right side window
→
81
15
16
At a glance – Control settings in the rear passenger compartment
At a glance – Control settings in the rear passenger compartment
1 Control panel for rear compartment climate
control
→
160
2 Storage compartment in the center console
→
136
3 Adjusts the front passenger seat electrically
→
97
4 Switches the rear seat ventilation on/off
→
111
5 Switches the rear seat heating on/off
→
109
6 Adjusts the rear seats electrically
→
98
→
98
115 V socket
Mercedes-Maybach vehicles: adjusts a reclin‐
ing rear seat electrically
7 Mercedes-Maybach vehicles: operates the
memory function
→
116
8 Mercedes-Maybach vehicles: sets the fully
reclined position
→
99
9 Mercedes-Maybach vehicles: access to the
refrigerator box
→
137
A Stowage compartment in the rear armrest
MBUX rear tablet bracket
17
18
At a glance – Emergencies and breakdowns
At a glance – Emergencies and breakdowns
1 QR code for accessing the rescue card
→
31
2 Safety vests
→
336
3 me button and SOS button
→
304
4 Hazard warning light system
→
145
5 Checking and refilling operating fluids
→
394
→
347
6 Tow-starting and towing away
→
350
7 Flat tire
→
338
Starting assistance
8 Tow-starting and towing away
→
350
9 Fuel filler flap with instruction labels for tire
pressure, fuel type and QR code for accessing
the rescue card
→
191
A Warning triangle
→
336
B TIREFIT kit
→
339
C First-aid kit (soft sided)
→
337
19
20
Digital Operator's Manual
Calling up the Digital Operator's Manual
Multimedia system:
4 © 5 Info 5 Operator's Manual
5 Õ
R
R
R
R
R
R
The Digital Operator's Manual describes the
functions and operation of the vehicle and the
multimedia system.
# Select one of the following menu items in the
Digital Operator's Manual:
R Search: search for keywords in order to find
quick answers to questions about the opera‐
tion of the vehicle.
Quick start: find the first steps towards set‐
ting up your vehicle.
Tips: find information that prepares you for
certain everyday situations with your vehicle.
Animations: watch animations of the vehicle
functions.
Messages: receive additional information
about the messages in the instrument dis‐
play.
Bookmarks: gain access to your personally
saved bookmarks.
Language: select the language for the Digital
Operator's Manual.
1
2
3
4
5
6
Back
Adds bookmarks
Picture
Contents section
Directions of movement of contents section
Menu
Some sections in the Digital Operator's Manual,
e.g. warning notes, can be expanded and col‐
lapsed.
Additional methods of calling up the Digital
Operator's Manual:
Direct access: open the required content in the
Digital Operator's Manual by pressing and hold‐
Digital Operator's Manual
ing an entry on the tab bar in the multimedia
system:
Instrument Display: call up brief information as
display messages in the instrument cluster
Voice Control System: call up via the voice
control system
For safety reasons, the Digital Operator's Man‐
ual is deactivated while driving.
21
22
General notes
Protecting the environment
+ ENVIRONMENTAL NOTE Environmental
damage due to operating conditions and
personal driving style
The pollutant emission of the vehicle is
directly related to the way you operate the
vehicle.
Operate your vehicle in an environmentally
responsible manner to help protect the envi‐
ronment. Please observe the following rec‐
ommendations on operating conditions and
personal driving style.
Operating conditions:
# Make sure that the tire pressure is cor‐
rect.
# Do not carry any unnecessary weight
(e.g. roof luggage racks once you no
longer need them).
# Adhere to the service intervals.
A regularly serviced vehicle will contrib‐
ute to environmental protection.
#
Always have maintenance work carried
out at a qualified specialist workshop.
Personal driving style:
# Do not depress the accelerator pedal
when starting the engine.
# Do not warm up the engine while the
vehicle is stationary.
# Drive carefully and maintain a suitable
distance from the vehicle in front.
# Avoid frequent, sudden acceleration
and braking.
# Change gear in good time and use each
gear only up to Ô of its maximum
engine speed.
# Switch off the engine in stationary traf‐
fic, e.g. by using the ECO start/stop
function.
# Drive fuel-efficiently. Observe the ECO
display for a fuel-efficient driving style.
+ ENVIRONMENTAL NOTE Environmental
pollution caused by irresponsible dis‐
posal of the high-voltage battery
A high-voltage battery contains materials
which are harmful to the environment.
# Dispose of defective high-voltage bat‐
teries at a qualified specialist work‐
shop.
Environmental issues and recommendations:
It is recommended that you re-use or recycle
materials instead of just disposing of them.
The relevant environmental guidelines and regu‐
lations serve to protect the environment and
must be strictly observed.
General notes
Mercedes-Benz GenuineParts
+ ENVIRONMENTAL NOTE Environmental
damage caused by not using recycled
reconditioned components
Mercedes-Benz AG offers recycled recondi‐
tioned components and parts with the same
quality as new parts. The same entitlement
from the Limited Warranty is valid as for new
parts.
# Recycled reconditioned components
and parts from Mercedes-Benz AG.
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
#
#
#
* NOTE Impairment of the operating effi‐
ciency of the restraint systems from
installing accessory parts or from repairs
or welding
Airbags and Emergency Tensioning Devices,
as well as control units and sensors for the
restraint systems, may be installed in the fol‐
lowing areas of your vehicle:
R Doors
Door pillars
Door sills
Seats
Cockpit
Instrument cluster
Center console
Lateral roof frame
Do not install accessory parts such as
audio systems in these areas.
Do not carry out repairs or welding.
Have aftermarket installation of acces‐
sories carried out at a qualified special‐
ist workshop.
You could jeopardize the operating safety of your
vehicle if you use parts, tires and wheels as well
as accessories relevant to safety which have not
been approved by Mercedes-Benz. Safety-rele‐
vant systems, e.g. the brake system, may mal‐
function. Only use Mercedes-Benz GenuineParts
or parts of equal quality. Only use tires, wheels
23
and accessory parts that have been specifically
approved for your vehicle model.
Mercedes-Benz GenuineParts are subject to
strict quality inspections. Each part has been
specially developed, manufactured or selected
for Mercedes-Benz vehicles and adapted to
them. Therefore, only Mercedes-Benz Genuine‐
Parts should be used.
More than 300,000 different Mercedes-Benz
GenuineParts are available for Mercedes-Benz
models.
All authorized Mercedes-Benz Centers maintain
a supply of Mercedes-Benz GenuineParts for
necessary service and repair work. In addition,
strategically located parts delivery centers pro‐
vide for quick and reliable parts service.
Always specify the vehicle identification number
(VIN) (/ page 392) when ordering MercedesBenz GenuineParts.
Operator's Manual
This Operator's Manual describes all models and
all standard and optional equipment available for
24
General notes
your vehicle at the time of this Operator's Man‐
ual going to press. Country-specific differences
are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all features described. This is also
the case for systems and functions relevant to
safety. Therefore, the equipment on your vehicle
may differ from that in the descriptions and illus‐
trations.
The original purchase agreement for your vehicle
contains a list of all of the systems in your vehi‐
cle.
Should you have any questions concerning
equipment and operation, please consult an
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.
The Operator's Manual and Maintenance Booklet
are important documents and should be kept in
the vehicle.
Service and vehicle operation
Vehicle operation outside the USA or Canada
When you are abroad with your vehicle, observe
the following points:
R Service points or replacement parts may not
be available immediately.
R Unleaded fuel may not be available for vehi‐
cles with a catalytic converter. Leaded fuel
may cause damage to the catalytic converter.
R The fuel may have an extremely low octane
number. Unsuitable fuel can cause engine
damage.
Some Mercedes-Benz models are available in
Europe through our European Delivery Program.
For more information, please consult an author‐
ized Mercedes‑Benz service center, or write to
one of the following address:
In the USA:
Mercedes-Benz USA, LLC
European Delivery Department
One Mercedes-Benz Drive
Sandy Springs, GA 30328
In Canada:
Mercedes-Benz Canada, Inc.
European Delivery Department
98 Vanderhoof Avenue
Toronto, Ontario M4G 4C9
Maintenance
Your customer advisor confirms the service in
the service report.
Roadside Assistance
The Mercedes-Benz Roadside Assistance Pro‐
gram offers technical help in the case of a
breakdown. Your calls to the toll-free Roadside
Assistance Hotline are answered by our agents
24 hours a day, 365 days a year.
1-800-FOR-MERCedes (1-800-367-6372) (USA)
1-800-387-0100 (Canada)
You can find further information in the
Mercedes-Benz Roadside Assistance Program
brochure (USA) or the "Roadside Assistance"
General notes
section in the Service and Warranty booklet
(Canada). You will find both in the vehicle docu‐
ment wallet.
Change of address or change of ownership
In the event of a change of address, please send
us the "Notification of address change" in the
Service and Guarantee booklet or simply call the
Mercedes-Benz Customer Assistance Center
(USA) on the hotline number
1-800-FOR-MERCedes (1-800-367-6372) or Cus‐
tomer Service (Canada) on 1-800-387-0100. We
can then reach you in a timely fashion, if neces‐
sary.
If you sell your Mercedes, please leave all litera‐
ture in the vehicle so that it is available to the
next owner. If you have purchased a used vehi‐
cle, please send us the "Notice of Purchase of
Used Car" in the Service and Guarantee booklet
or simply call the Mercedes-Benz Customer
Assistance Center (USA) at the hotline number
1-800-FOR-MERCedes (1-800-367-6372) or Cus‐
tomer Service (Canada) at 1-800-387-0100.
Possible danger due to substances hazard‐
ous to health
In compliance with Proposition 65 ("Prop65"),
the following detachable label has been added to
each vehicle sold in California:
Operating safety
& WARNING Risk of accident due to mal‐
functions or system failures
To avoid malfunctions or system failures:
# Always have the prescribed service and
maintenance work as well any required
25
repairs carried out at a qualified spe‐
cialist workshop.
& WARNING Risk of accident or injury due
to incorrect modifications on electronic
component parts
Modification of electronic components, their
software or wiring could impair their function
and/or the function of other networked com‐
ponent parts or safety-relevant systems.
This can endanger the operating safety of the
vehicle.
# Never tamper with the wiring and elec‐
tronic component parts or their soft‐
ware.
# You should have all work on electrical
and electronic components carried out
at a qualified specialist workshop.
Observe the "On-board electronics" section in
"Technical data".
26
General notes
& WARNING Risk of fire due to flammable
materials on hot parts of the exhaust
system
R
Flammable material such as leaves, grass or
twigs may ignite if they come into contact
with hot parts of the exhaust system.
# When driving on unpaved roads or offroad, regularly check the vehicle under‐
side.
# Remove trapped plants or other flam‐
mable material, in particular.
# If there is damage, consult a qualified
specialist workshop immediately.
R
* NOTE Damage to the vehicle
In the following situations, in particular, there
is a risk of damage to the vehicle:
R The vehicle becomes grounded, e.g. on a
high curb or an unpaved road
The vehicle is driven too fast over an
obstacle, e.g. a curb, speed bump or pot‐
hole
A heavy object strikes the underbody or
chassis components
In situations such as this, the body, the
underbody, chassis components, wheels or
tires could be damaged without the damage
being visible. Components damaged in this
way can unexpectedly fail or, in the case of
an accident, may not absorb the loads that
arise as intended.
If the underbody paneling is damaged, flam‐
mable materials such as leaves, grass or
twigs can collect between the underbody and
the underbody paneling. These materials may
ignite if they come into contact with hot
parts on the exhaust system.
# Have the vehicle checked and repaired
immediately at a qualified specialist
workshop.
or
#
If driving safety is impaired while con‐
tinuing your journey, pull over and stop
the vehicle immediately in accordance
with the traffic conditions, and contact
a qualified specialist workshop.
Vehicles with a 48 V on-board electrical sys‐
tem (EQ Boost technology)
& DANGER Risk of fatal injury by touching
damaged high-voltage components
Vehicles with a 48 V on-board electrical sys‐
tem contain individual high-voltage compo‐
nents. These high-voltage components are
under high voltage.
If you modify component parts of these highvoltage components or touch damaged com‐
ponent parts, you may be electrocuted.
High voltage components may be damaged
in an accident, although the damage may not
be visible.
# Never perform modifications to compo‐
nent parts of high-voltage components.
General notes
#
#
Never touch damaged component parts
of high-voltage components.
Never touch component parts of highvoltage components after an accident.
Vehicles with a 48 V on-board electrical system
contain high voltage components. These compo‐
nents are marked with a high voltage label:
All work on high voltage components must be
carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.
Declaration of conformity for wireless vehi‐
cle components
USA: "Radio based devices of this vehicle com‐
ply with Part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is
subject to the following two conditions: 1) These
devices may not cause harmful interference, and
2) These devices must accept any interference
received, including interference that may cause
undesired operation. Changes or modifications
not expressly approved by the party responsible
for compliance could void the user's authority to
operate the equipment."
Canada: "This vehicle contains license-exempt
transmitter(s)/receiver(s) that comply with Inno‐
vation, Science and Economic Development Can‐
ada’s RSS(s). Operation is subject to the follow‐
ing two conditions: (1) These devices may not
cause interference, and (2) These devices must
accept any interference, including interference
that may cause undesired operation of the
device."
USA: "Wireless charging system for mobile devi‐
ces (model: WMI2 Wireless Mobile Interface):
27
This device complies with Part 18 of the FCC
Rules."
The name and address of the responsible party
is:
peiker acustic GmbH
Max-Planck-Str. 28-32
61381 Friedrichsdorf
Germany
Diagnostics connection
The diagnostics connection is only intended for
the connection of diagnostic devices at a quali‐
fied specialist workshop.
& WARNING Risk of accident due to con‐
necting devices to the diagnostics con‐
nection
If you connect devices to the diagnostics
connection of the vehicle, the function of
vehicle systems and operating safety may be
impaired.
28
#
General notes
Only connect the vehicle diagnostics
connection to devices which have been
tested with regard to their suitability
and are considered safe.
& WARNING Risk of accident due to
objects in the driver's footwell
Objects in the driver's footwell may impede
pedal travel or block a depressed pedal.
This jeopardizes the operating and road
safety of the vehicle.
# Stow all objects in the vehicle securely
so that they cannot get into the driver's
footwell.
# Always install the floor mats securely
and as prescribed in order to ensure
that there is always sufficient room for
the pedals.
# Do not use loose floor mats and do not
place floor mats on top of one another.
* NOTE Battery discharging from using
devices connected to the diagnostics
connection
Using devices at the diagnostics connection
drains the battery.
# Check the charge level of the battery.
# If the charge level is low, charge the
battery, e.g. by driving a considerable
distance.
Connecting equipment to the diagnostics con‐
nection can lead to emissions monitoring infor‐
mation being reset, for example. This may lead
to the vehicle failing to meet the requirements of
the next emissions inspection during the main
inspection.
Qualified specialist workshop
An authorized Mercedes-Benz Center is a quali‐
fied specialist workshop. It has the necessary
special skills, tools and qualifications to cor‐
rectly carry out the work required on your vehi‐
cle. This particularly applies to safety-relevant
works.
For the following, always have your vehicle
checked at an authorized Mercedes-Benz Cen‐
ter:
R safety-relevant works
R service and maintenance work
R repair work
R modifications as well as installations and
conversions
R work on electronic components
R vehicles with 48 V on-board electrical
system (EQ boost technology): work on
high voltage components of the 48 V onboard electrical system
Mercedes‑Benz recommends a Mercedes‑Benz
service center.
Correct use of the vehicle
If you remove any warning stickers, you or others
could fail to recognize certain dangers. Leave
warning stickers in position.
General notes
Observe the following information in particular
when driving your vehicle:
R the safety notes in this manual
R technical data for the vehicle
R traffic rules and regulations
R laws and safety standards pertaining to
motor vehicles
If this type of vehicle is not driven safely, an acci‐
dent can occur, the vehicle can roll over and
occupants can suffer serious or even fatal inju‐
ries.
In a rollover crash, an unbelted person is signifi‐
cantly more likely to die than a person wearing a
seat belt.
You and all vehicle occupants should always
wear your seat belts.
manufacturer and your doctor. MercedesBenz AG recommends using only few electrical
vehicle systems if there is continuing uncertainty
concerning the possibility of aids malfunction‐
ing.
Have repairs and maintenance work in the area
of vehicle components carrying live voltage and
transmission antenna carried out by a qualified
specialist workshop.
Notes for persons with electronic medical
aids
Mercedes-Benz AG cannot, despite carefully
developing vehicle systems, completely rule out
the interaction of vehicle systems with electronic
medical aids such as cardiac pacemakers.
For this reason, the following can occur in isola‐
ted cases, depending on the aids used:
R Aids malfunctioning
R Adverse health effects
Problems with your vehicle
If you should experience a problem with your
vehicle, particularly one that you believe may
affect its safe operation, we urge you to contact
an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center immedi‐
ately to have the problem diagnosed and recti‐
fied. If the problem is not resolved to your satis‐
faction, please discuss the problem again with
an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center or, if nec‐
essary, contact us at one of the following
addresses:
In the USA:
Mercedes-Benz USA, LLC
Sport Utility Vehicle
& WARNING Risk of accident when the
center of gravity is too high
The vehicle may start to skid and rollover in
the event of sudden steering maneuvers
and/or when the vehicle's speed is not adap‐
ted to the road conditions.
# Always adapt your speed and driving
style to the vehicle's driving character‐
istics and to the prevailing road and
weather conditions.
Utility vehicles have a significantly higher roll‐
over rate than other types of vehicles.
29
Observe the notes and warnings of the manufac‐
turer of the aids; if in doubt, contact the device
30
General notes
Customer Assistance Center
One Mercedes-Benz Drive
Sandy Springs, GA 30328
In Canada:
Mercedes-Benz Canada, Inc.
Customer Relations Department
98 Vanderhoof Avenue
Toronto, Ontario M4G 4C9
Reporting safety defects
USA only:
The following text is published as required of
manufacturers under Title 49, Code of U.S. Fed‐
eral Regulations, Part 575 pursuant to the
"National Traffic and Motor Vehicle Safety Act of
1966".
If you believe that your vehicle has a defect
which could cause a crash or could cause injury
or death, you should immediately inform the
National Highway Traffic Safety Administration
(NHTSA) in addition to notifying Mercedes-Benz
USA, LLC.
If NHTSA receives similar complaints, it may
open an investigation, and if it finds that a safety
defect exists in a group of vehicles, it may order
a recall and remedy campaign. However, NHTSA
cannot become involved in individual problems
between you, your dealer, or Mercedes-Benz
USA, LLC.
To contact NHTSA, you may call the Vehicle
Safety Hotline toll-free at 1-888-327-4236
(TTY: 1-800-424-9153); go to the https://
www.safercar.gov/; or write to: Administrator,
NHTSA, 400 Seventh Street, SW., Washington,
DC 20590,: USA.
You can also obtain other information about
motor vehicle safety from: https://
www.safercar.gov
Canada only:
The following text is published as required of
manufacturers under subsection 18.4 (4) of the
Motor Vehicle Safety Regulations.
If you believe that your vehicle has a defect
which could cause a crash or could cause injury
or death, you should immediately inform Trans‐
port Canada in addition to notifying MercedesBenz Canada Inc.
If Transport Canada received similar complaints,
it may open an investigation, and if it finds that a
safety defect exists in a group of vehicles, it may
order a recall and remedy campaign. However,
Transport Canada cannot become involved in
individual problems between you, your dealer or
Mercedes-Benz Canada Inc.
To contact Transport Canada, you may call the
Defect Investigations and Recalls Division tollfree in Canada at 1-800-333-0510 or
819-994-3328in the Gatineau-Ottawa area or
internationally; you may also go to the following
websites for more information:
R English: https://www.tc.gc.ca/recalls
R French: https://www.tc.gc.ca/rappels
General notes
Limited Warranty
* NOTE Damage to the vehicle arising
from violation of these operating instruc‐
tions.
Damage to the vehicle can arise from viola‐
tion of these operating instructions.
This damage is not covered either by the
Mercedes-Benz implied warranty or by the
New‑ or Used-Vehicle Warranty.
# Follow the instructions in these operat‐
ing instructions on proper operation of
your vehicle as well as on possible vehi‐
cle damage.
QR code for rescue card
The QR code is secured in the fuel filler flap and
on the opposite side on the B-pillar. In the event
of an accident, rescue services can use the QR
code to quickly find the appropriate rescue card
for your vehicle. The current rescue card con‐
tains the most important information about your
vehicle in a compact form, e.g. the routing of the
electric lines.
Further information can be obtained at https://
www.mercedes-benz.de/qr-code.
Data storage
Electronic control units
Electronic control units are installed in your vehi‐
cle. Some of these are necessary for the safe
operation of your vehicle, while some assist you
when driving (driver assistance systems). In
addition, your vehicle provides comfort and
entertainment functions, which are also made
possible by electronic control units.
Electronic control units contain data memories
which can temporarily or permanently store
technical information about the vehicle's operat‐
ing state, component loads, maintenance
requirements and technical events or malfunc‐
tions.
31
In general, this information documents the state
of a component part, a module, a system or the
surroundings such as:
R Operating status of system components (e.g.
fill levels, battery status, tire pressure)
R Status messages concerning the vehicle or
its individual components (e.g. number of
wheel revolutions/speed, longitudinal accel‐
eration, lateral acceleration, display of fas‐
tened seat belts)
R Malfunctions or faults in important system
components (e.g. lights, brakes)
R Information on events leading to vehicle
damage
R System reactions in special driving situations
(e.g. airbag deployment, intervention of sta‐
bility control systems)
R Ambient conditions (e.g. temperature, rain
sensor)
In addition to providing the actual control unit
function, this data assists the manufacturer in
detecting and rectifying malfunctions and opti‐
mizing vehicle functions. The majority of this
32
General notes
data is temporary and is only processed in the
vehicle itself. Only a small portion of the data is
stored in the event or fault memory.
When your vehicle is serviced, technical data
from the vehicle can be read out by service net‐
work employees (e.g. workshops, manufactur‐
ers) or third parties (e.g. breakdown services).
Services include, for example, repair services,
maintenance processes, warranty claims and
quality assurance measures. The read out is per‐
formed via the legally prescribed port for the
diagnostics connection in the vehicle. The
respective service network locations or third
parties collect, process and use the data. They
document technical statuses of the vehicle,
assist in finding faults and improving quality and
are transmitted to the manufacturer, if neces‐
sary. Furthermore, the manufacturer is subject
to product liability. For this, the manufacturer
requires technical data from vehicles.
Fault memories in the vehicle can be reset by a
service outlet as part of repair or maintenance
work.
Depending on the selected equipment, you can
import data into vehicle convenience and info‐
tainment functions yourself.
This includes, for example:
R Multimedia data such as music, films or pho‐
tos for playback in an integrated multimedia
system
R Address book data for use in connection with
an integrated hands-free system or an inte‐
grated navigation system
R Entered navigation destinations
R Data about the use of Internet services
This data can be saved locally in the vehicle or it
is located on a device which you have connected
to the vehicle (e.g. a smartphone, USB flash
drive or MP3 player). If this data is stored in the
vehicle, you can delete it at any time. This data
is sent to third parties only at your request, par‐
ticularly when you use online services in accord‐
ance with the settings that you have selected.
You can store or change convenience settings/
individualization in the vehicle at any time.
Depending on the equipment, this includes, for
example:
R Settings for the seat and steering wheel posi‐
tions
R Suspension and climate control settings
R Customizations such as interior lighting
If your vehicle is accordingly equipped, you can
connect your smartphone or another mobile end
device to the vehicle. You can control this by
means of the control elements integrated in the
vehicle. Images and audio from the smartphone
can be output via the multimedia system. Cer‐
tain information is simultaneously transferred to
your smartphone.
Depending on the type of integration, this can
include:
R General vehicle data
R Position data
This allows you to use selected apps on your
smartphone, such as navigation or music play‐
back. There is no further interaction between the
smartphone and the vehicle; in particular, vehi‐
cle data is not directly accessible. Which type of
General notes
further data processing occurs is determined by
the provider of the specific app used. Which set‐
tings you can make, if any, depends on the spe‐
cific app and the operating system of your
smartphone.
Online services
Wireless network connection
If your vehicle has a wireless network connec‐
tion, it enables data to be exchanged between
your vehicle and additional systems. The wire‐
less network connection is enabled via the vehi‐
cle's transmission and reception unit or via con‐
nected mobile end devices (e.g. smartphones).
Online functions can be used via the wireless
network connection. This includes online serv‐
ices and applications/apps provided by the man‐
ufacturer or other providers.
Manufacturer's services
Regarding online services of the manufacturer,
the individual functions are described by the
manufacturer in a suitable place (e.g. Operator's
Manual, website of the manufacturer) along with
the relevant data protection information. Per‐
sonal data may be used for the provision of
online services. Data is exchanged via a secure
connection, e.g. the manufacturer's designated
IT systems. Personal data is collected, pro‐
cessed and used via the provision of services
exclusively on the basis of legal permissions or
with prior consent.
The services and functions (sometimes subject
to a fee) can usually be activated or deactivated.
In some cases, this also applies to the entire
vehicle's data connection. This excludes, in par‐
ticular, legally prescribed functions and services.
Third party services
If it is possible to use online services from other
providers, these services are the responsibility
of the provider in question and subject to that
provider's data protection conditions and terms
of use. The manufacturer has no influence on
the content exchanged.
For this reason, please ask the service provider
for information about the type, extent and pur‐
pose of the collection and use of personal data
when services are provided by third parties.
33
MBUX multimedia system/Mercedes me
connect
If the vehicle is equipped with the MBUX multi‐
media system or Mercedes me connect, addi‐
tional data about the vehicle's operation, the use
of the vehicle in certain situations, and the loca‐
tion of the vehicle may be compiled by the
MBUX multimedia system or Mercedes me con‐
nect.
For additional information, please refer to the
"MBUX multimedia system" section and/or the
Mercedes me connect Terms and Conditions.
Event data recorders
USA only:
This vehicle is equipped with an event data
recorder (EDR). The main purpose of an EDR is
to record, in certain crash or near crash-like sit‐
uations, such as an airbag deployment or hitting
a road obstacle, data that will assist in under‐
standing how a vehicle's systems performed.
The EDR is designed to record data related to
34
General notes
vehicle dynamics and safety systems for a short
period of time, typically 30 seconds or less.
The EDR in this vehicle is designed to record
such data as:
R How various systems in your vehicle were
operating
R Whether or not the driver and front
passenger seat belts were buckled/fastened
R How far (if at all) the driver was depressing
the accelerator and/or brake pedal and
R How fast the vehicle was traveling
This data can help provide a better understand‐
ing of the circumstances in which accidents and
injuries occur. NOTE: EDR data is recorded by
your vehicle only if a non-trivial crash situation
occurs; no data is recorded by the EDR under
normal driving conditions and no personal data
(e.g. name, gender, age and accident location) is
recorded. However, other parties, such as law
enforcement, could combine EDR data with the
type of personally identifying data routinely
acquired during a crash investigation.
To read data recorded by an EDR, special equip‐
ment is required, and access to the vehicle or
the EDR is needed. In addition to the vehicle
manufacturer, other parties that have the special
equipment, such as law enforcement, can read
the information by accessing the vehicle or the
EDR.
EDR data may be used in civil and criminal mat‐
ters as a tool in accident reconstruction, acci‐
dent claims and vehicle safety. Since the Crash
Data Retrieval (CDR) tool that is used to extract
data from the EDR is commercially available,
Mercedes-Benz USA, LLC ("MBUSA") expressly
disclaims any and all liability arising from the
extraction of this information by unauthorized
Mercedes-Benz personnel.
MBUSA will not share EDR data with others with‐
out the consent of the vehicle owner or, if the
vehicle is leased, without the consent of the les‐
see. Exceptions to this representation include
responses to subpoenas by law enforcement; by
federal, state or local government; in connection
with or arising out of litigation involving MBUSA
or its subsidiaries and affiliates; or, as required
by law.
Warning: The EDR is a component of the
Restraint System Module. Tampering with, alter‐
ing, modifying or removing the EDR component
may result in a malfunction of the Restraint Sys‐
tem Module and other systems.
State laws or regulations regarding EDRs that
conflict with federal regulation are pre-empted.
This means that in the event of such conflict, the
federal regulation governs. As of December
2016, 17 states have enacted laws relating to
EDRs.
Copyright
Free and open source software
Information on license for free and open-source
software used in your vehicle can be found on
the data carrier in your vehicle document wallet
and with updates on the following website:
https://www.mercedes-benz.com/opensource
General notes
Registered trademarks
R Bluetooth®
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
is a registered trademark of Blue‐
tooth SIG, Inc.
DTS™ is a registered trademark of DTS, Inc.
Dolby® and MLP™ are registered trademarks
of DOLBY Laboratories.
BabySmart™, ESP® and PRE-SAFE® are reg‐
istered trademarks of Mercedes-Benz AG.
HomeLink® is a registered trademark of Gen‐
tex Corporation.
iPod® and iTunes® are registered trademarks
of Apple Inc.
Burmester® is a registered trademark of
Burmester Audiosysteme GmbH.
Microsoft® and Windows Media® are regis‐
tered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation.
SIRIUS® is a registered trademark of Sirius
XM Radio Inc.
HD Radio™ is a registered trademark of iBiq‐
uity Digital Corporation.
R
R
Gracenote® is a registered trademark of
Gracenote, Inc.
ZAGATSurvey® and related brands are regis‐
tered trademarks of ZagatSurvey, LLC.
35
36
Occupant safety
Restraint system
Protection provided by the restraint system
The restraint system includes the following com‐
ponents:
R Seat belt system
R Airbags
R Child restraint system
R Child seat securing systems
The restraint system can help prevent the vehi‐
cle occupants from coming into contact with
parts of the vehicle interior in the event of an
accident. In the event of an accident, the
restraint system can also reduce the forces to
which the vehicle occupants are subjected.
A seat belt can only provide the best level of pro‐
tection if it is worn correctly. Depending on the
detected accident situation, Emergency Tension‐
ing Devices and/or airbags supplement the pro‐
tection offered by a correctly worn seat belt.
Emergency Tensioning Devices and/or airbags
are not deployed in every accident.
In order for the restraint system to provide the
intended level of protection, each vehicle occu‐
pant must observe the following information:
R Fasten seat belts correctly.
R Sit in an almost upright seat position with
their back against the seat backrest.
R Sit with their feet resting on the floor, if pos‐
sible.
R Always secure persons under 5 ft (1.50 m)
tall in an additional restraint system suitable
for Mercedes-Benz vehicles.
However, no system available today can com‐
pletely eliminate injuries and fatalities in every
accident situation. In particular, the seat belt
and airbag generally do not protect against
objects penetrating the vehicle from the outside.
It is also not possible to completely rule out the
risk of injury caused by the airbag deploying.
Reduced restraint system protection
& WARNING Risk of injury or death due to
modifications to the restraint system
Vehicle occupants may no longer be protec‐
ted as intended if alterations are made to the
restraint system.
# Never alter the parts of the restraint
system.
# Never tamper with the wiring or any
electronic component parts or their
software.
If it is necessary to modify the vehicle to accom‐
modate a person with disabilities, contact an
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for details.
USA only: for details, contact our Customer
Assistance Center on 1-800-FOR-MERCedes
(1‑800‑367‑6372).
Restraint system functionality
When the ignition is switched on, a self-test is
performed, during which the 6 restraint sys‐
Occupant safety
tem warning lamp lights up. It goes out no later
than a few seconds after the vehicle is started.
The components of the restraint system are then
functional.
Malfunctioning restraint system
A malfunction has occurred in the restraint sys‐
tem if:
R The 6 restraint system warning lamp
does not light up when the ignition is
switched on
R The 6 restraint system warning lamp
lights up continuously or repeatedly during a
journey
& WARNING Risk of injury due to malfunc‐
tions in the restraint system
Components in the restraint system may be
activated unintentionally or not deploy as
planned in an accident.
# Have the restraint system checked and
repaired immediately at a qualified spe‐
cialist workshop.
Function of the restraint system in an acci‐
dent
How the restraint system works is determined by
the severity of the impact detected and the type
of accident anticipated:
R Frontal impact
R Rear impact
R Side impact
R Rollover
The activation thresholds for the components of
the restraint system are determined based on
the evaluation of the sensor values measured at
various points in the vehicle. This process is preemptive in nature. The triggering/deployment of
the components of the restraint system must
take place in good time at the start of the colli‐
sion.
Factors which can only be seen and measured
after a collision has occurred do not play a deci‐
sive role in the deployment of an airbag. Nor do
they provide an indication of airbag deployment.
The vehicle may be deformed significantly with‐
out an airbag being deployed. This is the case if
37
only parts which are relatively easily deformed
are affected and the rate of vehicle deceleration
is not high. Conversely, an airbag may be
deployed even though the vehicle suffers only
minor deformation. If very rigid vehicle parts
such as longitudinal members are hit, this may
result in sufficiently high levels of vehicle decel‐
eration.
Depending on the detected deployment situa‐
tion, the components of the restraint system can
be activated or deployed independently of each
other:
R Emergency Tensioning Device: frontal
impact, rear impact, side impact, rollover
R Driver's airbag, front passenger airbag: fron‐
tal impact
R Knee airbag: frontal impact
R Side airbag: side impact
R Window curtain airbag: side impact, rollover,
frontal impact
R Cushionbag: frontal impact
R PRE-SAFE® Impulse Side: side impact
38
Occupant safety
The front passenger airbag can only be deployed
in an accident if the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF
indicator lamp is off. If the front passenger seat
is occupied, make sure, both before and during
the journey, that the status of the front
passenger airbag is correct (/ page 47).
& WARNING Risk of burns from hot air bag
components
The air bag parts are hot after an air bag has
been deployed.
# Do not touch the air bag parts.
# Have a deployed air bag replaced at a
qualified specialist workshop as soon
as possible.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you have the
vehicle towed to a qualified specialist workshop
after an accident. Take this into account, partic‐
ularly if an Emergency Tensioning Device is trig‐
gered or an airbag deployed.
If the Emergency Tensioning Devices are trig‐
gered or an airbag is deployed, you will hear a
bang, and a small amount of powder may also be
released:
R The bang will not generally affect your hear‐
ing.
R In general, the powder released is not haz‐
ardous to health but may cause short-term
breathing difficulties to persons suffering
from asthma or other pulmonary conditions.
Provided it is safe to do so, leave the vehicle
immediately or open the window in order to
prevent breathing difficulties.
Airbags and pyrotechnic Emergency Tensioning
Devices contain perchlorate material, which may
require special handling or environmental pro‐
tection measures. National guidelines regarding
waste disposal must be observed. In California,
see https://dtsc.ca.gov/. Using the search
function, you will find information on perchlo‐
rate, for example.
Seat belts
Protection provided by the seat belt
Always fasten your seat belt correctly before
starting a journey. A seat belt can only provide
the best level of protection if it is worn correctly.
& WARNING Risk of injury or death due to
incorrectly fastened seat belt
If the seat belt is not worn correctly, it can‐
not perform its intended protective function.
In addition, an incorrectly fastened seat belt
can also cause injuries, for example, in the
event of an accident or when braking or
changing direction suddenly.
# Always ensure that all vehicle occu‐
pants have their seat belts fastened
correctly and are sitting properly.
Always observe the instructions about the cor‐
rect driver's seat position and adjusting the seat
(/ page 94).
Occupant safety
In order for the correctly worn seat belt to pro‐
vide the intended level of protection, each vehi‐
cle occupant must observe the following infor‐
mation:
R The seat belt must not be twisted and must
fit tightly and snugly across the body.
R The seat belt must be routed across the cen‐
ter of the shoulder and as low down across
the hips as possible.
R The shoulder section of the seat belt should
not touch your neck nor be routed under
your arm or behind your back.
R Avoid wearing bulky clothing, e.g. a winter
coat.
R Push the lap belt down as far as possible
across your hips and pull tight with the shoul‐
der section of the belt. Never route the lap
belt across your abdomen.
Pregnant women must also take particular
care with this.
R Never route the seat belt across sharp, poin‐
ted, abrasive or fragile objects.
R
R
Only one person should use each seat belt at
any one time. Never allow babies and chil‐
dren to travel sitting on the lap of another
vehicle occupant.
Never secure objects with a seat belt if the
seat belt is also being used by one of the
vehicle's occupants. Always observe the
instructions for loading the vehicle when
securing objects, luggage or loads
(/ page 119).
Also ensure that no objects, e.g. a cushion,
are ever placed between a person and the
seat.
The seat belts on the following seats are equip‐
ped with a special seat belt retractor:
R Front passenger seat
R Rear seats
Activate or deactivate the special seatbelt
retractor (/ page 56).
If children are traveling in the vehicle, be sure to
observe the instructions and safety notes on
"Children in the vehicle" (/ page 52).
39
Limitations of the protection provided by the
seat belt
& WARNING Risk of injury or death due to
an incorrect seat position
The seat belt does not offer the intended
level of protection if you have not moved the
seat backrest to an almost vertical position.
You could slip beneath the seat belt and
injure yourself.
# Adjust the seat properly before com‐
mencing your journey.
# Always ensure that the seat backrest is
in an almost vertical position and that
the shoulder belt is routed across the
center of your shoulder.
& WARNING Risk of injury or death when
additional restraint systems are not used
for persons with a smaller stature
Persons under 5 ft (1.50 m ) tall cannot wear
the seat belt correctly without a suitable
additional restraint system.
40
#
Occupant safety
Always secure persons under 5 ft
(1.50 m) tall in a suitable restraint sys‐
tem.
& WARNING Danger of injury or death due
to blocked seat belt anchorage
The restraint effect of the seat belt is
impaired if objects between the front seat
and the door are blocking the movable seat
belt anchorage on the front seat.
# Before starting a journey, make sure
that there are no objects between the
front seat and the door.
& WARNING Risk of injury or death due to
damaged or modified seat belts
Seat belts cannot provide protection in the
following situations:
R The seat belt is damaged, has been modi‐
fied, is extremely dirty, bleached or dyed
R
R
The seat belt buckle is damaged or
extremely dirty
Modifications have been made to the
Emergency Tensioning Device, seat belt
anchorage or seat belt retractor
Seat belts may sustain non-visible damage in
an accident, e.g. due to glass splinters.
Modified or damaged seat belts could tear or
fail in the event of an accident, for example.
Modified Emergency Tensioning Devices may
be deployed unintentionally or not function
as intended.
# Never modify the seat belts, Emergency
Tensioning Devices, seat belt ancho‐
rages or seat belt retractors.
# Make sure that the seat belts are not
damaged, are not worn and are clean.
# Always have the seat belts checked
immediately after an accident at a
qualified specialist workshop.
Only use seat belts which have been approved
for your vehicle by Mercedes-Benz.
& WARNING Risk of injury or death from
deployed pyrotechnic Emergency Ten‐
sioning Devices
Pyrotechnic Emergency Tensioning Devices
that have been deployed are no longer opera‐
tional and are unable to perform their inten‐
ded protective function.
# Therefore, have deployed pyrotechnic
Emergency Tensioning Devices immedi‐
ately replaced at a qualified specialist
workshop.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you have the
vehicle towed to a qualified specialist workshop
after an accident.
* NOTE Damage caused by trapping the
seat belt
If an unused seat belt is not fully retracted, it
may become trapped in the door or in the
seat mechanism.
# Always ensure that an unused seat belt
is fully retracted.
Occupant safety
Fastening and adjusting the seat belts
If the seat belt is pulled quickly or sharply, the
seat belt retractor locks. The seat belt strap can‐
not be pulled out any further.
#
#
Press and hold the seat belt outlet release
and slide seat belt outlet 3 into the desired
position.
Let go of the seat belt outlet release and
ensure that seat belt outlet 3 locks into
position.
* NOTE Deployment of the Emergency
Tensioning Device and side air bag when
the front passenger seat is unoccupied
If the seat belt tongue is engaged in the seat
belt buckle of the unoccupied front
passenger seat, the Emergency Tensioning
Device and the side air bag may also deploy
in the event of an accident along with other
systems.
# Only one person should use each seat
belt at any one time.
#
Always engage seat belt tongue 2 of the
seat belt into seat belt buckle 1 of the cor‐
responding seat.
Seat belt adjustment function
Vehicles with PRE-SAFE®: If the front seat belt
is not pulled tightly across your body, the seat
belt adjustment may automatically apply a cer‐
41
tain tightening force. Do not hold the seat belt
tightly while it is adjusting.
You can activate and deactivate the seat belt
adjustment function using the multimedia sys‐
tem (/ page 41).
Releasing seat belts
#
Press the release button in the seat belt
buckle and guide the seat belt back with the
seat belt tongue.
Activating/deactivating seat belt adjustment
via the multimedia system
Multimedia system:
4 © 5 Settings 5 Vehicle
# Activate or deactivate Belt Adjustment.
Seat belt warning function for the driver and
front passenger
The ü seat belt warning lamp in the instru‐
ment display is a reminder that all vehicle occu‐
pants must wear their seat belts correctly.
42
Occupant safety
The ü seat belt warning lamp lights up for six
seconds every time the vehicle is started.
In addition, a warning tone may sound.
When the driver's and front passenger's doors
are closed and the driver and front passenger
have fastened their seat belts, the seat belt
warning goes out.
In the following cases, the seat belt warning
lights up during a journey if:
R The vehicle speed exceeds 15 mph
(25 km/h) and the driver's or front
passenger seat belt is not fastened.
R The driver or front passenger unfastens their
seat belt while the vehicle is in motion.
Airbags
Overview of airbags
Potential protection provided by each airbag:
Knee airbag: thigh, knee and lower leg
R Driver's airbag, front passenger airbag: head
and ribcage
R Window curtain airbag: head
R Side airbag: ribcage and pelvis
R
& WARNING Risk of injury or fatal injuries
if the front passenger airbag is enabled
1
2
3
4
5
Driver's knee airbag
Driver's airbag
Front passenger airbag
Window curtain airbag
Side airbag
The installation location of an airbag is identified
by the AIRBAG symbol.
When enabled, an airbag can provide additional
protection for the respective vehicle occupant.
If the front passenger airbag is enabled, a
child on the front passenger seat may be
struck by the front passenger airbag during
an accident.
NEVER use a rearward facing child restraint
system on a seat protected by an ENABLED
FRONT AIRBAG in front of it, this can result in
DEATH or SERIOUS INJURY to the child.
When installing a child restraint system on the
front passenger seat, observe the vehicle-spe‐
cific information (/ page 62). Also, always
observe the notes on rearward-facing or
forward-facing child restraint systems on the
front passenger seat.
Occupant safety
Information on automatic front passenger
airbag shutoff
The front passenger airbag can only be deployed
in an accident if the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF
indicator lamp is off. If the front passenger seat
is occupied, make sure, both before and during
the journey, that the status of the front
passenger airbag is correct (/ page 47).
* NOTE Important points to remember if
the front passenger seat is unoccupied
In an accident, the components of the
restraint system may deploy unnecessarily
on the front passenger side if:
R There are heavy objects on the front
passenger seat.
R The seat belt tongue is engaged in the
seat belt buckle of the front passenger
seat and the front passenger seat is
unoccupied.
#
#
Stow objects in a suitable place.
Only one person should use each seat
belt at any one time.
Depending on the detected accident situation,
the window curtain airbag on the front
passenger side may deploy. The airbag is
deployed regardless of whether the front
passenger seat is occupied.
Information on the cushionbag in the reclin‐
ing rear seat
The cushionbag offers additional occupant pro‐
tection in the event of frontal impacts. When
activated, the cushionbag deploys under the
seat cushion. This helps prevent the vehicle
occupant from slipping off the seat cushion.
If you install a child restraint system on the
reclining rear seat, always observe the additional
notes (/ page 52).
Protection provided by the airbags
Depending on the accident situation, an airbag
may supplement the protection provided by a
correctly fastened seat belt.
43
& WARNING Risk of injury or death due to
an incorrect seat position
If you deviate from the correct seat position,
the airbag cannot perform its intended pro‐
tective function.
Each vehicle occupant must make sure of the
following:
R Fasten seat belts correctly. Pregnant
women must take particular care to
ensure that the lap belt never lies across
the abdomen.
R Adopt the correct seat position and keep
as far away as possible from the airbags.
R Observe the following information.
#
Always make sure that there are no
objects between the airbag and vehicle
occupant.
To avoid the risks resulting from the deployment
of an airbag, each vehicle occupant must
observe the following information in particular:
R Before starting your journey, adjust your seat
correctly; the driver's seat and front
44
R
R
R
R
R
Occupant safety
passenger seat should be moved as far back
as possible.
When doing so, always observe the informa‐
tion on the correct driver's seat position
(/ page 94).
Only hold the steering wheel by the steering
wheel rim. This allows the airbag to be fully
deployed.
Always lean against the seat backrest when
the vehicle is in motion. Do not lean forwards
or against the door or side window. You may
otherwise be in the deployment area of the
airbags.
Always keep your feet on the floor. Do not
put your feet on the cockpit, for example.
Your feet may otherwise be in the deploy‐
ment area of the airbag.
If children are traveling in the vehicle,
observe the additional notes (/ page 52).
Always stow and secure objects correctly.
Objects in the vehicle interior may prevent an
airbag from functioning correctly. Each vehicle
occupant must always make sure of the follow‐
ing in particular:
R There are no people, animals or objects
between the vehicle occupants and an air‐
bag.
R There are no objects between the seat, door
and door pillar (B-pillar).
R There are no hard objects, e.g. coat hangers,
hanging on the grab handles or coat hooks.
R There are no accessory parts, such as mobile
navigation devices, mobile phones or cup
holders, attached to the vehicle within the
deployment area of an airbag, e.g. on the
cockpit, on the door, on the side window or
on the side wall trim.
In addition, no connecting cables, tensioning
straps or retaining straps must be routed or
attached to the vehicle within the deploy‐
ment area of an airbag. Always comply with
the accessory manufacturer's installation
instructions and, in particular, the notes on
suitable places for installation.
R
There are no heavy, sharp-edged or fragile
objects in the pockets of your clothing. Store
such objects in a suitable place.
Limited protection provided by airbags
& WARNING Risk of injury due to modifi‐
cations to the cover of an airbag
If you modify the cover of an airbag or affix
objects such as stickers to it, the airbag may
no longer function correctly.
# Never modify the cover of an airbag and
do not affix objects to it.
The installation location of an airbag is identified
by the airbag symbol (/ page 42).
& WARNING Risk of injury or death due to
the use of unsuitable seat covers
Due to unsuitable seat covers, the airbags
cannot protect vehicle occupants as inten‐
ded.
Occupant safety
In addition, the operation of the automatic
front passenger airbag shutoff could be
restricted.
# You should only use seat covers that
have been approved for the correspond‐
ing seats by Mercedes-Benz.
& WARNING Risk of injury due to malfunc‐
tioning sensors in the door
The function of the airbags can be impaired
due to modifications or incorrect work per‐
formed on the doors or door trim, or if the
doors are damaged.
# Never modify the doors or parts of the
doors.
# Always have work on the doors or door
trim carried out at a qualified specialist
workshop.
& WARNING Risk of injury due to deployed
airbag
A deployed airbag no longer offers any pro‐
tection.
#
Have the vehicle towed to a qualified
specialist workshop in order to have the
deployed airbag replaced.
R
R
Have deployed airbags replaced immediately.
R
Status of the front passenger front airbag
Function of the automatic front passenger
airbag shutoff
The automatic front passenger airbag shutoff is
able to detect whether the front passenger seat
is occupied by a person or a child restraint sys‐
tem. The front passenger airbag is enabled or
disabled accordingly.
When installing a child restraint system on the
front passenger seat, always make sure of the
following:
R Ensure that the child restraint system is posi‐
tioned correctly (/ page 51).
R Always comply with the child restraint sys‐
tem manufacturer's installation instructions.
R Never place objects (e.g. cushions) under or
behind the child restraint system.
R
45
Fully retract the seat cushion length adjust‐
ment.
The entire base of the child restraint system
must always rest on the sitting surface of the
front passenger seat.
The backrest of the forward-facing child
restraint system must, as far as possible, be
resting on the seat backrest of the front
passenger seat.
The child restraint system must not touch the
roof or be put under strain by the head
restraints. Adjust the seat backrest inclina‐
tion and the head restraint setting accord‐
ingly.
& WARNING Risk of injury or death due to
objects between the seat surface and
the child restraint system
Objects between the sitting surface and the
child restraint system could affect the func‐
tion of the automatic front passenger airbag
shutoff.
46
#
#
#
#
Occupant safety
Do not place any objects between the
sitting surface and the child restraint
system.
The entire base of the child restraint
system must always rest on the sitting
surface of the front passenger seat.
The backrest of the forward-facing child
restraint system must, as far as possi‐
ble, be resting on the seat backrest of
the front passenger seat.
Always comply with the child restraint
system manufacturer's installation
instructions.
A person on the front passenger seat must
observe the following information:
R Fasten seat belts correctly (/ page 38).
R Sit in an almost upright seat position with
their back against the seat backrest.
R Sit with their feet resting on the floor, if pos‐
sible.
The front passenger airbag may otherwise be
disabled by mistake, for example, in the follow‐
ing situations:
R The front passenger transfers their weight by
supporting themselves on a vehicle armrest.
R The front passenger sits in such a way that
their weight is raised from the sitting sur‐
face.
& WARNING Risk of injury or death due to
a disabled front passenger airbag
The front passenger airbag is disabled when
the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp
is lit.
A person in the front passenger seat could
then, for example, come into contact with
the vehicle interior, especially if the person is
sitting too close to the cockpit.
If the front passenger seat is occupied,
always ensure that:
R The classification of the person in the
front passenger seat is correct and the
R
R
#
front passenger airbag is enabled or disa‐
bled in accordance with the person in the
front passenger seat.
The front passenger seat has been moved
as far back as possible.
The person is seated correctly.
Both before and during the journey,
ensure that the status of the front
passenger airbag is correct.
If the front passenger seat is occupied, the clas‐
sification of the person or child restraint system
on the front passenger seat takes place after the
front passenger airbag shutoff self-test. The
PASSENGER AIR BAG indicator lamps display the
status of the front passenger airbag.
Always observe the notes on the function of the
PASSENGER AIR BAG indicator lamps
(/ page 47).
Occupant safety
Function of the PASSENGER AIR BAG indica‐
tor lamps
Self-test of automatic front passenger airbag
shutoff
When the ignition is switched on, a self-test is
performed during which the two PASSENGER
AIR BAG ON and OFF indicator lamps light up
simultaneously.
The status of the front passenger airbag is dis‐
played via the PASSENGER AIR BAG indicator
lamps after the self-test:
R ON is lit: the front passenger airbag may
deploy during an accident.
The indicator lamp goes out after approx‐
imately 60 seconds.
R ON and OFF are not lit: the front passenger
airbag may deploy during an accident.
R OFF is lit: the front passenger airbag is disa‐
bled. It will then not be deployed in the event
of an accident.
If the PASSENGER AIR BAG ON indicator lamp is
off, only the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator
lamp shows the status of the front passenger
airbag. The PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator
lamp may be lit continuously or be off.
If the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp
and the 6 restraint system warning lamp
light up simultaneously, the front passenger seat
may not be used. Also in this case, do not install
a child restraint system on the front passenger
seat. Have the automatic front passenger airbag
47
shutoff checked and repaired immediately at a
qualified specialist workshop.
Status display
If the front passenger seat is occupied, ensure,
both before and during the journey, that the sta‐
tus of the front passenger airbag is correct for
the current situation.
After installing a rearward-facing child
restraint system on the front passenger
seat: PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF must be lit con‐
tinuously.
& WARNING Risk of injury or death when
using a rearward-facing child restraint
system while the front passenger airbag
is enabled
If you secure a child in a rearward-facing
child restraint system on the front passenger
seat and the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indi‐
cator lamp is off, the front passenger airbag
can deploy in the event of an accident.
The child could be struck by the airbag.
48
Occupant safety
Always ensure that the front passenger air‐
bag is disabled. The PASSENGER AIR BAG
OFF indicator lamp must be lit.
NEVER use a rearward-facing child restraint
system on a seat with an ENABLED FRONT
AIRBAG; DEATH or SERIOUS INJURY to the
CHILD can occur.
When installing a child restraint system on the
front passenger seat, observe the vehicle-spe‐
cific information (/ page 62).
Depending on the child restraint system and the
stature of the child, the PASSENGER AIR BAG
OFF indicator lamp may be off. In this case, do
not install the rearward-facing child restraint
system on the front passenger seat.
Instead, install the rearward-facing child
restraint system on a suitable rear seat.
After installing a forward-facing child
restraint system on the front passenger
seat: depending on the child restraint system
and the stature of the child, PASSENGER AIR
BAG OFF may be lit continuously or be off.
Always observe the following information.
& WARNING Risk of injury or death due to
incorrect positioning of the forwardfacing child restraint system
If you secure a child in a forward-facing child
restraint system on the front passenger seat
that is positioned too close to the cockpit, in
the event of an accident, the child could:
R come into contact with the vehicle inte‐
rior if the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indi‐
cator lamp is lit, for example
R be struck by the airbag if the PASSENGER
AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp is off.
#
Always move the front passenger seat
as far back as possible and fully retract
the seat cushion length adjustment.
While doing so, always make sure that
the shoulder belt strap is correctly
routed from the seat belt outlet of the
vehicle to the shoulder belt guide on
the child restraint system. The shoulder
belt strap must be routed forwards and
downwards from the seat belt outlet. If
necessary, adjust the seat belt outlet
#
and the front passenger seat accord‐
ingly.
Always comply with the child restraint
system manufacturer's installation
instructions.
When installing a child restraint system on the
front passenger seat, observe the vehicle-spe‐
cific information (/ page 62).
If a person is sitting on the front passenger
seat: PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF may be lit con‐
tinuously or be off, depending on the person's
stature.
A person on the front passenger seat must
always observe the following information:
R If the front passenger seat is occupied by an
adult or a person with a stature correspond‐
ing to that of an adult, the PASSENGER AIR
BAG OFF indicator lamp must be off. This
indicates that the front passenger airbag is
enabled.
If the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator
lamp is lit continuously, an adult or person
Occupant safety
R
with a build corresponding to that of an adult
should not use the front passenger seat.
Instead, they should use a rear seat.
If the front passenger seat is occupied by a
person of smaller stature (e.g. a teenager or
small adult), the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF
indicator lamp either lights up continuously
or remains off, depending on the classifica‐
tion.
If the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator
lamp is off: move the front passenger
seat as far back as possible, or the per‐
son of smaller stature should use a rear
seat.
If the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator
lamp is lit continuously: the person of
smaller stature should not use the front
passenger seat.
& WARNING Risk of injury or death when
the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator
lamp is lit
If the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator
lamp remains lit after the self-test, the front
passenger airbag is disabled.
If the front passenger seat is occupied,
always ensure that:
R The classification of the person in the
front passenger seat is correct and the
front passenger airbag is enabled or disa‐
bled in accordance with the person in the
front passenger seat.
R The person is seated properly with a cor‐
rectly fastened seat belt.
Be sure to also observe the following further
related subjects:
R Securing the child restraint system on the
front passenger seat (/ page 62)
49
PRE-SAFE® system
PRE-SAFE® (anticipatory occupant protec‐
tion)
PRE-SAFE® is able to detect certain critical driv‐
ing situations and implement pre-emptive meas‐
ures to protect the vehicle occupants.
PRE-SAFE® can implement the following meas‐
ures independently of each other:
R Tightening the seat belts on the driver's seat
and front passenger seat.
R Closing the side windows.
R Vehicles with sliding sunroof: Close the
sliding sunroof.
R Vehicles with memory function: Move the
front passenger seat to a more favorable
seat position.
R Vehicles with memory function in the
rear passenger compartment: move the
outer rear seats to a more favorable seat
position.
50
R
R
Occupant safety
Vehicles with multicontour seat: Increase
the air pressure in the seat side bolsters of
the seat backrest.
PRE-SAFE® Sound: provided that the multi‐
media system is switched on, generates a
brief noise signal to stimulate the innate pro‐
tective mechanism of a person's hearing.
* NOTE Damage caused by objects in the
footwell or behind the seat
The automatic adjustment of the seat posi‐
tion may result in damage to the seat and/or
the object.
# Stow objects in a suitable place.
Reversing the PRE-SAFE® system measures
If an accident did not occur, the pre-emptive
measures that were taken are reversed.
You will need to perform certain settings your‐
self.
#
If the seat belt pre-tensioning is not reduced,
move the seat backrest back slightly.
The locking mechanism releases.
Function of PRE-SAFE® PLUS (anticipatory
occupant protection plus)
PRE-SAFE® PLUS can detect certain impacts,
particularly an imminent rear impact, and take
pre-emptive measures to protect the vehicle
occupants. These measures cannot necessarily
prevent an imminent impact.
PRE-SAFE® PLUS can implement the following
measures independently of each other:
R Tightening the seat belts on the driver's seat
and front passenger seat.
R Increasing brake pressure when the vehicle
is stationary. This brake application is can‐
celed automatically when the vehicle pulls
away.
If an accident did not occur, the pre-emptive
measures that were taken are reversed.
System limits
The system will not initiate any action in the fol‐
lowing situations:
R when backing up
or
R when the vehicle is towing a trailer and there
is a risk of a rear impact
The system will not initiate any braking applica‐
tion in the following situations:
R whilst driving
or
R when entering or exiting a parking space
while using Active Parking Assist
Function of PRE-SAFE® Impulse Side
If an imminent side impact is detected, PRESAFE® Impulse Side can pre-emptively move the
front seat vehicle occupant's upper body
towards the center of the vehicle. It does this by
rapidly inflating an air cushion in the outer seat
side bolster of the seat backrest on the side on
which the impact is anticipated. This increases
Occupant safety
the distance between the door and the vehicle
occupant.
If PRE-SAFE® Impulse Side has been deployed or
is faulty, the PRE-SAFE Impulse Side Inoperative
See Operator's Manual display message appears
(/ page 409).
Automatic measures after an accident
Depending on the type and severity of the acci‐
dent, and depending on the vehicle's equipment,
the following measures can be implemented, for
example:
R Automatic braking (post-collision brake)
R Activating the hazard warning lights
R Triggering an automatic emergency call
(/ page 310)
R Switching off the engine
To restart the vehicle, switch the ignition off
and switch it back on (/ page 169).
Depending on the type and severity of the
accident, it is possible that the vehicle can
no longer be started.
R
R
R
R
R
Switching off the fuel supply
Unlocking the vehicle doors
Lowering the side windows
Displaying the emergency guide in the multi‐
media system display
Switching on the interior lighting
Function of the post-collision brake
Depending on the accident situation, the postcollision brake can minimize the severity of a fur‐
ther collision or even avoid it.
If an accident is detected, the post-collision
brake can implement automatic braking. When
the vehicle has come to a standstill, the electric
parking brake is automatically applied.
The driver can cancel automatic braking by tak‐
ing the following actions:
R Braking more strongly than automatic brak‐
ing
R Fully depressing the accelerator pedal with
force
51
Safely transporting children in the vehicle
Always observe when children are traveling
in the vehicle
% Also strictly observe the safety notes for the
specific situation. In this way you can recog‐
nize potential risks and avoid dangers if chil‐
dren are traveling in the vehicle
(/ page 52).
Be diligent
Bear in mind that negligence when securing the
child in the child restraint system may have seri‐
ous consequences. Always be diligent in secur‐
ing a child carefully before every journey.
To improve protection for children younger than
twelve years old or under 5 ft (1.50 m) in height,
Mercedes-Benz recommends you observe the
following information:
R Always secure the child in a child restraint
system suitable for this Mercedes-Benz vehi‐
cle.
R The child restraint system must be appropri‐
ate to the age, weight and size of the child.
52
R
Occupant safety
The vehicle seat must be suitable for instal‐
ling a child restraint system.
Accident statistics show that children secured
on the rear seats are generally safer than chil‐
dren secured on the front seats. For this reason,
Mercedes-Benz strongly advises that you install
a child restraint system on a rear seat.
The generic term child restraint system
The generic term child restraint system is used
in this Operator's Manual. A child restraint sys‐
tem is, for example:
R a baby car seat
R a rearward-facing child seat
R a forward-facing child seat
R a child booster seat with a backrest and seat
belt guide
Mercedes-Benz recommends using a child
booster seat with a backrest.
The child restraint system must be appropriate
to the age, weight and size of the child.
Observe laws and legal requirements
Always observe the legal requirements when
using a child restraint system in the vehicle.
Observe standards for child restraint sys‐
tems
All child restraint systems must meet the follow‐
ing standards:
R U.S. Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standards
213 and 225
R Canadian Motor Vehicle Safety Standards
213 and 210.2
Confirmation that the child restraint system
complies with the standards can be found on an
instruction label on the child restraint system.
This confirmation can also be found in the instal‐
lation instructions that are included with the
child restraint system.
Detecting risks, avoiding danger
Securing systems for child restraint systems
in the vehicle
Only use the following securing systems for child
restraint systems:
R the LATCH-type (ISOFIX) mounting brackets
R the vehicle's seat belt system
R the Top Tether anchorages
Installing a LATCH-type (ISOFIX) child restraint
system is preferred.
Simply attaching to the securing rings on the
vehicle can reduce the risk of installing the child
restraint system incorrectly.
When securing a child with the integrated seat
belt of the LATCH-type (ISOFIX) child restraint
system, always comply with the permissible
gross weight for the child and child restraint sys‐
tem (/ page 57).
A booster seat may be necessary to achieve
proper seat belt positioning for children over
40 lbs (18 kg) in weight or until they reach a
Occupant safety
height where a three-point seat belt can be fas‐
tened properly without a booster seat.
Mercedes-Benz recommends a suitable child
booster seat with a backrest and seat belt guide.
Advantage of a rearward-facing child
restraint system
It is preferable to transport a baby or a small
child in a suitable rearward-facing child restraint
system. In this case, the child sits in the oppo‐
site direction to the direction of travel and faces
backwards.
Babies and small children have comparatively
weak neck muscles in relation to the size and
weight of their head. The risk of injury to the cer‐
vical spine during an accident can be reduced in
a rearward-facing child restraint system.
Always secure a child restraint system cor‐
rectly
& WARNING Risk of injury or death due to
incorrect installation of the child
restraint system
The child can then not be protected or
restrained as intended.
# Be sure to comply with the manufactur‐
er's installation instructions for the
child restraint system and its correct
use.
# Make sure that the entire base of the
child restraint system always rests on
the sitting surface of the seat.
# Never place objects (e.g. cushions)
under or behind the child restraint sys‐
tem.
# Use child restraint systems only with
the original cover designed for them.
# Always replace damaged covers with
genuine covers.
53
& WARNING Risk of injury or death due to
unsecured child restraint systems in the
vehicle
If the child restraint system is incorrectly
installed or not secured, it can come loose.
The child restraint system could be flung
around and hit vehicle occupants.
# Always install child restraint systems
correctly, even when not in use.
# Always comply with the child restraint
system manufacturer's installation
instructions.
R
Always observe the child restraint system
manufacturer's installation and operating
instructions as well as the vehicle-specific
information:
Installing the LATCH-type (ISOFIX) child
restraint system on the rear seat
(/ page 57).
Securing the child restraint system with
the seat belt on the rear seat
(/ page 61).
54
Occupant safety
Securing the child restraint system with
the seat belt on the front passenger seat
(/ page 63). Observe the specific
instructions for the rearward-facing and
forward-facing child restraint systems
(/ page 62).
If the front passenger seat is occupied,
ensure, both before and during the jour‐
ney, that the status of the front
passenger airbag is correct for the cur‐
rent situation (/ page 47).
Observe the warning labels in the vehicle
interior and on the child restraint system.
Also secure Top Tether if present.
-
R
R
Do not alter the child restraint system
& WARNING Risk of injury due to modifi‐
cations to the child restraint system
The child restraint system can no longer
function properly. This poses an increased
risk of injury.
# Never modify a child restraint system.
#
Only affix accessories which have been
specially approved for this child
restraint system by the child restraint
system's manufacturer.
Only use child restraint systems which are in
proper working condition
& WARNING Risk of injury or death caused
by the use of damaged child restraint
systems
Child restraint systems or their retaining sys‐
tems that have been subjected to stress in
an accident may not be able to perform their
intended protective function.
It may be the case that the child cannot be
properly restrained.
# Always immediately replace child
restraint systems that have been dam‐
aged or involved in an accident.
# Have the securing systems for the child
restraint systems checked at a qualified
specialist workshop before installing a
child restraint system again.
Avoid direct sunlight
& WARNING Risk of burns when the child
seat is exposed to direct sunlight
If the child restraint system is exposed to
direct sunlight or heat, parts could heat up.
Children could suffer burns from these parts,
particularly on the metallic parts of the child
restraint system.
# Always make sure that the child
restraint system is not exposed to
direct sunlight.
# Protect the child restraint system with a
blanket, for example.
# If the child restraint system has been
exposed to direct sunlight, allow it to
cool before securing a child into it.
# Never leave children unattended in the
vehicle.
Occupant safety
Observe when stopping or parking
& WARNING Risk of accident and injury
due to children left unattended in the
vehicle
If children are left unsupervised in the vehi‐
cle, they could, in particular:
R Open doors, thereby endangering other
persons or road users.
R Get out and be struck by oncoming traf‐
fic.
R Operate vehicle equipment and become
trapped, for example.
In addition, the children could also set the
vehicle in motion, for example by:
R Releasing the parking brake.
R Change the transmission position.
R Start the vehicle.
#
Never leave children unattended in the
vehicle.
#
#
When leaving the vehicle, always take
the SmartKey with you and lock the
vehicle.
Keep the SmartKey out of reach of chil‐
dren.
& WARNING Risk of fatal injury due to
exposure to extreme heat or cold in the
vehicle
If people – particularly children – are
exposed to extreme temperatures over an
extended period of time, there is a risk of
serious or even fatal injury.
# Never leave anyone – particularly chil‐
dren – unattended in the vehicle.
# Never leave animals in the vehicle unat‐
tended.
55
Overview of suitable seats in the vehicle for
installing a child restraint system
Left/right rear seat
Second row of seats, preferred securing system:
® LATCH-type (ISOFIX) child seat securing
system
¯ Also secure Top Tether if present
(/ page 60)
Third row of seats, preferred securing system:
® LATCH-type (ISOFIX) child seat securing
system
¯ Also secure Top Tether if present
(/ page 60)
Left/right rear seat (second and third seat row)
– alternative securing system:
7 Vehicle seat belt
Front passenger seat
Securing system:
7 Vehicle seat belt
56
Occupant safety
Be sure to observe:
If the front passenger seat is occupied,
ensure, both before and during the journey,
that the status of the front passenger airbag
is correct for the current situation
(/ page 47).
R Observe the notes on automatic front
passenger airbag shutoff (/ page 45)
R
Center rear seat
Center rear seat (second seat row) – securing
system:
7 Vehicle seat belt
¯ Also secure Top Tether if present
(/ page 60)
Activating or deactivating the child seat
safety feature of the seat belt
& WARNING Risk of injury or death if a
seat belt is unfastened while the vehicle
is in motion
If the seat belt is released while the vehicle is
in motion, the child safety lock is deactivated
and the child restraint system is no longer
correctly secured. The seat belt is retracted
slightly by the inertia reel and cannot be
immediately fastened again.
# Stop the vehicle immediately in accord‐
ance with the traffic conditions.
# Activate the special seat belt retractor
again and correctly secure the child
restraint system.
When enabled, the child seat safety feature
ensures that the seat belts of the front
passenger seat and rear seats do not slacken
once the child restraint system is secured.
The seat belts on the following seats are equip‐
ped with a child seat safety feature:
R Front passenger seat
R Rear seats
#
#
#
#
#
#
To install a child restraint system: when
installing a child restraint system, always
observe the manufacturer's installation and
operating instructions as well as the informa‐
tion in this Operator's Manual.
Pull the seat belt smoothly from the seat belt
outlet.
Engage the seat belt tongue in the seat belt
buckle.
To activate the child seat safety feature:
pull the seat belt out fully and let the inertia
reel retract it again.
When the child seat safety feature is activa‐
ted, you will hear a ratcheting sound.
Push the child restraint system down until
the seat belt sits tightly.
To deactivate the child seat safety fea‐
ture: press the release button of the seat
belt buckle.
Occupant safety
#
Hold the seat belt tongue and guide back to
the seat belt outlet.
Installing a LATCH-type (ISOFIX) child
restraint system on the rear seat
Installing a LATCH-type (ISOFIX) child
restraint system on the rear seat
& WARNING Risk of accident if the rear
bench seat, rear seat and seat backrest
are not engaged
The rear bench seat, rear seat and seat back‐
rest may fold forwards, even when you are
driving.
R As a result, the vehicle occupant will be
pushed into the seat belt with increased
force. The seat belt will not be able to
protect as intended and could cause
additional injury.
R Objects or loads in the trunk or cargo
compartment will not be restrained by
the seat backrest.
#
Make sure that the rear bench seat, the
rear seat and the seat backrest are
engaged before every trip.
If the seat backrest is not engaged and locked in
place, this will be shown on the multifunction
display on the instrument cluster (fold rear seat
back electrically) or the red lock verification indi‐
cator will be visible (fold rear seat back mechani‐
cally).
& WARNING Risk of injury or death if the
permissible gross mass of the child and
child restraint system is exceeded
Too much load may be placed on the LATCHtype (ISOFIX) child seat securing systems
and the child may not be restrained in the
event of an accident, for example.
# If the child and the child restraint sys‐
tem together weigh more than the per‐
missible gross mass of 73 lb (33 kg),
use only a LATCH-type (ISOFIX) child
restraint system that secures the child
with the vehicle seat belt.
#
57
Also secure the child restraint system
with the Top Tether belt, if available.
Always comply with the information about the
mass of the child restraint system:
R in the manufacturer's installation and operat‐
ing instructions for the child restraint system
used
R on a label on the child restraint system, if
present
Regularly check that the permissible gross mass
of the child and child restraint system is still
complied with.
When installing a child restraint system, observe
the following:
O Always observe the correct use of the seats
and consider their suitability for attaching a
child restraint system.
O Always comply with the manufacturer's
installation and operating instructions for
the child restraint system used.
58
Occupant safety
O Make sure that the child's feet do not touch
the front seat. If necessary, move the front
seat slightly forwards.
® When installing a LATCH-type (ISOFIX)
child restraint system, also observe the follow‐
ing:
O When using a Group 0/0+ baby car seat
and a Group I rearward-facing child
restraint system on a rear seat: adjust
the front seat so that the seat does not
touch the child restraint system.
O When using a Group I forward-facing
child restraint system: remove the head
restraint from the respective seat, if possi‐
ble. In addition, the backrest of the child
restraint system must lie as flat as possible
against the backrest of the vehicle seat.
After the child restraint system has been
removed, replace the head restraint immedi‐
ately and adjust all head restraints cor‐
rectly.
O When using a child restraint system on
a seat on the third row of seats: adjust
the front seat so that it does not touch the
child restraint system and move the seat
backrest of the front seat into an upright
position if necessary.
O For certain child restraint systems in weight
group II or III, there may be restrictions on
the maximum size setting, e.g. due to possi‐
ble contact with the roof.
O The child restraint system must not be
installed between the roof and the seat
cushion and/or be installed facing the
wrong direction. Where possible, adjust the
seat cushion inclination accordingly.
O The child restraint system must not be put
under strain by the head restraint. Adjust
the head restraints accordingly.
#
* NOTE Damage to the seat belt for the
center seat during installation of the
child restraint system
#
Make sure that the seat belt is not trap‐
ped.
Vehicles with individual rear seats:
Before every journey, make sure that the
LATCH-type (ISOFIX) child restraint system is
engaged in both mounting brackets in the
vehicle.
1 LATCH-type (ISOFIX) mounting bracket
Occupant safety
#
#
#
Remove and store away covers 1 of the
mounting brackets in the vehicle.
Attach the LATCH-type (ISOFIX) child
restraint system to both mounting brackets
in the vehicle.
After removing the child restraint system,
reattach covers 1.
Vehicles with a rear bench seat:
#
#
#
#
#
#
Mercedes-Maybach vehicles with reclin‐
ing rear seats: Before a LATCH-type (ISO‐
FIX) or i-Size child restraint system is instal‐
led, tilt the reclining rear seat backrest back
slightly.
Remove upholstered lining 1.
Vehicles without reclining rear seats: Fold
upholstered lining 1 upwards.
Turn the support on the back of upholstered
lining 1 by 90°.
Upholstered lining 1 will remain folded
upwards.
Attach the LATCH-type (ISOFIX) child
restraint system to both mounting brackets
2 in the vehicle.
Mercedes-Maybach vehicles with reclin‐
ing rear seats: Return the reclining rear seat
backrest to an upright position.
The reclining rear seat backrest must be in
contact with the child restraint system.
59
Vehicles with a third row of seats:
#
Attach the LATCH-type (ISOFIX) child
restraint system to both LATCH-type (ISOFIX)
mounting brackets 1.
60
Occupant safety
Securing a Top Tether
& WARNING Risk of injury or death if the
rear seat backrests are not locked after
installing Top Tether belts
The rear seat backrests may fold forwards
when driving.
In this case, child restraint systems may no
longer perform their intended protective
function. Additional injuries may also be
caused.
# Always lock rear seat backrests after
installing Top Tether belts.
# Pay attention to the lock verification
indicator.
If the seat backrest is not engaged and locked in
place, this will be shown on the multifunction
display on the instrument cluster (fold rear seat
back electrically) or the red lock verification indi‐
cator will be visible (fold rear seat back mechani‐
cally).
¯ If the child restraint system is equipped
with a Top Tether belt:
The risk of injury can be reduced by a Top
Tether. The Top Tether belt enables an
additional connection between the child
restraint system attached with LATCHtype (ISOFIX) and the vehicle.
The Top Tether anchorages for the second row of
seats are located on the back of the seat back‐
rest. For the third row of seats, use the Top
Tether anchorage on the back of the seat back‐
rest.
Second row of seats
Occupant safety
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
If necessary, slide head restraint 1 upwards
(/ page 105).
Install the LATCH-type (ISOFIX) child restraint
system with Top Tether. Comply with the
child restraint system manufacturer's instal‐
lation instructions.
Guide Top Tether belt 5 under head
restraint 1 between the two head restraint
bars.
If cargo compartment cover 3 is installed,
guide Top Tether belt 5 downwards
between cargo compartment cover 3 and
seat backrest 2.
Hook Top Tether hook 6 of Top Tether belt
5 into Top Tether anchorage 4 without
twisting.
Tension Top Tether belt 5. Comply with the
child restraint system manufacturer's instal‐
lation instructions.
If necessary, slide head restraint 1 down‐
wards (/ page 105). Make sure that you do
not interfere with the correct routing of Top
Tether belt 5.
Securing the child restraint system with the
seat belt
Securing the child restraint system with the
seat belt on the rear seat
& WARNING Risk of accident if the rear
bench seat, rear seat and seat backrest
are not engaged
The rear bench seat, rear seat and seat back‐
rest may fold forwards, even when you are
driving.
R
R
#
61
As a result, the vehicle occupant will be
pushed into the seat belt with increased
force. The seat belt will not be able to
protect as intended and could cause
additional injury.
Objects or loads in the trunk or cargo
compartment will not be restrained by
the seat backrest.
Make sure that the rear bench seat, the
rear seat and the seat backrest are
engaged before every trip.
If the seat backrest is not engaged and locked in
place, this will be shown on the multifunction
display on the instrument cluster (fold rear seat
back electrically) or the red lock verification indi‐
cator will be visible (fold rear seat back mechani‐
cally).
When installing a belt-secured child
restraint system, observe the following:
O Always comply with the manufacturer's
installation and operating instructions for
the child restraint system used.
62
Occupant safety
O When using a category 0/0+ baby car
seat and a category I rearward-facing
child restraint system on a rear seat:
adjust the front seat so that the seat does
not touch the child restraint system.
O When using a category I forward-facing
child restraint system: remove the head
restraint from the respective seat, if possi‐
ble.
After the child restraint system has been
removed, replace the head restraint immedi‐
ately and adjust all head restraints cor‐
rectly.
O The backrest of the forward-facing child
restraint system must, as far as possible, be
resting on the seat backrest of the rear
seat.
O For certain child restraint systems in weight
category II or III, there may be restrictions
on the maximum size setting, e.g. due to
possible contact with the roof.
O The child restraint system must not be put
under strain between the roof and the seat
cushion and/or be installed facing the
outlet of the vehicle to the shoulder belt
guide on the child restraint system.
The shoulder belt strap must be routed for‐
wards and downwards from the seat belt out‐
let.
wrong direction. Where possible, adjust the
seat cushion inclination accordingly.
O The child restraint system must not be put
under strain by the head restraint. Adjust
the head restraints accordingly.
O Make sure that the child's feet do not touch
the front seat. If necessary, move the front
seat slightly forwards.
Notes on rearward-facing and forward-facing
child restraint systems on the front
passenger seat
The seat belts on the following seats are equip‐
ped with a special seat belt retractor:
R Front passenger seat
R Rear seats
& WARNING Risk of injury or death when
using a rearward-facing child restraint
system while the front passenger airbag
is enabled
When enabled, the special seat belt retractor
ensures that the seat belts of the front
passenger seat and rear seats do not slacken
once the child restraint system is secured
(/ page 56).
# Install the child restraint system.
The entire base of the child restraint system
must always rest on the sitting surface of the
rear seat.
# Always make sure that the shoulder belt
strap is correctly routed from the seat belt
If you secure a child in a rearward-facing
child restraint system on the front passenger
seat and the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indi‐
cator lamp is off, the front passenger airbag
can deploy in the event of an accident.
The child could be struck by the airbag.
Always ensure that the front passenger air‐
bag is disabled. The PASSENGER AIR BAG
OFF indicator lamp must be lit.
Occupant safety
NEVER use a rearward-facing child restraint
system on a seat with an ENABLED FRONT
AIRBAG; DEATH or SERIOUS INJURY to the
CHILD can occur.
Observe the specific instructions for rearwardfacing and forward-facing child restraint systems
(/ page 63).
Always observe the status of the front passenger
airbag on the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indica‐
tor lamp:
R When using a rearward-facing child restraint
system on the front passenger seat, the front
passenger airbag must always be disabled.
This is only the case if the PASSENGER AIR
BAG OFF indicator lamp is lit continuously
(/ page 47).
R If the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator
lamp is off, the front passenger airbag is ena‐
bled. The front passenger airbag may deploy
during an accident.
Securing the child restraint system with the
seat belt on the front passenger seat
When installing a belt-secured child restraint
system on the front passenger seat, always
observe the following:
O Observe the child restraint system manufac‐
turer's installation and operating instruc‐
tions.
O When using a forward-facing child restraint
system in category I: remove the head
restraint from the respective seat, if possi‐
ble.
After the child restraint system has been
removed, replace the head restraint immedi‐
ately and adjust all head restraints cor‐
rectly.
O The backrest of the forward-facing child
restraint system must, as far as possible, be
resting on the seat backrest of the front
passenger seat.
O For certain child restraint systems in weight
category II or III, there may be restrictions
on the maximum size setting, e.g. due to
possible contact with the roof.
63
O The child restraint system must not be put
under strain between the roof and the seat
cushion and/or be installed facing the
wrong direction.
O The child restraint system must not be put
under strain by the head restraint. Adjust
the head restraints accordingly.
O Never place objects (e.g. cushions) under or
behind the child restraint system.
The seat belt on the front passenger side is
equipped with a child seat safety feature.
When enabled, the child seat safety feature
ensures that the seat belt does not slacken once
the child seat is secured (/ page 56).
# Set the front passenger seat as far back as
possible and move the seat into the highest
position if possible.
# Fully retract the seat cushion length adjust‐
ment.
# Adjust the seat cushion inclination so that
the front edge of the seat cushion is in the
highest position and the rear edge of the
seat cushion is in the lowest position.
64
#
#
#
#
Occupant safety
Set the seat backrest to the most vertical
position possible.
Install the child restraint system.
The entire base of the child restraint system
must always rest on the sitting surface of the
front passenger seat.
Always make sure that the shoulder belt
strap is correctly routed from the seat belt
outlet of the vehicle to the shoulder belt
guide on the child restraint system.
The shoulder belt strap must be routed for‐
wards and downwards from the seat belt out‐
let.
If necessary, adjust the seat belt outlet and
the front passenger seat accordingly.
Child safety locks
#
Activating or deactivating the child safety
lock for the rear doors
#
& WARNING Risk of accident and injury
due to children left unattended in the
vehicle
If children are left unsupervised in the vehi‐
cle, they could, in particular:
R Open doors, thereby endangering other
persons or road users.
R Get out and be struck by oncoming traf‐
fic.
R Operate vehicle equipment and become
trapped, for example.
In addition, the children could also set the
vehicle in motion, for example by:
R Releasing the parking brake.
R Change the transmission position.
R Start the vehicle.
#
Never leave children unattended in the
vehicle.
When leaving the vehicle, always take
the SmartKey with you and lock the
vehicle.
Keep the SmartKey out of reach of chil‐
dren.
& WARNING Risk of fatal injury due to
exposure to extreme heat or cold in the
vehicle
If people – particularly children – are
exposed to extreme temperatures over an
extended period of time, there is a risk of
serious or even fatal injury.
# Never leave anyone – particularly chil‐
dren – unattended in the vehicle.
# Never leave animals in the vehicle unat‐
tended.
Occupant safety
& WARNING Risk of accident and injury
due to children left unattended in the
vehicle
The child safety lock on the rear doors secures
each door separately. The doors can no longer
be opened from the inside.
65
Activating or deactivating the child safety
lock for the rear side windows
If children are traveling in the vehicle, they
could, in particular:
R Open doors, thereby endangering other
persons or road users
R Get out and be struck by oncoming traffic
R Operate vehicle equipment and become
trapped, for example
#
#
#
Always activate the child safety locks
installed if children are traveling in the
vehicle.
Never leave children unattended in the
vehicle.
When leaving the vehicle, always take
the SmartKey with you and lock the
vehicle.
There are child safety locks for the rear doors
and the rear side windows.
#
#
Press the lever in direction 1 (activate) or
2 (deactivate).
Make sure that the child safety locks are
working properly.
#
To activate/deactivate: press button 2.
The rear side window can be opened or
closed in the following cases:
R indicator lamp 1 is lit: via the switch on
the driver's door
66
Occupant safety
R
Indicator lamp 1 is off: via the switch on
the corresponding rear door or driver's
door.
Notes on pets in the vehicle
& WARNING Risk of accident and injury
due to animals left unsecured or unat‐
tended in the vehicle
If you leave animals in the vehicle unatten‐
ded or unsecured, they could possibly press
down buttons or switches.
Thereby an animal may:
R activate vehicle equipment and become
trapped, for example
R switch systems on or off and endanger
other road users
Unsecured animals may be thrown around in
the vehicle in the event of an accident or
sudden steering and braking maneuver and
injure vehicle occupants in the process.
#
#
Never leave animals in the vehicle unat‐
tended.
Always correctly secure animals while
driving, for example using a suitable
animal carrier.
Opening and closing
SmartKey
Overview of SmartKey functions
& WARNING Risk of accident and injury
due to children left unattended in the
vehicle
If children are left unsupervised in the vehi‐
cle, they could, in particular:
R Open doors, thereby endangering other
persons or road users.
R Get out and be struck by oncoming traf‐
fic.
R Operate vehicle equipment and become
trapped, for example.
#
#
When leaving the vehicle, always take
the SmartKey with you and lock the
vehicle.
Keep the SmartKey out of reach of chil‐
dren.
* NOTE Damage to the SmartKey caused
by magnetic fields
#
Keep the SmartKey away from strong
magnetic fields.
In addition, the children could also set the
vehicle in motion, for example by:
R Releasing the parking brake.
R Change the transmission position.
R Start the vehicle.
#
Never leave children unattended in the
vehicle.
1 Locks
2 Indicator lamp
67
3 Unlocks
4 Opens/closes the tailgate
5 Panic alarm
% If indicator lamp 2 does not light up after
pressing the Ü or ß button, the bat‐
tery is discharged.
Replacing the SmartKey battery (/ page 69).
The SmartKey locks and unlocks the following
components:
R the doors
R the fuel filler flap
R the tailgate
If the vehicle is not opened within approximately
40 seconds after unlocking, it locks again. Antitheft protection is armed again.
Do not keep the SmartKey together with elec‐
tronic devices or metal objects. This can affect
the SmartKey's functionality.
Do not keep the SmartKey in the temperaturecontrolled cup holder. Otherwise, the SmartKey
will not be reliably detected.
68
Opening and closing
Activating/deactivating the acoustic locking
verification signal
Multimedia system:
4 © 5 Settings 5 Vehicle
# Activate or deactivate Acoustic Lock.
Activating/deactivating the panic alarm
Requirements:
R The ignition is switched off.
#
or
#
To activate: press button 1 for approx‐
imately one second.
A visual and audible alarm is triggered.
Press the start/stop button on the cockpit
(the SmartKey is inside the vehicle).
Changing the unlocking settings
Possible unlocking functions of the SmartKey:
Central unlocking
R Unlocking the driver's door and fuel filler flap
R
To switch between settings: press the
Ü and ß buttons simultaneously for
approximately six seconds until the indicator
lamp flashes twice.
Options if the unlocking function for the driver's
door and fuel filler flap has been selected:
R To unlock the vehicle centrally: press the
Ü button twice.
R Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO: if you touch
the inner surface of the door handle on the
driver's door, only the driver's door and fuel
filler flap are unlocked.
#
#
To deactivate: briefly press button 1 again.
Deactivating the SmartKey functions
If you do not use the vehicle or a SmartKey for
an extended period of time, you can reduce the
energy consumption of the respective SmartKey.
To do so, deactivate the SmartKey functions.
# To deactivate: press the ß button on the
SmartKey twice in quick succession.
The SmartKey indicator lamp flashes twice
briefly and lights up once.
# To activate: press any button on the Smart‐
Key.
% When the vehicle is started with the Smart‐
Key in the marked space of the center con‐
sole, the SmartKey functions are automati‐
cally activated (/ page 169).
Opening and closing
Removing/inserting the emergency key
Replacing the SmartKey battery
& DANGER Serious damage to health
caused by swallowing batteries
To remove: press release knob 1.
Emergency key 2 is pushed out slightly.
# Pull out emergency key 2 until it engages in
the intermediate position.
# Press release knob 1 again and fully
remove emergency key 2.
# To insert: press release knob 1.
# Insert emergency key 2 to the intermediate
position or fully until it engages.
% You can use the intermediate position of
emergency key 2 to attach the SmartKey to
a key ring.
#
Batteries contain toxic and corrosive sub‐
stances. Swallowing batteries may cause
serious damage to health.
There is a risk of fatal injury.
# Keep batteries out of the reach of chil‐
dren.
# If batteries are swallowed, seek medical
attention immediately.
+ ENVIRONMENTAL NOTE Environmental
damage caused by improper disposal of
batteries
Batteries contain pollutants. It is
illegal to dispose of them with the household
rubbish.
69
#
Dispose of batteries in an
environmentally responsible manner.
Take discharged batteries to a qualified
specialist workshop or to a collection
point for used batteries.
Requirements:
R You require a CR 2032 3 V cell battery.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you have the
battery replaced at a qualified specialist work‐
shop.
# Remove the emergency key (/ page 69).
70
Opening and closing
Problems with the SmartKey
You can no longer lock or unlock the vehicle
Possible causes:
R The SmartKey battery is weak or discharged.
R The SmartKey is faulty.
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
Press release knob 2 down fully and slide
cover 1 in the direction of the arrow.
Fold out cover 1 in the direction of the
arrow and remove.
Remove battery compartment 3 and take
out the discharged battery.
Insert the new battery into battery compart‐
ment 3. Observe the positive pole marking
in the battery compartment and on the bat‐
tery when doing this.
Push in battery compartment 3.
Re-attach cover 1 and push it until it
engages.
#
#
Check the battery using the indicator lamp
and replace if necessary (/ page 69).
Use the emergency key to lock or unlock
(/ page 69).
Have the SmartKey checked at a qualified
specialist workshop.
There is interference from a powerful radio
signal source
The SmartKey function is impaired by, for exam‐
ple:
R High voltage power lines
R Mobile phones
R Electronic devices (notebooks, Tablets)
R Shielding due to metal objects or induction
loops for electrical gate systems or auto‐
matic barriers
#
Make sure that there is a sufficient distance
between the SmartKey and the potential
source of interference.
You have lost a SmartKey
# Have the SmartKey deactivated at a qualified
specialist workshop.
# If necessary, have the mechanical lock
replaced as well.
Doors
Unlocking and opening doors from the inside
Opening and closing
#
#
#
Locking/unlocking the vehicle with KEY‐
LESS-GO
To unlock and open a front door: pull door
handle 2.
Locking pin 1 pops up when the door is
unlocked.
To unlock a rear door: pull the rear door
handle.
The locking pin pops up when the rear door
is unlocked.
To open a rear door: pull the rear door han‐
dle again.
Requirements:
R The SmartKey is outside the vehicle.
R The distance between the SmartKey and the
vehicle does not exceed 3 ft (1 m).
R The driver's door and the door at which the
door handle is used are closed.
Centrally locking and unlocking the vehicle
from the inside
Mercedes-Maybach vehicles: the buttons are
also located in the rear doors.
71
#
#
To unlock: press button 1.
To lock: press button 2.
This does not lock or unlock the fuel filler flap.
The vehicle is not unlocked:
R If you have locked the vehicle using the
SmartKey.
R If you have locked the vehicle using KEY‐
LESS-GO.
72
Opening and closing
To unlock the vehicle: touch the inner sur‐
face of the door handle.
# To lock the vehicle: touch sensor surface
1 or 2.
# Convenience closing: touch recessed sen‐
sor surface 2 until the closing process has
been completed.
% Further information on convenience closing
(/ page 83).
If you open the tailgate from outside, it is auto‐
matically unlocked.
#
Problems with KEYLESS-GO
You can no longer lock or unlock the vehicle
using KEYLESS-GO.
Possible causes:
R The SmartKey functions have been deactiva‐
ted (/ page 68).
R The SmartKey battery is weak or discharged.
R The SmartKey is faulty.
#
#
#
#
Activate the SmartKey functions
(/ page 68).
Check the battery using the indicator lamp
and replace if necessary (/ page 69).
Use the emergency key to unlock or lock the
vehicle (/ page 69).
Have the vehicle and SmartKey checked at a
qualified specialist workshop.
Activating/deactivating the automatic lock‐
ing feature
The vehicle is locked automatically when the
ignition is switched on and the wheels are turn‐
ing faster than walking pace.
There is interference from a powerful radio
signal source
The KEYLESS-GO function is impaired by, for
example:
R High voltage power lines
R Mobile phones
R Electronic devices (notebooks, tablets)
R Shielding due to metal objects or induction
loops for electrical gate systems or auto‐
matic barriers
#
Make sure that there is a sufficient distance
between the SmartKey and the potential
source of interference.
#
To activate: press and hold button 2 for
approximately five seconds until an acoustic
signal sounds.
Opening and closing
To deactivate: press and hold button 1 for
approximately five seconds until an acoustic
signal sounds.
In the following situations, there is a danger of
being locked out when the function is activated:
R While the vehicle is being tow started/
pushed.
R If the vehicle is being tested on a roller dyna‐
mometer.
#
Power closing function
73
If you push the door into the lock to the first
detent position, the power closing function will
automatically pull the door into the lock.
Locking/unlocking the driver's door with the
emergency key
% If you wish to lock the vehicle entirely using
the emergency key, first press the button for
locking from the inside while the driver's
door is open. Then proceed to lock the driv‐
er's door using the emergency key.
& WARNING Risk of becoming trapped
when the doors close automatically
Body parts or objects can become trapped,
causing injuries.
# Ensure that no body parts or objects
are in the closing area.
# Automatic closing of the doors can be
canceled by pulling the outer or inner
door handle.
#
#
#
#
Insert the emergency key as far as it will go
into opening 1 in the cover.
Pull and hold the door handle.
Pull the cover on the emergency key as
straight as possible away from the vehicle
until it releases.
Release the door handle.
74
Opening and closing
Running boards
Operation of the running boards
#
#
#
To unlock: turn the emergency key counterclockwise to position 1.
To lock: turn the emergency key clockwise to
position 1.
Carefully press the cover onto the lock cylin‐
der until it engages and is seated firmly.
Mercedes-Maybach vehicles: the vehicle is
equipped with electrically extendable running
boards. If you have selected the automatic mode
in the multimedia system, (/ page 75) the
running board will extend automatically on the
respective side when a door is opened. You can
use manual mode to clean the running boards
(/ page 332).
% The running boards will extend and retract
only if the vehicle is stationary.
In the following cases, the running boards will
retract automatically:
R If you select an off-road drive program
(/ page 182).
R If you activate car wash mode (/ page 330).
R If the outside mirrors fold in automatically
(/ page 157).
R If you are driving at a speed greater than
2.5 mph (4 km/h).
If you have selected the automatic mode in the
multimedia system and you manually extend the
running boards when the doors are closed, the
running boards will remain extended, even if you
open a door and then close it again. Automatic
mode will be reactivated only when you are driv‐
ing at a speed greater than 2.5 mph (4 km/h).
* NOTE Damage to the running boards
during extension or retraction
The running boards extend at the side during
extension. During retraction, the running
boards are integrated in the side skirt.
# Make sure that there is sufficient space
during extension and retraction.
Read the display message that may be displayed
in the instrument cluster (/ page 408).
Opening and closing
Extending and retracting the running boards
via the multimedia system
Multimedia system:
4 © 5 Settings 5 Vehicle
5 SIDE RUNNING BOARD
# Select Extend or Retract.
Automatically extending and retracting the
running boards
# Activate or deactivate AUTOMATIC EXTENSION.
% This equipment is available only for
Mercedes-Maybach vehicles.
Cargo compartment
Opening the tailgate
gate is open when the engine is running,
especially if the vehicle is in motion.
# Always switch off the engine before
opening the tailgate.
# Never drive with the tailgate open.
* NOTE Damage to the tailgate caused by
obstacles above the vehicle
The tailgate swings rearwards and upwards
when it is opened.
# Make sure that there is sufficient space
behind and above the tailgate.
#
#
& DANGER Risk of exhaust gas poisoning
Combustion engines emit poisonous exhaust
gases such as carbon monoxide. Exhaust
gases can enter the vehicle interior if the tail‐
75
#
Pull remote operating switch 1 for the tail‐
gate.
Press and hold the p button on the
SmartKey.
Vehicles with HANDS-FREE ACCESS: Use
your foot to kick below the bumper
(/ page 78).
76
#
#
Opening and closing
If the tailgate is unlocked, pull the tailgate
handle and release it.
For a tailgate stopped in an intermediate
position, pull it upwards and release it as
soon as it starts to open.
The tailgate is equipped with an automatic
object recognition function. If a solid object
blocks or restricts the tailgate during automatic
opening, this process will be stopped. The auto‐
matic object recognition function is only an aid.
It is not a substitute for your attentiveness when
you are opening the tailgate.
Closing the tailgate
& WARNING Risk of injury from unsecured
items in the vehicle
If objects, luggage or loads are not secured
or not secured sufficiently, they could slip,
tip over or be thrown around and thereby hit
vehicle occupants.
There is a risk of injury, particularly in the
event of sudden braking or a sudden change
in direction.
# Always stow objects in such a way that
they cannot be thrown around.
# Before the journey, secure objects, lug‐
gage or loads against slipping or tipping
over.
Observe the notes on loading the vehicle.
# Pull the tailgate downwards slightly. Release
it as soon as it begins to close.
& WARNING Risk of becoming trapped
during automatic closing of the tailgate
Body parts may become trapped. There may
be people in the closing area.
# Make sure that nobody is in the vicinity
of the closing area during the closing
process.
Use one of the following options to stop the
closing process:
R Press the p button on the SmartKey.
R Press or pull the remote operating switch
on the driver's door.
R Press the closing or locking button on the
tailgate.
R Pull the tailgate handle.
#
Vehicles with HANDS-FREE ACCESS: it is
also possible to stop the closing process by
making a kicking movement below the rear
bumper.
Opening and closing
#
77
Press and hold the p button on the
SmartKey (with the SmartKey in the vicinity
of the vehicle).
Vehicles with HANDS-FREE ACCESS
# Make a kicking movement with your foot
below the bumper (/ page 78).
#
#
Switch on the power supply or the ignition.
Press remote operating switch 1 for the
tailgate.
#
Press closing button 1 on the tailgate.
Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO
# Press locking button 2 on the tailgate.
If a SmartKey is detected outside the vehicle,
the tailgate will close and the vehicle will be
locked.
Automatic reversing function for the tailgate
The tailgate is equipped with automatic object
recognition with a reversing function. If a solid
object hinders or restricts the tailgate when it is
closing automatically, the tailgate will automati‐
cally open again slightly. Automatic object recog‐
nition with reversing function is only an aid. It is
not a substitute for your attentiveness when you
are closing the tailgate.
# During the closing process, make sure that
no body parts are in the closing area.
& WARNING Risk of becoming trapped
despite reversing function
The reversing function will not react:
R To soft, light and thin objects, e.g. fingers
78
R
Opening and closing
Towards the end of the closing procedure
HANDS-FREE ACCESS function
In these situations in particular, the reversing
function cannot prevent someone being trap‐
ped.
# Ensure that no body parts are in the
closing area.
If someone is trapped, either:
R Press the p button on the SmartKey.
R Press or pull the remote operating switch
on the driver's door.
R Press the closing or locking button on the
tailgate.
R Pull the tailgate handle.
Observe the notes when opening (/ page 75)
and closing (/ page 76) the tailgate.
% Two warning tones sound when the tailgate
is opening or closing.
& WARNING Risk of burns caused by a hot
exhaust system
The vehicle exhaust system can become very
hot. If you use HANDS-FREE ACCESS, you
could burn yourself by touching the exhaust
system.
# Always ensure that you only make a
kicking movement within the detection
range of the sensors.
With HANDS-FREE ACCESS you can open, close
or stop the closing process of the tailgate by
performing a kicking movement under the rear
bumper.
The kicking movement triggers the opening or
closing process alternately.
* NOTE Vehicle damage due to uninten‐
tional opening of the tailgate
R
R
#
when using an automatic car wash
when using a high pressure cleaner
Deactivate KEYLESS-GO or make sure
that the key located is at least 10 ft
Opening and closing
(3 m) away from the vehicle in such sit‐
uations.
When making the kicking movement, make sure
that you are standing firmly on the ground. You
could otherwise lose your balance, e.g. on ice.
Observe the following notes:
R The SmartKey is behind the vehicle.
R Stand at least 12 in (30 cm) away from the
vehicle while performing the kicking move‐
ment.
R Do not come into contact with the bumper
while making the kicking movement.
R Do not carry out the kicking movement too
slowly.
R The kicking movement must be towards the
vehicle and back again.
1 Detection range of the sensors
If several consecutive kicking movements are
not successful, wait ten seconds.
System limits
The system may be impaired or may not function
in the following cases:
R The sensors are dirty, e.g. due to road salt or
snow.
R The kicking movement is made using a pros‐
thetic leg.
79
The tailgate can open or close unintentionally in
the following situations:
R If a person's arms or legs are moving in the
sensor detection range, e.g. when polishing
the vehicle or picking up objects.
R If objects are moved or placed behind the
vehicle, e.g. tensioning straps or luggage.
R If clamping straps, tarps or other coverings
are pulled over the bumper.
R If a protective mat with a length reaching
over the trunk sill down into the detection
range of the sensors is used.
R If the protective mat is not secured correctly.
R When working on the trailer hitch, trailers or
rear bicycle racks.
Deactivate the SmartKey functions (/ page 68)
or do not carry the SmartKey about your person
in such situations.
80
Opening and closing
Limiting the opening angle of the tailgate
Activating the opening angle limiter
You can limit the opening angle of the tailgate in
the top half of its opening range to approx‐
imately 8 in (20 cm) before the end position.
# Stop the opening procedure of the tailgate at
the desired position.
# Press and hold the closing button on the tail‐
gate until you hear a short acoustic signal.
The opening angle limiter will be activated.
The tailgate will then stop in the stored posi‐
tion when opened.
To open the tailgate fully, pull the handle on the
outside of the tailgate again after it has stopped
automatically.
Deactivating the opening angle limiter
# Press and hold the closing button on the tail‐
gate until two short acoustic signals sound.
Releasing the tailgate in an emergency
Requirements:
R Only for Mercedes-Maybach vehicles.
#
Remove cover 1.
#
Pull lever 2 in the direction of the arrow
until the tailgate unlocks.
Unlocking the tailgate with the emergency
key
Requirements:
R Not for Mercedes-Maybach vehicles.
Opening and closing
R
R
The rear seat backrest has been folded
forward.
The cargo compartment cover has been
removed.
Side windows
Opening and closing the side windows
& WARNING Risk of entrapment when
opening a side window
When opening a side window, parts of the
body could be drawn in or become trapped
between the side window and window frame.
# When opening, make sure that nobody
is touching the side window.
# If someone is trapped, release the but‐
ton immediately or pull it in order to
close the side window again.
& WARNING Risk of becoming trapped
when closing a side window
#
Insert emergency key 2 into opening 1 in
the trim and push it in.
The tailgate will be unlocked.
When closing a side window, body parts
could be trapped in the closing area in the
process.
# When closing, make sure that no body
parts are in the closing area.
#
81
If someone is trapped, release the but‐
ton immediately or press the button in
order to reopen the side window.
& WARNING Risk of becoming trapped
when children operate the side windows
Children could become trapped if they oper‐
ate the side windows, particularly when unat‐
tended.
# Activate the child safety lock for the
rear passenger compartment side win‐
dows.
# When leaving the vehicle, always take
the SmartKey with you and lock the
vehicle.
# Never leave children unattended in the
vehicle.
Requirements:
R The power supply or the ignition is switched
on.
82
Opening and closing
#
To interrupt automatic operation: press or
pull the W button again.
When the vehicle is switched off, the side win‐
dows can continue being operated.
This function is available for around four minutes
or until a front door is opened.
% Vehicles with electric roller sunblinds on
rear doors on the left and right: The but‐
tons for the rear side windows also open and
close the roller sunblinds (/ page 89).
1 Closes
2 Opens
The buttons on the driver's door take prece‐
dence.
# To start automatic operation: press the
W button beyond the point of resistance
or pull and release it.
Automatic reversing function of the side win‐
dows
If an object impedes a side window during the
closing process, the side window will open again
automatically. The automatic reversing function
is only an aid and is not a substitute for your
attentiveness.
# During the closing process, make sure that
no body parts are in the closing area.
& WARNING Risk of becoming trapped
despite there being reversing protection
on the side window
The reversing function does not react:
R To soft, light and thin objects, e.g. fin‐
gers.
R During resetting.
The reversing function cannot prevent some‐
one from becoming trapped in these situa‐
tions.
# During the closing process, make sure
that no body parts are in the closing
area.
# If someone becomes trapped, press the
W button to open the side window
again.
Opening and closing
Convenience opening (ventilating the vehicle
before starting a journey)
& WARNING Risk of entrapment when
opening a side window
When opening a side window, parts of the
body could be drawn in or become trapped
between the side window and window frame.
# When opening, make sure that nobody
is touching the side window.
# Release the button immediately if
somebody becomes trapped.
#
Press and hold the Ü button on the
SmartKey.
The following functions are performed:
R The vehicle is unlocked.
R The side windows are opened.
R The sliding sunroof is opened.
R The panoramic sliding roof is opened.
R The seat ventilation of the driver's seat is
switched on.
% If the roller sunblind of the panoramic sliding
sunroof is closed, the roller sunblind is
opened first.
% If the roller sunblinds of the rear doors are
closed, the roller sunblinds are opened first.
# To interrupt convenience opening: release
the Ü button.
# To continue convenience opening: press
and hold the Ü button again.
Convenience closing (closing the vehicle
from outside)
& WARNING Risk of entrapment due to not
paying attention during convenience
closing
When the convenience closing feature is
operating, parts of the body could become
trapped in the closing area of the side win‐
dow and the sliding sunroof.
# When the convenience closing feature
is operating, monitor the entire closing
83
process and make sure that no body
parts are in the closing area.
#
Press and hold the ß button on the
SmartKey.
The following functions are performed:
R The vehicle is locked.
R The side windows are closed.
R The sliding sunroof is closed.
R The panoramic sliding roof is closed.
# To interrupt convenience closing: release
the ß button.
# To close the roller sunblinds: press and
hold the ß button again.
% Convenience closing can also be operated
with KEYLESS-GO (/ page 71).
#
84
Opening and closing
Problems with the side windows
& WARNING Risk of becoming trapped or
fatally injured if reversing protection is
not activated
If you close a side window again immediately
after it has been blocked, the side window
will close with increased or maximum force.
The reversing function is then not active and
body parts may become trapped.
# Make sure that no parts of the body are
in the closing area.
# To stop the closing process, release the
button or press the button again to
reopen the side window.
A side window cannot be closed and you can‐
not see the cause.
# Check to see whether any objects are in the
window guide.
# Adjust the side windows.
Adjusting the side windows
If a side window is obstructed during closing and
reopens again immediately:
# Immediately after this, pull the correspond‐
ing button again until the side window has
closed and hold the button for at least one
more second (re-adjustment).
The side window will be closed without the
automatic reversing function.
If the side window is obstructed again and
reopens again immediately:
# Immediately after this, pull the correspond‐
ing button again until the side window has
closed and hold the button for at least one
more second (follow-up adjustment).
The side window will be closed without the
automatic reversing function.
The side windows cannot be opened or
closed using the convenience opening fea‐
ture.
R The SmartKey battery is weak or discharged.
#
Check the battery using the indicator lamp
and replace if necessary (/ page 69).
Sliding sunroof
Opening and closing the sliding sunroof
% The term "sliding sunroof" also refers to the
panorama roof with power tilt/sliding panel.
& WARNING Risk of becoming trapped
when the sliding sunroof is being opened
and closed
Body parts may become trapped in the range
of movement.
# During opening and closing, make sure
that no body parts are in the range of
movement.
# Release the button immediately if
somebody becomes trapped.
or
# Briefly press the button in any direction
during automatic operation.
The opening or closing process will be
stopped.
Opening and closing
& WARNING Risk of becoming trapped if
the sliding sunroof is operated by chil‐
dren
Children operating the sliding sunroof could
get caught in the moving parts, particularly if
unattended.
# Never leave children unattended in the
vehicle.
# When leaving the vehicle, always take
the key with you and lock the vehicle.
& WARNING Risk of becoming trapped
when the roller sunblind is being opened
and closed
Body parts may become trapped between
the roller sunblind and frame or sliding roof.
# When opening or closing, make sure
that no body parts are in the roller sun‐
blind's range of movement.
# Release the button immediately if
somebody becomes trapped.
or
#
Briefly press the button in any direction
during automatic operation.
The opening or closing process will be
stopped.
* NOTE Malfunction due to snow and ice
Snow and ice may cause the sliding sunroof
to malfunction.
# Open the sliding sunroof only if it is free
of snow and ice.
* NOTE Damage caused by protruding
objects
Objects that protrude from the sliding sun‐
roof may damage the sealing strips.
# Do not allow anything to protrude from
the sliding sunroof.
85
* NOTE Important points to remember
when a roof luggage rack is installed
When a roof luggage rack is installed, raising
or opening the sliding sunroof may be limi‐
ted.
# Check whether the sliding sunroof can
be raised or opened when a roof lug‐
gage rack is installed.
# If in doubt, do not raise or open the
sliding sunroof.
86
Opening and closing
1 To raise
2 To open
3 To close/lower
Use the 3 button to operate the panorama
roof with power tilt/sliding panel and the roller
sunblind.
The panorama roof with power tilt/sliding panel
can be operated only when the roller sunblind is
open.
% The roller sunblind can be opened only when
the panorama roof with power tilt/sliding
panel is closed or in the raised position.
# Check whether the sliding sunroof can be
raised or opened when a roof luggage rack is
installed.
# To start automatic operation: press the
3 button beyond the point of resistance
or pull and release it.
# To interrupt automatic operation: briefly
press the 3 button in any direction.
The opening/closing process will be stop‐
ped.
Vehicles with a panorama roof with power
tilt/sliding panel: The automatic raising feature
is available only when the sliding sunroof is
closed or raised.
Vehicles without a panorama roof with
power tilt/sliding panel: The automatic open‐
ing and raising features are available only when
the sliding sunroof is closed.
# To ventilate the vehicle interior: raise the
sliding sunroof.
The roller sunblind will open slightly.
Operating the roller sunblind for the sliding
sunroof from the rear passenger compart‐
ment
Opening and closing
To open: press button 1.
To close: pull button 1.
% When the sliding sunroof is open, it will close
first. To close the roller sunblind, you must
pull button 1 again.
If you push or pull button 1 beyond the point of
resistance, you will start automatic operation in
the direction in question. You can stop auto‐
matic operation by pressing or pulling the button
again.
#
#
Automatic reversing function of the sliding
sunroof
If an object is obstructing the sliding sunroof
during the closing process, the sliding sunroof
will open again automatically. The automatic
reversing function is only an aid and is not a sub‐
stitute for your attentiveness.
# During the closing process, make sure that
no body parts are in the closing area.
& WARNING Risk of becoming trapped
despite the reversing function being
active
In particular, the reversing function does not
react:
R To soft, light and thin objects, e.g. fin‐
gers.
R Towards the end of the closing proce‐
dure.
R During resetting.
#
#
During the closing process, make sure
that no body parts are in the closing
area.
Release the button immediately if
somebody becomes trapped.
or
#
Briefly press the button in any direction
during automatic operation.
The closing process will be stopped.
87
Automatic reversing function of the roller
sunblind
If an object is obstructing the roller sunblind dur‐
ing the closing process, the roller sunblind will
open again automatically. The automatic revers‐
ing function is only an aid and is not a substitute
for your attentiveness.
# When closing the roller sunblind, make sure
that no body parts are in the range of move‐
ment.
& WARNING Risk of becoming trapped
despite reversing function
In particular, the reversing function does not
react to soft, light and thin objects, e.g. fin‐
gers.
# When closing the roller sunblind, make
sure that no body parts are in the range
of movement.
# Release the button immediately if
somebody becomes trapped.
or
88
#
Opening and closing
Briefly press the button in any direction
during the automatic closing process.
The closing process will be stopped.
Automatic functions of the sliding sunroof
% The term "sliding sunroof" also refers to the
panorama roof with power tilt/sliding panel.
By pushing or pulling the 3 button, you can
interrupt the automatic functions: "Rain closing
function when driving" and "Automatic lower‐
ing".
Rain closing function when driving
Vehicles with a panorama roof with power
tilt/sliding panel: If it starts to rain, the raised
sliding sunroof will automatically be lowered
while the vehicle is in motion.
Automatic lowering function
Vehicles with a panorama roof with power
tilt/sliding panel: If the sliding sunroof is raised
at the rear, it will automatically be lowered
slightly at higher speeds. At low speeds, it will
be raised again automatically.
& WARNING Risk of becoming trapped by
automatic lowering of the sliding sunroof
At higher speeds, the raised sliding sunroof
will automatically be lowered slightly at the
rear.
# Make sure that nobody reaches into the
sliding sunroof's range of movement
while the vehicle is in motion.
# If somebody becomes trapped, briefly
push the sliding sunroof button for‐
wards or backwards.
Problems with the sliding sunroof
& WARNING Risk of becoming trapped or
fatal injuries when the sliding sunroof is
closed again
If the sliding sunroof is closed again immedi‐
ately after it has been blocked or reset, it will
close with increased force.
# Make sure that no parts of the body are
in the closing area.
#
Release the button immediately if
somebody becomes trapped.
or
#
Briefly press the button in any direction
during the automatic closing process.
The closing process will be stopped.
The sliding sunroof cannot be closed and you
cannot see the cause.
% The term "sliding sunroof" also refers to the
panorama roof with power tilt/sliding panel.
If the sliding sunroof is obstructed during closing
and reopens again slightly:
# Immediately after automatic reversing, pull
and hold the 3 button down again to the
point of resistance until the sliding sunroof is
closed.
The sliding sunroof will be closed with
increased force.
If the sliding sunroof is obstructed again and
reopens again slightly:
Opening and closing
Repeat the previous step.
The sliding sunroof will be closed with even
greater force.
Vehicles without a panorama roof with
power tilt/sliding panel: The sliding sunroof
is not operating smoothly.
# Reset the sliding sunroof.
#
Resetting the sliding sunroof
# Push the 3 button up to the point of
resistance repeatedly until the sliding sun‐
roof is fully open.
# Press the 3 button for another second.
# Close the sliding sunroof.
Vehicles with a panorama roof with power
tilt/sliding panel: The sliding sunroof or the
roller sunblind is not operating smoothly.
# Reset the sliding sunroof and the roller sun‐
blind.
Resetting the sliding sunroof and the roller
sunblind
# Pull and hold the 3 button little by little
until the sliding sunroof is fully closed.
#
#
Pull and hold the 3 button little by little
until the roller sunblind is fully closed.
Use automatic operation to fully open and
then close the sliding sunroof.
Roller sun blinds
Extending or retracting the roller sunblinds
on the rear side windows
& WARNING Risk of becoming trapped
when extending or retracting the roller
sunblind
Body parts could become trapped in the
sweep of the roller sunblind when it is being
extended or retracted.
# Make sure that no body parts are in the
sweep of the roller sunblind when it is
being extended or retracted.
#
If someone becomes trapped, briefly
press the button in the opposite direc‐
tion.
The opening or closing process will
briefly be stopped. The roller sunblind
will then return to its starting position.
* NOTE Damage caused by objects
Objects could cause malfunctions of the
roller sunblind.
# Make sure that the roller sunblind can
move freely.
The roller sunblinds for the rear side windows
can be operated with the buttons for the side
windows in the driver's door and in the rear
doors.
89
90
Opening and closing
Anti-theft protection
Function of the immobilizer
1 Rear left side window/roller sunblind
2 Rear right side window/roller sunblind
#
#
To close fully: briefly pull the corresponding
button when the side window is closed.
To open fully: briefly press the correspond‐
ing button.
The immobilizer prevents your vehicle from being
started without the correct SmartKey.
The immobilizer is automatically activated when
the ignition is switched off and deactivated when
the ignition is switched on.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the Smart‐
Key with you and lock the vehicle. Anyone can
start the engine if a valid SmartKey has been left
inside the vehicle.
% In the event the engine cannot be started
(yet the vehicle’s battery is charged), the
system is not operational. Contact an
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center or call
1-800-FOR-MERCedes (in the USA) or
1-800-387-0100 (in Canada).
ATA (anti-theft alarm system)
Function of the ATA system
If the ATA system is armed, a visual and audible
alarm is triggered in the following situations:
R when a door is opened
R when the tailgate is opened
R when the hood is opened
R when interior protection is triggered
(/ page 92)
R when the tow-away alarm is triggered
(/ page 91)
The ATA system is armed automatically after
approximately ten seconds in the following situa‐
tions:
R after locking the vehicle with the SmartKey
R after locking the vehicle using KEYLESS-GO
Opening and closing
R
after pressing the start/stop button with the
SmartKey in the stowage compartment
(/ page 169)
% When the Mercedes‑Benz emergency call
system is active and the alarm stays on for
more than 30 seconds, a message is auto‐
matically sent to the Customer Assistance
Center (/ page 310).
% In the case of severe battery discharging,
the anti-theft alarm system is automatically
deactivated to facilitate the next engine
start.
Indicator lamp 1 flashes when the ATA system
is armed.
The ATA system is deactivated automatically in
the following situations:
R after unlocking the vehicle with the SmartKey
R after unlocking the vehicle using KEYLESSGO
Deactivating the ATA
# Press the Ü, ß or p button on the
SmartKey.
or
# Press the start/stop button with the Smart‐
Key in the marked space (/ page 169)
Deactivating the alarm using KEYLESS-GO
Grasp the outside door handle with the
SmartKey outside the vehicle.
#
91
Function of the tow-away alarm
% This function may not be available in all
countries.
An audible and visual alarm is triggered if an
alteration to your vehicle's angle of inclination is
detected while the tow-away alarm is armed.
The tow-away alarm is automatically armed after
approximately 60 seconds:
R after locking the vehicle with the SmartKey
R after locking the vehicle using KEYLESS-GO
The tow-away alarm is only armed when the fol‐
lowing components are closed:
R the doors
R the tailgate
The tow-away alarm is automatically deactiva‐
ted:
R after pressing the Ü or p button on
the SmartKey
R after pressing the start/stop button with the
SmartKey in the stowage compartment
(/ page 169)
92
R
R
Opening and closing
after unlocking the vehicle using KEYLESSGO
when using HANDS-FREE ACCESS
Information on collision detection on a parked
vehicle (/ page 200).
Arming/disarming the tow-away alarm
Multimedia system:
4 © 5 Settings 5 Quick Access
# Arm or disarm Tow-away Protection.
The tow-away alarm is armed again in the follow‐
ing cases:
R The vehicle is unlocked again.
R A door is opened.
R The vehicle is locked again.
% If quick access is unavailable, select the
Vehicle submenu in the Settings main menu
to arm or disarm the tow-away alarm.
Function of the interior motion sensor
% This function may not be available in all
countries.
When the interior motion sensor is activated, a
visual and audible alarm is triggered if move‐
ment is detected in the vehicle interior.
The interior motion sensor is activated automati‐
cally after approximately ten seconds:
R after locking the vehicle with the SmartKey
R after locking the vehicle using KEYLESS-GO
The interior motion sensor is only activated
when the following components are closed:
R the doors
R the tailgate
The interior motion sensor is automatically deac‐
tivated:
R after pressing the Ü or p button on
the SmartKey
R after pressing the start/stop button with the
SmartKey in the storage compartment
(/ page 169)
R
R
after unlocking the vehicle using KEYLESSGO
when using HANDS-FREE ACCESS
The following situations can lead to a false
alarm:
R moving objects such as mascots in the vehi‐
cle interior
R when the side window is open
R when the sliding sunroof is open
R when the panoramic sliding sunroof is open
Arming/deactivating the interior motion sen‐
sor
Multimedia system:
4 © 5 Settings 5 Quick Access
# Activate or deactivate Interior Motion Sensor.
The interior motion sensor is activated again in
the following cases:
R The vehicle is unlocked again.
R A door is opened.
Opening and closing
R
The vehicle is locked again.
% If quick access is unavailable, select the
Vehicle menu under Settings to activate or
deactivate the interior motion sensor.
93
94
Seats and stowing
Notes on the correct driver's seat position
R
& WARNING Risk of accident due to
adjusting vehicle settings while the vehi‐
cle is in motion
R
R
You could lose control of the vehicle in the
following situations in particular:
R If you adjust the driver's seat, the head
restraints, the steering wheel or the mir‐
ror while the vehicle is in motion.
R If you fasten your seat belt while the vehi‐
cle is in motion.
#
Before starting the engine: adjust the
driver's seat, the head restraints, the
steering wheel and the mirror and fas‐
ten your seat belt.
R
R
R
R
Ensure the following when adjusting steering
wheel 1, seat belt 2 and driver's seat 3:
R You are sitting as far away from the driver's
airbag as possible, taking the following
points into consideration.
R You are sitting in an upright position
R Your thighs are slightly supported by the seat
cushion
Your legs are not fully extended and you can
depress the pedals properly
The back of your head is supported at eye
level by the center of the head restraint
You can hold the steering wheel with your
arms slightly bent
You can move your legs freely
You can see all the displays on the instru‐
ment cluster clearly
You have a good overview of the traffic con‐
ditions
Your seat belt sits snugly against your body
and passes across the center of your shoul‐
der and across your hips in the pelvic area
Seats
Adjusting the front seat
& WARNING Risk of becoming trapped if
the seats are adjusted by children
Children could become trapped if they adjust
the seats, particularly when unattended.
Seats and stowing
#
#
When leaving the vehicle, always take
the SmartKey with you and lock the
vehicle.
Never leave children unattended in the
vehicle.
You can adjust the seats when the ignition is
switched off.
& WARNING Risk of becoming trapped
when adjusting the seat
When you adjust a seat, you or other vehicle
occupants could become trapped, e.g. on the
seat guide rail.
# When adjusting a seat, make sure that
no one has any part of their body within
the sweep of the seat.
Observe the safety notes on "Airbags" and "Chil‐
dren in the vehicle".
& WARNING Risk of accident due to
adjusting vehicle settings while the vehi‐
cle is in motion
You could lose control of the vehicle in the
following situations in particular:
R If you adjust the driver's seat, the head
restraints, the steering wheel or the mir‐
ror while the vehicle is in motion.
R If you fasten your seat belt while the vehi‐
cle is in motion.
#
Before starting the engine: adjust the
driver's seat, the head restraints, the
steering wheel and the mirror and fas‐
ten your seat belt.
& WARNING Risk of becoming trapped if
the seat height is adjusted carelessly
If you adjust the seat height carelessly, you
or other vehicle occupants could be trapped
and thereby injured.
95
Children in particular could accidentally
press the electrical seat adjustment buttons
and become trapped.
# While moving the seats, make sure that
hands or other body parts do not get
under the lever assembly of the seat
adjustment system.
& WARNING Risk of injury due to head
restraints not being installed or being
adjusted incorrectly
If head restraints have not been installed or
have not been adjusted correctly, there is an
increased risk of injury in the head and neck
area, e.g. in the event of an accident or when
braking.
# Always drive with the head restraints
installed.
# Before driving off, make sure for every
vehicle occupant that the center of the
head restraint supports the back of the
head at about eye level.
96
Seats and stowing
Adjusting the front passenger seat electri‐
cally from the driver's seat
Do not interchange the head restraints of the
front and rear seats. Otherwise, you will not be
able to adjust the height and angle of the head
restraints correctly.
Adjust the head restraint fore-and-aft position so
that it is as close as possible to the back of your
head.
Requirements:
R The power supply is switched on.
& WARNING Risk of injury or death due to
an incorrect seat position
The seat belt does not offer the intended
level of protection if you have not moved the
seat backrest to an almost vertical position.
You could slip beneath the seat belt and
injure yourself.
# Adjust the seat properly before com‐
mencing your journey.
# Always ensure that the seat backrest is
in an almost vertical position and that
the shoulder belt is routed across the
center of your shoulder.
1
2
3
4
5
6
Head restraint height
Seat backrest inclination
Seat height
Seat cushion length
Seat cushion inclination
Seat fore-and-aft position
#
Save the settings with the memory function
(/ page 115).
You can call up the following functions for the
front passenger seat:
R Seat adjustment
Seats and stowing
R
R
R
#
#
#
Seat heating
Seat ventilation
Memory function
Adjusting the front passenger seat electri‐
cally from the rear passenger compartment
To select the front passenger seat: press
button 1.
When the indicator lamp lights up, the front
passenger seat is selected.
Adjust the front passenger seat using the
buttons on the driver's side door control
panel.
Select the driver's seat: press button 1
again.
When the indicator lamp goes out, the driv‐
er's seat has been selected.
#
#
To select the front passenger seat: press
button 1.
When the indicator lamp lights up, the front
passenger seat is selected.
Adjust the front passenger seat using the
buttons on the door control panel in the rear
passenger compartment (/ page 98).
97
% Mercedes-Maybach vehicles: if the front
passenger seat is in the foremost position,
you can set the seat backrest at a very steep
angle. This will provide a better forward view
from the rear passenger compartment.
Despite the steep angle of the seat backrest,
a person may occupy the front passenger
seat.
98
Seats and stowing
Adjusting the 4-way lumbar support
Adjusting the rear seats electrically
The middle seat backrest is adjusted together
with the left seat.
#
Save the settings with the memory function
(/ page 116).
Adjusting the reclining rear seats electrically
The reclining rear seats are on the driver's and
front passenger sides.
1
2
3
4
Higher
Softer
Lower
Firmer
#
Using buttons 1 to 4, adjust the contour
of the backrest individually to suit your back.
1 Head restraint height
2 Seat backrest inclination
3 Seat fore-and-aft position
1 Head restraint height
2 Head restraint fore-and-aft position
Seats and stowing
3 Seat backrest inclination
4 Combined seat cushion inclination and
R
length
R
5 Combined seat cushion inclination and
length
The front passenger seat head restraint
will be completely retracted.
The front passenger seat backrest will
move as far forwards and as far down as
it will go.
6 Fore-and-aft position of the leg rest
7 Angle of the leg rest
Save the settings with the memory function
(/ page 116).
% The leg rest folds down if overloaded. If this
is the case, fold up the leg rest and engage
it.
#
Setting the fully reclined position
Requirements:
R The power supply is switched on.
#
To set the fully reclined position: press
button 1.
R The rear seat will move into the fully
reclined position.
R The rear seat head restraint will move.
R The leg rest will rise.
R The front passenger seat will move as far
forwards as possible.
#
or
99
To restore the standard seat settings:
press button 1.
100 Seats and stowing
Folding the rear seats on the second row of
seats forwards and back electrically
Calling up the settings with the memory
function (/ page 116).
% You can use the rear passenger compart‐
ment child safety lock to disable this func‐
tion (/ page 65).
% The leg rest folds down if overloaded. If this
is the case, fold up the leg rest and engage
it.
#
& WARNING Risk of injury due to seat
backrest folded forwards
Attaching and removing the additional cush‐
ion of the leg rest
Use the additional cushion only when the vehicle
is stationary. The additional cushion is in the
vehicle.
#
#
#
To attach: place the additional cushion on
the leg rest.
Pull the rubber straps laterally over the leg
rest.
To remove: remove the rubber straps from
the leg rest and stow the additional cushion
safely in the vehicle.
If the rear seat backrest is folded forwards,
persons in the third row of seats could col‐
lide with parts of the seat adjustment mech‐
anism, in particular in the event of an acci‐
dent, sudden braking or an abrupt change of
direction.
# If there is a person in the third row of
seats, the rear seat in front of that per‐
son must be folded back into the driv‐
ing position before starting the journey.
# People in the third row of seats must
not place their legs on a rear seat back‐
rest that has been folded forwards.
Always ensure that all vehicle occupants have
their seat belts fastened correctly and are sitting
properly. Particular attention must be paid to
children.
Seats and stowing 101
If you no longer require the seat backrest to be
folded down for loading or for getting in and out,
fold it back into place.
& WARNING Risk of becoming trapped if
the seat is not engaged
The seat does not engage when folded for‐
wards. The seat can fold backwards unex‐
pectedly, e.g. when accelerating, braking or
in the event of an abrupt change of direction
or an accident.
People in the seat's sweep can become trap‐
ped.
# If a seat is folded forwards, always fold
it back before driving off.
# Make sure that the seat is engaged.
If a seat on the second row of seats is not
engaged, this will be shown on the multifunction
display on the instrument cluster.
Requirements:
R The area into which the rear seat is folded is
clear.
R The rear seat has been folded up.
R
R
R
R
Vehicles with comfort seating: the center
armrest is folded up.
Vehicles with an extended center console:
the storage compartment in the center con‐
sole is closed.
Vehicles with a folding rear armrest: the rear
armrest has been folded up.
Vehicles with center seat backrests: the cen‐
ter seat backrest has been folded up.
R
Seven-seater with center seat backrest: both
sides
% To increase the size of the cargo compart‐
ment, you can move the seat backrests into
the cargo compartment floor position
(/ page 124).
Folding the rear seat in the front position
You can fold the seats on the second row of
seats forwards for the following situations:
R For easier access to the cargo compartment
R Vehicles with a third row of seats: for getting
in or out
Vehicles with a center seat backrest: the center
rear seat folds forwards and backwards,
together with the left rear seat.
Depending on the vehicle equipment, you can
fold the rear seats forwards as follows:
R Six-seater: on the right-hand side of the vehi‐
cle only
Button on the backrest shoulder of the second row
of seats
102 Seats and stowing
#
When the rear door is closed: pull and hold
button 1 on the backrest shoulder of the
rear seat.
or
Press and hold button 2 on the armrest of
the third row of seats.
The head restraint moves downwards. The
seat backrest moves into the front position.
The rear seat moves forwards until it
unlocks. The rear seat then tips forwards.
If a seat on the second row of seats is not
engaged, this will be shown on the multifunc‐
tion display on the instrument cluster.
% You can prevent the rear seats from folding
forwards when the rear door is closed by
activating the child safety lock for the back
windows (/ page 65).
#
Button on the armrest of the third row of seats
(seven-seater)
#
When the rear door is open: briefly pull but‐
ton 1 on the backrest shoulder of the rear
seat.
or
#
Briefly press button 2 on the armrest of the
third row of seats.
Folding back the rear seat
Press and hold button 1 on the backrest
shoulder of the rear seat or 2 on the arm‐
#
#
rest of the third row of seats and hold it
down until the rear seat audibly engages.
The rear seat tips downwards and move
back. The seat backrests and head restraint
will then move into a suitable seat position
automatically.
If a seat on the second row of seats is not
engaged, this will be shown on the multifunc‐
tion display on the instrument cluster.
To interrupt the folding procedure before
engagement, let go of button 1. To continue
the folding procedure, press and hold button
1 again.
Folding the rear seats forwards mechanically
(emergency release)
You can also fold the rear seats forwards
mechanically using release loops. The release
loops are located on the outer sides and backs
of the seats on the second row of seats.
Seats and stowing 103
#
#
#
Pull one of the release loops 1.
Fold the seat backrest forwards.
Before you start the journey, make sure that
the seat backrest and the rear bench seat
are engaged.
Head restraints
Release loops on the second row of seats
Release loops on the backs of the second row of
seats
Adjusting the front seat head restraints man‐
ually
& WARNING Risk of accident due to
adjusting vehicle settings while the vehi‐
cle is in motion
You could lose control of the vehicle in the
following situations in particular:
R If you adjust the driver's seat, the head
restraints, the steering wheel or the mir‐
ror while the vehicle is in motion.
R If you fasten your seat belt while the vehi‐
cle is in motion.
#
Before starting the engine: adjust the
driver's seat, the head restraints, the
steering wheel and the mirror and fas‐
ten your seat belt.
& WARNING Risk of injury due to head
restraints not being installed or being
adjusted incorrectly
If head restraints have not been installed or
have not been adjusted correctly, there is an
increased risk of injury in the head and neck
area, e.g. in the event of an accident or when
braking.
# Always drive with the head restraints
installed.
# Before driving off, make sure for every
vehicle occupant that the center of the
head restraint supports the back of the
head at about eye level.
Do not interchange the head restraints of the
front and rear seats. Otherwise, you will not be
able to adjust the height and angle of the head
restraints correctly.
104 Seats and stowing
Adjust the head restraint fore-and-aft position so
that it is as close as possible to the back of your
head.
#
#
To move forward: press release knob 2
and pull the head restraint forward.
To move backwards: press release knob 2
and push the head restraint backwards.
Adjusting the EASY ADJUST luxury head
restraints on the front seats mechanically
Adjusting the front seat luxury head
restraints mechanically
#
#
#
To raise: pull the head restraint up.
To lower: press release knob 1 in the direc‐
tion of the arrow and push the head restraint
down.
#
To move forward: press release knob 1
and pull the head restraint forward.
To move backwards: press release knob 1
and push the head restraint backwards.
#
#
To move forward: press release knob 1
and pull the head restraint forward.
To move backwards: press release knob 1
and push the head restraint backwards.
Seats and stowing 105
To adjust the side bolsters of the head
restraint: pull or push right or left-hand side
bolster 2.
% The fore-and-aft position of the head
restraint will be adjusted automatically when
you adjust the backrest using the buttons on
the door control panel.
Vehicles with a third row of seats
The head restraints on the third row of seats
have a usage position and a non-usage position.
The usage position is the extended, top position
in which the head restraint engages; the nonusage position is the bottom, retracted position
of the head restraint. If the seats on the third
row of seats are being used, the head restraint
must be in the top, engaged usage position.
# If the third row of seats is occupied: move
the head restraints to the very top and have
them engage there.
# If the third row of seats is not occupied:
move the head restraints to the very bottom.
#
Adjusting the head restraints of the rear
seats mechanically
Depending on the vehicle equipment, you can
mechanically adjust the head restraints on the
third row of seats as well as the center head
restraint on the second row of seats.
Head restraint of the standard vehicle (example)
#
#
#
To raise: pull the head restraint up.
To lower (standard vehicle): press release
knob 1 in the direction of the arrow and
push the head restraint down.
To lower (Mercedes-Maybach vehicles):
push the head restraint down.
106 Seats and stowing
Installing/removing the head restraint of the
middle rear seat on the second row
Removing
#
Push release knob 1 in the direction of the
arrow and pull out the head restraint.
Installing
Insert the head restraint such that the
notches on the bar are on the left when
viewed in the direction of travel.
# Push the head restraint down until it
engages.
# Fold the middle rear seat backrest back until
it engages.
#
Adjusting the luxury head restraints of the
rear seats mechanically
Mercedes-Maybach vehicles: you can set only
the side bolsters mechanically. You can adjust
the angle of the head restraint electrically.
#
#
Release the middle rear seat backrest and
fold it forward slightly (/ page 124).
Pull the head restraint upwards as far as it
will go.
Head restraint of the standard vehicle (example)
#
#
To adjust the side bolsters of the head
restraint: pull or push right or left-hand side
bolster 1.
To adjust the angle of the head restraint:
pull or push the head restraint in the direc‐
tion of arrow 2.
Attaching and removing the additional cush‐
ion of the luxury head restraint in the rear
compartment
Use the additional cushion only when the vehicle
is stationary. The additional cushion is in the
vehicle.
Seats and stowing 107
Configuring the seat settings
Multimedia system:
4 © 5 Comfort
5
Seat Comfort
Adjusting the backrest contour in the lumbar
region of the seat backrest (lumbar)
# Select Lumbar.
# Select the settings Z for the desired seat.
# Adjust the air cushions.
Adjusting the backrest side bolsters
Select Side Bolsters.
# Adjust the air cushion for the desired seat.
#
#
#
#
Position the head restraint as far forwards as
possible.
To attach the additional cushion: hold
additional cushion 1 against the head
restraint and push press studs 2 into the
counterpieces.
To remove the additional cushion: release
press studs 2 and remove additional cush‐
ion 1.
Setting the seat heating balance
Select Seat Heating Balance.
# Adjust the heat distribution for the desired
seat.
#
Setting automatic seat adjustment
& WARNING Risk of becoming trapped
during adjustment of the driver's seat
after calling up a driver profile
Selecting a profile may trigger an adjustment
of the driver's seat to the position saved
under the profile. You or other vehicle occu‐
pants could be injured in the process.
# Make sure that when the position of
driver's seat is being adjusted using the
multimedia system, no people or body
parts are in the seat's range of move‐
ment.
If there is a risk of someone becoming trap‐
ped, stop the adjustment process immedi‐
ately:
# a) Tap the warning message on the
media display.
or
108 Seats and stowing
#
b) Press a memory position button or a
seat adjustment switch on the driver's
door.
The adjustment process is stopped.
Requirements:
R Adapting the driver's seat and steering wheel
position to the body size: automatic seat
adjustment has been switched on.
Multimedia system:
4 © 5 Settings 5 Vehicle
5 Automatic Seat Adjustment
Switching automatic seat adjustment on/off
When the active user profile is changed while
the vehicle is stationary, the driver's seat, steer‐
ing wheel, outside mirrors and seat contour will
automatically be adapted to the driver.
# Select On or Off.
% This setting is available only for individual
user profiles. For the guest profile, auto‐
matic seat adjustment cannot be switched
on or off. Further information about user
profiles .
Adjusting driver's seat and steering wheel
position to body size
The vehicle calculates a suitable driver's seat
and steering wheel position on the basis of the
driver's body size and sets this directly.
# To set the unit of measurement: select cm
or ft/in.
# Set the size using the scale.
# Select Start Positioning.
The driver's seat and steering wheel position
is adjusted to the body size that has been
set.
% If the driver's seat and steering wheel posi‐
tion calculated by the vehicle is not practical
or comfortable, it can be manually changed
at any time via the buttons.
The exterior mirrors are not set via this func‐
tion. Instead, they have to be set manually
via the switches.
% You can also make these settings via the
Mercedes me portal for your user profile. By
synchronising the profiles in the vehicle and
the Mercedes me connect profiles, you can
carry over these settings for your vehicle.
Further information about synchronising
user profiles .
Setting the easy entry and exit feature
Select Steering Wheel & Seat, Steering
Wheel Only or Off.
% If you use an individual user profile and have
set your body size, this information is carried
over for the easy entry and exit feature. This
causes the driver's seat and steering wheel
to automatically move into the correct posi‐
tion .
#
Overview of massage programs
R
R
Hot Relaxing Back Combination of heat and
massage. It starts by massaging the back. In
addition, warm pressure points become
noticeable, starting in the pelvic area.
Hot Relaxing Shoulder Combination of heat
and massage. It starts by massaging the
shoulders. In addition, warm pressure points
become noticeable, starting in the pelvic
area.
Seats and stowing 109
R
R
R
R
R
Activating Massage Activating massage with
upward-moving massage waves.
Classic Massage Relaxing back massage.
Wave Massage Regenerating massage via
massage waves across the back and in the
seat cushion.
Mobilizing Massage Mobilizing Massage with
upward-moving massage waves. Can pro‐
mote deeper respiration and hence improve
circulation and blood pressure.
Active Workout, Backrest and Active Workout, Cushion These programs require your
cooperation. Alternating between tensing
and releasing helps to improve blood flow to
your muscles. Press against a pressure point
as soon as you feel it.
Selecting the massage program for the front
seats
Multimedia system:
4 © 5 Comfort 5 Massage
# Select a massage program (/ page 108).
Start the program for the desired seat ;.
To set the massage intensity: switch High
Intensity on or off.
% For the rear seats, the massage program can
be selected on the following devices (if avail‐
able):
R On the rear displays
The selection can be made for the rear
seats on the second and third rows of
seats.
R On the MBUX rear tablet
The selection is made in the same way as
on the rear displays for the rear seats on
the second row of seats.
#
#
Resetting seat settings
Multimedia system:
4 © 5 Comfort 5 Seat Comfort
# Select ß for the desired seat.
# Confirm the prompt.
Switching the seat heating on/off
& WARNING Risk of burns due to repeat‐
edly switching on the seat heating
Repeatedly switching on the seat heating can
cause the seat cushion and seat backrest
padding to become very hot.
The health of persons with limited tempera‐
ture sensitivity or a limited ability to react to
high temperatures may be affected or they
may even suffer burn-like injuries.
# Do not repeatedly switch on the seat
heating.
To protect against overheating, the seat heating
may be temporarily deactivated after it is
switched on repeatedly.
* NOTE Damage to the seats caused by
objects or documents when the seat
heating is switched on
When the seat heating is switched on, over‐
heating may occur due to objects or docu‐
110 Seats and stowing
ments placed on the seats, e.g. seat cush‐
ions or child seats. This could cause damage
to the seat surface.
# Make sure that no objects or docu‐
ments are on the seats when the seat
heating is switched on.
Requirements:
R The power supply is switched on.
Seat heating in the cockpit
Seat heating in the rear passenger compartment
Seats and stowing 111
10 and 20 minutes until the seat heating is
switched off.
Setting the panel heating
Multimedia system:
4 © 5 Settings 5 Vehicle
5 Panel Heating
When the seat heating is switched on, the armr‐
ests, the door center panel and the center con‐
sole can be heated.
# Switch the function for the desired seats on
or off.
Seat heating in the third row of seats
Press button 1 repeatedly until the desired
heating level is set.
Depending on the heating level, up to three
indicator lamps will light up. If all indicator
lamps are off, the seat heating is switched
off.
% The seat heating will automatically switch
down from the three heating levels after 8,
#
Switching the seat ventilation on/off
Requirements:
R The power supply is switched on.
Seat ventilation in the cockpit
112 Seats and stowing
Steering wheel
Adjusting the steering wheel mechanically
& WARNING Risk of accident due to
adjusting vehicle settings while the vehi‐
cle is in motion
#
#
Never leave children unattended in the
vehicle.
When leaving the vehicle, always take
the SmartKey with you and lock the
vehicle.
You could lose control of the vehicle in the
following situations in particular:
R If you adjust the driver's seat, the head
restraints, the steering wheel or the mir‐
ror while the vehicle is in motion.
R If you fasten your seat belt while the vehi‐
cle is in motion.
Seat ventilation in the rear passenger compartment
#
Press button 1 repeatedly until the desired
ventilation level is set.
Depending on the ventilation level, up to
three indicator lamps will light up. If all indi‐
cator lamps are off, the seat ventilation is
switched off.
#
Before starting the engine: adjust the
driver's seat, the head restraints, the
steering wheel and the mirror and fas‐
ten your seat belt.
& WARNING Risk of entrapment for chil‐
dren when adjusting the steering wheel
Children could injure themselves if they
adjust the steering wheel.
#
To unlock: push release lever 1 down as
far as it will go.
Seats and stowing 113
#
#
#
Adjust height 2 and distance 3 to the
steering wheel.
To lock: push release lever 1 up as far as it
will go.
Check and make sure that the steering col‐
umn is locked by moving the steering wheel.
R
The ignition is switched on.
#
To switch on: push the switch to position
1.
Indicator lamp 3 lights up.
To switch off: push the switch to position
2.
Indicator lamp 3 goes out.
Adjusting the steering wheel electrically
The steering wheel can be adjusted when the
ignition is switched off.
1 To adjust the distance to the steering wheel
2 To adjust the height
#
Save the settings with the memory function
(/ page 115).
#
Switching the steering wheel heater on or off
Requirements:
114 Seats and stowing
When you switch the ignition off, the steering
wheel heater switches off.
Easy entry and exit feature
Using the easy entry and exit feature
& WARNING Risk of accident when pulling
away during the adjustment process for
the easy exit feature
You could lose control of the vehicle.
# Always wait until the adjustment proc‐
ess is complete before pulling away.
#
If someone becomes trapped, move the
steering wheel adjustment lever.
The adjustment process will be stop‐
ped.
If there is a risk of becoming trapped by the
driver's seat:
# Press the seat adjustment switch.
The adjustment process will be stop‐
ped.
You can stop the adjustment process by press‐
ing one of the memory function position
switches.
& WARNING Risk of becoming trapped
while adjusting the easy entry and exit
feature
& WARNING Risk of becoming trapped
during activation of the easy entry and
exit feature by children
You and other vehicle occupants could
become trapped.
# Ensure that no-one has a body part in
the range of movement of the seat or
steering wheel.
If children activate the easy entry and exit
feature, they can become trapped, particu‐
larly when unattended.
# Never leave children unattended in the
vehicle.
#
When leaving the vehicle, always take
the SmartKey with you and lock the
vehicle.
If the easy entry and exit feature is active, the
steering wheel will move upwards and the driv‐
er's seat will move back in the following situa‐
tions:
R You switch the ignition off with the driver's
door open.
R You open the driver's door with the ignition
switched off.
% The steering wheel will then move upwards
only if it is not already as high as it will go.
The driver's seat will then move backwards
only if it is not already in the rearmost posi‐
tion.
The driver's seat backrest will then move for‐
wards only if it is not already in the front‐
most position.
Seats and stowing 115
The steering wheel and the driver's seat will
move back to the last drive position in the fol‐
lowing cases:
R You switch the power supply or the ignition
on when the driver's door is closed.
R You close the driver's door with the ignition
switched on.
The last drive position will be saved when:
R You switch the ignition off.
R You save the seat settings via the memory
function
If you press one of the memory function position
switches, the adjustment process will be stop‐
ped.
Operating the memory function
& WARNING Risk of an accident if the
memory function is used while driving
If you use the memory function on the driv‐
er's side while driving, you could lose control
of the vehicle as a result of the adjustments
being made.
# Only use the memory function on the
driver's side when the vehicle is station‐
ary.
& WARNING Risk of entrapment when set‐
ting the seat with the memory function
When the memory function adjusts the seat,
you and other vehicle occupants – particu‐
larly children – could become trapped.
# During the adjustment process of the
memory function, make sure that no
one has any body parts in the sweep of
the seat.
# If someone becomes trapped, press a
preset position button or seat adjust‐
ment switch immediately.
& WARNING Risk of entrapment if the
memory function is activated by children
Children could become trapped if they acti‐
vate the memory function, particularly when
unattended.
# Never leave children unattended in the
vehicle.
# When leaving the vehicle, always take
the SmartKey with you and lock the
vehicle.
You can use the memory function when the igni‐
tion is switched off.
Storing
Seat adjustments for up to three people can be
stored and called up using the memory function.
You can save settings for the following systems:
R Front seat
R Outside mirrors
R Head-up Display
R Steering column
R Seat contour
116 Seats and stowing
#
To call up: press and briefly hold preset posi‐
tion button 4, T or U.
After releasing the button, all systems are
moved into the stored position.
Memory function in the rear passenger
compartment
Operating the rear seat via the memory func‐
tion in the rear passenger compartment
#
#
Set all systems to the desired position.
Briefly press the V memory button and
then press preset position 4, T or
U within three seconds.
An acoustic signal sounds. The settings are
stored.
Storing
Seat adjustments for the rear seat can be stored
and called up using the memory function in the
rear passenger compartment.
R Driver's side: two persons
R Front passenger side: one person
You can save the following settings for the rear
seat:
R Position of the seat, backrest and head
restraint
R Seat heating: distribution of the heated sec‐
tions of the seat cushion and seat backrest
#
#
Press button 1.
The rear seat is selected if the indicator lamp
in the button does not light up.
Adjust the rear seat using the buttons in the
door control panel (/ page 98).
Seats and stowing 117
Calling up
Briefly press memory button M and then
press preset position button 1 or 2 within
three seconds.
The settings for the rear seat are stored in
the corresponding preset position.
% You cannot store any settings on the button
for straightening the fully reclined position.
#
#
#
Press button 1.
The rear seat is selected if the indicator lamp
in the button does not light up.
Press corresponding preset position button 1
or 2.
The rear seat moves to the stored position.
Operating the front passenger seat and rear
seats via the memory function in the rear
passenger compartment
Requirements:
118 Seats and stowing
R
For selecting the front passenger seat: the
power supply is switched on
#
Storing
Seat adjustments for the front passenger seat
and the rear seat can be stored and called up
using the rear seat memory function.
You can save the following settings for the front
passenger seat:
R Position of the seat, backrest and head
restraint
You can save the following settings for the rear
seat:
R Position of the seat, backrest and head
restraint
R Seat heating: distribution of the heated sec‐
tions of the seat cushion and seat backrest
#
#
#
#
Press button 1.
The rear seat is selected if the indicator lamp
in the button does not light up.
Adjust the rear seat using the buttons in the
door control panel (/ page 98).
Press button 1.
When the indicator lamp lights up, the front
passenger seat is selected.
Adjust the front passenger seat using the
buttons on the door control panel in the rear
passenger compartment (/ page 94).
Ensure that the indicator lamp in button 1
lights up.
Seats and stowing 119
Press memory button M and, within three
seconds, press preset position button 1.
The settings for the front passenger seat and
the rear seat are stored in the preset posi‐
tion.
% You cannot store any settings on the buttons
for setting and straightening the fully
reclined position.
#
#
Press button 1.
When the indicator lamp lights up, the front
passenger seat is selected.
Stowage areas
Notes on loading the vehicle
& DANGER Risk of exhaust gas poisoning
Combustion engines emit poisonous exhaust
gases such as carbon monoxide. Exhaust
gases can enter the vehicle interior if the tail‐
gate is open when the engine is running,
especially if the vehicle is in motion.
# Always switch off the engine before
opening the tailgate.
# Never drive with the tailgate open.
Calling up
& WARNING Risk of injury from unsecured
items in the vehicle
Press preset position button 1.
Both seats move into the stored position.
% You can use the rear-compartment child
safety lock to disable this function
(/ page 65).
#
If objects, luggage or loads are not secured
or not secured sufficiently, they could slip,
tip over or be thrown around and thereby hit
vehicle occupants.
There is a risk of injury, particularly in the
event of sudden braking or a sudden change
in direction.
120 Seats and stowing
#
#
Always stow objects in such a way that
they cannot be thrown around.
Before the journey, secure objects, lug‐
gage or loads against slipping or tipping
over.
& WARNING Risk of injury due to objects
being stowed incorrectly
If you do not adequately stow objects in the
vehicle interior, they could slip or be tossed
around and thereby strike vehicle occupants.
In addition, cup holders, open stowage
spaces and mobile phone brackets cannot
always restrain the objects they contain in
the event of an accident.
There is a risk of injury, particularly in the
event of sudden braking or a sudden change
in direction.
# Always stow objects in such a way that
they cannot be tossed about in these or
similar situations.
#
#
#
Always make sure that objects do not
project from stowage spaces, parcel
nets or stowage nets.
Close the lockable stowage spaces
before starting a journey.
Stow and secure objects that are heavy,
hard, pointed, sharp-edged, fragile or
too large in the cargo compartment.
& WARNING ‑ Risk of accident or injury
when using the cup holder while the
vehicle is moving
The cup holder cannot secure containers
while the vehicle is moving.
If you use a cup holder while the vehicle is
moving, the container may be flung around
and liquids may be spilled. The vehicle occu‐
pants may come into contact with the liquid
and if it is hot, they could be scalded. You
could be distracted from traffic conditions
and you may lose control of the vehicle.
# Only use the cup holder when the vehi‐
cle is stationary.
#
#
Only use the cup holder for containers
of the right size.
Close the container, particularly if the
liquid is hot.
* NOTE Damage to the cup holder
When the rear armrest is folded back the cup
holder could become damaged.
# Only fold the rear armrest back when
the cup holder is closed.
* NOTE Damage to the rear armrest due to
body weight
When folded out, the rear armrest can be
damaged by body weight.
# Do not sit or support yourself on the
rear seat armrest.
Seats and stowing 121
& WARNING Risk of injury due to an open
cargo compartment floor
If you drive with the cargo compartment floor
open, objects could be flung around and hit
vehicle occupants as a result. There is a risk
of injury, particularly in the event of sudden
braking or a sudden change in direction.
# Always close the cargo compartment
floor before a journey.
& WARNING ‑ Risk of fire and injury from
hot cigarette lighter
You can burn yourself if you touch the hot
heating element or the socket of the ciga‐
rette lighter.
In addition, flammable materials may ignite
if:
R you drop the hot cigarette lighter
R a child holds the hot cigarette lighter to
objects, for example
#
#
#
Always hold the cigarette lighter by the
knob.
Always make sure that the cigarette
lighter is out of reach of children.
Never leave children unattended in the
vehicle.
& WARNING Risk of burns from the tail‐
pipe and tailpipe trims
The exhaust tailpipe and tailpipe trims can
become very hot. If you come into contact
with these parts of the vehicle, you could
burn yourself.
# Always be particularly careful around
the tailpipe and the tailpipe trims and
supervise children especially closely in
this area.
# Allow vehicle parts to cool down before
touching them.
The driving characteristics of your vehicle are
dependent on the distribution of the load within
the vehicle. You should bear the following in
mind when loading the vehicle:
R Never exceed the permissible gross mass or
the gross axle weight rating for the vehicle
(including occupants). The values are speci‐
fied on the vehicle identification plate on the
vehicle's B-pillar.
R The load must not protrude above the upper
edge of the seat backrests.
R All vehicles except Mercedes-Maybach vehi‐
cles: always use the partition net when trans‐
porting objects in the cargo compartment.
R Always place the load behind unoccupied
seats if possible.
R Secure the load using the tie-down eyes and
distribute the load evenly.
122 Seats and stowing
Stowage spaces in the vehicle interior
Overview of the front storage compartments
3 Mercedes-Maybach vehicles: storage/tele‐
phone compartment with temperature-con‐
trolled cup holder, USB ports (depending on
the vehicle equipment) and charging module
for wireless charging of mobile phones
(depending on the vehicle equipment) in the
front center console
4 Glove box
#
Make sure that the folding tables are
folded in when moving the front seats
back.
Folding out
This equipment is available only for MercedesMaybach vehicles.
Folding the folding table out or in
& WARNING Risk of injury from an open
folding table
1 Storage space in the doors
2 Storage compartment in the armrest with
USB ports (depending on vehicle equipment)
3 Storage/telephone compartment with cup
holder in the center console at front
Vehicle occupants may bump into the folding
table and injure themselves.
# Close the folding table before each jour‐
ney.
* NOTE Damage to the folding tables when
moving the seats back
Open folding tables may be damaged when
the seats are moved back.
#
#
#
#
Open rear armrest 1.
Pull the folding table forwards and upwards
by recess 2 or 3 and swing outwards.
Fold the table panels apart.
To fold in: fold the table panels together and
swing in the folding table.
Seats and stowing 123
Opening the stowage box in the backrest in
the rear compartment
Removing the handset from the storage com‐
partment in the rear passenger compart‐
ment
* NOTE Damage to the rear armrest due to
body weight
Opening the drawer
This equipment is available only for MercedesMaybach vehicles with individual rear seats.
When folded out, the rear armrest can be
damaged by body weight.
# Do not sit or support yourself on the
rear seat armrest.
This equipment is available only for MercedesMaybach vehicles.
Vehicles with individual seats (example)
#
#
Vehicles with 5-seater variant: fold down the
rear armrest.
Pull handle 1 and fold down cover 2.
Vehicles with individual rear seats
124 Seats and stowing
#
#
Press button 1.
Remove the handset.
Closing the drawer
# Place the handset in the drawer.
# Press the handset drawer back until it
engages.
Through-loading facility to cargo compart‐
ment
Folding the rear seat backrest forwards
& WARNING Risk of becoming trapped
when adjusting the seats
When you adjust a seat, you may trap your‐
self or a vehicle occupant.
# When adjusting a seat, make sure that
no one has any body parts in the sweep
of the seat.
& WARNING Risk of accident if the seat
and seat backrest are not engaged
R
The seat and seat backrest can fold for‐
wards.
There is a risk of the following, in particular:
R The vehicle occupant may be pressed
against the seat belt. The seat belt will
not be able to protect as intended and
could cause additional injury.
R A child restraint system will no longer be
properly supported or positioned and will
no longer fulfill its function as intended.
R The seat backrest will not be able restrain
objects or goods in the cargo compart‐
ment.
R
Always ensure that the seat and seat back‐
rest are engaged, in particular:
R Before persons travel in the vehicle while
sitting on a seat with the easy entry and
exit feature
R After you have adjusted the seat
After the easy entry and exit feature has
been used
After the cargo compartment enlarge‐
ment has been folded forwards
Always ensure that all vehicle occupants have
their seat belts fastened correctly and are sitting
properly. Particular attention must be paid to
children.
If you no longer require the folded-down rear
seat backrest as a load area, fold the backrest
back into place.
Make sure that the red marking of the lock verifi‐
cation indicator is no longer visible. Otherwise,
the seat backrest will not be locked.
Requirements:
R Vehicles with a center seat backrest: the
center seat backrest is not in the cargo com‐
partment floor position.
R Vehicles with a folding rear armrest: the rear
armrest has been folded up.
Seats and stowing 125
If a seat in the second row of seats is not
engaged and locked, this will be shown on the
multifunction display on the instrument cluster.
% Seven-seaters: all seat backrests can be fol‐
ded forwards together using the ALL button.
Folding the rear passenger compartment
center seat backrest forwards separately
(seven-seaters)
Seven-seater (example)
#
To fold the left or right seat backrest for‐
wards: briefly press one of buttons 1.
The head restraint on the seat backrest will
move into a suitable position. The rear seat
folds forwards.
Vehicles with a center seat backrest: the
center seat backrest folds forwards together
with the left seat backrest.
#
#
Press release catch 3.
Fold seat backrest 2 forwards.
Folding back the rear seat backrest
* NOTE Damage caused by trapping the
seat belt when folding back the seat
backrest
The seat belt could become trapped and thus
damaged when the seat backrest is folded
back.
# Make sure that the seat belt is not trap‐
ped when folding back the seat back‐
rest.
126 Seats and stowing
If a seat backrest is not engaged and locked,
this will be shown on the multifunction dis‐
play on the instrument cluster.
% Seven-seaters: all seat backrests can be fol‐
ded back together using the ALL button.
Folding the seat backrest on the third row of
seats forwards
Folding back the center seat backrest sepa‐
rately (seven-seaters)
# Swing the seat backrest back until it audibly
engages.
Seven-seater (example)
#
To fold back the seat backrest: briefly pull
one of buttons 1.
The rear seat folds back.
Vehicles with a center seat backrest: the
center seat backrest folds back together with
the left seat backrest.
Left-hand-drive vehicle (example)
#
In the rear passenger compartment (sevenseater): briefly pull one of buttons 1.
Seats and stowing 127
Folding back the seat backrest on the third
row of seats
#
In the cargo compartment: briefly press one
of buttons 1.
#
Left-hand-drive vehicle (example)
#
In the rear passenger compartment: briefly
press one of buttons 1.
If a seat backrest is not engaged and locked,
this will be shown on the multifunction dis‐
play on the instrument cluster.
In the cargo compartment: briefly pull one of
buttons 1.
If a seat backrest is not engaged and locked,
this will be shown on the multifunction dis‐
play on the instrument cluster.
128 Seats and stowing
EASY-PACK cargo compartment cover and
partition net cassette
Notes on the cargo compartment cover
#
Do not place any objects above the
lower edge of the side windows or on
the cargo compartment cover.
& WARNING Risk of injury or death due to
poorly secured objects
This equipment is available for all vehicles
except Mercedes-Maybach vehicles.
The cargo compartment cover alone cannot
secure or restrain heavy objects, items of
luggage or heavy loads.
You could be hit by an unsecured load, par‐
ticularly in the event of abrupt changes in
direction, sudden braking or an accident.
# Always stow objects in such a way that
they cannot be thrown around.
# Secure objects, luggage or loads
against slipping or tipping over, e.g. by
using tie downs, even if you are using
the cargo compartment cover.
Extending/retracting the cargo compart‐
ment cover
* NOTE Damage to the cargo compart‐
ment cover when loading the vehicle
The cargo compartment cover may be dam‐
aged when the vehicle is being loaded.
#
To extend: pull the cargo compartment
cover back by grab handle 1 and clip it into
brackets 2 on the left and right.
Retracting
# Remove the cargo compartment cover from
the brackets on the left and right.
# Guide the cargo compartment cover for‐
wards using the grab handle until it is fully
retracted.
The rolled-up cargo compartment cover can be
used in two positions:
R Folded 45° upwards for loading (fold down
before commencing your journey)
R Horizontal position
Installing or removing the cargo compart‐
ment cover
Requirements:
R The cargo compartment cover is rolled up.
Seats and stowing 129
Removing the cargo compartment cover
Installing the cargo compartment cover
#
#
#
#
#
Press end cap 1 on the left or right
inwards.
Pull out the cargo compartment cover back‐
wards.
Storing the cargo compartment cover
The cargo compartment cover can be stored
beneath the cargo compartment floor.
Open the cargo compartment floor .
To insert: place cargo compartment cover
1 into brackets 2. Ensure it is seated cor‐
rectly.
To remove: take the cargo compartment
cover out of brackets 2.
#
Place the cargo compartment cover in brack‐
ets 1 on the left and right.
The end caps of the cargo compartment
cover engage audibly.
130 Seats and stowing
Attaching/removing the partitioning net
& WARNING Risk of injury or death due to
poorly secured objects
This equipment is available for all vehicles
except Mercedes-Maybach vehicles.
The partitioning net alone cannot secure or
restrain heavy objects, items of luggage or
heavy loads.
You could be hit by an unsecured load, par‐
ticularly in the event of abrupt changes in
direction, sudden braking or an accident.
# Always stow objects in such a way that
they cannot be thrown around.
# Secure objects, luggage or loads
against slipping or tipping over, e.g. by
using tie downs, even if you are using
the partitioning net.
For safety reasons, always use a partitioning net
when transporting a load. The partitioning net
can be used with or without cargo compartment
enlargement
Damaged partitioning nets can no longer fulfill
their functions and must be replaced. Visit a
qualified specialist workshop.
Partitioning net with cargo compartment
enlargement
Partitioning net without cargo compartment
enlargement
#
#
#
To attach: extend the partition net.
Attach the top guide rod to holders 1 on
the headliner.
Engage hooks 2 in eyelets 3 on the left
and right.
Seats and stowing 131
#
#
#
#
#
Overview of bag hooks
Pull on the loose ends of the lashing straps
until the partitioning net is tight.
After driving a short distance, check the ten‐
sion of the partitioning net and re-tension it if
necessary.
To remove: pull the belt clamps until the
lashing straps are loose.
Remove hooks 2 from eyelets 3 on the
left and right.
Remove the top guide rod from the holders
1.
& WARNING Risk of injury when using bag
hooks with heavy objects
The bag hooks cannot restrain heavy objects
or items of luggage.
Objects or items of luggage may be flung
around and hit vehicle occupants.
# Only hang light objects on the bag
hooks.
# Never hang hard, sharp-edged or fragile
objects on the bag hooks.
Overview of the tie-down eyes in the cargo
compartment
Observe the notes on loading the vehicle
(/ page 119).
1 Cargo tie-down rings
The front tie-down eyes are accessible when the
third row of seats is in the cargo compartment
floor position (/ page 124).
% Mercedes-Maybach vehicles: both tie-down
eyes on Mercedes-Maybach vehicles are
located in the rear of the cargo compart‐
ment, left and right.
Observe the notes on loading the vehicle
(/ page 119).
Subject the bag hooks to a maximum load of
6.6 lbs (3 kg) and do not attach any goods to
them.
132 Seats and stowing
1 Coat hook on the tailgate
Coat hooks are not suitable for heavy objects.
Use the coat hooks only for light objects such as
jackets.
1 Bag hook
Coat hook on the tailgate
This equipment is available for all vehicles
except Mercedes-Maybach vehicles.
Locking and unlocking the cargo compart‐
ment floor
This equipment is available for all vehicles
except Mercedes-Maybach vehicles.
#
Turn the emergency key a quarter turn clock‐
wise 2 (to lock) or counter-clockwise 1 (to
unlock).
Seats and stowing 133
Attaching a roof luggage rack
#
& WARNING Risk of accident due to
exceeding the maximum roof load
The vehicle center of gravity and the usual
driving characteristics as well as the steering
and braking characteristics alter.
If you exceed the maximum roof load, the
driving characteristics, as well as steering
and braking, will be greatly impaired.
# Never exceed the maximum roof load
and adjust your driving style.
You will find information on the maximum roof
load in the "Technical data" section.
* NOTE Vehicle damage from nonapproved roof luggage racks
The vehicle could be damaged by roof lug‐
gage racks that have not been tested and
approved for Mercedes-Benz.
# Use only roof luggage racks tested and
approved for Mercedes-Benz.
#
#
Depending on the vehicle equipment,
ensure that the sliding sunroof can be
fully raised when the roof luggage rack
is installed.
Depending on the vehicle equipment,
ensure that the tailgate can be fully
opened when the roof luggage rack is
installed.
Position the load on the roof luggage
rack in such a way that the vehicle will
not sustain damage even when it is in
motion.
* NOTE Damage to the panorama roof with
power tilt/sliding panel due to nonapproved roof luggage racks
The panorama roof with power tilt/sliding
panel may be damaged by the roof luggage
rack if you attempt to open it when using a
roof luggage rack not tested and approved
for Mercedes-Benz.
# When a roof luggage rack is installed,
open the panorama roof with power
tilt/sliding panel only if this has been
tested and approved for MercedesBenz.
The panorama roof with power tilt/sliding
panel may be raised to allow ventilation of
the vehicle interior.
#
#
Secure the roof luggage rack to the roof rail‐
ing.
Observe the manufacturer's installation
instructions.
Cup holder
Switching the cooling or heating function for
the temperature-controlled cup holder on or
off
& WARNING Risk of injury by touching the
heating elements
The cup holder's heating elements may be
very hot.
You can burn yourself on them.
134 Seats and stowing
#
#
#
Do not touch the cup holder's hot heat‐
ing elements.
Ensure that no children can access the
cup holder's hot heating elements.
Never leave children unattended in the
vehicle.
* NOTE Damage to objects in the tempera‐
ture-controlled cup holder
If you place objects into the temperaturecontrolled cup holder, they may become
damaged.
# Do not place objects into the tempera‐
ture-controlled cup holder.
Cup holder in the front center console
Cup holder in the rear passenger compartment cen‐
ter console
Seats and stowing 135
To switch off: press button 2 repeatedly
until the indicator lamp on the button goes
out.
% Clean the removable rubber mat only with
clean, lukewarm water and the cup holder
only with a soft cloth.
#
Cup holder in the rear passenger compartment cen‐
ter console (Mercedes-Maybach four-seater vehi‐
cles)
#
To switch on: on cup holder 1, press but‐
ton 2 repeatedly until the blue (keep cool)
or red (keep warm) indicator lamp on the but‐
ton lights up.
If you use the heating function, the metal
insert of the cup holder is heated. Once a
certain temperature has been reached, the
warning lamp lights up. Do not reach into the
cup holder's metal insert when the warning
lamp is lit.
Sockets
Using the 12 V socket in the front center
console
Requirements:
R Only connect devices up to a maximum of
240 W (20 A).
Depending on the vehicle equipment, the vehicle
has the following 12 V sockets:
R In the storage compartment in the front cen‐
ter console
R In the cargo compartment
Example: 12 V socket in the storage compartment
in the front center console
#
Lift up cap 1 of the socket and insert the
plug of the device.
If you have connected a device to the 12 V
socket, leave the cover of the storage compart‐
ment open.
136 Seats and stowing
Using the 115 V socket in the rear passenger
compartment
& DANGER Risk of fatal injury due to incor‐
rect handling of the socket
& DANGER Risk of fatal injury due to dam‐
aged connecting cables or sockets
You could receive an electric shock in partic‐
ular:
R If you reach into the socket.
R If you insert unsuitable devices or objects
into the socket.
You could receive an electric shock if the
connecting cable or the 115 V power socket
is pulled out of the trim or is damaged or
wet.
# Use only connecting cables that are dry
and free of damage.
# When the ignition is switched off, make
sure that the 115 V power socket is dry.
# Immediately have the 115 V power
socket checked or replaced at a quali‐
fied specialized workshop if it is dam‐
aged or has been pulled out of the trim.
# Never plug the connecting cable into a
115 V power socket that is damaged or
has been pulled out of the trim.
#
#
Do not reach into the socket.
Only connect suitable devices to the
socket.
Requirements:
R Only connect devices with a suitable plug
which conforms to the standards specific to
the country you are in.
R Only connect devices up to a maximum of
150 watts (1.30 A).
R Do not use multiple socket outlets.
Depending on the vehicle equipment, the design
of the center console and storage compartment
may differ.
Using the 115 V socket in the center console of the
rear passenger compartment
Seats and stowing 137
#
Insert the plug of the device into 115 V
socket 1.
When the on-board electrical system voltage
is sufficient, indicator lamp 2 lights up.
Overview of USB ports
115 V socket in the center console of the rear
passenger compartment (Mercedes-Maybach 4seat vehicles)
#
#
Mercedes-Maybach vehicles with individual
rear seats: open the storage compartment of
the center console of the rear passenger
compartment .
Open flap 3.
Depending on the vehicle equipment, the vehicle
has the following USB ports:
R In the storage compartment of the cockpit
armrest (/ page 122)
R In the front center console next to the mobile
phone storage compartment
R In the rear passenger compartment center
console
R Vehicles with Rear Comfort Package: in the
center armrest of the second row of seats in
the rear compartment
R Mercedes-Maybach vehicles with 5 seats in
the rear passenger compartment: in the cen‐
ter armrest in the rear passenger compart‐
ment
R
R
Mercedes-Maybach vehicles with individual
rear seats: in the center console of the rear
passenger compartment
Vehicles with three rows of seats: to the right
and left next to the seat
If the ignition is switched on you can charge USB
devices, e.g. mobile phones, at USB ports. The
charging voltage is approximately 5 V (up to
3 A).
Refrigerator box
Using the refrigerator box
& WARNING Risk of fire due to a covered
vent grille on the refrigerator box
If you cover the vent grille for the refrigerator
box, it may overheat.
# Always make sure that the vent grille is
not covered.
The ventilation grille for the refrigerator box is in
the trunk.
138 Seats and stowing
This equipment is available only for MercedesMaybach vehicles.
Subject the refrigerator box to a maximum load
of 7.7 lb (3.5 kg) .
Store only plastic bottles in the upper compart‐
ment of the refrigerator box. The contents of the
bottle must be no more than 17 fl. oz.
(0.5 liters).
If you do not need to use the refrigerator box for
an extended period, switch it off, defrost it and
clean it. After doing so, leave the lid open for a
time.
The refrigerator box will reduce its cooling capa‐
city or switch off in the following cases:
R Too many electrical consumers are turned
on.
R The starter battery is not sufficiently
charged.
If this is the case, the indicator lamps will flash
on the button for switching the refrigerator box
on and off. The cooling function will automati‐
cally switch back on as soon as there is suffi‐
cient voltage.
% To install the refrigerator box in the cargo
compartment or remove it, please contact a
qualified specialist workshop.
Example: vehicles with individual rear seats
#
Example: vehicles with individual rear seats
#
#
Vehicles with 5-seater variant: fold down the
rear armrest.
Pull the handle of stowage box 1 and fold
down the cover of stowage box 2.
#
To open: pull the handle of refrigerator box
1 and fold down the cover of the refrigera‐
tor box.
To switch on: press button 2 repeatedly
until an indicator lamp (low cooling) lights up
or two indicator lamps (high cooling) light up.
Seats and stowing 139
#
To switch off: press button 2 repeatedly
until both indicator lamps go out.
Wireless charging of the mobile phone and
connection with the exterior antenna
Notes on wirelessly charging the mobile
phone
& WARNING Risk of injury due to objects
being stowed incorrectly
If objects in the vehicle interior are stowed
incorrectly, they can slide or be thrown
around and hit vehicle occupants. In addi‐
tion, cup holders, open stowage spaces and
mobile phone receptacles cannot always
retain all objects within.
There is a risk of injury, particularly in the
event of sudden braking or a sudden change
in direction.
# Always stow objects so that they can‐
not be thrown around in such situa‐
tions.
#
#
Always make sure that objects do not
protrude from stowage spaces, parcel
nets or stowage nets.
Close the lockable stowage spaces
before starting a journey.
Always stow and secure heavy, hard,
pointed, sharp-edged, fragile or bulky
objects in the trunk/cargo compart‐
ment.
* NOTE Damage to objects caused by
placing them in the mobile phone stor‐
age compartment
Observe the notes on loading the vehicle.
If objects are placed in the mobile phone
storage compartment, they may be damaged
by electromagnetic fields.
# Do not place credit cards, data storage
devices, ski passes or other objects
sensitive to electromagnetic fields in
the mobile phone storage compart‐
ment.
& WARNING Risk of fire from placing
objects in the mobile phone storage
compartment
* NOTE Damage to the mobile phone
stowage compartment caused by liquids
#
Placing other objects in the mobile phone
storage compartment could constitute a fire
hazard.
# Apart from a mobile phone, do not
place any other objects in the mobile
phone storage compartment, especially
those made of metal.
If liquids enter the mobile phone stowage
compartment, the compartment may be
damaged.
# Ensure that no liquids enter the mobile
phone stowage compartment.
Always observe the notes for persons with elec‐
tronic medical aids (/ page 29).
140 Seats and stowing
R
R
R
R
R
R
Depending on the vehicle equipment, the
mobile phone is connected to the vehicle's
exterior antenna via the charging module.
The charging function and wireless connec‐
tion of the mobile phone to the vehicle's
exterior antenna are only available if the igni‐
tion is switched on.
Small mobile phones may not be able to be
charged in every position of the mobile
phone storage compartment.
Large mobile phones which do not rest flat in
the mobile phone storage compartment may
not be able to be charged or connected with
the vehicle's exterior antenna.
The mobile phone may heat up during the
charging process. This may also depend on
the applications (apps) currently open in the
background.
To ensure more efficient charging and con‐
nection with the vehicle's exterior antenna,
remove the protective cover from the mobile
phone. Protective covers which are neces‐
sary for wireless charging are excluded.
Wireless charging of a mobile phone in the
cockpit
Requirements:
R The mobile phone is suitable for wireless
charging.
% A list of compatible mobile phones can be
found at: https://www.mercedes-benzmobile.com/
Malfunctions detected during the charging
process are shown in the multimedia system
display.
% The mat can be removed for cleaning, e.g.
using clean, lukewarm water.
Wireless charging of a mobile phone in the
rear passenger compartment
* NOTE Damage to the drawer in the cen‐
ter console of the rear passenger com‐
partment due to body weight
When open, the drawer in the center console
of the rear passenger compartment can be
damaged by body weight.
# Do not support yourself on the open
drawer.
#
Place the mobile phone as close to the cen‐
ter of mat 1 as possible with the display
facing upwards.
When a message is shown in the multimedia
system, the mobile phone is being charged.
Requirements:
R The mobile phone must be suitable for wire‐
less charging.
Seats and stowing 141
% A list of compatible mobile phones can be
found at: https://www.mercedes-benzmobile.com/
Installing/removing the floor mats
& WARNING Risk of accident due to
objects in the driver's footwell
Mat in the center console of the rear passenger
compartment (only Mercedes-Maybach vehicles
with individual rear seats)
Mat in front of the stowage compartment in the
rear armrest
#
Place the mobile phone as close to the cen‐
ter of mat 1 as possible with the display
facing upwards.
When the indicator lamp lights up, the mobile
phone is being charged.
Objects in the driver's footwell may impede
pedal travel or block a depressed pedal.
This jeopardizes the operating and road
safety of the vehicle.
# Stow all objects in the vehicle securely
so that they cannot get into the driver's
footwell.
# Always install the floor mats securely
and as prescribed in order to ensure
that there is always sufficient room for
the pedals.
# Do not use loose floor mats and do not
place floor mats on top of one another.
142 Seats and stowing
Installing floor mats
row of seats, slide the corresponding seat on
the second row of seats forwards.
Removing floor mats
# To remove: pull the floor mat off the holders
2.
# Remove the floor mat.
% Vehicles with a third row of seats (all
vehicles except Mercedes-Maybach vehi‐
cles): to remove the floor mats on the third
row of seats, slide the corresponding seat on
the second row of seats forwards.
Move the corresponding seat backwards and
lay the floor mat in the footwell.
# Press studs 1 onto holders 2.
# Adjust the corresponding seat.
% Vehicles with a third row of seats (all
vehicles except Mercedes-Maybach vehi‐
cles): to install the floor mats on the third
#
Light and visibility 143
Exterior lighting
Information about lighting systems and your
responsibility
Light switch
Operating the light switch
5 L Low beam/high beam
6 R Switches the rear fog light on/off
When low beam is activated, the T indicator
lamp for the parking lamps will be deactivated
and replaced by the L low-beam indicator
lamp.
# Always park your vehicle safely using suffi‐
cient lighting, in accordance with the rele‐
vant legal stipulations.
The various lighting systems of the vehicle are
only aids. The driver of the vehicle is responsible
for correct vehicle illumination in accordance
with the prevailing light and visibility conditions,
legal requirements and traffic situation.
* NOTE Battery discharging by operating
the standing lights
Operating the standing lights over a period of
hours puts a strain on the battery.
# Where possible, switch on the
right X or left W parking light.
1
2
3
4
W Left-hand standing lamps
X Right-hand standing lamps
T Parking lamps and license plate lamp
à Automatic driving lights (preferred light
switch position)
In the event of severe battery discharging, the
parking lamps or standing lamps will be
switched off automatically to facilitate the next
engine start.
144 Light and visibility
The exterior lighting (except standing and park‐
ing lamps) will switch off automatically when the
driver's door is opened.
R Observe the notes on surround lighting
(/ page 148).
Automatic driving lights function
The parking lamps, low beam and daytime run‐
ning lamps are switched on automatically
depending on the ignition status and the ambi‐
ent light.
& WARNING Risk of accident when the low
beam is switched off in poor visibility
When the light switch is set to Ã, the low
beam may not be switched on automatically
if there is fog, snow or other causes of poor
visibility such as spray.
# In such cases, turn the light switch to
L.
The automatic driving lights are only an aid. You
are responsible for vehicle lighting.
Switching the rear fog lamps on or off
Requirements:
R The light switch is in the L or à posi‐
tion.
#
Operating the combination switch for the
lights
Press the R button.
Please observe the country-specific laws on the
use of rear fog lamps.
% Vehicles with AIRMATIC or E-ACTIVE BODY
CONTROL with off-road package: when the
rear fog lamp is switched on, off-road level
+3 will not be available. If the rear fog lamp
is switched on and off-road level +3 is acti‐
vated, the vehicle will be lowered to off-road
level +2.
1
2
3
4
High beam
Turn signal light, right
High-beam flasher
Turn signal light, left
#
Use the combination switch to activate the
desired function.
Light and visibility 145
High beam
# To switch on: turn the light switch to the
L or à position.
# Push the combination switch in the direction
of arrow 1.
When the high beam is activated, the L
indicator lamp for low beam is deactivated
and replaced by the K indicator lamp for
high beam.
# To switch off: push the combination switch
in the direction of arrow 1 or pull it in the
direction of arrow 3.
#
To indicate permanently: push the combi‐
nation switch beyond the point of resistance
in the direction of arrow 2 or 4.
Vehicles with Active Lane Change Assist:
R Indicator operation activated by the driver
can extend for the duration of the lane
change.
R If the driver indicated directly beforehand
but a lane change was not immediately
possible, the turn signal indicator may
activate automatically.
Activating/deactivating the hazard warning
lights
High-beam flasher
# Pull the combination switch in the direction
of arrow 3.
Turn signal light
To indicate briefly: push the combination
switch briefly to the point of resistance in the
direction of arrow 2 or 4.
The corresponding turn signal light will flash
three times.
#
Press button 1.
The hazard warning lights will switch on auto‐
matically if:
R The airbag has been deployed.
#
When the indicator is activated, the hazard warn‐
ing lights are interrupted.
146 Light and visibility
Cornering light
Cornering light function
R
At speeds between 25 mph (40 km/h) and
45 mph (70 km/h) when the steering wheel
is turned
Roundabout and intersection function: the
cornering light will be activated on both sides
based on an evaluation of the vehicle's current
GPS position. It will remain active until after the
vehicle has left the roundabout or the intersec‐
tion.
Adaptive Highbeam Assist
The cornering light improves the illumination of
the road over a wide angle in the turning direc‐
tion, enabling better visibility on tight curves, for
example. It can be activated only when the low
beam is switched on.
The function is active under the following condi‐
tions:
R At speeds below 25 mph (40 km/h) when
the turn signal light is switched on or the
steering wheel is turned
Adaptive Highbeam Assist function
& WARNING Risk of accident despite
Adaptive Highbeam Assist
Adaptive Highbeam Assist does not react to:
Road users without lights, e.g. pedes‐
trians
R Road users with poor lighting, e.g.
cyclists
R Road users whose lighting is obstructed,
e.g. by a barrier
R
On very rare occasions, Adaptive Highbeam
Assist may fail to recognize other road users
with their own lighting, or may recognize
them too late.
In these, or in similar situations, the auto‐
matic high beam will not be deactivated or
will be activated despite the presence of
other road users.
# Always observe the road and traffic
conditions carefully and switch off the
high beam in good time.
System limits
Adaptive Highbeam Assist cannot take into
account road, weather or traffic conditions.
Detection may be restricted in the following
cases:
R In poor visibility, e.g. fog, heavy rain or snow
R If there is dirt on the sensors or the sensors
are obscured
Adaptive Highbeam Assist is only an aid. You are
responsible for adjusting the vehicle's lighting to
Light and visibility 147
the prevailing light, visibility and traffic condi‐
tions.
At speeds greater than 19 mph (30 km/h):
R If no other road users are detected, the high
beam will be switched on automatically.
The high beam switches off automatically in the
following cases:
R At speeds below 16 mph (25 km/h).
R If other road users are detected.
R If street lighting is sufficient.
At speeds greater than approximately 31 mph
(50 km/h):
R The headlamp range of the low beam is regu‐
lated automatically based on the distance to
other road users.
The system's optical sensor is located behind
the windshield near the overhead control panel.
The Adaptive Highbeam Assist automatically
switches between the following types of light:
R Low beam
R High beam
Switching Adaptive Highbeam Assist on/off
# To switch on: turn the light switch to
the à position.
#
#
Switch on the high beam using the combina‐
tion switch.
When the high beam is switched on automat‐
ically in the dark, the _ indicator lamp on
the multifunction display will light up.
To switch off: switch off the high beam
using the combination switch.
Switching the daytime running lamps on/off
Multimedia system:
4 © 5 Settings 5 Light
5 Daytime Run. Lights
# Activate D or deactivate E the func‐
tion.
Setting the exterior lighting switch-off delay
time
Requirements:
R The light switch is in the à position.
148 Light and visibility
Multimedia system:
4 © 5 Settings 5 Light
5 Exterior Lighting Delay
# Set the switch-off delay time.
When the vehicle engine is switched off, the
exterior lighting will be activated for the set
time.
#
Activate or deactivate the function.
Interior lighting
Adjusting the interior lighting
#
To switch on or off: press button 1 – 5
accordingly.
Control panel in the grab handle
Front overhead control panel
Switching the surround lighting on/off
Multimedia system:
4 © 5 Settings 5 Light
5 Locator Lighting
When Locator Lighting is active, the exterior
lighting lights up for 40 seconds after the vehicle
is unlocked. When you start the vehicle, the sur‐
round lighting is deactivated and the automatic
driving lights are activated.
Illuminated running boards: when the sur‐
round lighting is switched on, the illumination of
the running boards is activated when a door is
opened. If the door is not closed, the running
board courtesy lighting is automatically deactiva‐
ted after 40 seconds.
1 p Rear reading lamp
#
1
2
3
4
5
p Front left reading lamp
| Automatic interior lighting control
c Front interior lighting
u Rear interior lighting
p Front right reading lamp
To switch on or off: press button 1.
Light and visibility 149
Adjusting the ambient lighting
Multimedia system:
4 © 5 Settings
5 Ambient Lighting
5
Light
Setting the color
Select Color.
# Set the desired color.
#
Adjusting the brightness
Select Brightness.
#
Adjust the brightness.
Activating the brightness for zones
Select Brightness.
# Select Brightness Zones.
The ACCENT, AMBIANCE and ROOF zones
can be set separately.
#
Activating multi-color lighting
Select Color.
# Select Multi-color.
# Select a color combination.
#
Activating multi-color animation
# Select Color.
# Select Multi-color Animation.
The chosen color combination will change at
predefined intervals.
Activating welcome lighting
Select Color.
# Select Welcome.
When the vehicle is unlocked, a special ambi‐
ent lighting sequence will run.
#
Activating dependency on air conditioning
settings
# Select Color.
# Select Climate.
If changes are made to the temperature set‐
ting in the vehicle, the color of the ambient
lighting will change briefly.
Switching the interior lighting switch-off
delay time on/off
Multimedia system:
4 © 5 Settings 5 Light
5 Interior Lighting Delay
# Switch the switch-off delay time on or off.
When this function is active, the interior light‐
ing lights up for a short time after the vehicle
is locked.
150 Light and visibility
Windshield wiper and windshield washer
system
Switching the windshield wipers on/off
4 ° Continuous wiping, slow
5 ¯ Continuous wiping, fast
#
#
Switching the rear window wiper on/off
Turn the combination switch to the correct
position 1 - 5.
Single wipe/washing: push the button on
the combination switch in the direction of
arrow 1.
R í Single wipe
R î Wipes with washer fluid
Vehicles with MAGIC VISION CONTROL: in
position 2 or 3 , the windshield washing proc‐
ess is automatically triggered if dirt is detected
on the windshield unless the Check Washer Fluid
message is being displayed.
1 ô Single wipe/washing
2 è Intermittent wipe
1 g Windshield wipers off
2 Ä Automatic wiping, normal
3 Å Automatic wiping, frequent
#
#
Single wipe: press button 1 to the point of
resistance.
Wiping with washer fluid: press button 1
beyond the point of resistance.
Light and visibility 151
#
Switching intermittent wipe on/off: press
button 2.
Vehicles with rain sensor: The wipe inter‐
val automatically adapts to the driving condi‐
tions.
The è symbol will appear on the instru‐
ment cluster when the rear window wiper is
switched on.
Changing the windshield wiper blades
& WARNING Risk of becoming trapped if
the windshield wipers are switched on
while wiper blades are being replaced
If the windshield wipers begin to move while
you are changing the wiper blades, you can
be trapped by the wiper arm.
# Always switch off the windshield wipers
and the ignition before changing the
wiper blades.
Moving the wiper arms into the replacement
position
# Switch the ignition on and switch off again
immediately.
# Within around 15 seconds, press and hold
the î button on the combination switch
for approximately three seconds
(/ page 150).
The wiper arms will move into the replace‐
ment position.
Removing the wiper blades
Fold the wiper arms away from the wind‐
shield.
#
#
#
#
Hold the wiper arm with one hand. With the
other hand, turn the wiper blade in the direc‐
tion of arrow 1 away from the wiper arm as
far as it will go.
Slide catch 2 in the direction of arrow 3
until it engages in the removal position.
Remove the wiper blade from the wiper arm
in the direction of arrow 4.
152 Light and visibility
Installing the wiper blades
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
Insert the new wiper blade into the wiper
arm in the direction of arrow 1.
Slide catch 2 in the direction of arrow 3
until it engages in the locking position.
Make sure that the wiper blade is seated cor‐
rectly.
Fold the wiper arms back onto the wind‐
shield.
Switch on the ignition.
Press the î button on the combination
switch.
The wiper arms will move into the original
position.
Switch the ignition off.
Maintenance display
#
Remove protective film 1 from the mainte‐
nance display on the tip of the newly instal‐
led wiper blades.
When the color of the maintenance display
changes from black to yellow, the wiper blades
should be replaced.
Light and visibility 153
% The duration until the color changes varies
depending on the usage conditions.
Removing the wiper blades
Replacing the windshield wiper blades
(MAGIC VISION CONTROL)
#
To remove the wiper blade: press release
knob 2, pull the wiper blade in the direction
of arrow 3 and remove.
Installing the wiper blades
Moving the wiper arms into the replacement
position
# Switch off the ignition.
# Within around 15 seconds, press the î
button on the combination switch
(/ page 150).
The wiper arms will move into the replace‐
ment position.
#
To bring the wiper blade into position to
be removed: hold the wiper arm firmly in
one hand. With the other hand, turn the
wiper blade in the direction of arrow 1
beyond the point of resistance.
The wiper blade will engage in the removal
position with a click.
#
Push the new wiper blade onto the wiper arm
in the direction of arrow 1 until release
knob 2 engages.
154 Light and visibility
#
#
Installing the wiper blade
Press the wiper blade onto the wiper arm in
the direction of arrow 3 beyond the point of
resistance.
The wiper blade will engage with a noticeable
click and move freely again.
Fold the wiper arm back onto the windshield.
Replacing the rear window wiper blade
& WARNING Risk of becoming trapped if
the windshield wipers are switched on
while wiper blades are being replaced
If the windshield wipers begin to move while
you are changing the wiper blades, you can
be trapped by the wiper arm.
# Always switch off the windshield wipers
and the ignition before changing the
wiper blades.
Removing the wiper blade
# Switch the ignition off.
#
#
Fold wiper arm 2 away from the rear win‐
dow until it engages in the replacement posi‐
tion.
Unclip wiper blade 1 from wiper arm 2
and remove it in the direction of arrow 3.
#
#
#
Position wiper blade 1 with both lugs 3 on
holder 2 on the wiper arm.
Push wiper blade 1 in the direction of arrow
4 until it engages in holder 2.
Make sure that wiper blade 1 is seated cor‐
rectly.
Light and visibility 155
#
Fold the wiper arm from the replacement
position back onto the rear window.
Mirrors
Operating the outside mirrors
& WARNING Risk of accident due to
adjusting vehicle settings while the vehi‐
cle is in motion
You could lose control of the vehicle in the
following situations in particular:
R If you adjust the driver's seat, the head
restraints, the steering wheel or the mir‐
ror while the vehicle is in motion.
R If you fasten your seat belt while the vehi‐
cle is in motion.
#
Before starting the engine: adjust the
driver's seat, the head restraints, the
steering wheel and the mirror and fas‐
ten your seat belt.
& WARNING Risk of accident due to mis‐
judgment of distance when using the
front-passenger mirror
Folding the outside mirrors in/out
The outside mirror on the front passenger
side reflects objects on a smaller scale.
# Therefore, always look over your shoul‐
der in order to ensure that you are
aware of the actual distance between
you and the road users driving behind
you.
# Briefly press button 2.
% If the battery has been disconnected or has
discharged, the outside mirrors must be
moved briefly using button 2. Only then will
the automatic mirror folding function work
properly.
156 Light and visibility
% Mercedes-Maybach vehicles: when the out‐
side mirrors fold in, the extendable running
boards will retract if these were previously
extended.
Adjusting the outside mirrors
# Press button 1 or 3 to select the outside
mirror to be adjusted.
# Press button 4 to adjust the position of the
mirror glass.
Engaging the outside mirrors
If an outside mirror has been forcibly disen‐
gaged, proceed as follows.
# Vehicles without electrically folding outside
mirrors: manually move the outside mirror
into the correct position.
# Vehicles with electrically folding outside mir‐
rors: press and hold button 2.
You will hear a click and the mirror will audi‐
bly click into place. The outside mirror will
now be set to the correct position.
Automatic anti-glare mirrors function
& WARNING Risk of acid burns and poi‐
soning due to the anti-glare mirror elec‐
trolyte
Electrolyte may escape if the glass in an
automatic anti-glare mirror breaks.
The electrolyte is hazardous to health and
causes irritation. It must not come into con‐
tact with your skin, eyes, respiratory organs
or clothing or be swallowed.
# If you come into contact with electro‐
lyte, observe the following:
R Immediately rinse the electrolyte
from your skin with water and seek
medical attention.
R If electrolyte comes into contact
with your eyes, immediately rinse
them thoroughly with clean water
and seek medical attention.
R If the electrolyte is swallowed,
immediately rinse your mouth out
thoroughly. Do not induce vomiting.
Seek medical attention immediately.
R
R
Immediately change out of clothing
which has been contaminated with
electrolyte.
If an allergic reaction occurs, seek
medical attention immediately.
The inside rearview mirror and the outside mir‐
ror on the driver's side will automatically go into
anti-glare mode if light from a headlamp hits the
sensor on the inside rearview mirror.
System limits
The system will not go into anti-glare mode if:
R The engine is switched off.
R Reverse gear is engaged.
R The interior lighting is switched on.
Front-passenger outside mirror parking posi‐
tion function
% The parking position is available only in vehi‐
cles with a memory function.
The parking position makes parking easier.
Light and visibility 157
In the following situations, the front-passenger
outside mirror will swivel downwards in the
direction of the rear wheel on the front passeng‐
er's side:
R The parking position is stored (/ page 157)
R The front-passenger mirror is selected
R Reverse gear is engaged.
Storing and calling up the parking position of
the front-passenger outside mirror
Storing
Calling up
# Select the front-passenger outside mirror
using button 1.
# Engage reverse gear.
The front-passenger outside mirror will move
to the stored parking position.
Activating/deactivating the automatic mirror
folding function
The front-passenger outside mirror will move
back to its original position in the following sit‐
uations:
R You shift the transmission to another trans‐
mission position
R You are traveling at speeds greater than
9 mph (15 km/h)
R You press the button for the outside mirror
on the driver's side
Multimedia system:
4 © 5 Settings 5 Vehicle
# Switch Automatic Folding on or off.
#
#
#
Select the front-passenger outside mirror
using button 1.
Engage reverse gear.
Move the front-passenger outside mirror into
the desired parking position using button 2.
158 Light and visibility
Area permeable to radio waves on the
windshield
Radio-controlled equipment, such as toll sys‐
tems, can be mounted only on areas 1 of the
windshield that are permeable to radio waves.
Areas permeable to radio waves 1 are best visi‐
ble from outside the vehicle when the windshield
is illuminated with an external light source.
Note this position for vehicles with:
R Windshield heating
R Infrared reflective windshield
Infrared-reflective windshield function
The infrared-reflective windshield is coated and
reduces the build-up of heat in the vehicle inte‐
rior.
The coating shields the vehicle interior from
radio waves.
Climate control 159
7 g Switches air-recirculation mode on/off
Overview of climate control systems
Notes on climate control
An interior air filter in combination with the pre‐
filter in the engine compartment must always be
used so that the air conditioning system, pollu‐
tion level monitoring and the air filtration work
correctly. Make sure that the filter is installed
correctly and the filter housing in the engine
compartment is closed correctly using the cap
and always tightly sealed when in operation. Use
filters recommended and approved by
Mercedes-Benz. Always have service work car‐
ried out at a qualified specialist workshop.
(/ page 162)
8 Á Switches the A/C function on/off
Example: control panel for dual-zone automatic cli‐
mate control with stationary heater
1 w Sets the driver's side temperature
2 A Calls up/exits the air conditioning
Overview of the air conditioning control
panel
The indicator lamps on the buttons indicate that
the corresponding function is activated.
3
4
5
6
menu
Pressing and holding (approx. four seconds):
resets climate control to the basic settings
H Sets the airflow or switches off climate
control
à Sets climate control to automatic
mode (/ page 161)
¬ Defrosts the windshield
¤ Switches the rear window heater
on/off
(/ page 160)
Switches residual heat on/off (/ page 162)
9 Vehicles with control panel for dual-zone
automatic climate control or 3-zone auto‐
matic climate control without stationary
heater: 0 switches synchronization
on/off (/ page 162)
Vehicles with control panel for dual-zone
automatic climate control or 3-zone auto‐
matic climate control with stationary heater:
& switches stationary heater on/off
A w Sets the temperature on the front
passenger side
160 Climate control
Overview of the rear operating unit
The settings for the second and third row of
seats (equipment-dependent) can be made via
the rear operating unit, the multimedia system
(/ page 161) or the MBUX rear tablet depend‐
ing on the vehicle's equipment.
Operating the climate control system
Switching climate control on/off
To switch on: set the airflow to level 1 or
higher using the H button.
# To switch off: set the airflow to level 0 using
the H button.
% If climate control is switched off, the win‐
dows may fog up more quickly. Switch off
climate control only briefly.
#
Example: USA
1 Sets the temperature, left
2 Sets the air distribution, left
3 Sets climate control to automatic mode
(/ page 161)
4 Sets the airflow
5 Switches climate control on/off
(/ page 160)
Switches the residual heat on/off
(/ page 163)
6 Sets the air distribution, right
7 Sets the temperature, right
Switching the climate control in the rear
passenger compartment on/off
Press button 5.
% When climate control in the second seat row
is switched off, the indicator lamp is activa‐
ted and OFF is shown on the rear display.
#
Switching the A/C function on or off via the
control panel
The A/C function heats, cools and dehumidifies
the vehicle's interior air.
# Press the Á button.
Switch off the A/C function only briefly; other‐
wise, the windows may fog up more quickly.
Condensation may drip from the underside of
the vehicle when cooling mode is active. This is
not a sign that there is a malfunction.
Calling up the air conditioning menu
Calling up the air conditioning menu using
the multimedia system
# Select one of the temperature displays at the
lower edge of the media display.
Activating/deactivating the A/C function via
the multimedia system
The A/C function heats, cools and dehumidifies
the vehicle's interior air.
Climate control 161
#
#
#
Call up the air-conditioning menu
(/ page 160).
Select First Row of Seats.
Select A/C.
Setting climate control to automatic mode
In automatic mode, the set temperature is con‐
trolled and maintained at a constant level by the
air supply.
# Press the à button.
# To switch to manual mode: press the Ã
button.
In automatic mode, you can choose between five
different air quantities using the H button.
Automatic mode is retained.
Automatically controlling the climate control
in the rear passenger compartment
In automatic mode, the set temperature is regu‐
lated by the temperature of the dispensed air
and the airflow.
#
Press the à button (/ page 160).
Setting the air distribution
Call up the air conditioning menu
(/ page 160).
# Select a row of seats.
# To set the air distribution: select ¯,
P or O.
# Set the airflow.
% Several air distribution options can be selec‐
ted at the same time, for example to set the
climate control for the windshield and the
footwells simultaneously.
The ¯ climate control for the windshield
can only be selected for the first seat row.
#
Setting climate control for the rear
passenger compartment (multimedia sys‐
tem)
Setting the temperature
Call up the air conditioning menu
(/ page 160).
#
#
#
Select Second Row of Seats or Third Row of
Seats.
For Maybach vehicles: select Second Row of
Seats.
% Maybach vehicles are equipped with one and
two rows of seats.
# Set the temperature.
Setting the airflow
# Call up the air conditioning menu
(/ page 160).
# Select Second Row of Seats or Third Row of
Seats.
# For Maybach vehicles: select Second Row of
Seats.
% Maybach vehicles are equipped with one and
two rows of seats.
# Set the airflow.
162 Climate control
Controlling the rear climate control automat‐
ically
# Select REAR AUTO.
Rear climate control is controlled automati‐
cally.
Deactivating rear climate control
Select REAR OFF.
Rear climate control is deactivated.
#
Activating/deactivating the climate control
synchronization function via the control
panel
Activating/deactivating the climate control
synchronization function via the multimedia
system
Climate control can be set centrally using the
synchronization function. The driver's settings
for temperature, air quantity and air distribution
are adopted automatically for all climate zones.
# Call up the air conditioning menu
(/ page 160).
# Select First Row of Seats.
# Select SYNC.
Climate control can be set centrally using the
synchronization function. The temperature and
air distribution setting for the driver's side will be
adopted automatically for all climate control
zones.
# Press the 0 button.
Removing condensation from the windows
The synchronization function will be deactivated
if the settings for one of the other climate zones
are changed.
Windows fogged up on the outside
# Switch on the windshield wipers.
# Press the à button.
Windows fogged up on the inside
# Press the à button.
# If the windows continue to fog up: press the
¬ button.
Switching air-recirculation mode on/off
#
Press the g button.
The interior air will be recirculated.
Air-recirculation mode automatically switches to
fresh air mode after some time.
% If air-recirculation mode is switched on, the
windows may fog up more quickly. Switch on
air-recirculation mode only briefly.
Switching the residual heat on or off
Requirements:
R The vehicle is parked.
It is possible to make use of the residual heat
from the engine to continue heating or ventilat‐
ing the front compartment of the vehicle for
approximately 30 minutes, depending on the
temperature set.
# To activate: press Á button.
Residual heat will be switched off automatically.
Climate control 163
Switching the residual heat in the rear
passenger compartment on/off
Requirements:
R The vehicle is parked.
When the residual heat of the engine is activated
in the rear compartment, you can heat or venti‐
late the rear passenger compartment for approx‐
imately 30 minutes.
# Press button 5 (/ page 160).
Activating/deactivating ionization
Ionization improves the quality of the vehicle's
interior air. Ionization of the interior air is odor‐
less.
# Call up the air conditioning menu
(/ page 160).
# Select Air Quality.
# Select IONIZATION.
Fragrance system
Setting the fragrance system
Requirements:
R Automatic climate control is activated.
R The glove box is closed.
The fragrance system distributes a pleasant fra‐
grance throughout the vehicle interior from a fla‐
con located in the glove box.
# Call up the climate control menu
(/ page 160).
# Select Air Quality.
# Select AIR FRESHENER.
# Keep pressing until the desired intensity is
reached.
Inserting or removing the flacon of the fra‐
grance system
& WARNING Risk of injury from liquid per‐
fume
If children open the flacon, they could drink
the liquid perfume or it could come into con‐
tact with their eyes.
# Do not leave children unattended in the
vehicle.
# Consult a doctor immediately if liquid
perfume has been drunk.
# If liquid perfume comes into contact
with your eyes or skin, rinse your eyes
with clean water.
# If symptoms continue, consult a doctor.
164 Climate control
+ ENVIRONMENTAL NOTE Environmental
If you do not use genuine Mercedes-Benz interior
perfumes, observe the manufacturers' safety
notices on the perfume packaging.
Dispose of the genuine Mercedes-Benz interior
perfume flacon when it is empty and do not refill
it.
Full flacons must not be disposed
of with household waste.
Refillable flacon
# Unscrew the cap of the empty flacon.
# Fill the flacon with a maximum of 0.5 fl. oz.
(15 ml).
# Screw the cap back on to the flacon.
damage due to improper disposal of full
flacons
#
Full flacons must be taken to
a harmful substance collection point.
1 Cap
2 Flacon
#
#
To insert: slide the flacon into the holder as
far as it will go.
To remove: after opening the glove box, wait
for approximately seven seconds and pull out
the flacon.
Always refill the empty refillable flacon with the
same perfume. Observe the separate informa‐
tion sheet with the flacon.
Information on the windshield heater
The windshield heater is switched on automati‐
cally if the ¬ button is activated.
In addition, it is automatically switched on when
necessary.
Climate control 165
Air vents
Adjusting the rear air vents
Adjusting the front air vents
& WARNING Risk of burns and frostbite
due to being too close to the air vents
Very hot or very cold air can flow from the air
vents.
# Make sure that all vehicle occupants
always maintain a sufficient distance
from the air vents.
# If necessary, direct the airflow to
another area of the vehicle interior.
To guarantee the flow of fresh air through the air
vents into the vehicle interior, comply with the
following:
R Always keep the vents and vent grilles in the
vehicle interior free.
R Keep the air inlet free of deposits
(/ page 328).
R Optimum climate comfort is achieved with
the air vents in the center position.
#
#
#
To open or close center air vents: turn
controller 2 up or down as far as it will go.
To open or close side air vents: turn con‐
troller 2 to the left or right as far as it will
go.
To adjust the air direction: hold air vent 1
in the center and move it up or down or to
the left or right.
Air vents in the center console
166 Climate control
Air vents above the second and third row of seats
(all vehicles except Mercedes-Maybach vehicles)
#
Air vents in the B-pillar
#
To set the airflow direction: hold air
vent 1 in the center and move it accord‐
ingly.
To open or close: turn the controller 2 as
far as it will go.
Air vents above the second row of seats, towards
the cargo compartment (Mercedes-Maybach vehi‐
cles)
#
To open or close: turn controller 1 as far
as it will go.
Climate control 167
Opening or closing the air vent in the glove
box
* NOTE Damage to temperature-sensitive
objects in the glove box
Temperature-sensitive objects stored in the
glove box may be damaged by the air vent
located inside it.
# Close the air vent when you heat the
vehicle.
# At high outside temperatures, open the
air vent and switch on the A/C func‐
tion.
The automatic climate control must be switched
on to cool the glove box.
#
To open or close: turn controller 1 of air
vent 2 clockwise or counter-clockwise.
168 Driving and parking
Driving
Notes on Mercedes-AMG vehicles
R
Observe the notes on the following additional
topics in the Supplement, as you may otherwise
fail to recognize dangers:
R Emotion Start
R AMG ACTIVE adaptive sport suspension sys‐
tem
In addition, the children could also set the
vehicle in motion, for example by:
R Releasing the parking brake.
R Change the transmission position.
R Start the vehicle.
#
Switching on the power supply or the igni‐
tion (without engine start)
#
& WARNING Risk of accident and injury
due to children left unattended in the
vehicle
#
If children are left unsupervised in the vehi‐
cle, they could, in particular:
R Open doors, thereby endangering other
persons or road users.
R Get out and be struck by oncoming traf‐
fic.
Operate vehicle equipment and become
trapped, for example.
Never leave children unattended in the
vehicle.
When leaving the vehicle, always take
the SmartKey with you and lock the
vehicle.
Keep the SmartKey out of reach of chil‐
dren.
Also observe the "Notes on pets in the vehicle".
Requirements:
R the SmartKey is located in the vehicle and
the SmartKey battery is not discharged.
R the brake pedal is not depressed.
#
To switch on the power supply: press but‐
ton 1 once.
You can activate the windshield wipers, for
example.
The power supply is switched off again if the fol‐
lowing conditions are met:
R you open the driver's door.
R you press button 1 twice more.
Driving and parking 169
To switch on the ignition: press button 1
twice.
The indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
light up.
The ignition is switched off again if one of the
following conditions is met:
R you do not start the vehicle within
15 minutes and the transmission is in posi‐
tion j or the electric parking brake is
applied.
R you press button 1 once.
#
Starting the vehicle
Starting the vehicle with the start/stop but‐
ton
& DANGER Risk of death caused by
exhaust gases
Combustion engines emit poisonous exhaust
gases such as carbon monoxide. Inhaling
these exhaust gases is hazardous to health
and leads to poisoning.
#
Never leave the engine or, if present,
the auxiliary heating running in an
enclosed space without sufficient venti‐
lation.
& WARNING Risk of fire due to flammable
material in the engine compartment or
the exhaust system
Flammable materials may ignite.
# Therefore, check regularly that there
are no flammable materials in the
engine compartment or on the exhaust
system.
Requirements
R The SmartKey is located in the vehicle and
the SmartKey battery is not discharged.
#
#
Shift the transmission to position j or i.
Depress the brake pedal and press button
1 once.
If the vehicle does not start: switch off nonessential consumers and press button 1
once.
# If the vehicle still does not start and the
Place the Key in the Marked Space See
Operator's Manual message also appears in
the multifunction display: start the vehicle
with the SmartKey in the marked space
(emergency operation mode) (/ page 169).
% You can switch off the engine while driving
by pressing button 1 for about three sec‐
onds or by pressing button 1 three times
within three seconds. Be sure to observe the
safety notes under "Driving tips"
(/ page 173).
#
Starting the vehicle with the SmartKey in the
marked space (emergency operation mode)
If the vehicle does not start and the Place the
Key in the Marked Space See Operator's Manual
message appears in the multifunction display,
you can start the vehicle in emergency operation
mode.
170 Driving and parking
#
must be located in marked space 2 next to
symbol 3 during the entire journey.
Have SmartKey 1 checked at a qualified
specialist workshop.
If the vehicle does not start:
Place SmartKey 1 in marked space 2 and
leave it there.
# Depress the brake pedal and start the vehi‐
cle using the start/stop button.
% You can also switch on the power supply or
the ignition with the start/stop button.
#
#
#
#
Make sure that marked space 2 is empty.
Remove SmartKey 1 from the key ring.
Place SmartKey 1 in marked space 2 next
to symbol 3.
The vehicle will start after a short time.
If you remove SmartKey 1 from marked
space 2 the engine continues running. For
further vehicle starts however, SmartKey 1
Starting the vehicle via Remote Online serv‐
ices
Cooling or heating the vehicle interior before
commencing your journey
Ensure the following before starting the engine:
R The legal stipulations in the area where your
vehicle is parked allow engine starting via
smartphone.
R It is safe to start and run the engine where
your vehicle is parked.
R
R
The fuel tank is sufficiently full.
The starter battery is sufficiently charged.
Charging the starter battery before starting
the journey
If the vehicle battery is discharged, you receive a
message on your smartphone. You can then
start the vehicle with the smartphone to charge
the battery. The vehicle is automatically
switched off after ten minutes.
Ensure the following before starting the engine:
R The legal stipulations in the area where your
vehicle is parked allow engine starting via
smartphone.
R It is safe to start and run the engine where
your vehicle is parked.
R The fuel tank is sufficiently full.
Driving and parking 171
Starting the vehicle (Remote Online)
& WARNING Risk of crushing or entrap‐
ment due to unintentional starting of the
engine
Limbs could be crushed or trapped if the
engine is started unintentionally during
service or maintenance work.
# Always secure the engine against unin‐
tentional starting before carrying out
maintenance or repair work.
Requirements:
R Park position j is selected.
R The anti-theft alarm system is not activated.
R The panic alarm is not activated.
R The hazard warning light system is switched
off.
R The hood is closed.
R The doors are closed and locked.
R The windows and sliding sunroof are closed.
#
Start the vehicle using the smartphone.
After every engine start, the engine runs for
ten minutes.
You can carry out a maximum of two consecu‐
tive starting attempts. The vehicle must be star‐
ted once with the SmartKey before trying to
start the engine again with the smartphone. you
can stop the vehicle again at any time.
% Further information can be found in the
smartphone app.
Securing the engine against starting before
carrying out maintenance or repair work:
# Switch on the hazard warning light system.
or
# Unlock the doors.
or
# Open a side window or the sliding sunroof.
Breaking-in notes
Mercedes-AMG vehicles: observe the notes in
the Supplement. You could otherwise fail to rec‐
ognize dangers.
To preserve the engine during the first
1,000 miles (1,500 km):
R drive at varying road speeds and engine
speeds.
R drive the vehicle in drive program A
or ;.
R shift to the next highest gear at the very lat‐
est when the needle reaches the last third
before the red area in the tachometer.
R do not shift down a gear manually in order to
brake.
R avoid overstraining the vehicle, e.g. driving at
full throttle.
R do not depress the accelerator pedal past
the pressure point (kickdown).
R only increase the engine speed gradually and
accelerate the vehicle to full speed after
1,000 miles (1,500 km).
This also applies when the engine or parts of the
drivetrain have been replaced.
172 Driving and parking
Please also observe the following breaking-in
notes:
R in certain driving and driving safety systems,
the sensors adjust automatically while a cer‐
tain distance is being driven after the vehicle
has been delivered or after repairs. Full sys‐
tem effectiveness is not reached until the
end of this teach-in process.
R brakepads, brake discs and tires that are
either new or have been replaced only ach‐
ieve optimum braking effect and grip after
several hundred miles of driving. Compen‐
sate for the reduced braking effect by apply‐
ing greater force to the brake pedal.
Notes on optimized acceleration
If all necessary requirements and activation con‐
ditions are fulfilled, the best possible accelera‐
tion can be achieved from a standstill.
Do not use the optimized acceleration on public
roads. Individual wheels could spin and you
could lose control of the vehicle. There is an
increased risk of skidding and/or accident.
Be sure to observe the safety notes and informa‐
tion on ESP® (/ page 203).
Pulling away with optimized acceleration
& WARNING Risk of skidding and having
an accident from wheels spinning
When you use optimized acceleration, indi‐
vidual wheels could spin and you could lose
control of the vehicle.
If ESP® is deactivated, there is a risk of skid‐
ding and accident.
# Make sure that no persons or obstacles
are in the close vicinity of your vehicle.
Requirements:
R The vehicle has been broken in
(/ page 171).
R The vehicle and tires are in good condition.
R You are on a high-grip roadway.
R The engine and transmission are at normal
operating temperature.
* NOTE Increased wear due to optimized
acceleration
When pulling away with optimized accelera‐
tion, all components of the drivetrain are
subjected to a very high load.
This can lead to increased component wear.
# Do not always pull away with optimized
acceleration.
#
#
#
#
#
#
Engage the h drive position (/ page 187).
Move the steering wheel to the straightahead position.
Select the sportiest available drive program
B or C(/ page 184).
Deactivate ESP® (/ page 205).
Depress and hold the brake pedal firmly with
your left foot.
With your right foot, fully depress the accel‐
erator pedal.
Driving and parking 173
#
#
After no more than five seconds, take your
left foot quickly off the brake, but keep the
accelerator pedal depressed.
The vehicle pulls away at maximum accelera‐
tion.
Switch on ESP® once the acceleration proce‐
dure is complete.
Ending optimized acceleration
Remove your foot from the accelerator pedal.
# Reactivate the ESP®.
% After you pull away with optimized accelera‐
tion, components of the drivetrain can
become very hot, which means that opti‐
mized acceleration values may be reached
again only after a few minutes.
#
Notes on driving
& WARNING Risk of accident due to
objects in the driver's footwell
Objects in the driver's footwell may impede
pedal travel or block a depressed pedal.
This jeopardizes the operating and road
safety of the vehicle.
# Stow all objects in the vehicle securely
so that they cannot get into the driver's
footwell.
# Always install the floor mats securely
and as prescribed in order to ensure
that there is always sufficient room for
the pedals.
# Do not use loose floor mats and do not
place floor mats on top of one another.
& WARNING Risk of accident due to incor‐
rect footwear
Incorrect footwear includes, for example:
R Shoes with platform soles
R Shoes with high heels
R Slippers
#
Always wear suitable footwear so that
you can operate the pedals safely.
& WARNING Risk of accident when switch‐
ing off the ignition when driving
If you switch off the ignition while driving,
safety functions are restricted or no longer
available.
You will then need, for example, to use con‐
siderably more force to steer and brake.
# Do not switch off the ignition while driv‐
ing.
& DANGER Risk of death caused by
exhaust gases
Combustion engines emit poisonous exhaust
gases such as carbon monoxide. Inhaling
these exhaust gases is hazardous to health
and leads to poisoning.
# Never leave the engine or, if present,
the auxiliary heating running in an
enclosed space without sufficient venti‐
lation.
174 Driving and parking
& WARNING Risk of skidding and of an
accident due to shifting down on slippery
road surfaces
If you shift down on slippery road surfaces to
increase the engine braking effect, the drive
wheels may lose traction.
# Do not shift down on slippery road sur‐
faces to increase the engine braking
effect.
& DANGER Risk of fatal injury due to poi‐
sonous exhaust gases
If the tailpipe is blocked or sufficient ventila‐
tion is not possible, poisonous exhaust gases
such as carbon monoxide may enter the vehi‐
cle. This is the case when the vehicle
becomes stuck in snow, for example.
# Keep the tailpipe and the area around
the vehicle free from snow when the
engine or the stationary heater are run‐
ning.
#
Open a window on the side of the vehi‐
cle facing away from the wind to ensure
an adequate supply of fresh air.
& WARNING Risk of accident and injury
due to being under the influence of alco‐
hol and drugs while driving
Driving when under the influence of alcohol
and/or drugs is an extremely dangerous
combination. Even small quantities of alcohol
or drugs may affect your reflexes, perception
and judgment.
The probability of a serious or even fatal acci‐
dent greatly increases if you drive when
under the influence of alcohol or drugs.
# Do not drink alcohol or take drugs while
driving, and do not allow anyone to
drive who has been drinking alcohol or
taking drugs.
& WARNING Risk of accident due to the
brake system overheating
If you leave your foot on the brake pedal
when driving, the brake system may over‐
heat.
This increases the braking distance and the
brake system may even fail.
# Never use the brake pedal as a footrest.
# Do not depress the brake pedal and the
accelerator pedal at the same time
while driving.
* NOTE Engine damage due to excessively
high engine speeds
The engine will be damaged if you drive with
the engine in the overrevving range.
# Do not drive with the engine in the over‐
revving range.
Driving and parking 175
* NOTE Wearing out the brake linings by
continuously depressing the brake pedal
#
#
Do not depress the brake pedal contin‐
uously whilst driving.
To use the braking effect of the engine,
shift to a lower gear in good time.
* NOTE Damage to the drivetrain and
engine when pulling away
#
#
Do not warm up the engine while the
vehicle is stationary. Pull away immedi‐
ately.
Avoid high engine speeds and driving at
full throttle until the engine has reached
its operating temperature.
* NOTE Damage to the catalytic converter
due to non-combusted fuel
The engine is not running smoothly and is
misfiring.
Non-combusted fuel may get into the cata‐
lytic converter.
#
#
Only depress the accelerator pedal
slightly.
Have the cause rectified immediately at
a qualified specialist workshop.
Notes on driving on salt-treated roads
The braking effect is limited on salt-treated
roads.
Therefore, observe the following notes:
R due to salt build-up on the brake discs and
brakepads, the braking distance can increase
considerably or result in braking only on one
side
R maintain a much greater safe distance to the
vehicle in front
To remove salt build-up:
R brake occasionally while paying attention to
the traffic conditions
R carefully depress the brake pedal at the end
of the journey and when starting the next
journey
Notes on hydroplaning
Hydroplaning can take place once a certain
amount of water has accumulated on the road
surface.
Observe the following notes during heavy precip‐
itation or in conditions in which hydroplaning
may occur:
R reduce speed
R avoid tire ruts
R avoid sudden steering movements
R brake carefully
% Also observe the notes on regularly checking
wheels and tires (/ page 356).
Notes on driving through water on the road
surface
Water which has entered into the vehicle can
damage the engine, electrics and transmission.
Water can also enter the air intake of the engine
and cause engine damage.
176 Driving and parking
Observe the following if you must drive through
water:
R Observe the maximum permissible fording
depth (/ page 403).
R Drive at walking pace at most, otherwise
water can enter the vehicle interior or engine
compartment.
R Vehicles traveling in front, or oncoming vehi‐
cles, can create waves which may exceed the
maximum permissible depth of the water.
The braking effect of the brakes is reduced after
fording. Brake carefully while paying attention to
the traffic conditions until braking power has
been fully restored.
Notes on off-road driving
& WARNING Risk of accident if you do not
keep to line of fall on inclines
If you drive at an angle or turn on an incline,
the vehicle could slip sideways, tip and roll‐
over.
#
Always drive on inclines in the line of
fall (straight up or down) and do not
turn.
& WARNING Risk of fire due to flammable
materials on hot parts of the exhaust
system
Flammable material such as leaves, grass or
twigs may ignite if they come into contact
with hot parts of the exhaust system.
# When driving on unpaved roads or offroad, regularly check the vehicle under‐
side.
# Remove trapped plants or other flam‐
mable material, in particular.
# If there is damage, consult a qualified
specialist workshop immediately.
When driving off-road, sand, mud and water or
water mixed with oil may get into the brakes.
This may lead to a reduction in braking effect or
total brake failure as a result of increased wear.
The braking characteristics will vary depending
on the material that has entered the system.
Clean the brakes after driving off-road. If you
then notice reduced braking effect or hear
scraping noises, have the brake system checked
at a qualified specialist workshop. Adapt your
driving style to the changed braking characteris‐
tics.
* NOTE Damage caused by driving over
obstacles
The vehicle can be damaged by:
R driving up onto high curbs or unpaved
roads.
R quickly driving over obstacles such as
curbs, speed bumps or potholes.
R heavy objects hitting the underbody or
chassis components.
#
#
#
Do not drive over obstacles that could
damage the vehicle.
Check the vehicle regularly for damage
during off-road driving.
Adjust the vehicle speed to suit the
road surface conditions.
Driving and parking 177
#
If there is damage, consult a qualified
specialist workshop immediately.
+ ENVIRONMENTAL NOTE Environmental
damage due to non-observance of pro‐
hibition signs
Environmental protection has priority. Treat
nature with respect.
# Be sure to observe prohibition signs.
Checklist before driving off-road
Check the following points before driving offroad:
R Fuel level
R Engine oil level: fill engine oil to the maxi‐
mum level to ensure full gradeability
(/ page 324).
R Tire-change tool kit and spare wheel
R Tires and wheels
% Further information about special all-terrain
tires for retrofitting can be obtained from a
qualified specialist workshop.
Off-road driving
Read this section before driving your vehicle offroad. Practice by driving over more gentle offroad terrain first.
R Observe the notes on the cross-country ABS
(/ page 203).
R If necessary, select the F or G drive
program (vehicles with an Off-road package)
before driving off-road (/ page 184).
R Before driving off-road, shift the transfer
case to the LOW RANGE off-road gear (vehi‐
cles with an Offroad package) (/ page 190).
R Select a vehicle level suitable for off-road ter‐
rain (/ page 231). To avoid damaging the
vehicle, make sure there is always sufficient
ground clearance.
R
R
Always keep the engine running and in gear
when driving on downhill gradients and
slopes. Observe the notes on driving in
mountainous terrain.
Do not drive on unknown terrain that is not
easily visible and stay on marked routes.
R
R
R
R
Always keep the doors and windows closed
while the vehicle is in motion.
Deactivate Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC
and cruise control.
Adapt your driving style to the terrain.
Do not use the HOLD function on steep
downhill or uphill gradients with slippery or
loose surfaces.
Driving on sand
When driving on sand, also observe the following
instructions:
R Select the F drive program.
R Select a higher vehicle level.
R Shift to a lower gear.
R Drive quickly to overcome the rolling resist‐
ance, otherwise the vehicle may dig itself in.
R Drive in the tracks of other vehicles if possi‐
ble. Make sure that the following prerequi‐
sites are met:
the tire ruts are not too deep
the sand is firm enough
178 Driving and parking
-
the ground clearance is sufficient
Mercedes-AMG vehicles: observe the notes in
the Supplement. You could otherwise fail to rec‐
ognize dangers.
Fording
Also observe the following information when
fording:
R Drive no faster than 6 mph (10 km/h).
R Observe the maximum permissible fording
depth (/ page 403).
R Switch off automatic climate control
(/ page 161).
R Ensure that a bow wave does not form as you
drive.
R Do not stop in the water and do not switch
off the engine. Ensure the ECO start/stop
function is switched off (/ page 180).
Driving in mountainous terrain
Also observe the following information when
driving in mountainous terrain:
R Observe the values of the approach/depar‐
ture angle and of the maximum gradient
(/ page 403).
R Avoid high engine speeds.
R Use the braking power of the engine when
driving downhill.
R Shift to a lower gear on uphill gradients and
on long, steep downhill gradients.
R Activate DSR before driving downhill, if nec‐
essary (/ page 214).
Checklist after driving off-road
Driving off-road places greater demands on your
vehicle than driving on normal roads. Check the
entire vehicle for damage and foreign bodies
every time after driving off-road. Foreign bodies
in the wheels or drivetrain can lead to imbalan‐
ces and therefore vibrations.
R If the F or G drive program is selec‐
ted: select another drive program.
R Shift the transfer case to the on-road posi‐
tion HIGH RANGE.
R
R
R
R
R
R
Deactivate DSR.
Lower the vehicle level again to a level suita‐
ble to the road conditions, e.g. to the normal
level.
Apply the brakes to dry them after fording.
Check that the service brake is working nor‐
mally after a long downhill stretch.
Clean the following components every time
after driving off-road:
license plate number
headlamps and tail lamps
tires, wheels and wheel arches
underbody
After driving through sand, mud, water or
gravel, have the following components
checked and cleaned:
brake discs and brakepads
tires and wheels
axle joints
Driving and parking 179
ECO start/stop function
Operation of the ECO start/stop function
Mercedes-AMG vehicles: observe the notes in
the Supplement. You could otherwise fail to rec‐
ognize dangers.
% The ECO start/stop function is available only
in the C, A, ;, N and =
drive programs (depending on the setting).
The engine is switched off automatically in the
following situations if all vehicle conditions for
an automatic engine stop are met:
R you brake the vehicle to a standstill in trans‐
mission position h or i.
R vehicles with a 48 V on-board electrical
system: you depress the brake pedal when
traveling at a low speed.
If the system has detected one of the following
situations, the engine will not stop:
R you stop at a stop sign and there is no vehi‐
cle in front of you.
R the vehicle that stopped in front of you starts
up again.
R
you maneuver, turn the steering wheel
sharply or engage reverse gear.
% When the HOLD function is active and in
transmission position j, the engine can
stop in spite of an intelligent stop inhibitor.
The engine is restarted automatically if:
R you engage transmission position h or k.
R you depress the accelerator pedal.
R an automatic engine start is required by the
vehicle.
R you release the brake pedal.
R vehicles with a 48 V on-board electrical
system:
you release the brake pedal on a downhill
gradient and the vehicle does not roll.
the vehicle rolls on a downhill gradient
and does not automatically enter glide
mode at 15 mph (20 km/h).
ECO start/stop function symbols in the multi‐
function display:
R the è symbol (green) appears when the
vehicle is at a standstill: the engine was
switched off by the ECO start/stop function.
R the ç symbol (yellow) appears when the
vehicle is at a standstill: not all vehicle condi‐
tions for an engine stop have been met.
R neither the è nor ç symbol appears
when the vehicle is at a standstill: an intelli‐
gent stop inhibitor was detected, e.g. a stop
sign.
R the s symbol appears: the ECO start/
stop function is deactivated or there is a mal‐
function.
If the engine was switched off by the ECO start/
stop function and you leave the vehicle, a warn‐
ing tone sounds and the engine is not restarted.
In addition, the following display message
appears in the multifunction display:
Vehicle Ready to Drive Switch the Ignition Off
Before Exiting
180 Driving and parking
If you do not switch off the ignition, the ignition
is automatically switched off after three
minutes.
Deactivating or activating the ECO start/
stop function
Press button 1.
A display appears in the instrument cluster
when switching the ECO start/stop function
off/on.
% A continuous s display appears in the
instrument cluster while the ECO start/stop
function is deactivated.
#
ECO display function
The ECO display summarizes your driving char‐
acteristics from the start of the journey to its
completion and assists you in achieving the
most economical driving style.
You can influence consumption by doing the fol‐
lowing:
R Drive with particular care
R Drive the vehicle in drive program ;
R Follow the gearshift recommendations
The lettering in the segment will light up brightly,
the outer edge will light up and the segment will
fill up when the following driving style is adop‐
ted:
R 1 Steady speed
R 2 Gentle deceleration and rolling
R 3 Moderate acceleration
The lettering in the segment will be gray, the
outer edge will be dark and the segment will
empty when the following driving style is adop‐
ted:
R 1 Fluctuations in speed
R 2 Heavy braking
Driving and parking 181
R
3 Sporty acceleration
The ECO display will show you when you have
driven economically:
R The three segments will fill up completely at
the same time
R The edges around all three segments will
light up
The additional range achieved as a result of your
driving style in comparison with a driver with a
very sporty driving style will be shown in the
center of display 4. The range displayed does
not indicate a fixed reduction in consumption.
ECO Assist function
Vehicles with a 48 V on-board electrical sys‐
tem (EQ Boost technology):
ECO Assist analyzes data for the vehicle's expec‐
ted route. This allows the system to optimally
adjust the driving style for the route ahead, save
fuel and recuperate. If the system detects an
event ahead, e.g. a speed limit or a roundabout,
it will appear on the multifunction display. The
following symbols can be displayed:
Examples of an event ahead
1 Event ahead
2 Distance display for the event ahead
3 "Foot off the accelerator" prompt
Distance display segments 2 show the dis‐
tance to the event ahead as follows:
R A few segments light up: the event ahead is
near.
R Many segments light up: the event ahead is
further away.
When the vehicle nears the event, ECO Assist
will calculate the optimal speed for maximum
fuel economy and recuperative energy based on
the distance, speed and downhill gradient. The
182 Driving and parking
Foot off the Accelerator3 message appears in
the multifunction display. The first segments in
front of the vehicle will turn green. The remain‐
ing segments will initially stay white. If the driver
takes their foot off the accelerator pedal in good
time, the remaining segments on the display will
successively turn green until the event shown is
reached. The drivetrain will be set for maximum
fuel economy. Recuperation will charge the bat‐
tery. Recuperation will be adapted to the selec‐
ted drive program.
The event will be shown for a short time after it
has been passed. If there is no response to the
Foot off the Accelerator prompt, the segments
will remain white.
If the event involves a vehicle in front, all seg‐
ments will immediately turn green once there is
a response to the Foot off the Accelerator
prompt.
For active ECO Assist in drive program ;,
symbol 3 will appear on the multifunction dis‐
play and on the Head-up Display beside trans‐
mission position h. Symbol 3 will also appear
when the assistant display is not selected.
If the system does not intervene during the
event ahead, nothing will be displayed. The sys‐
tem is passive.
ECO Assist is active only in drive programs ;
and A.
System limits
ECO Assist can function even more precisely if
the route is adhered to when route guidance is
active. The basic function is also available with‐
out active route guidance. Not all information
and traffic situations can be foreseen. The qual‐
ity depends on the map data.
ECO Assist is only an aid. The driver is responsi‐
ble for keeping a safe distance from the vehicle
in front, for vehicle speed and for braking in
good time. The driver must be ready to brake at
all times irrespective of whether the system
intervenes.
The system may be impaired or may not function
in the following situations:
R If there is poor visibility, e.g. due to insuffi‐
cient illumination of the road, highly variable
shade conditions, rain, snow, fog or heavy
spray.
R
R
R
R
R
If there is glare, e.g. from oncoming traffic,
direct sunlight or reflections.
If there is dirt on the windshield in the area
of the multifunction camera or the camera is
fogged up, damaged or obscured.
If traffic signs are hard to discern, e.g. due to
dirt, snow or insufficient lighting, or because
they are obscured.
If the information on the navigation system's
digital map is incorrect or out of date.
If signs are ambiguous, e.g. traffic signs in
roadworks or in adjacent lanes.
DYNAMIC SELECT switch
Function of the DYNAMIC SELECT switch
Mercedes-AMG vehicles: observe the notes in
the Supplement. You could otherwise fail to rec‐
ognize dangers.
% Depending on the engine and equipment,
the vehicle has different drive programs.
Driving and parking 183
Use the DYNAMIC SELECT switch to change
between the following drive programs:
= (Individual): individual settings
B (Sport +): particularly sporty driving style
C (Sport): sporty driving style
A (Comfort): comfortable and economical
driving style
£ (Maybach): highest level of driving com‐
fort for comfortable and luxurious travel
(Mercedes-Maybach vehicles only)
; (Eco): particularly economical driving
style
N (CURVE): comfortable driving with curve
inclination function (vehicles with
E‑ACTIVE BODY CONTROL)
F Offroad: driving on less demanding offroad terrain
G (Offroad +): driving on difficult off-road
terrain
% Mercedes-Maybach vehicles: in the drive
programs F and G, the extendible
running boards remain retracted or retract if
they have already been extended.
% The drive program selected appears in the
multifunction display of the on-board com‐
puter.
% Depending on the situation, the cylinder can
be briefly switched on in the drive pro‐
grams ; and A, depending on the
engine.
Depending on the drive program, the following
systems change their characteristics:
R Drive
Engine and transmission management
Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC
R ESP®
R Vehicles with AIRMATIC or E‑ACTIVE
BODY CONTROL:
Suspension tuning
Vehicle level
R Electric power steering
Notes on the roof load display
Certain drive programs and ESP® settings are
unsuitable for transporting a roof load.
If one of these drive programs is set or selected,
symbol is shown as a warning. When
the
this symbol is shown, the selected drive program
is not suitable for transporting a load on the
roof.
The following drive programs are affected:
R Sport drive program
R Sport + drive program
R
Individual drive program with the ESP® set‐
ting Sport or Sport+
% The symbol is also shown in the following sit‐
uations:
R Within the themes if a corresponding
drive program is saved
For more information on themes see .
184 Driving and parking
R
Within the reset display if the previously
active drive program is unsuitable for the
transport of a roof load
For further information on the reset dis‐
play, see (/ page 184).
Selecting the drive program
#
Press DYNAMIC SELECT switch 1 forwards
or backwards.
The drive program selected appears in the
multifunction display.
Configuring DYNAMIC SELECT (multimedia
system)
Multimedia system:
4 © 5 Settings
5 DYNAMIC SELECT
5
Vehicle
Setting drive program I
Select Individual Configuration.
# Select and set a category.
#
Switching the restoration display on or off
# Switch Request at Start on or off.
Function on: the next time the vehicle is started
a prompt appears asking whether the last active
drive program should be restored. If the ECO
start/stop function was deactivated, an addi‐
tional prompt appears asking if the function
should remain deactivated.
% The prompt appears only if the previously
active settings deviate from the standard
settings.
Function off: the next time the vehicle is star‐
ted the A drive program is set automatically.
The ECO start/stop function is activated auto‐
matically.
% This function must be activated for each user
profile separately. Only when this function is
activated will the drive program and Eco
start/stop setting for the previous journey
be saved for the respective user profile.
Displaying vehicle data
Multimedia system:
4 © 5 Info
# Select Vehicle.
The vehicle data is displayed.
Driving and parking 185
Displaying engine data
Calling up the consumption indicator
Multimedia system:
4 © 5 Info
# Select Engine.
The engine data is displayed.
% The actual (maximum) values that can be
achieved for engine output and engine tor‐
que may deviate from the certified values
within the country-specific guidelines for
permissible tolerances (basis: UN-ECE No.
85 or country-specific guidelines).
Factors that can influence this are, for exam‐
ple:
R Sea level
R Fuel grade
R Outside temperature
R Operating temperature of the engine
% The values displayed serve only as orienta‐
tion. The values for engine output and
engine torque shown in the media display
may deviate from the actual values.
Multimedia system:
4 © 5 Info
# Select Consumption.
The current and average consumption is dis‐
played.
Automatic transmission
DIRECT SELECT lever
Function of the DIRECT SELECT lever
& WARNING Risk of accident due to incor‐
rect gearshifting
If the engine speed is higher than the idle
speed and you engage the transmission posi‐
tion h or k, the vehicle may accelerate
sharply.
# If you engage the transmission position
h or k when the vehicle is at a
standstill, always depress the brake
pedal firmly and do not accelerate at
the same time.
& WARNING Risk of accident and injury
due to children left unattended in the
vehicle
If children are left unsupervised in the vehi‐
cle, they could, in particular:
R Open doors, thereby endangering other
persons or road users.
R Get out and be struck by oncoming traf‐
fic.
R Operate vehicle equipment and become
trapped, for example.
In addition, the children could also set the
vehicle in motion, for example by:
R Releasing the parking brake.
R Change the transmission position.
R Start the vehicle.
#
#
Never leave children unattended in the
vehicle.
When leaving the vehicle, always take
the SmartKey with you and lock the
vehicle.
186 Driving and parking
#
Keep the SmartKey out of reach of chil‐
dren.
Use the DIRECT SELECT lever to switch the
transmission position. The current transmission
position is displayed in the multifunction display.
i Neutral
h Drive position
Engaging reverse gear R
Depress the brake pedal and push the
DIRECT SELECT lever upwards past the first
point of resistance.
#
Engaging neutral N
Depress the brake pedal and push the
DIRECT SELECT lever up or down to the first
point of resistance.
#
Subsequently releasing the brake pedal will
allow you to move the vehicle freely, e.g. to push
it or tow it away.
Proceed as follows if you want the automatic
transmission to remain in neutral i even if
the ignition is switched off or the driver's
door is opened:
# Start the vehicle.
j Park position
k Reverse gear
Depress the brake pedal and engage neutral
i when the car is stationary.
The N Permanently Active Risk of Rolling
Away message appears in the instrument
cluster.
# Release the brake pedal.
# Switch the ignition off.
% If you then exit the vehicle leaving the
SmartKey in the vehicle, the automatic trans‐
mission remains in neutral i.
The park position j is automatically re-engaged
as soon as one of the following conditions is
met:
R You switch to transmission position h or
k.
R You press the j button.
#
Engaging park position P
Observe the notes on parking the vehicle
(/ page 194).
# Depress the brake pedal until the vehicle is
stationary.
#
Driving and parking 187
When the vehicle is stationary, press button
j.
When the transmission position display
shows j, the park position is engaged. If no
transmission position display j appears,
secure the vehicle to prevent it from rolling
away.
% Depending on the situation, it may take a
short time until j is engaged. Therefore,
always pay attention to the transmission
position display.
Park position j is engaged automatically if one
of the following conditions is met:
R you switch off the ignition when the vehicle
is stationary and the transmission is in posi‐
tion h or k.
R you open the driver's door when the vehicle
is stationary or when driving at a very low
speed and the transmission is in position h
or k.
R you switch the engine off and bring the vehi‐
cle to a standstill when the vehicle is rolling
and the transmission is in position h or k.
#
R
R
you switch off the engine, bring the vehicle
to a standstill and open the driver's door
when the vehicle is stationary or when the
vehicle is rolling and the transmission is in
position i.
engaging park position j automatically is
required by the vehicle.
% To maneuver with an open driver's door,
open the driver's door while stationary and
engage transmission position h or k
again.
Engaging drive position D
# Depress the brake pedal and push the
DIRECT SELECT lever down past the first
point of resistance.
When the automatic transmission is in transmis‐
sion position h, it shifts the gears automati‐
cally. This depends, among other things, on the
following factors:
R The selected drive program
R The position of the accelerator pedal
R The driving speed
Manual gearshifting
Permanent setting (vehicles with Offroad
package or E-Active Body Control)
Mercedes-AMG vehicles: observe the notes in
the Supplement. You could otherwise fail to rec‐
ognize dangers.
188 Driving and parking
#
To activate/deactivate: pull rocker switch
1.
If indicator lamp is lit, manual gearshifting is
activated. The current gear is displayed in the
multifunction display.
Temporary setting
To deactivate: pull steering wheel gearshift
paddle 2 and hold it in place.
The transmission position h appears in the
multifunction display.
% To permanently shift the gears manually in
drive program = using the steering wheel
gearshift paddles, select the p setting for
the transmission.
#
Gearshifting
# To shift up: pull steering wheel gearshift
paddle 2.
# To shift down: pull steering wheel gearshift
paddle 1.
Gearshift recommendation
#
To activate: pull steering wheel gearshift
paddle 1 or 2.
Manual gearshifting is activated for a short
time. Transmission position p and the cur‐
rent gear appear in the multifunction display.
Mercedes-AMG vehicles: observe the notes in
the Supplement. You could otherwise fail to rec‐
ognize dangers.
The gearshift recommendation assists you in
adopting an economical driving style.
#
If gearshift recommendation 1 appears
next to the transmission position display,
shift to the recommended gear.
Using kickdown
Mercedes-AMG vehicles: observe the notes in
the Supplement. You could otherwise fail to rec‐
ognize dangers.
# Maximum acceleration: depress the accel‐
erator pedal beyond the pressure point.
The automatic transmission shifts up to the next
gear when the maximum engine speed is
reached to protect the engine from overrevving.
Driving and parking 189
Glide mode function
Mercedes-AMG vehicles: observe the notes in
the Supplement. You could otherwise fail to rec‐
ognize dangers.
With an anticipatory driving style, Glide mode
helps you to reduce fuel consumption.
Glide mode is characterized by the following:
R The combustion engine is disconnected from
the drivetrain and continues to run in neutral.
R The transmission position display h is
shown in green.
R Vehicles with 48 V on-board electrical
system (EQ-Boost technology): the com‐
bustion engine can be switched off. All of the
vehicle functions remain active.
Glide mode is activated if the following condi‐
tions are met:
R Mercedes-Maybach vehicles: drive pro‐
gram £ is selected.
R All other models: drive program ; is
selected.
R The speed is within a suitable range.
R
R
R
The road's course is suitable, e.g. no steep
uphill or downhill inclines or tight curves.
There is no trailer coupled to the trailer hitch,
and no bicycle rack installed.
You do not depress the accelerator or brake
pedal (except for light brake applications).
% Glide mode can also be activated if you have
selected the "Eco" setting for the drive in the
drive program =.
Glide mode is deactivated again if one of the
conditions is no longer met.
Glide mode can also be prevented by the follow‐
ing parameters:
R Incline
R Downhill gradient
R Temperature
R Height
R Speed
R Operating status of the engine
R Traffic situation
Transfer case
Function of the transfer case
& WARNING Risk of skidding and having
an accident when in LOW RANGE on slip‐
pery road surfaces
The wheels can block and thus lose traction
on slippery road surfaces, particularly in the
following situations:
R if you release the accelerator pedal when
the vehicle is in motion.
R if off-road ABS intervenes when braking.
#
Never select the LOW RANGE off-road
gear when driving on slippery road sur‐
faces.
& WARNING Risk of accident when the
transfer case is in neutral position
The vehicle may roll away unintentionally if
you do not wait until the transfer case shift
operation is complete.
190 Driving and parking
#
Wait until the transfer case shift opera‐
tion is complete.
This function is only available in vehicles with
Off-road package.
Shift the transfer case to the on-road position
HIGH RANGE or into the LOW RANGE off-road
gear.
Do not switch off the engine during shift opera‐
tion and do not shift the automatic transmission
to another position.
R
R
changing the transmission ratio by a factor of
about three
increased drive torque
Shifting the transfer case
Shifting to the LOW RANGE off-road gear
Do not use LOW RANGE in the following situa‐
tions:
R when driving on public roads.
Shift ranges
HIGH RANGE
LOW RANGE
Road position for all
normal on-road driv‐
ing situations.
Off-road gear for driv‐
ing off-road, when
fording and on steep
uphill or downhill
inclines.
Properties of the LOW RANGE off-road gear:
R reduced maximum permissible speed:
31 mph (50 km/h)
R increased tractive power
Requirements:
R you are not driving on a paved or public road.
R the vehicle is stationary.
Driving and parking 191
Pull LOW RANGE 1 rocker switch.
Indicator lamp 2 flashes. The shift request
stays active for a maximum of 30 seconds. If
all requirements for shift operation are not
fulfilled within this time, indicator lamp 2
switches off again and the shift operation
must be started again.
# Switch the transmission to position i.
If shift operation is successful, the LOW
RANGE On message appears in the instru‐
ment cluster, an audible signal sounds and
indicator lamp 2 and an indicator lamp in
the instrument cluster light up continuously.
# Switch the transmission to position h.
% The vehicle stays in LOW RANGE if you park
the vehicle in LOW RANGE, even after the
engine has been restarted.
% You will not be able to switch on LOW
RANGE if drive program C or B is
switched on. The vehicle switches to drive
program A.
#
In the on-road position, shift to HIGH RANGE
Requirements:
R the engine is running and you are not driving
faster than 31 mph (50 km/h).
#
#
#
Pull LOW RANGE 1 rocker switch.
The shift request stays active for a maximum
of 30 seconds. If all requirements for shift
operation have not been fulfilled within this
time, shift operation must be started again.
Switch the transmission to position i.
If shift operation is successful, the LOW
RANGE Off message appears in the instru‐
ment cluster, an audible signal sounds and
the indicator lamps go out.
Switch the transmission to position h.
Function of the 4MATIC
4MATIC ensures that all four wheels are driven.
Together with ESP® and 4ETS, 4MATIC improves
the traction of your vehicle whenever a driven
wheel spins due to insufficient traction.
If you fail to adapt your driving style, 4MATIC can
neither reduce the risk of an accident nor over‐
ride the laws of physics. 4MATIC cannot take
account of road, weather and traffic conditions.
4MATIC is only an aid. You are responsible espe‐
cially for maintaining a safe distance from the
vehicle in front, for vehicle speed, for braking in
good time and for staying in lane.
% In wintry road conditions, the maximum
effect of 4MATIC can be achieved only if you
use winter tires (M+S tires), with snow
chains if necessary.
Refueling
Refueling the vehicle
& WARNING Risk of fire or explosion from
fuel
Fuels are highly flammable.
# Fire, open flames, smoking and creation
of sparks must be avoided.
192 Driving and parking
#
Switch off the ignition and, if available,
the stationary heater, before and while
refueling the vehicle.
& WARNING Risk of injury from fuels
Fuels are poisonous and hazardous to your
health.
# Do not swallow fuel or let it come into
contact with skin, eyes or clothing.
# Do not inhale fuel vapor.
# Keep children away from fuel.
# Keep doors and windows closed during
the refueling process.
If you or other people come into contact with
fuel, observe the following:
# Immediately rinse fuel off your skin with
soap and water.
# If fuel comes into contact with your
eyes, immediately rinse them thor‐
oughly with clean water. Seek medical
attention immediately.
#
#
If you swallow fuel, seek medical atten‐
tion immediately. Do not induce vomit‐
ing.
Change immediately out of clothing that
has come into contact with fuel.
& WARNING Risk of fire and explosion due
to electrostatic charge
Electrostatic charge can ignite fuel vapor.
# Before you open the fuel filler cap or
take hold of the pump nozzle, touch the
metallic vehicle body.
# To avoid creating another electrostatic
charge, do not get into the vehicle again
during the refueling process.
* NOTE Damage caused by the wrong fuel
Vehicles with a gasoline engine:
Even small amounts of the wrong fuel could
result in damage to the fuel system, the
engine and the emission control system.
#
Only refuel with low-sulfur unleaded
fuel.
This fuel may contain up to 10% ethanol. Your
vehicle is suitable for use with E10 fuel.
Never refuel with one of the following fuels:
R Diesel
R Gasoline with more than 10% ethanol by
volume, e.g. E15, E85, E100
R Gasoline with more than 3% methanol by
volume, e.g. M15, M30, M85, M100
R Gasoline with additives containing metal
If you have accidentally refueled with the
wrong fuel:
# Do not switch the ignition on.
# Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Driving and parking 193
* NOTE Do not use diesel to refuel vehi‐
cles with a gasoline engine
If you have accidentally refueled with the
wrong fuel:
R Do not switch the ignition on. Otherwise
fuel can enter the engine.
Even small amounts of the wrong fuel
could result in damage to the fuel system
and the engine. The repair costs are high.
#
#
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Have the fuel tank and fuel lines
drained completely.
* NOTE Damage to the fuel system caused
by overfilled fuel tanks
#
Only fill the fuel tank until the pump
nozzle switches off.
If you have added too much fuel because of a
defective filling pump, for instance:
# Do not switch the ignition on.
#
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
* NOTE Fuel may spray out when you
remove the fuel pump nozzle
#
Only fill the fuel tank until the pump
nozzle switches off.
Requirements:
R The vehicle is unlocked.
% Do not get into the vehicle again during the
refueling process. Otherwise, electrostatic
charge could build up again.
Observe the notes on operating fluids and fuel.
Only refuel with fuel that has at least the octane
number specified in the information label in the
fuel filler flap. Otherwise, engine output can be
reduced and fuel consumption increased.
1
2
3
4
5
Fuel filler flap
Bracket for fuel filler cap
Tire pressure table
QR code for rescue card
Fuel type
#
Press on the back area of fuel filler flap 1.
Turn the fuel filler cap counter-clockwise and
remove it.
#
194 Driving and parking
Insert the fuel filler cap from above into
bracket 2.
# Completely insert the pump nozzle into the
tank filler neck, hook in place and refuel.
# Only fill the fuel tank until the pump nozzle
switches off.
# Replace the cap on the filler neck and turn
clockwise until it engages audibly.
# Close fuel filler flap 1.
% Close the fuel filler flap before locking the
vehicle.
#
Parking
Parking the vehicle
& WARNING Risk of accident and injury
caused by an insufficiently secured vehi‐
cle rolling away
If the vehicle is not securely parked suffi‐
ciently, it can roll away in an uncontrolled
way even at a slight downhill gradient.
#
#
#
On uphill or downhill gradients, turn the
front wheels so that the vehicle rolls
towards the curb if it starts moving.
Apply the parking brake.
Switch the transmission to position j.
& WARNING Risk of fire caused by hot
exhaust system parts
Flammable materials such as leaves, grass or
twigs may ignite.
# Park the vehicle so that no flammable
material can come into contact with hot
vehicle components.
# In particular, do not park on dry grass‐
land or harvested grain fields.
& WARNING Risk of accident and injury
due to children left unattended in the
vehicle
If children are left unsupervised in the vehi‐
cle, they could, in particular:
R Open doors, thereby endangering other
persons or road users.
R Get out and be struck by oncoming traf‐
fic.
R Operate vehicle equipment and become
trapped, for example.
In addition, the children could also set the
vehicle in motion, for example by:
R Releasing the parking brake.
R Change the transmission position.
R Start the vehicle.
#
#
Never leave children unattended in the
vehicle.
When leaving the vehicle, always take
the SmartKey with you and lock the
vehicle.
Driving and parking 195
#
Keep the SmartKey out of reach of chil‐
dren.
* NOTE Damage to the vehicle due to it
rolling away
#
Always secure the vehicle against roll‐
ing away.
Bring the vehicle to a standstill by applying
the brake pedal.
# On gradients, turn the front wheels so that
the vehicle will roll towards the curb if it
starts moving.
# Apply the electric parking brake.
# Engage transmission position j in a station‐
ary vehicle with the brake pedal applied
(/ page 186).
# Switch off the engine and the ignition by
pressing button 1.
# Release the service brake slowly.
# Get out of the vehicle and lock it.
% When you park the vehicle, you can still
operate the side windows and the sliding
sunroof for approximately five minutes if the
driver's door is closed.
% When you park the vehicle, you can still
operate the side windows and the panorama
roof with power tilt/sliding panel for approx‐
imately five minutes if the driver's door is
closed.
#
Garage door opener
Programming buttons for the garage door
opener
& DANGER Risk of death caused by
exhaust gases
Combustion engines emit poisonous exhaust
gases such as carbon monoxide. Inhaling
these exhaust gases is hazardous to health
and leads to poisoning.
# Never leave the engine or, if present,
the auxiliary heating running in an
enclosed space without sufficient venti‐
lation.
& WARNING Risk of injury when opening
or closing a door with the garage door
opener
When you operate or program the door with
the integrated garage door opener, persons
in the range of movement of the door may
become trapped or be struck by the door.
196 Driving and parking
#
#
Always make sure that nobody is within
the range of movement of the door.
Only operate the following doors using the
garage door opener:
R Doors with a safety stop and reversing fea‐
ture
R Doors which conform to the current U.S.
safety standards
Requirements:
R The vehicle has been parked outside the
garage or outside the range of movement of
the door.
R The engine is switched off.
R The ignition is switched on.
% The garage door opener function is always
available when the ignition is switched on.
#
Check if the transmitter frequency of the
remote control has the frequency range of
280 to 868 MHz.
Radio equipment approval number:
R NZLMUAHL5 (USA)
R 4112A-MUAHL5 (Canada)
Press and hold button 1, 2 or 3 that you
wish to program.
Indicator lamp 4 flashes yellow.
% It can take up to 20 seconds before the indi‐
cator lamp flashes yellow.
# Release the previously pressed button.
Indicator lamp 4 continues to flash yellow.
# Point remote control 5 from a distance of
0.4 in (1 cm) to 3 in (8 cm) towards button
1, 2 or 3.
# Press and hold button 6 of remote control
5 until one of the following signals appears:
R Indicator lamp 4 lights up green contin‐
uously. Programming is complete.
R Indicator lamp 4 flashes green. Pro‐
gramming was successful. Additionally,
synchronization of the rolling code with
the door system must also be carried out.
# If indicator lamp 4 does not light up or flash
green: repeat the procedure.
# Release all of the buttons.
Driving and parking 197
% The remote control for the door drive is not
included in the scope of delivery of the
garage door opener.
Synchronizing the rolling code
Requirements:
R The door system uses a rolling code.
R The vehicle must be within range of the
garage door or door drive.
R The vehicle as well as persons and objects
are located outside the range of movement
of the door.
Press the programming button on the door
drive unit.
Initiate the next step within approximately
30 seconds.
# Press previously programmed button 1, 2
or 3 repeatedly until the door closes.
When the door closes, programming is com‐
pleted.
% Please also read the operating instructions
for the door drive.
#
Troubleshooting when programming the
remote control
# Check if the transmitter frequency of remote
control 5 is supported.
# Replace the batteries in remote control 5.
# Hold remote control 5 at various angles
from a distance of 0.4 in (1 cm) to 3 in
(8 cm) front of the inside rearview mirror.
You should test every position for at least
25 seconds before trying another position.
# Hold remote control 5 at the same angles
at various distances in front of the inside
rearview mirror. You should test every posi‐
tion for at least 25 seconds before trying
another position.
# Note that some remote controls transmit
only for a limited period, press button 6 on
remote control 5 again before transmission
ends.
# Align the antenna line of the door opener unit
with the remote control.
% Support and additional information on pro‐
gramming:
R On the toll free HomeLink® Hotline on
1-800-355-3515
R On the Internet at https://
www.homelink.com/mercedes
Opening or closing the garage door
Requirements:
R The corresponding button is programmed to
operate the door.
#
#
Press and hold buttons 1, 2 or 3 until
the door opens or closes.
If indicator lamp 4 flashes yellow after
approximately 20 seconds: press and hold
the previously pressed button again until the
door opens or closes.
Clearing the garage door opener memory
Press and hold buttons 1 and 3.
Indicator lamp 4 lights up yellow.
# If indicator lamp 4 flashes green: release
buttons 1 and 3.
The entire memory has been deleted.
#
198 Driving and parking
Electric parking brake
#
Electric parking brake function (applying
automatically)
#
& WARNING Risk of accident and injury
due to children left unattended in the
vehicle
If children are left unsupervised in the vehi‐
cle, they could, in particular:
R Open doors, thereby endangering other
persons or road users.
R Get out and be struck by oncoming traf‐
fic.
R Operate vehicle equipment and become
trapped, for example.
In addition, the children could also set the
vehicle in motion, for example by:
R Releasing the parking brake.
R Change the transmission position.
R Start the vehicle.
#
Never leave children unattended in the
vehicle.
When leaving the vehicle, always take
the SmartKey with you and lock the
vehicle.
Keep the SmartKey out of reach of chil‐
dren.
The electric parking brake is applied if the trans‐
mission is in position j and one of the follow‐
ing conditions is fulfilled:
R The engine is switched off.
R The seat belt tongue is not inserted in the
seat belt buckle of the driver's seat and the
driver's door is opened.
R The transfer case is in the LOW RANGE posi‐
tion.
% To prevent application: pull the handle of the
electric parking brake.
In the following situations, the electric parking
brake is also applied:
R Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC is bringing
the vehicle to a standstill.
R
R
The HOLD function is keeping the vehicle sta‐
tionary.
Active Parking Assist is keeping the vehicle
stationary.
This is the case if one of the following conditions
is also fulfilled:
R The engine is switched off.
R The seat belt tongue is not inserted in the
seat belt buckle of the driver's seat and the
driver's door is opened.
R There is a system malfunction.
R The power supply is insufficient.
R The vehicle is stationary for a lengthy period.
When the electric parking brake is applied, the
red F (USA) or ! (Canada) indicator lamp
appears in the instrument cluster.
The electric parking brake is not automatically
applied if the engine is switched off by the ECO
start/stop function.
Driving and parking 199
Electric parking brake function (releasing
automatically)
The electric parking brake is released when the
following conditions are fulfilled:
R The driver's door is closed.
R The engine is running.
R The transmission is in position h or k and
you depress the accelerator pedal or you
shift from transmission position j to h or
k when on level ground with the driver's
door closed.
R If the transmission is in position k, the tail‐
gate must be closed.
R The seat belt tongue is inserted into the seat
belt buckle of the driver's seat.
If the seat belt tongue is not inserted into the
seat belt buckle of the driver's seat, one of the
following conditions must be fulfilled:
R You shift from transmission position j.
R You have previously driven at speeds greater
than 2 mph (3 km/h).
When the electric parking brake is released, the
red F (USA) or ! (Canada) indicator lamp
in the instrument cluster goes out.
Applying/releasing the electric parking
brake manually
Applying
Push handle 1.
The red F (USA) or ! (Canada) indica‐
tor lamp appears in the instrument cluster.
% The electric parking brake is only securely
applied if the indicator lamp is lit continu‐
ously.
#
Releasing
Switch on the ignition.
# Pull handle 1.
The red F (USA) or ! (Canada) indica‐
tor lamp in the instrument cluster goes out.
#
Emergency braking
Press and hold handle 1.
As long as the vehicle is driving, the Please
Release Parking Brake message is displayed.
When the vehicle has been braked to a
standstill, the electric parking brake is
applied. The red F (USA) or ! (Can‐
ada) indicator lamp appears in the instru‐
ment cluster.
#
200 Driving and parking
Information on collision detection on a
parked vehicle
vehicle is automatically deactivated to facili‐
tate the next engine start.
If a collision is detected when the tow-away
alarm is armed on a locked vehicle, you will
receive a notification in the multimedia system
when you switch on the ignition.
You will receive information about the following
points:
R The area of the vehicle that may have been
damaged.
R The force of the impact.
System limits
Detection may be restricted in the following sit‐
uations:
R The vehicle is damaged without impact, e.g.
if an outside mirror is torn off or the paint is
damaged by a key
R An impact occurs at low speed
R The electric parking brake is not applied
The following situations can lead to inadvertent
activation:
R The parked vehicle is moved, e.g. in a twostory garage.
Notes on parking the vehicle for an extended
period
% Deactivate the tow-away alarm in order to
prevent inadvertent activation. If you deacti‐
vate the tow-away alarm, collision detection
will also be deactivated.
% If the battery is severely discharged, the
function for detecting a collision on a parked
If you leave the vehicle parked for longer than six
weeks, it may suffer damage through disuse.
The 12 V battery may also be impaired or dam‐
aged by heavy discharging.
% Further information can be obtained at a
qualified specialist workshop.
Standby mode (extension of the starter bat‐
tery's period out of use)
Standby mode function
% This function is not available for all models.
If standby mode is activated, energy loss will be
minimised during extended periods of non-oper‐
ation.
Standby mode is characterised by the following:
R The starter battery is preserved.
R The maximum non-operational time appears
in the media display.
R The connection to online services is interrup‐
ted.
R The ATA (anti-theft alarm system) is not avail‐
able.
R The interior motion sensor and tow-away
alarm functions are not available.
R The function for detecting collisions on a
parked vehicle is not available.
Driving and parking 201
If the following conditions are fulfilled, standby
mode can be activated or deactivated using the
multimedia system:
R The engine is switched off.
R The ignition is switched on.
Exceeding the vehicle's displayed non-opera‐
tional time may cause inconvenience, i.e. it can‐
not be guaranteed that the starter battery will
reliably start the engine.
The starter battery must be charged first in the
following situations:
R The vehicle's non-operational time must be
extended.
R The Battery Charge Insufficient for Standby
Mode message appears in the media display.
% Standby mode is automatically deactivated
when the ignition is switched on.
Activating/deactivating standby mode (park‐
ing the vehicle for an extended period)
Requirements:
R The engine is switched off.
Multimedia system:
4 © 5 Settings 5 Vehicle
# Activate or deactivate Standby Mode.
# Select Yes.
take into account road, weather or traffic condi‐
tions.
Information on vehicle sensors and cameras
Driving and driving safety systems
Driving systems and your responsibility
Your vehicle is equipped with driving systems
which assist you in driving, parking and maneu‐
vering the vehicle. The driving systems are only
aids. They are not a substitute for your attention
to the surroundings and do not relieve you of
your responsibility pertaining to road traffic law.
The driver is always responsible for maintaining
a safe distance to the vehicle in front, for vehicle
speed, for braking in good time and for staying
in lane. Pay attention to the traffic conditions at
all times and intervene when necessary. Be
aware of the limitations regarding the safe use of
these systems.
Driving systems can neither reduce the risk of
accident if you fail to adapt your driving style nor
override the laws of physics. They cannot always
1 Cameras in the outside mirrors
2 Multifunction camera
3 Front camera
202 Driving and parking
4 Ultrasonic sensors
5 Rear view camera
% Depending on the vehicle's equipment, the
radar sensors are integrated behind the
bumpers and/or behind the radiator grill.
Some driving and driving safety systems use
cameras as well as radar or ultrasonic sensors
to monitor the area in front of, behind or next to
the vehicle.
Keep the areas around the sensors and cameras
free of dirt, ice or slush (/ page 332). The cam‐
eras and sensors must not be covered, for exam‐
ple by bicycle racks, overhanging loads, stickers,
foil or foils to protect against stone chipping.
Additional license plate brackets can impair the
function of the ultrasonic sensors, in particular.
In the event of damage or a severe impact in the
area of the sensors, have the function of the
sensors checked at a qualified specialist work‐
shop. Have damage or stone chipping in the area
of the cameras repaired at a qualified specialist
1
2
workshop. If the sensors or cameras are dam‐
aged, some driving systems and driving safety
systems may no longer function properly.
Overview of driving systems and driving
safety systems
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
ABS (Anti-lock Braking System)
(/ page 203)
Off-road ABS (/ page 203)
BAS (Brake Assist System) (/ page 203)
ESP® (Electronic Stability Program)
(/ page 203)
ESP® Crosswind Assist (/ page 206)
ESP® trailer stabilization (/ page 206)
EBD (Electronic Brakeforce Distribution)
(/ page 207)
STEER CONTROL (/ page 207)
Active Brake Assist (/ page 207)1
Cruise control (/ page 212)
This function includes subfunctions which are only available in conjunction with the Driving Assistance Package.
This function is country-dependent and only available in conjunction with the Driving Assistance Package.
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
DSR (Downhill Speed Regulation)
(/ page 214)
Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC
(/ page 216)1
Active Speed Limit Assist (/ page 220)2
Route-based speed adaptation
(/ page 221)2
Active Steering Assist (/ page 222)2
Active Lane Change Assist (/ page 224)2
Active Emergency Stop Assist (/ page 226)2
Active Traffic Jam Assist (/ page 227)2
Hill Start Assist (/ page 227)
HOLD function (/ page 228)
AIRMATIC (/ page 229)
E-ACTIVE BODY CONTROL (/ page 236)
Parking Assist PARKTRONIC (/ page 244)
Rear view camera (/ page 249)
Surround view camera (/ page 252)
Driving and parking 203
R
R
R
R
R
Active Parking Assist (/ page 255)
ATTENTION ASSIST (/ page 261)
Traffic Sign Assist (/ page 262)1
Blind Spot Assist and Active Blind Spot Assist
with exit warning (/ page 264)1
Active Lane Keeping Assist (/ page 267)3
Function of ABS
The Anti-lock Brake System (ABS) regulates the
brake pressure in critical driving situations:
R During braking, e.g. at full brake application
or insufficient tire traction, the wheels are
prevented from locking.
R Vehicle steerability while braking is ensured.
If ABS intervenes when braking, you will feel a
pulsing in the brake pedal. The pulsating brake
pedal can be an indication of hazardous road
conditions and can serve as a reminder to take
extra care while driving.
1
3
Functions of Off-road ABS
% Off-road ABS is activated automatically when
you select the F or G drive program.
Off-road ABS is specially adapted for driving offroad:
R The front wheels lock cyclically during brak‐
ing.
R The braking distance is shortened due to the
digging-in effect.
System limits
R Off-road ABS functions at speeds below
25 mph (40 km/h).
R If Off-road ABS intervenes, the ability to steer
may be restricted.
Function of BAS
The Brake Assist System (BAS) supports your
emergency braking situation with additional
brake force.
If you depress the brake pedal quickly, BAS is
activated:
R BAS automatically boosts the brake pres‐
sure.
R BAS can shorten the braking distance.
R ABS prevents the wheels from locking.
The brakes will function as usual once you
release the brake pedal. BAS is deactivated.
Functions of ESP®
& WARNING Risk of skidding if ESP® is
deactivated
If you deactivate ESP®, ESP® cannot carry
out vehicle stabilization.
# ESP® should only be deactivated in the
following situations.
This function includes subfunctions which are only available in conjunction with the Driving Assistance Package.
This function includes subfunctions which are only available in conjunction with the Driving Assistance Package or only available depending on the country.
204 Driving and parking
Mercedes-AMG vehicles: observe the notes in
the Supplement. You could otherwise fail to rec‐
ognize dangers.
The Electronic Stability Program (ESP®) can
monitor and improve driving stability and trac‐
tion in the following situations within physical
limits:
R When pulling away on a wet or slippery road.
R When braking.
If the vehicle deviates from the direction desired
by the driver, ESP® can stabilize the vehicle by
intervening in the following ways:
R One or more wheels are braked.
R The engine output is adapted according to
the situation.
ESP®
ESP®
is deactivated if the å
OFF warn‐
ing lamp lights up continuously in the instrument
cluster:
R Driving stability will no longer be improved.
R The drive wheels could spin.
R ETS/4ETS traction control is still active.
% When ESP® is deactivated, you are still assis‐
ted by ESP® when braking.
If the ÷ ESP® warning lamp flashes in the
instrument cluster, one or several vehicle wheels
has reached its grip limit:
R Adapt your driving style to suit the current
road and weather conditions.
R Do not deactivate ESP®.
R Only depress the accelerator pedal as far as
is necessary when pulling away.
It can be advantageous to deactivate ESP® in the
following situations to improve traction:
R When using snow chains.
R In deep snow.
R On sand or gravel.
% Spinning the wheels results in a cutting
action, which enhances traction.
If the ÷ ESP® warning lamp lights up continu‐
ously, ESP® is not available due to a malfunction.
Observe the following information:
R Indicator and warning lamps (/ page 460)
R
Display messages (/ page 408)
ETS/4ETS (Electronic Traction System)
ETS/4ETS traction control is part of ESP® and
makes it possible to pull away and accelerate on
a slippery road.
If you select the F or G drive program, a
special ETS system specifically suited to off-road
terrain is automatically activated.
ETS/4ETS can improve the vehicle's traction by
intervening in the following ways:
R The drive wheels are braked individually if
they spin.
R More drive torque is transferred to the wheel
or wheels with traction.
ESP® modes
Depending on the selected drive program, the
appropriate ESP® mode will be activated auto‐
matically. ESP® adapts to different weather and
road conditions as well as the driver's preferred
driving style. You can select the drive programs
using the DYNAMIC SELECT switch
(/ page 184).
Driving and parking 205
ESP® Comfort
active in drive programs A, ; and
N
R balance between traction and stability
R recommended for all road surface conditions
R suitable for both dry and difficult road condi‐
tions, such as snow or ice, or when the road
is wet from rain
R
ESP® Sport
R active in drive program C
R continues to offer stability but with a sporty
setup
R allows the sporty driver a more active driving
style
R only suitable for good road conditions, a dry
road surface and a clear stretch of road
ESP® Sport +
R active in drive program B
R emphasizes the vehicle's own oversteering
and understeering characteristics for a more
active driving style
R
only suitable for good road conditions, a dry
road surface and a clear stretch of road
ESP® off-road and ESP® off-road +
R active in drive programs F and G
R intervenes later if there is oversteering or
understeering, thus improving traction
R ESP® off-road (F): suitable for easily
negotiable off-road terrain such as dirt
tracks, gravel or sandy surfaces
R ESP® off-road + (G): suitable for rough
terrain such as steep and/or uneven terrain
or for driving on rocky terrain
Activating/deactivating ESP® (Electronic Sta‐
bility Program) (vehicles without Off-road
package)
Multimedia system:
4 © 5 Settings 5 Quick Access
% ESP® can only be activated/deactivated
using quick access when at least one other
function is available in quick access. ESP®
can otherwise be found in the Assistance
menu.
Mercedes‑AMG vehicles: observe the notes in
the Supplement. You could otherwise fail to rec‐
ognize dangers.
# Select ESP.
# Select On or å Off.
ESP® is deactivated if the å ESP® OFF warn‐
ing lamp lights up continuously in the instrument
cluster.
Observe the information on warning lamps and
display messages which may be shown in the
instrument cluster.
Activating/deactivating ESP® (Electronic Sta‐
bility Program) (vehicles with Off-road pack‐
age or E-Active Body Control)
Mercedes-AMG vehicles: observe the notes in
the Supplement. You could otherwise fail to rec‐
ognize dangers.
206 Driving and parking
Function of ESP® Crosswind Assist
ESP® Crosswind Assist detects sudden gusts of
side wind and helps the driver to keep the vehi‐
cle in the lane:
R ESP® Crosswind Assist is active at vehicle
speeds between approx. 47 mph (75 km/h)
and 125 mph (200 km/h) when driving
straight ahead or cornering slightly.
R The vehicle is stabilized by means of individ‐
ual brake application on one side.
Function of ESP® trailer stabilization
#
Pull rocker switch 1.
ESP® is deactivated if the å ESP® OFF warn‐
ing lamp lights up continuously in the instrument
cluster.
Observe the information on warning lamps and
display messages which may be shown in the
instrument cluster.
& WARNING Risk of accident in poor road
and weather conditions
In poor road and weather conditions, the
trailer stabilization cannot prevent lurching of
the vehicle/trailer combination. Trailers with
a high center of gravity may tip over before
ESP® detects this.
#
Always adapt your driving style to suit
the current road and weather condi‐
tions.
When driving with a trailer, ESP® can stabilize
your vehicle if the trailer begins to swerve from
side to side:
R ESP® trailer stabilization is active above
speeds of 40 mph (65 km/h).
R Slight swerving is reduced by means of a tar‐
geted, individual brake application on one
side.
R In the event of severe swerving, the engine
output is also reduced and all wheels are
braked.
ESP® trailer stabilization may be impaired or
may not function if:
R The trailer is not connected correctly or is
not detected properly by the vehicle.
Driving and parking 207
Function of EBD
Electronic Breakforce Distribution (EBD) is char‐
acterized by the following:
R Monitoring and regulating the brake pressure
on the rear wheels.
R Improved driving stability when braking,
especially on bends.
Function of STEER CONTROL
STEER CONTROL helps you by transmitting a
noticeable steering force to the steering wheel in
the direction required for vehicle stabilization.
This steering recommendation is given particu‐
larly in the following situations:
R Both right wheels or both left wheels are on
a wet or slippery road surface when you
brake.
R The vehicle starts to skid.
System limits
STEER CONTROL may be impaired or may not
function in the following situations:
R ESP® is deactivated.
R ESP® is malfunctioning.
R The steering is malfunctioning.
If ESP® is malfunctioning, you will be assisted
further by the electric power steering.
Function of Active Brake Assist
Active Brake Assist consists of the following
functions:
R Distance warning function
R Autonomous braking function
R Situation-dependent braking assistance
R Vehicles with Driving Assistance Pack‐
age: Evasive Steering Assist and cornering
function
Active Brake Assist can help you to minimize the
risk of a collision with vehicles, cyclists or
pedestrians, or reduce the effects of such a colli‐
sion.
If Active Brake Assist has detected a risk of colli‐
sion, a warning tone sounds and the L dis‐
tance warning lamp lights up in the instrument
cluster.
Vehicles with PRE-SAFE®: depending on the
country, an additional haptic warning occurs in
the form of slight, repeated tensioning of the
seat belt.
If you do not react to the warning, autonomous
braking can be initiated in critical situations.
In especially critical situations, Active Brake
Assist can initiate autonomous braking directly.
In this case, the warning lamp and warning tone
occur simultaneously with the braking applica‐
tion.
If you apply the brake yourself in a critical situa‐
tion or apply the brake during autonomous brak‐
ing, situation-dependent braking assistance
occurs. The brake pressure increases up to max‐
imum full-stop braking if necessary.
208 Driving and parking
Observe the notes on driving systems and your
responsibility; you may otherwise fail to recog‐
nize dangers (/ page 201).
If autonomous braking or situation-dependent
braking assistance has occurred, display 1
appears in the multifunction display and then
automatically goes out after a short time.
If the autonomous braking function or the situa‐
tion-dependent braking assistance is triggered,
additional preventive measures for occupant
protection (PRE-SAFE®) may also be initiated.
& WARNING Risk of an accident caused by
limited detection performance of Active
Brake Assist
Active Brake Assist cannot always clearly
identify objects and complex traffic situa‐
tions.
# Always pay careful attention to the traf‐
fic situation; do not rely on Active Brake
Assist alone. Active Brake Assist is only
an aid. The driver is responsible for
maintaining a sufficiently safe distance
to the vehicle in front, vehicle speed
and for braking in good time.
# Be prepared to brake or swerve if nec‐
essary.
Also observe the system limits of Active Brake
Assist.
The individual subfunctions are available in
various speed ranges:
The distance warning function can issue a warn‐
ing in the following situations:
R From approximately 4 mph (7 km/h), if your
vehicle is critically close to a vehicle, cyclist
or pedestrian, you will hear an intermittent
warning tone and the L distance warning
lamp lights up in the instrument cluster.
Vehicles with PRE-SAFE®: depending on
the country, an additional haptic warning
occurs in the form of slight, repeated ten‐
sioning of the seat belt.
Brake immediately or take evasive action, provi‐
ded it is safe to do so and the traffic situation
allows this.
Driving and parking 209
Distance warning function (vehicles without
Driving Assistance Package)
The distance warning function can aid you in the
following situations with an intermittent warning
tone and a warning lamp:
R at speeds up to approximately 155 mph
(250 km/h) when approaching vehicles
ahead
R at speeds up to approximately 50 mph
(80 km/h) when approaching stationary vehi‐
cles, moving pedestrians and cyclists ahead
R at speeds up to approximately 37 mph
(60 km/h) when approaching crossing
cyclists
Distance warning function (vehicles with
Driving Assistance Package)
The distance warning function can aid you in the
following situations with an intermittent warning
tone and a warning lamp:
R at speeds up to approximately 155 mph
(250 km/h) when approaching vehicles
ahead
R
R
R
at speeds up to approximately 62 mph
(100 km/h) when approaching stationary
vehicles
at speeds up to approximately 50 mph
(80 km/h) when approaching moving pedes‐
trians and cyclists ahead
at speeds up to approximately 43 mph
(70 km/h) when approaching stationary
pedestrians, crossing vehicles and stationary
and crossing cyclists
Autonomous braking function (vehicles with‐
out Driving Assistance Package)
If the vehicle is traveling at speeds above
approximately 4 mph (7 km/h), the autonomous
braking function may intervene in the following
situations:
R at speeds up to approximately 124 mph
(200 km/h) when approaching vehicles
ahead
R at speeds up to approximately 50 mph
(80 km/h) when approaching cyclists ahead
R
R
at speeds up to approximately 37 mph
(60 km/h) when approaching moving pedes‐
trians and crossing cyclists
at speeds up to approximately 31 mph
(50 km/h) when approaching stationary vehi‐
cles
Autonomous braking function (vehicles with
Driving Assistance Package)
If the vehicle is traveling at speeds above
approximately 4 mph (7 km/h), the autonomous
braking function may intervene in the following
situations:
R at speeds up to approximately 155 mph
(250 km/h) when approaching vehicles
ahead
R at speeds up to approximately 62 mph
(100 km/h) when approaching stationary
vehicles
R at speeds up to approximately 50 mph
(80 km/h) when approaching cyclists ahead
R at speeds up to approximately 43 mph
(70 km/h) when approaching stationary and
210 Driving and parking
moving pedestrians, crossing vehicles and
stationary and crossing cyclists
Situation-dependent braking assistance
(vehicles without Driving Assistance Pack‐
age)
The situation-dependent braking assistance can
intervene from a speed of approximately 4 mph
(7 km/h) in the following situations:
R at speeds up to approximately 155 mph
(250 km/h) when approaching vehicles
ahead
R at speeds up to approximately 50 mph
(80 km/h) when approaching stationary vehi‐
cles and vehicles ahead
R at speeds up to approximately 37 mph
(60 km/h) when approaching moving pedes‐
trians and crossing cyclists
Situation-dependent braking assistance
(vehicles with Driving Assistance Package)
The situation-dependent braking assistance can
intervene from a speed of approximately 4 mph
(7 km/h) in the following situations:
R at speeds up to approximately 155 mph
(250 km/h) when approaching vehicles
ahead
R at speeds up to approximately 62 mph
(100 km/h) when approaching stationary
vehicles
R at speeds up to approximately 50 mph
(80 km/h) when approaching cyclists ahead
R at speeds up to approximately 37 mph
(60 km/h) when approaching stationary and
moving pedestrians, crossing vehicles and
stationary and crossing cyclists
Canceling a brake application of Active Brake
Assist
You can cancel a brake application of Active
Brake Assist at any time by:
R Activating kickdown.
R Releasing the brake pedal.
Active Brake Assist may cancel the brake appli‐
cation when one of the following conditions is
fulfilled:
R You maneuver to avoid the obstacle.
R There is no longer a risk of collision.
R An obstacle is no longer detected in front of
your vehicle.
Evasive Steering Assist (only vehicles with
Driving Assistance Package)
Evasive Steering Assist has the following charac‐
teristics:
R The ability to detect stationary or moving
pedestrians.
R Assistance through power-assisted steering if
it detects a swerving maneuver.
R Activation by an abrupt steering movement
during a swerving maneuver.
R Assistance during swerving and straightening
of the vehicle.
R Reaction from a speed of approximately
12 mph (20 km/h) up to a speed of approx‐
imately 43 mph (70 km/h).
Driving and parking 211
You can prevent the assistance at any time by
actively steering.
Cornering function (only vehicles with Driv‐
ing Assistance Package)
If a danger of collision from an oncoming vehicle
is detected when turning across an oncoming
lane, autonomous braking can be initiated at
speeds below 9 mph (15 km/h) before you have
left the lane in which you are driving.
& WARNING Risk of accident despite Eva‐
sive Steering Assist
Evasive Steering Assist cannot always recog‐
nize objects or complex traffic situations
clearly.
Moreover, the steering support provided by
Evasive Steering Assist is not sufficient to
avoid a collision.
# Always pay careful attention to the traf‐
fic situation; do not rely on Evasive
Steering Assist alone.
# Be prepared to brake or swerve if nec‐
essary.
#
#
End the support by actively steering in
non-critical situations.
Drive at an appropriate speed if there
are pedestrians close to the path of
your vehicle.
System limits
Full system performance is not available for a
few seconds after switching on the ignition or
after driving off.
The system may be impaired or may not function
in the following situations:
R In snow, rain, fog, heavy spray, if there is
glare, in direct sunlight or in greatly varying
ambient light.
R If the sensors are dirty, fogged up, damaged
or covered.
R If the sensors are impaired due to interfer‐
ence from other radar sources, e.g. strong
radar reflections in parking garages.
R If a loss of tire pressure or a faulty tire has
been detected and displayed.
R If DSR is active.
R
R
R
R
R
R
In complex traffic situations where objects
cannot always be clearly identified.
If pedestrians or vehicles move quickly into
the sensor detection range.
If pedestrians are hidden by other objects.
If the typical outline of a pedestrian cannot
be distinguished from the background.
If a pedestrian is not detected as such, e.g.
due to special clothing or other objects.
On bends with a tight radius.
% The Active Brake Assist sensors adjust auto‐
matically while a certain distance is being
driven after the vehicle has been delivered.
Active Brake Assist is unavailable or only
partially available during this teach-in period.
Setting Active Brake Assist
Requirements:
R The ignition is switched on.
212 Driving and parking
Multimedia system:
4 © 5 Settings 5 Assistance
5 Active Brake Assist
# Select the desired setting.
The setting is retained when the engine is
next started.
Deactivating Active Brake Assist
% It is recommended that you always leave
Active Brake Assist activated.
# Select Off.
The distance warning function, the autono‐
mous braking function and the Evasive Steer‐
ing Assist are deactivated.
When the vehicle is next started, the middle
setting is automatically selected.
% If Active Brake Assist is deactivated, the
æ symbol appears in the status bar of the
multifunction display.
Speed control cruise control
Function of cruise control
Cruise control regulates the speed to the value
selected by the driver.
If you accelerate to overtake, for example, the
stored speed is not deleted. If you remove your
foot from the accelerator pedal after overtaking,
cruise control will resume speed regulation back
to the stored speed.
Cruise control is operated using the correspond‐
ing steering wheel buttons. You can store any
speed above 15 mph (20 km/h) up to the maxi‐
mum design speed.
Observe the notes on driving systems and your
responsibility; you may otherwise fail to recog‐
nize dangers (/ page 201).
Mercedes‑AMG vehicles: Cruise control is
available up to a maximum speed of 155 mph
(250 km/h).
Displays on the multifunction display
h (gray): cruise control is selected but
not yet activated.
R h (green): cruise control is active.
R
A stored speed appears along with the h dis‐
play.
% The segments between the stored speed and
the end of the segment display light up in
the speedometer.
System limits
Cruise control may be unable to maintain the
stored speed on uphill gradients. The stored
speed is resumed when the gradient evens out.
Change into a lower gear in good time on long
and steep downhill gradients. Take particular
note of this when driving a laden vehicle. By
doing so, you will make use of the braking effect
of the engine. This relieves the load on the brake
system and prevents the brakes from overheat‐
ing and wearing too quickly.
Do not use cruise control in the following situa‐
tions:
R In traffic situations which require frequent
changes of speed, e.g. in heavy traffic, on
winding roads.
R On slippery roads. Accelerating can cause
the drive wheels to lose traction and the
vehicle could then skid.
Driving and parking 213
R
If you are driving when visibility is poor.
#
Operating cruise control
& WARNING Risk of accident due to stored
speed
or
Requirements:
R
R
ESP® must be activated, but not intervening.
The vehicle speed is at least 15 mph
(20 km/h).
The transmission is in position h.
Select J with the left rocker switch.
The last stored speed is called up and main‐
tained by the vehicle.
If the last stored speed has previously been
deleted, the current vehicle speed is stored.
% When you switch off the vehicle, the last
speed stored is cleared.
Increasing/decreasing the stored speed
# 1 mph (1 km/h): press rocker switch 1 up
M or down N to the pressure point.
or
# 5 mph (10 km/h): press rocker switch 1 up
M or down N beyond the pressure
point.
or
# Accelerate the vehicle to the desired speed
and press rocker switch 1 up M.
Adopting a detected speed
#
If you call up the stored speed and this is
lower than your current speed, the vehicle
decelerates.
# Take into account the traffic situation
before calling up the stored speed.
R
Press rocker switch 1 up M or down
N.
The current speed is stored and maintained
by the vehicle.
Operating cruise control
# Press the rocker switch on the steering
wheel control panel up or down to the
desired position.
Activating cruise control
# Select M with the right rocker switch.
Activating cruise control
214 Driving and parking
#
#
Activate cruise control or the variable limiter.
If a traffic sign has been detected and is dis‐
played in the instrument cluster: select J
with the left rocker switch.
The maximum permissible speed shown by
the traffic sign is stored and the vehicle
maintains or does not exceed this speed.
Deactivating cruise control
Select O with the left rocker switch.
#
Deactivating cruise control
Select N with the right rocker switch.
% If you brake, deactivate ESP® or if ESP®
intervenes, cruise control is deactivated.
#
ents, the DSR brakes the vehicle minimally or
not at all.
When DSR is activated and the transmission is in
position h, k or i, DSR controls the driving
speed. The target speed can be set to a value
between 1 mph (2 km/h) and 11 mph
(18 km/h). By braking or accelerating, you can
drive at a higher or lower speed than the target
speed at any time.
DSR is deactivated automatically if you drive at
speeds greater than 28 mph (45 km/h) or select
drive program C or B. The î Off mes‐
sage then appears in the multifunction display.
The status indicator in the multifunction display
disappears. You also hear a warning tone.
Mercedes-Maybach vehicles: in drive program
DSR (Downhill Speed Regulation)
Function of DSR (Downhill Speed Regulation)
DSR is an aid to assist you when driving down‐
hill. It keeps the speed of travel at the selected
target speed. The steeper the downhill gradient,
the greater the DSR braking effect on the vehi‐
cle. On flat stretches of road and uphill gradi‐
able.
, the DSR function is likewise not avail‐
Notes on DSR
& WARNING Risk of skidding and accident
when DSR is activated on slippery road
surfaces
If the driven speed and the target speed dif‐
fer, the wheels may lose traction.
# Take into account the road surface and
the difference between the driving
speed and target speed before activat‐
ing DSR.
Observe the notes on driving systems and your
responsibility; you may otherwise fail to recog‐
nize dangers (/ page 201).
You are always responsible for keeping control of
the vehicle and for assessing whether the down‐
hill gradient can be negotiated. Depending on
road surface and tires, DSR may not always be
able to keep to the target speed. Select a target
speed suitable for the environmental conditions
and also apply the brakes yourself if required.
Driving and parking 215
Activating/deactivating DSR (vehicles with
Off-road package or E-Active Body Control)
Requirements:
R You are driving at 24 mph (40 km/h) or
slower.
If the current vehicle speed is too high, the
Max. Speed 24 mph message appears in the
multifunction display.
R You have not selected drive program C or
B.
R Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC is deacti‐
vated.
Activating/deactivating DSR (Downhill Speed
Regulation) (vehicles without Off-road pack‐
age)
Requirements:
R You are driving at 24.8 mph (40 km/h) or
slower.
If the current vehicle speed is too high, the
Max. Speed 24 mph message appears in the
multifunction display.
R Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC is deacti‐
vated.
#
#
To activate: pull rocker switch 1.
Indicator lamp 2 lights up.
The î symbol appears in the multifunc‐
tion display.
To deactivate: pull rocker switch 1.
Indicator lamp 2 and the î symbol go
out.
Multimedia system:
4 © 5 Settings
5 Schnellzugriff (Quick access)
# Select î DSR.
The î DSRsymbol appears in the multi‐
function display when the function is activa‐
ted.
216 Driving and parking
Changing the target speed
#
To increase/reduce the target speed:
press rocker switch 1 up M or down
N to the point of resistance.
The selected target speed increases or
decreases by 1 mph (1 km/h) and appears
along with the î symbol in the multifunc‐
tion display.
Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC
Function of Active Distance Assist
DISTRONIC
Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC maintains the
set speed on free-flowing roads. If vehicles in
front are detected, the set distance is main‐
tained, if necessary, until the vehicle comes to a
halt. The vehicle accelerates or brakes depend‐
ing on the distance to the vehicle in front and
the set speed. The speed and distance to the
vehicle in front are set and saved using the
steering wheel.
Available speed range:
R Vehicles without Driving Assistance Pack‐
age: 15 mph (20 km/h) - 120 mph
(200 km/h)
R Vehicles with Driving Assistance Pack‐
age: 15 mph (20 km/h) - 130 mph
(210 km/h)
% The maximum speed is reduced when driving
in LOW RANGE off-road gear (/ page 189).
Other features of Active Distance Assist
DISTRONIC:
R Adjusts the driving style depending on the
selected drive program (fuel efficient, com‐
fortable or dynamic)
R Initiates acceleration to the stored speed if
the turn signal indicator is switched on to
change to the overtaking lane
R Vehicles with Driving Assistance Pack‐
age:
Reacts to stationary vehicles detected in
urban speed ranges (except bicycles and
motorcycles)
Takes one-sided overtaking restrictions
into account on freeways or on multi-lane
roads with separate roadways (countrydependent)
Vehicles with Active Parking Assist and Driv‐
ing Assistance Package: if the vehicle has
been braked to a standstill on multi-lane, sepa‐
rate roadways by Active Distance Assist
DISTRONIC, it can automatically follow the vehi‐
cle in front, driving off again within 30 seconds.
Driving and parking 217
If a critical situation is detected when driving off,
a visual and acoustic warning is given indicating
that the driver must now take control of the vehi‐
cle. The vehicle is not accelerated any further.
Observe the notes on driving systems and your
responsibility; you may otherwise fail to recog‐
nize dangers (/ page 201).
Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC displays in
the instrument cluster
Assistant display
1 Route-based speed adaptation: type of route
event (/ page 221)
2 Vehicle in front
3 Distance indicator
4 Set specified distance
5 Active Lane Change Assist lane change dis‐
play
Permanent status display of Active Distance
Assist DISTRONIC
R k (white): Active Distance Assist
DISTRONIC selected, specified distance set
R k (green): Active Distance Assist
DISTRONIC active, specified distance set and
vehicle detected
R r: Route-based speed adaptation active
(/ page 221).
The stored speed is shown along with the per‐
manent status display and highlighted on the
speedometer. When Active Distance Assist
DISTRONIC is passive, the speed is grayed out.
% On freeways or high-speed major roads, the
green ç vehicle symbol is displayed cycli‐
cally when the vehicle is ready to pull away.
% If you depress the accelerator pedal beyond
the setting of the Active Distance Assist
DISTRONIC, the system is switched to pas‐
sive mode. The ç Suspendedmessage
appears in the multifunction display.
Display on the speedometer
The stored speed is highlighted on the speedom‐
eter. If the speed of the vehicle in front or the
speed adjustment is less than the stored speed
due to the route event ahead, the segments on
the speedometer light up. Deactivation of Active
Distance Assist DISTRONIC, as well as altera‐
tions to the speed due to manual or automatic
adoption of the maximum permissible speed, are
displayed in the control feedback of the multi‐
function display on a single line.
System limits
The system may be impaired or may not function
in the following situations, for example:
R In snow, rain, fog, heavy spray, if there is
glare, in direct sunlight or in greatly varying
ambient light.
R If there is swirling dust, e.g. when driving offroad or on sandy surfaces.
R The windshield in the area of the camera is
dirty, fogged up, damaged or covered.
218 Driving and parking
R
R
R
If the radar sensors are dirty or covered.
In parking garages or on roads with steep
uphill or downhill gradients.
If there are narrow vehicles in front, such as
bicycles or motorcycles.
In addition, on slippery roads, braking or accel‐
erating can cause one or several wheels to lose
traction and the vehicle could then skid.
Do not use Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC in
these situations.
& WARNING Risk of accident from acceler‐
ation or braking by Active Distance
Assist DISTRONIC
Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC may accel‐
erate or brake in the following cases, for
example:
R If the vehicle pulls away using Active Dis‐
tance Assist DISTRONIC.
R If the stored speed is called up and is
considerably faster or slower than the
currently driven speed.
R
If Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC no
longer detects a vehicle in front or does
not react to relevant objects.
& WARNING Risk of accident if detection
function of Active Distance Assist
DISTRONIC is impaired
#
Always carefully observe the traffic con‐
ditions and be ready to brake at all
times.
Take into account the traffic situation
before calling up the stored speed.
Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC does not
react or has a limited reaction:
R when driving on a different lane or when
changing lanes
R to pedestrians, animals, bicycles or sta‐
tionary vehicles, or unexpected obstacles
R to complex traffic conditions
R to oncoming vehicles and crossing traffic
#
& WARNING Risk of accident due to insuf‐
ficient deceleration by Active Distance
Assist DISTRONIC
Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC brakes
your vehicle with up to 50% of the possible
deceleration. If this deceleration is not suffi‐
cient, Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC
alerts you with a visual and acoustic warning.
# Adjust your speed and maintain a suita‐
ble distance from the vehicle in front.
# Brake the vehicle yourself and/or take
evasive action.
As a result, Active Distance Assist
DISTRONIC may neither give warnings nor
intervene in such situations.
# Always observe the traffic conditions
carefully and react accordingly.
Operating Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC
Requirements:
R The electric parking brake is released.
R ESP® is activated and is not intervening.
R The transmission is in position h.
Driving and parking 219
R
R
R
R
R
The driver's door is closed.
Check of the radar sensor system has been
successfully completed.
Parking Assist PARKTRONIC is not being
used to park the vehicle or to exit from a
parking space.
DSR is deactivated.
Vehicles with Off-road package: the G
drive program is deactivated.
#
To activate without a stored speed: press
rocker switch 1 up M or down N, or
select J with the left rocker switch.
or
To activate with a stored speed: select
J with the left rocker switch.
# Remove your foot from the accelerator pedal.
The current speed is stored and maintained
by the vehicle.
Adopting a detected speed limit
# Activate Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC.
# If a traffic sign has been detected and is dis‐
played in the instrument cluster: select J
with the left rocker switch.
The maximum permissible speed on the traf‐
fic sign is adopted as the stored speed. The
vehicle adapts its speed to that of the vehicle
in front, but only up to the stored speed.
#
To operate Active Distance Assist
DISTRONIC: press the rocker switch on the
steering wheel control unit up or down to the
desired position.
Activating/deactivating Active Distance
Assist DISTRONIC
# Press the H button.
#
Activating Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC
Pulling away with Active Distance Assist
DISTRONIC
# Activate Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC
and remove your foot from the brake pedal.
220 Driving and parking
#
Select J with the left rocker switch.
or
Depress the accelerator pedal briefly and
firmly.
The functions of Active Distance Assist
DISTRONIC continue to be carried out.
Deactivating Active Distance Assist
DISTRONIC
#
& WARNING Risk of accident due to Active
Distance Assist DISTRONIC still being
activated when you leave the driver's
seat
If you leave the driver's seat while the vehicle
is being braked by Active Distance Assist
DISTRONIC only, the vehicle can roll away.
# Always deactivate Active Distance
Assist DISTRONIC and secure the vehi‐
cle to prevent it from rolling away
before you leave the driver's seat.
#
Select O with the left rocker switch.
% If you brake, deactivate ESP® or if ESP®
intervenes, Active Distance Assist
DISTRONIC is deactivated.
Increasing or decreasing the speed
# 1 mph (1 km/h): press rocker switch 1 up
M or down N to the pressure point.
or
# 5 mph (10 km/h): press rocker switch 1 up
M or down N beyond the pressure
point.
or
# Accelerate the vehicle to the desired speed
and press rocker switch 1 up M.
Changing the specified distance to the vehi‐
cle in front
# To reduce the specified distance: press
the right rocker switch up (Ñ).
# To increase the specified distance: press
the right rocker switch down (Ò).
Function of Active Speed Limit Assist
If speed limit change between 12 mph
(20 km/h) and 80 mph (130 km/h) is detected
and the automatic adoption of speed limits is
active, it will be automatically adopted as the
stored speed (/ page 264).
The driven speed is adjusted when the vehicle is
level with the traffic sign at the latest. In the
case of signs indicating entry into an urban area,
the speed is adapted according to the speed
permitted within the urban area. The speed limit
display in the Instrument Display is always upda‐
ted when the vehicle is level with the traffic sign.
If there is no speed restriction on an unlimited
stretch of road (e.g. on a freeway), the recom‐
mended speed is automatically adopted as the
stored speed. The system uses the speed stored
on an unlimited stretch of road as the recom‐
mended speed. If you do not alter the stored
speed on an unlimited stretch of road, the rec‐
ommended speed is 80 mph (130 km/h).
If Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC has been
put into passive mode by pressing the accelera‐
Driving and parking 221
tor pedal, only speed limits which are higher
than the set speed are adopted.
Observe the notes on driving systems and your
responsibility; you may otherwise fail to recog‐
nize dangers (/ page 201).
System limits
The system limits of Traffic Sign Assist apply to
the detection of traffic signs (/ page 262).
Speed limits below 12 mph (20 km/h) are not
automatically adopted by the system as the
stored speed. Temporary speed restrictions (e.g.
for a certain time or due to weather conditions)
cannot be properly detected by the system. The
maximum permissible speed applying to a vehi‐
cle with a trailer is not detected by the system.
Adjust the speed in these situations.
& WARNING Risk of accident due to Active
Speed Limit Assist adapting the vehicle's
speed
The speed adopted by Active Speed Limit
Assist may be too high or incorrect in some
individual cases, such as:
R
R
R
#
#
at speed limits below 12 mph (20 km/h)
in wet conditions or in fog
when towing a trailer
Ensure that the driven speed complies
with traffic regulations.
Adjust the driving speed to suit current
traffic and weather conditions.
Function of route-based speed adaptation
When Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC is acti‐
vated, the vehicle speed will be adapted accord‐
ingly to the route events ahead. Depending on
the drive program selected, the vehicle negoti‐
ates a route event ahead in a fuel-saving, com‐
fortable or dynamic manner. When the route
event has been passed, the vehicle accelerates
again to the stored speed. The set distance to
the vehicle in front, vehicles detected ahead and
speed restrictions ahead are taken into account.
Route-based speed adaptation can be config‐
ured in the multimedia system (/ page 222).
The following route events are taken into
account:
R Curves
R T-intersections, roundabouts and toll stations
R Turns and exits
R Traffic jams ahead (only with Live Traffic )
% When the toll station is reached, Active Dis‐
tance Assist DISTRONIC adopts the speed as
the stored speed.
Also, the speed is reduced if the turn signal indi‐
cator to change lanes is switched on and one of
the following situations is detected:
R Turning off at intersections
R Driving on slowing-down lanes
R Driving on lanes adjacent to slowing-down
lanes
The driver is responsible for choosing the right
speed and observing other road users. This
applies in particular to intersections, round‐
abouts and traffic lights, as route-based speed
adaptation does not brake the vehicle to a stand‐
still.
222 Driving and parking
When route guidance is active, the first speed
adjustment is carried out automatically. If the
turn signal indicator is switched on, the selected
route is confirmed and further speed adjustment
is activated.
Speed adaptation is canceled in the following
cases:
R If the turn signal indicator is switched off
before the route event.
R If the driver depresses the accelerator or
brake pedal during the process.
System limits
Route-based speed adaptation does not take
right of way regulations into account. The driver
is responsible for complying with road traffic
regulations and driving at a suitable speed.
In difficult conditions, the speed selection made
by the system may not always be suitable:
R unclear roads
R road narrowing
R wet road surfaces, snow or ice
R when towing a trailer
In these situations the driver must intervene
accordingly.
& WARNING Risk of accident in spite of
route-based speed adaptation
Route-based speed adaptation can malfunc‐
tion or be temporarily unavailable in the fol‐
lowing situations:
R If the driver does not follow the calcula‐
ted route
R If map data is not up-to-date or available
R In the event of roadworks
R In bad weather or road conditions
R If the accelerator pedal is depressed
R In the event of electronically displayed
speed limitations
#
Adapt the speed to the traffic situation.
Setting route-based speed adaptation
Requirements:
R
Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC is activa‐
ted.
Multimedia system:
4 © 5 Settings 5 Assistance
5 Route-based Speed
# Activate or deactivate the function.
When the function is active, the vehicle
speed is adjusted depending on the route
events ahead.
% Further information on the route-based
speed adaptation (/ page 221).
Active Steering Assist
Function of Active Steering Assist
Active Steering Assist is only available up to a
speed of 130 mph (210 km/h). The system helps
you to stay in the center of the lane by means of
moderate steering interventions. Depending on
the speed driven, Active Steering Assist uses the
vehicles ahead and lane markings as a refer‐
ence.
Driving and parking 223
% Depending on the country, in the lower
speed range Active Steering Assist can use
the surrounding traffic as a reference. If nec‐
essary, Active Steering Assist can then also
provide assistance when driving outside the
center of the lane, for example to form a res‐
cue lane.
If the detection of lane markings and vehicles
ahead is impaired, Active Steering Assist
switches to passive mode. The system provides
no support in this case.
% Depending on the selected vehicle settings,
Active Steering Assist may be unavailable.
Steering and touch detection
The driver is required to keep their hands on the
steering wheel at all times and be able to inter‐
vene at any time to correct the course of the
vehicle and keep it in lane. The driver must
expect a change from active to passive mode or
vice versa at any time.
If Active Steering Assist detects that a system
limit has been reached, a visual warning is
issued and a warning tone sounds.
Observe the notes on driving systems and your
responsibility; you may otherwise fail to recog‐
nize dangers (/ page 201).
Status display of Active Steering Assist in
the multifunction display
R Ø (gray): activated and passive
R Ø (green): activated and active
R Ø (red): system limits detected
R Ø (white, red hands): "hands on the steer‐
ing wheel" prompt
% During the transition from active to passive
status, the Ø symbol is shown as
enlarged and flashing. Once the system is
passive, the Ø symbol is shown as gray in
the multifunction display.
sounds in addition to the visual warning mes‐
sage.
If the driver does not react to this warning for a
considerable period, an emergency stop is initi‐
ated (/ page 226).
The warning is not issued or is stopped when the
driver gives confirmation to the system:
R The driver steers the vehicle.
R The driver presses a steering wheel button or
operates Touch Control.
If the system detects that the driver has not
steered the vehicle for a considerable period of
time or has removed their hands from the steer‐
ing wheel, display 1 appears. If the driver still
does not steer the vehicle, a warning tone
System limits
Active Steering Assist has a limited steering tor‐
que for lateral guidance. In some cases, the
steering intervention is not sufficient to keep the
vehicle in the lane or to drive through exits.
224 Driving and parking
The system may be impaired or may not function
in the following instances:
R There is poor visibility, e.g. due to snow, rain,
fog, heavy spray, greatly varying ambient
light or strong shadows on the road.
R There is glare, e.g. from oncoming traffic,
direct sunlight or reflections.
R Insufficient road illumination.
R The windshield is dirty, fogged up, damaged
or covered in the vicinity of the camera, e.g.
by a sticker.
R No, or several, unclear lane markings are
present for one lane, or the markings change
quickly, for example, in a construction area
or intersections.
R The lane markings are worn away, dark or
covered up, e.g. by dirt or snow.
R If the distance to the vehicle in front is too
short and thus the lane markings cannot be
detected.
R The road is narrow and winding.
R There are obstacles on the lane or projecting
out into the lane, such as object markers.
The system does not provide assistance in the
following conditions:
R On tight curves and when turning.
R When crossing intersections.
R At roundabouts or toll stations.
R When towing a trailer.
R When the tire pressure is too low.
& WARNING Risk of accident if Active
Steering Assist unexpectedly stops func‐
tioning
If the system limits of Active Steering Assist
are reached there is no guarantee that the
system will remain active or will keep the
vehicle in lane.
# Always keep your hands on the steering
wheel and observe the traffic carefully.
# Always steer the vehicle paying atten‐
tion to traffic conditions.
& WARNING Risk of accident if Active
Steering Assist unexpectedly intervenes
The detection of lane markings and objects
may malfunction and cause unexpected
steering interventions.
# Steer according to traffic conditions.
Activating/deactivating Active Steering
Assist
Requirements:
R
R
ESP® is activated, but is not intervening.
Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC is activa‐
ted.
Multimedia system:
4 © 5 Settings 5 Quick Access
# Select a Steering Assist.
Function of Active Lane Change Assist
Active Lane Change Assist supports the driver
when changing lanes by applying steering torque
if the driver operates a turn signal indicator.
Driving and parking 225
Observe the notes on driving systems and your
responsibility; you may otherwise fail to recog‐
nize dangers (/ page 201).
Assistance when changing lanes is provided if all
the following conditions are met:
R You are driving on a freeway or road with
multiple lanes in the direction of travel.
R The neighboring lane is separated by a bro‐
ken lane marking.
R No vehicle is detected in the adjacent lane.
R The driven speed is between 50 mph
(80 km/h) and 110 mph (180 km/h).
R Active Lane Change Assist is switched on in
the multimedia system.
R Active Steering Assist is activated and active.
If no vehicle is detected in the adjacent lane and
a lane change is permitted, the lane change
begins after the driver has activated the turn sig‐
nal indicator. This is shown to the driver with a
green arrow next to the ± steering wheel
symbol. The Lane Change to the Leftmessage,
for example, also appears. If Active Lane Change
Assist has been activated with the turn signal
indicator but a lane change is not immediately
possible, a gray arrow appears next to the ±
steering wheel symbol, which remains green.
When the lane change assistance starts, the turn
signal indicator is automatically activated along
with the display in the multifunction display.
If the assistance graphic is shown when chang‐
ing lanes, the lane change display appears with
an additional arrow pointing towards the adja‐
cent lane (/ page 216)
If a lane change is not possible, the arrow is
faded out after a few seconds and a new lane
change must be initiated. An immediate lane
change is only possible on freeway sections
without speed limits.
If the system is impaired, Active Lane Change
Assist may be canceled. The Lane Change Canceled message appears in the multifunction dis‐
play.
In addition, a warning tone may sound.
& WARNING Risk of accident when chang‐
ing lane to an occupied adjacent lane
Lane Change Assist cannot always clearly
detect if the adjacent lane is free.
The lane change might be initiated although
the adjacent lane is not free.
# Before changing lanes, make sure that
the neighboring lane is free and there is
no danger to other road users.
# Monitor the lane change.
& WARNING Risk of accident if Lane
Change Assist unexpectedly stops func‐
tioning
If the system limitations for Lane Change
Assist have been reached, there is no guar‐
antee that the system will remain active.
Lane Change Assist cannot then assist you
by applying steering torques.
# Always monitor the lane change and
keep your hands on the steering wheel.
226 Driving and parking
Observe the traffic conditions and steer
and/or brake if necessary.
System limits
The system limitations of Active Steering Assist
apply to Active Lane Change Assist
(/ page 222).
The system may also be impaired or may not
function in the following situations:
R The sensors in the rear bumper are dirty,
damaged or covered by a sticker or ice and
snow, for example.
R The exterior lighting shows a defect.
% The Active Lane Change Assist sensors
adjust automatically while a certain distance
is being driven after the vehicle has been
delivered. Active Lane Change Assist is
unavailable or only partially available during
this teach-in process; no arrow appears next
to the Ø Active Steering Assist symbol
when the turn signal indicator is activated.
Activating/deactivating Active Lane Change
Assist
Multimedia system:
4 © 5 Settings 5 Assistance
5 Active Lane Change Assist
# Activate or deactivate the function.
Function of Active Emergency Stop Assist
If the system detects that the driver has not
steered the vehicle for a considerable period of
time or has removed their hands from the steer‐
ing wheel, display 1 appears in the multifunc‐
tion display. If the driver still does not steer the
vehicle, or gives no confirmation to the system,
a warning tone sounds in addition to the visual
warning message.
If the driver still does not respond to the warn‐
ing, the Beginning Emergency Stop message
appears in the multifunction display. If the driver
still does not respond, Active Distance Assist
DISTRONIC reduces the speed. The vehicle is
decelerated in stages to a standstill.
Depending on the country, at speeds below
40 mph (60 km/h) the hazard warning lights
switch on automatically.
When the vehicle is stationary, the following
actions are carried out:
R The vehicle is secured with the electric park‐
ing brake.
R Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC is ended
R The vehicle is unlocked.
R If possible, an emergency call is placed to
the Mercedes-Benz emergency call center
The driver can cancel the deceleration at any
time by performing one of the following actions:
R Steering
Driving and parking 227
R
R
Braking or accelerating
Deactivating Active Distance Assist
DISTRONIC
Function of Active Traffic Jam Assist
Active Traffic Jam Assist helps you when in traf‐
fic jams on multi-lane roads with separate road‐
ways by automatically pulling away within up to
60 seconds and with moderate steering maneu‐
vers. It orients itself using the vehicle in front
and lane markings. Active Traffic Jam Assist
automatically maintains a safe distance from the
vehicle in front and vehicles cutting in.
Active Traffic Jam Assist requires you, as the
driver, to keep your hands on the steering wheel
at all times so that you are able to intervene at
any time to correct the course of the vehicle and
keep it in lane.
Observe the notes on driving systems and your
responsibility; you may otherwise fail to recog‐
nize dangers (/ page 201).
Active Traffic Jam Assist activates automatically
when all of the following conditions are met:
R You are in a traffic jam on a freeway or highspeed major road.
R Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC is activa‐
ted and active (/ page 218).
R Active Brake Assist is available
(/ page 207).
R Active Steering Assist is activated and active
(/ page 224).
R Active Traffic Jam Assist is activated
(/ page 227).
R You are traveling no faster than 35 mph
(60 km/h).
The following symbol is displayed in the instru‐
ment cluster when the system is active:
System limits
The system limitations of Active Distance Assist
DISTRONIC and Active Steering Assist apply to
Active Traffic Jam Assist (/ page 222).
Activating/deactivating Active Traffic Jam
Assist
Multimedia system:
4 © 5 Settings
5
Quick Access
#
Select
.
Function of Hill Start Assist
Hill Start Assist holds the vehicle for a short
time when pulling away on a hill under the fol‐
lowing conditions:
R The transmission is in position h or k.
R The electric parking brake is released.
This gives you enough time to move your foot
from the brake pedal to the accelerator pedal
228 Driving and parking
and depress it before the vehicle begins to roll
away.
& WARNING Risk of accident and injury
due to the vehicle rolling away
After a short time, Hill Start Assist no longer
holds the vehicle.
# Swiftly move your foot from the brake
pedal to the accelerator pedal. Do not
leave the vehicle when it is being held
by Hill Start Assist.
HOLD function
HOLD function
The HOLD function holds the vehicle at a stand‐
still without requiring you to depress the brake
pedal, e.g. while waiting in traffic.
The HOLD function is only an aid. The responsi‐
bility for the vehicle safely standing still remains
with the driver.
System limits
The HOLD function is only intended to provide
assistance when driving and is not a sufficient
means of safeguarding the vehicle against rolling
away when stationary.
R The incline must not be greater than 30%.
R
R
Activating/deactivating the HOLD function
& WARNING Risk of an accident due to the
HOLD function being activated when you
leave the vehicle
If the vehicle is only braked with the HOLD
function it could, in the following situations,
roll away:
R If there is a malfunction in the system or
in the power supply.
R If the HOLD function is deactivated by
depressing the accelerator pedal or brake
pedal, e.g. by a vehicle occupant.
#
Always secure the vehicle against roll‐
ing away before you leave it.
Requirements:
R The vehicle is stationary.
R
R
R
The driver's door is closed or the seat belt on
the driver's side is fastened.
The engine is running or has been automati‐
cally switched off by the ECO start/stop
function.
The electric parking brake is released.
Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC is deacti‐
vated.
The transmission is in position h, k or i.
Activating the HOLD function
# Depress the brake pedal and after a short
time quickly depress further until the ë
display appears in the multifunction display.
# Release the brake pedal.
Deactivating the HOLD function
# Depress the accelerator pedal to pull away.
or
# Depress the brake pedal until the ë dis‐
play disappears from the multifunction dis‐
play.
Driving and parking 229
The HOLD function is deactivated in the follow‐
ing situations:
R Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC is activa‐
ted.
R The transmission is switched to position j.
R The vehicle is secured with the electric park‐
ing brake.
In the following situations, the vehicle is held by
transmission position j and/or by the electric
parking brake:
R The seat belt is unfastened and the driver's
door is opened.
R The vehicle is switched off.
R There is a malfunction in the system or the
power supply is insufficient.
AIRMATIC
Function of AIRMATIC
Mercedes-AMG vehicles: observe the notes in
the Supplement. You could otherwise fail to rec‐
ognize dangers.
AIRMATIC is an air suspension system with an
all-round level control system, which also
ensures the best possible suspension and con‐
stant ground clearance, even with a laden vehi‐
cle. When driving at speed, the vehicle is low‐
ered automatically to improve driving safety and
to reduce fuel consumption. You also have the
option of manually adjusting the vehicle level.
AIRMATIC is comprised of the following func‐
tions and components:
R All-round air suspension
R Speed-dependent lowering
R Manually selectable high level setting for
greater ground clearance which can be
adjusted using a level button
R Vehicles with ADS PLUS: also Adaptive
Damping System with constant adjustment
of damping characteristics for improved driv‐
ing comfort
Suspension settings and vehicle level per
drive program
Drive program A and ;:
R The suspension setting is comfortable.
R
R
R
The vehicle is set to the normal level.
When driving at speeds of approximately
87 mph (140 km/h) or above, the vehicle is
lowered.
When driving at speeds below approximately
25 mph (40 km/h), the vehicle is raised
again.
Drive program £ (Mercedes-Maybach vehi‐
cles only):
R The suspension setting is very comfortable.
R The vehicle is set to the normal level.
R When driving at speeds of approximately
87 mph (140 km/h) or above, the vehicle is
lowered.
R When driving at speeds below approximately
25 mph (40 km/h), the vehicle is raised
again.
Drive program C:
R The suspension setting is firmer.
R The vehicle is lowered to sport level.
230 Driving and parking
Drive program B:
R The suspension setting is even firmer.
R The vehicle is lowered to Sport + level.
Drive program F (vehicles without Off-road
package)
R The suspension setting is suitable for easily
negotiable off-road terrain.
R The vehicle is set to off-road level +1.
R When driving at speeds of approximately
50 mph (80 km/h) or above, the vehicle is
lowered.
R When driving at speeds below approximately
28 mph (45 km/h), the vehicle is raised.
Drive program F (vehicles with Off-road
package)
R The suspension setting is suitable for easily
negotiable off-road terrain.
R The vehicle is set to off-road level +1.
R When driving at speeds of approximately
71 mph (115 km/h) or above, the vehicle is
lowered.
R
When driving at speeds below approximately
47 mph (75 km/h), the vehicle is raised.
Differences between different vehicle levels
compared to the normal level
G (vehicles with Off-road package)
R The suspension setting is suitable for difficult
off-road terrain.
R The vehicle is set to off-road level +1.
R When driving at speeds of approximately
50 mph (80 km/h) or above, the vehicle is
lowered.
R When driving at speeds below approximately
28 mph (45 km/h), the vehicle is raised.
Vehicle
level
Vehicles
without Offroad package
Vehicles with
Off-road pack‐
age
Car wash
approximately
+3.5 in
(+90 mm)
approximately
+3.5 in
(+90 mm)
Off-road
level +3
Unavailable
approximately
+3.5 in
(+90 mm)
Individual suspension settings can be called up
in drive program = (/ page 184).
Off-road
level +2
Unavailable
approximately
+2.4 in
(+60 mm)
Driving and parking 231
Vehicle
level
Vehicles
without Offroad package
Vehicles with
Off-road pack‐
age
Off-road
level +1
MercedesMaybach vehi‐
cles: approx‐
imately
+2.0 in
(+50 mm)
All other mod‐
els: approx‐
imately
+2.4 in
(+60 mm)
approximately
+1.2 in
(+30 mm)
Sport
approximately
-0.6 in
(-15 mm)
approximately
-0.6 in
(-15 mm)
approximately
-1.0 in
(-25 mm)
approximately
-1.0 in
(-25 mm)
Sport +
If the entry/exit level function is activated, the
vehicle is set to the Sport + level to facilitate
entering/exiting the vehicle. When driving at
speeds of approximately 19 mph (30 km/h) or
above, the entry/exit level is deactivated and
the vehicle is raised (/ page 234).
Operation with a trailer or bicycle rack
If the electrical connection to the trailer or bicy‐
cle rack is established correctly:
R Drive program A, ;, £, =,
C and B: the vehicle remains at nor‐
mal level irrespective of speed.
R Drive program F and G: the vehicle
adopts the normal level starting from a
speed of 19 mph (30 km/h).
System limits
AIRMATIC may not be available or have only limi‐
ted availability in the following cases:
R The overheating protection has been activa‐
ted due to frequent level changes within a
short time. The Á warning lamp appears
in the multifunction display.
After the cooling phase, the system is again
available without restriction.
Setting the vehicle level (vehicles with AIR‐
MATIC)
& WARNING Risk of accident because
vehicle level is too high
If you drive at a higher vehicle level, the driv‐
ing characteristics may be impaired due to
the higher vehicle center of gravity.
The vehicle can drift outwards, for example,
when steering or cornering.
# Always choose a vehicle level which is
suited to the driving style and the road
surface conditions.
& WARNING Risk of entrapment from vehi‐
cle lowering
When lowering the vehicle, people could
become trapped if their limbs are between
the vehicle body and the tires or underneath
the vehicle.
# Make sure no one is underneath the
vehicle or in the immediate vicinity of
232 Driving and parking
the wheel arches when the vehicle is
being lowered.
& WARNING Risk of becoming trapped
due to the vehicle lowering
Vehicles with AIRMATIC or level control:
when you unload luggage or leave the vehi‐
cle, the vehicle first rises slightly and then
returns to the set level shortly afterwards.
You or anyone else in the vicinity of the
wheel arches or the underbody could thus
become trapped.
The vehicle can also be lowered after being
locked.
# When leaving the vehicle, make sure
that nobody is in the vicinity of the
wheel arches or the underbody.
* NOTE Damage due to vehicle lowering
Parts of the body could be damaged when
the vehicle is lowered.
#
Make sure that there are no obstacles
such as curbs underneath or in the
immediate vicinity of the body when the
vehicle is being lowered.
Mercedes-AMG vehicles: observe the notes in
the Supplement. You could otherwise fail to rec‐
ognize dangers.
Requirements:
R The vehicle has been started.
R Vehicles without Off-road package: the
vehicle is not moving faster than 40 mph
(65 km/h).
R Vehicles with Off-road package:
Off-road level +1: the vehicle is not mov‐
ing faster than 62 mph (100 km/h).
Off-road level +2: the vehicle is not mov‐
ing faster than 40 mph (65 km/h).
Off-road level +3: the vehicle is not mov‐
ing faster than 12 mph (20 km/h) and the
rear fog lamp is not switched on.
Raising the vehicle (vehicles without Offroad package)
#
Push rocker switch 1 forwards.
Indicator lamp 2 flashes while the vehicle is
being raised and lights up continuously when
it has finished rising.
Driving and parking 233
Your selection is saved. The off-road level set
remains stored even after the ignition has been
switched off.
The vehicle is lowered again in the following sit‐
uations:
R When driving faster than 50 mph (80 km/h).
R When driving briefly between 40 mph
(65 km/h) and 50 mph (80 km/h).
R After selecting a different drive program
using the DYNAMIC SELECT switch.
If the electrical connection to the trailer or bicy‐
cle rack is established correctly:
R Up to approximately 18.7 mph (30 km/h):
the off-road level +1 can be selected regard‐
less of the drive program.
R From approximately 18.7 mph (30 km/h):
the vehicle is set to the normal level regard‐
less of the drive program.
Raising the vehicle (vehicles with Off-road
package)
The vehicle is adjusted to the height of the
active drive program.
Lowering the vehicle (vehicles without Offroad package)
# Pull rocker switch 1.
The vehicle is adjusted to the height of the
active drive program.
Operation with a trailer or bicycle rack
#
Push rocker switch 1 forwards.
Off-road level +1: one indicator lamp 2
lights up continuously when the vehicle
has finished rising.
R Off-road level +2: two indicator lamps 2
light up continuously when the vehicle
has finished rising.
R
234 Driving and parking
R
Off-road level +3: three indicator lamps
2 light up continuously when the vehicle
has finished rising.
Your selection is saved. The off-road level set
remains stored even after the ignition has been
switched off.
The vehicle is lowered again in the following sit‐
uations:
R Off-road level +3: when driving faster than
12 mph (20 km/h) or when the rear fog lamp
is switched on.
The vehicle is lowered to off-road level +2.
R Off-road level +2:
When driving faster than 50 mph
(80 km/h).
When driving briefly between 40 mph
(65 km/h) and 50 mph (80 km/h).
R
The vehicle is lowered to off-road level +1.
Off-road level +1:
When driving faster than 71 mph
(115 km/h).
-
R
When driving briefly between 62 mph
(100 km/h) and 71 mph (115 km/h).
The vehicle is lowered to the normal level.
After selecting a different drive program
using the DYNAMIC SELECT switch.
The vehicle is adjusted to the height of the
active drive program.
Lowering the vehicle (vehicles with Off-road
package)
# Pull rocker switch 1.
R Off-road level +3: the vehicle is lowered
to off-road level +2. Two indicator lamps
2 light up continuously when the vehicle
has finished lowering.
R Off-road level +2: the vehicle is lowered
to off-road level +1. One indicator lamp
2 lights up continuously when the vehi‐
cle has finished lowering.
R Off-road level +1: the vehicle is lowered
to the normal level. No indicator lamp 2
lights up when the vehicle has finished
lowering.
Your selection is saved. The off-road level set
remains stored even after the ignition has been
switched off.
Operation with a trailer or bicycle rack
If the electrical connection to the trailer or bicy‐
cle rack is established correctly:
R Up to approximately 12 mph (20 km/h): offroad levels +1, +2 and +3 can be selected
regardless of the drive program.
R Up to approximately 19 mph (30 km/h): offroad levels +1 and +2 can be selected
regardless of the drive program.
R From approximately 19 mph (30 km/h): the
vehicle is set to the normal level regardless
of the drive program.
Setting the entering/exiting level (AIRMATIC)
Requirements:
R The engine is running.
R The vehicle is moving at speeds less than
20 mph (30 km/h).
Driving and parking 235
Multimedia system:
4 © 5 Settings
5 Schnellzugriff (Quick access)
# Select Lower When Getting In On.
The vehicle is lowered to low level -2 to facili‐
tate entering and exiting.
% The availability of this function depends on
the vehicle equipment.
% Further information on AIRMATIC
(/ page 229).
Lowering and raising the rear of the vehicle
& WARNING Risk of entrapment from vehi‐
cle lowering
When lowering the vehicle, people could
become trapped if their limbs are between
the vehicle body and the tires or underneath
the vehicle.
# Make sure no one is underneath the
vehicle or in the immediate vicinity of
the wheel arches when the vehicle is
being lowered.
Requirements:
R All vehicle doors are closed
R There is no trailer coupled
R There is no bicycle rack installed
R The battery is sufficiently charged; if neces‐
sary, start the engine
Lowering the rear of the vehicle
Apply the electric parking brake.
Shift the transmission to position j
(/ page 186).
# Pull switch 1 in the right-hand cargo com‐
partment trim briefly.
Indicator lamp 2 flashes until the vehicle
has been lowered.
The vehicle is lowered at the rear axle by
approx. 1.5 in (40 mm). When the vehicle has
been lowered, indicator lamp 2 remains lit.
When the rear of the vehicle has been com‐
pletely lowered, indicator lamp 2 remains
lit.
Lowering is interrupted in the following situa‐
tions:
R A vehicle door is opened
R Switch 1 is pulled again
R The vehicle is being driven faster than
1.2 mph (2 km/h).
#
#
% The vehicle is automatically set to the level
of the most recently selected drive program
if you drive at speeds greater than 1.2 mph
(2 km/h).
236 Driving and parking
If indicator lamp 2 flashes twice and the rear of
the vehicle does not lower:
# Make sure that the requirements are met.
% Lowering the rear of the vehicle allows the
vehicle to be loaded more easily. Observe
the notes on loading the vehicle when doing
this (/ page 119).
Raising the rear of the vehicle
Check if the battery is sufficiently charged. If
necessary, start the engine.
# Pull switch 1 briefly.
Indicator lamp 2 goes out.
The vehicle will be raised to the currently
selected level.
% The vehicle is automatically set to the level
of the most recently selected drive program
if you drive at speeds greater than 1.2 mph
(2 km/h).
If the vehicle cannot be raised:
# Ensure that the battery is sufficiently
charged; if necessary, start the engine.
The raising process continues.
#
E-ACTIVE BODY CONTROL
Function of E-ACTIVE BODY CONTROL
E-ACTIVE BODY CONTROL is an electrohydraulic
suspension system with variable damping for
improved driving comfort. The all-round level
control system ensures the best possible sus‐
pension and constant ground clearance, even
with a laden vehicle. When driving at speed, the
vehicle is lowered automatically to improve driv‐
ing safety and to reduce fuel consumption. The
suspension setting is adjusted depending on the
road surface, vehicle load and the drive program
selected.
The ROAD SURFACE SCAN function detects
areas of unevenness in the road before you drive
over them by means of a multifunction camera.
This reduces chassis movements.
The damping is adjusted individually to each
wheel and depends on the following factors:
R Driving style, e.g. sporty
R Road condition, e.g. bumps
R Drive program
E-ACTIVE BODY CONTROL is comprised of the
following functions and components:
R Vehicles with Driving Assistance Pack‐
age: ROAD SURFACE SCAN
R Curve inclination function CURVE
R Recovery mode
R Individual wheel control
R Air suspension with automatic level control
R Speed-dependent lowering to reduce fuel
consumption
R Manual level adjustment
R ADS PLUS (Adaptive Damping System with
constant adjustment of damping characteris‐
tics)
R DYNAMIC SELECT switch and level button.
Suspension settings and vehicle level per
drive program
Drive program C
R The suspension setting is firmer.
R The vehicle is set to Sport level.
R ROAD SURFACE SCAN is deactivated.
Driving and parking 237
R
The curve inclination function is deactivated.
Drive program B
R The suspension setting is even firmer.
R The vehicle is set to Sport + level.
R ROAD SURFACE SCAN is deactivated.
R The curve inclination function is active.
Drive program A
The suspension setting is comfortable.
R The vehicle is set to the normal level.
R When driving at speeds of approximately
87 mph (140 km/h) or above, the vehicle is
lowered.
R When driving at speeds below approximately
25 mph (40 km/h), the vehicle is raised.
R ROAD SURFACE SCAN is active.
R The curve inclination function is deactivated.
R
Drive program £
R The suspension setting is very comfortable.
R The vehicle is set to the normal level.
R
R
R
R
When driving at speeds of approximately
87 mph (140 km/h) or above, the vehicle is
lowered.
When driving at speeds below approximately
25 mph (40 km/h), the vehicle is raised.
ROAD SURFACE SCAN is active.
The curve inclination function is active.
Drive program N
The suspension setting is comfortable.
R The vehicle is set to the normal level.
R When driving at speeds of approximately
87 mph (140 km/h) or above, the vehicle is
lowered.
R When driving at speeds below approximately
25 mph (40 km/h), the vehicle is raised
again.
R ROAD SURFACE SCAN is active.
R The curve inclination function is active.
R
Drive program ;
R The suspension setting is comfortable.
R The vehicle is set to the normal level.
R
R
R
R
When driving at speeds of approximately
87 mph (140 km/h) or above, the vehicle is
lowered.
When driving at speeds below approximately
25 mph (40 km/h), the vehicle is raised
again.
ROAD SURFACE SCAN is deactivated.
The curve inclination function is deactivated.
Drive program F
R The suspension setting is suitable for easily
negotiable off-road terrain.
R The vehicle is set to off-road level +1.
R ROAD SURFACE SCAN is deactivated.
R The curve inclination function is deactivated.
R Recovery mode or individual wheel control
can be activated.
R Vehicles without Off-road package:
When driving at speeds of approximately
50 mph (80 km/h) or above, the vehicle
is lowered.
238 Driving and parking
When driving at speeds below approx‐
imately 28 mph (45 km/h), the vehicle is
raised.
Vehicles with Off-road package:
When driving at speeds of approximately
71 mph (115 km/h) or above, the vehicle
is lowered.
When driving at speeds below approx‐
imately 47 mph (75 km/h), the vehicle is
raised.
-
R
Drive program G
R The suspension setting is suitable for difficult
off-road terrain.
R The vehicle is set to off-road level +1.
R When driving at speeds of approximately
50 mph (80 km/h) or above, the vehicle is
lowered.
R When driving at speeds below approximately
28 mph (45 km/h), the vehicle is raised.
R ROAD SURFACE SCAN is deactivated.
R The curve inclination function is deactivated.
R
Recovery mode or individual wheel control
can be activated.
Drive program =
R You can call up individual suspension set‐
tings here.
Operation with a trailer or bicycle rack
If the electrical connection to the trailer or bicy‐
cle rack is established correctly:
R Drive program A, ;, £, N,
=, C and B: the vehicle remains at
normal level irrespective of speed.
R The curve inclination function is deactivated.
R Drive program F and G: the vehicle
adopts the normal level starting from a
speed of 19 mph (30 km/h).
Level differences compared to the normal
level
Vehicle
level
Vehicles
without Offroad package
Vehicles with
Off-road pack‐
age
Car wash
approximately
+3.5 in
(+90 mm)
approximately
+3.5 in
(+90 mm)
Off-road
level +3
Unavailable
approximately
+3.5 in
(+90 mm)
Off-road
level +2
Unavailable
approximately
+2.4 in
(+60 mm)
Driving and parking 239
Vehicle
level
Vehicles
without Offroad package
Vehicles with
Off-road pack‐
age
Off-road
level +1
MercedesMaybach vehi‐
cles: approx‐
imately
+2.0 in
(+50 mm)
All other mod‐
els: approx‐
imately
+2.4 in
(+60 mm)
approximately
+1.2 in
(+30 mm)
Sport
approximately
-0.6 in
(-15 mm)
approximately
-0.6 in
(-15 mm)
Sport +
approximately
-1.0 in
(-25 mm)
approximately
-1.0 in
(-25 mm)
Function of ROAD SURFACE SCAN
% This function is not available in all countries.
The ROAD SURFACE SCAN function monitors the
road in front of your vehicle using multifunction
camera (/ page 201). ROAD SURFACE SCAN
detects unevenness in the road surface, e.g.
bumps, before the vehicle drives over them.
Chassis movements are reduced and driving
comfort is increased.
ROAD SURFACE SCAN is automatically activated
if the following conditions are met:
R The drive program A or N is selected.
R The vehicle is set to the normal level.
R You are driving at a speed between 4 mph
(7 km/h) and 112 mph (180 km/h).
System limits
ROAD SURFACE SCAN can be impaired in the
following situations or can stop functioning:
R If the road is insufficiently lit, e.g. at night.
R In snow, rain, fog, heavy spray, if there is
glare, in direct sunlight or in greatly varying
ambient light.
R If the windshield in the area of multifunction
camera 1 is dirty, fogged up, damaged or
covered.
R
R
R
R
If the road surface has no optic structure or
reflects light.
If you are driving too close to the vehicle in
front.
If sections of the route have a very small
radius of curvature.
During abrupt driving maneuvers, e.g. heavy
braking or sudden acceleration.
Observe the notes on cleaning the multifunction
camera (/ page 332).
Function of recovery mode
& WARNING Risk of injury due to the vehi‐
cle moving up and down
During recovery mode, the vehicle moves up
and down and can cause injuries.
# When activating recovery mode, make
certain that no one is in the vicinity of
the vehicle.
240 Driving and parking
* NOTE Risk of damage due to the vehicle
moving up and down
When free driving mode is activated, the
vehicle moves up and down. Vehicle parts
may be damaged if the underbody bottoms
out.
# Make sure that there is sufficient
ground clearance when rocking free
mode is activated.
Recovery mode is a function of the suspension
which can assist the driver on loose surfaces
(e.g. sand, snow) when freeing a vehicle which
has become stuck.
The vehicle body rocks in slow, vertical motions
when recovery mode has been activated. This
temporarily puts the wheels under greater load,
which means they have increased traction and
the vehicle is freed.
You can activate free driving mode via Off-road
Assist (/ page 243).
Function of individual wheel control
& WARNING Risk of becoming trapped
due to the vehicle lowering
The vehicle can be lowered when the individ‐
ual wheel control function has been activa‐
ted. Body parts could become trapped if they
are between the vehicle body and the tires or
underneath the vehicle.
# Make sure that nobody is under the
vehicle or in the immediate vicinity of
the wheel arches when individual wheel
control is activated.
* NOTE Risk of damage due to the vehicle
moving up and down
The vehicle can be lowered or raised on one
or more wheels when the individual wheel
control function has been activated. Vehicle
parts could be damaged due to contact with
objects.
# Make sure that the vehicle has suffi‐
cient room to move when the individual
wheel control function has been activa‐
ted.
Individual wheel control is a function of the sus‐
pension, which can be used to set the vehicle
level for each wheel individually. This can help to
improve alignment of the body when driving offroad.
You can activate individual wheel control via Offroad Assist (/ page 243).
Adjusting the vehicle level (vehicles with EACTIVE BODY CONTROL)
& WARNING Risk of accident because
vehicle level is too high
Driving characteristics may be impaired.
The vehicle can drift outwards, for example,
when steering or cornering.
# Choose a vehicle level which is suited
to the driving style and the road surface
conditions.
Driving and parking 241
& WARNING Risk of entrapment from vehi‐
cle lowering
When lowering the vehicle, people could
become trapped if their limbs are between
the vehicle body and the tires or underneath
the vehicle.
# Make sure no one is underneath the
vehicle or in the immediate vicinity of
the wheel arches when the vehicle is
being lowered.
& WARNING Risk of becoming trapped
due to the vehicle lowering
Vehicles with AIRMATIC or level control:
when you unload luggage or leave the vehi‐
cle, the vehicle first rises slightly and then
returns to the set level shortly afterwards.
You or anyone else in the vicinity of the
wheel arches or the underbody could thus
become trapped.
The vehicle can also be lowered after being
locked.
#
When leaving the vehicle, make sure
that nobody is in the vicinity of the
wheel arches or the underbody.
Raising the vehicle (vehicles without Offroad package)
Requirements:
R The vehicle has been started.
R Vehicles without Off-road package: the
vehicle is being driven no faster than 40 mph
(65 km/h).
R Vehicles with Off-road package:
Off-road level +1: the vehicle is not mov‐
ing faster than 62 mph (100 km/h).
Off-road level +2: the vehicle is not mov‐
ing faster than 40 mph (65 km/h).
Off-road level +3: the vehicle is not mov‐
ing faster than 12 mph (20 km/h).
#
Push rocker switch 1 forwards.
Indicator lamp 2 flashes while the vehicle is
being raised and lights up continuously when
it has finished rising.
242 Driving and parking
Your selection is saved. The off-road level set
remains stored even after the ignition has been
switched off.
The vehicle is lowered again in the following sit‐
uations:
R When driving faster than 50 mph (80 km/h).
R When driving briefly between 40 mph
(65 km/h) and 50 mph (80 km/h).
R After selecting a different drive program
using the DYNAMIC SELECT switch.
If the electrical connection to the trailer or bicy‐
cle rack is established correctly:
R Up to approximately 18.7 mph (30 km/h):
the off-road level +1 can be selected regard‐
less of the drive program.
R From approximately 18.7 mph (30 km/h):
the vehicle is set to the normal level regard‐
less of the drive program.
Raising the vehicle (vehicles with Off-road
package)
The vehicle is adjusted to the height of the
active drive program.
Lowering the vehicle (vehicles without Offroad package)
# Pull rocker switch 1.
The vehicle is adjusted to the height of the
active drive program.
Operation with a trailer or bicycle rack
#
Push rocker switch 1 forwards.
Off-road level +1: one indicator lamp 2
lights up continuously when the vehicle
has finished rising.
R Off-road level +2: two indicator lamps 2
light up continuously when the vehicle
has finished rising.
R
Driving and parking 243
R
Off-road level +3: three indicator lamps
2 light up continuously when the vehicle
has finished rising.
Your selection is saved. The off-road level set
remains stored even after the ignition has been
switched off.
The vehicle is lowered again in the following sit‐
uations:
R Off-road level +3: when driving faster than
12 mph (20 km/h).
The vehicle is lowered to off-road level +2.
R Off-road level +2:
When driving faster than 50 mph
(80 km/h).
When driving briefly between 40 mph
(65 km/h) and 50 mph (80 km/h).
R
The vehicle is lowered to off-road level +1.
Off-road level +1:
When driving faster than 71 mph
(115 km/h).
-
R
When driving briefly between 62 mph
(100 km/h) and 71 mph (115 km/h).
The vehicle is lowered to the normal level.
After selecting a different drive program
using the DYNAMIC SELECT switch.
The vehicle is adjusted to the height of the
active drive program.
Operation with a trailer or bicycle rack
If the electrical connection to the trailer or bicy‐
cle rack is established correctly:
R Up to approximately 12 mph (20 km/h): offroad levels +1, +2 and +3 can be selected
regardless of the drive program.
R Up to approximately 19 mph (30 km/h): offroad levels +1 and +2 can be selected
regardless of the drive program.
R From approximately 19 mph (30 km/h): the
vehicle is set to the normal level regardless
of the drive program.
Lowering the vehicle (vehicles with Off-road
package)
# Pull rocker switch 1.
R Off-road level +3: the vehicle is lowered
to off-road level +2. Two indicator lamps
2 light up continuously when the vehicle
has finished lowering.
R Off-road level +2: the vehicle is lowered
to off-road level +1. One indicator lamp
2 lights up continuously when the vehi‐
cle has finished lowering.
R Off-road level +1: the vehicle is lowered
to the normal level. No indicator lamp 2
lights up when the vehicle has finished
lowering.
Your selection is saved. The off-road level set
remains stored even after the ignition has been
switched off.
Setting Off-road Assist
Requirements:
R the vehicle is stationary
R the vehicle is set to off-road level 1 or 2
244 Driving and parking
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
the Off-road or Off-road Plus (only vehicles
with Off-road package) drive program has
been selected
the ignition is switched on
all doors and the hood are closed
the transmission is not engaged in position
j
there is no trailer coupled
the vehicle is outdoors
the detected lateral inclination of the vehicle
must not exceed approx. 15°
the system is within its operating tempera‐
ture
the on-board voltage is sufficiently high
Multimedia system:
4 © 5 Settings
5 Offroad Assistant
5
Assistance
Recovery mode
Recovery mode assists the driver when pulling
away on rough terrain, such as sand or snow.
# Select Recovery Mode.
Select Start.
Recovery mode is activated.
# Select Stop to stop recovery mode.
Recovery mode is automatically deactivated in
the following situations:
R you are actually traveling faster than 9 mph
(15 km/h)
R after a running time of 30 seconds
R it is detected that an object has hit the
underbody of the vehicle hard
R not all conditions are met
#
% Further information on recovery mode
(/ page 239).
Individual wheel control
Individual wheel control enables the vehicle level
to be set separately for each wheel.
# Select Individual Wheel Ctrl..
# Set the vehicle level for the desired wheel.
% You can also use the touch display to set the
level for two or more wheels at the same
time.
Select Reset to set all wheels to the default
setting.
Individual wheel control is automatically deacti‐
vated in the following situations:
R you are traveling faster than 9 mph
(15 km/h)
R it is detected that an object has hit the
underbody of the vehicle hard
R not all conditions are met
#
% Further information on individual wheel con‐
trol (/ page 240).
Parking Assist PARKTRONIC
Function of Parking Assist PARKTRONIC
Parking Assist PARKTRONIC is an electronic
parking assistance system with ultrasound. It
monitors the area around your vehicle using mul‐
tiple sensors on the front bumper and on the
rear bumper. Parking Assist PARKTRONIC shows
you the distance between your vehicle and a
detected obstacle visually and audibly.
Driving and parking 245
Parking Assist PARKTRONIC is only an aid. It is
not a substitute for your attention to the sur‐
roundings. The responsibility for safe maneuver‐
ing and parking remains with you. Make sure
that there are no persons, animals or objects in
the maneuvering area while maneuvering and
parking in/exiting parking spaces.
In the standard setting, an intermittent warning
tone sounds from a distance of approximately
1.0 ft (0.3 m) to an obstacle in front and approx‐
imately 3.3 ft (1.0 m) to an obstacle behind. A
continuous warning tone sounds from a distance
of approximately 0.7 ft (0.2 m). Using the Warn
Early All Around setting in the multimedia sys‐
tem, the warning tones for front and side impact
protection can be set to sound at a greater dis‐
tance of approximately 3.3 ft (1.0 m) in front and
2.0 ft (0.6 m) on the sides (/ page 249).
% The Warn Early All Around setting is always
active at the rear of the vehicle.
If Parking Assist PARKTRONIC is deactivated,
Active Parking Assist is unavailable.
Parking Assist PARKTRONIC display in the
multimedia system
Vehicles with Active Parking Assist and a sur‐
round view camera
Vehicles with Active Parking Assist without a
surround view camera
If Active Parking Assist is deactivated and an
obstacle is detected in the path of the vehicle, a
pop-up window for Parking Assist PARKTRONIC
1 appears in the multimedia system at speeds
below 6 mph (10 km/h).
The color of the individual segments of the warn‐
ing display is based on the distance to the detec‐
ted obstacle:
R Yellow segments: obstacles at a distance
between approx. 2.0 ft (0.6 m) and 3.3 ft
(1.0 m)
246 Driving and parking
R
R
Orange segments: obstacles at a distance
between approx. 1.0 ft (0.3 m) and 2.0 ft
(0.6 m)
Red segments: obstacles at a very short
distance of approx. 1.0 ft (0.3 m) or less
Display of Parking Assist PARKTRONIC in the
Head-up Display
Optionally, obstacles detected by Parking Assist
PARKTRONIC from a distance of approximately
3.3 ft (1.0 m) in front 2 and 2.0 ft (0.6 m) on
the sides 3 can also be displayed in the Headup Display.
System limits
Parking Assist PARKTRONIC does not necessa‐
rily take into account the following obstacles:
R Obstacles below the detection range, e.g.
persons, animals or objects.
R Obstacles above the detection range, e.g.
overhanging loads, overhangs or loading
ramps of trucks.
The sensors must be free of dirt, ice and slush.
Otherwise, they may not function correctly.
Clean the sensors regularly, especially after driv‐
ing off-road, taking care not to scratch or dam‐
age them.
Vehicles with trailer hitch: Parking Assist
PARKTRONIC is deactivated for the rear zone
when you establish an electrical connection
between your vehicle and a trailer.
Problems with Parking Assist PARKTRONIC
Example: vehicles with surround view camera
When rear segments 1 or all-round segments
2 light up red and the é symbol appears in
the multifunction display, Parking Assist
PARKTRONIC may have been deactivated due to
signal interference. Start the vehicle again and
check if Parking Assist PARKTRONIC is working
at a different location.
Driving and parking 247
If a warning tone also sounds for approximately
two seconds every time the vehicle is started, it
may be due to one of the following causes:
R The sensors are dirty: clean the sensors
and observe the notes on care of vehicle
parts (/ page 332).
R Parking Assist PARKTRONIC has been
deactivated due to a malfunction: restart
the vehicle. If the problem persists, consult a
qualified specialist workshop.
Function of the passive side impact protec‐
tion
Passive side impact protection is an additional
Parking Assist PARKTRONIC function which
warns the driver about obstacles at the side of
the vehicle. A warning is issued when obstacles
are detected between the front and rear detec‐
tion range. In order for an object on the side to
be detected, the sensors in the front and rear
bumper must first detect the object while you
are driving past it.
During the parking procedure or when maneu‐
vering, objects are detected as the vehicle drives
past. If you steer in the direction of a detected
obstacle and there is a risk of a lateral collision,
a warning is issued and the segments light up in
color in the display.
The segment color changes depending on the
distance to the detected obstacle:
R Yellow: approximately 1.0 - 2.0 ft
(30 - 60 cm)
R Red: less than approximately 1.0 ft (30 cm)
In order for lateral front or rear segments to be
displayed, the vehicle must first travel a distance
of at least half of the vehicle length. Once the
vehicle has traveled the length of the vehicle, all
of the lateral front and rear segments can be dis‐
played.
Parking Assist PARKTRONIC display: vehicles
without a surround view camera
1 Operational front and rear
2 Operational front, rear and sides
3 Obstacle detected at the front right (yellow)
and rear (red)
248 Driving and parking
System limits
The system limits for Parking Assist
PARKTRONIC apply to passive side impact pro‐
tection.
The following objects are not detected, for exam‐
ple:
R Pedestrians who approach the vehicle from
the side
R Objects placed next to the vehicle
Parking Assist PARKTRONIC display: vehicles
with a surround view camera
1 Operational front and rear
2 Operational front, rear and sides
3 Obstacles detected at the front right (red)
Saved obstacles on the sides are deleted in the
following situations, for example:
R You park the vehicle and switch off the igni‐
tion.
R You open the doors.
After the engine is restarted, obstacles on the
sides must be detected again before a new
warning can be issued.
Activating/deactivating Parking Assist
PARKTRONIC
* NOTE Risk of an accident from objects
at close range
Parking Assist PARKTRONIC may not detect
certain objects at close range.
# When parking or maneuvering the vehi‐
cle, pay particular attention to any
objects which are above or below the
sensors, e.g. flower pots or drawbars.
The vehicle or other objects could oth‐
erwise be damaged.
Requirements:
R The camera menu is open.
R Or: Active Parking Assist is active.
R Or: the PARKTRONIC pop-up window
appears.
% Make sure that there are no persons, ani‐
mals or objects in the maneuvering area
while maneuvering and parking in/exiting
parking spaces.
# Tap é in the media display.
% If the é symbol is shown in the multifunc‐
tion display, Parking Assist PARKTRONIC is
not active. Parking Assist PARKTRONIC is
automatically activated when the vehicle is
started.
Alternatively, Parking Assist PARKTRONIC can be
activated or deactivated in the quick access
menu.
Driving and parking 249
Adjusting the warning tones of Parking
Assist PARKTRONIC
Multimedia system:
4 © 5 Settings 5 Assistance
5 Camera & Parking
Adjusting the volume of the warning tones
# Select Warning Tone Volume.
# Set a value.
Adjusting the pitch of the warning tones
# Select Warning Tone Pitch.
# Set a value.
Specifying the starting point for the warning
tones
You can specify whether the Parking Assist
PARKTRONIC warning tones should commence
when the vehicle is further away from an obsta‐
cle.
# Select Warn Early All Around.
# Activate or deactivate the function.
Activating/deactivating audio fadeout
You can specify whether the volume of a media
source in the multimedia system is to be
reduced when Parking Assist PARKTRONIC
sounds a warning tone.
# Select Audio Fadeout During Warning Tones.
# Activate or deactivate the function.
Reversing camera
Function of the rear view camera
When you engage reverse gear, the image from
the rear view camera is shown in the media dis‐
play. Dynamic guide lines show the path the
vehicle will take with the current steering angle.
This helps you to orient yourself and to avoid
obstacles when backing up.
The rear view camera is only an aid. It is not a
substitute for your attention to the surroundings.
The responsibility for safe maneuvering and
parking remains with you. Make sure that there
are no persons, animals or objects etc., in the
maneuvering area while maneuvering and park‐
ing.
% You can open the cover of the rear view cam‐
era manually (/ page 255).
The guide lines in the media display show the
distances to your vehicle. The distances dis‐
played only apply to road level.
Depending on the vehicle equipment, you can
select from the following views:
R Normal view
R Wide-angle view
R Trailer view
The area behind the vehicle is displayed as a
mirror image, as in the inside rearview mirror.
Vehicles without Active Parking Assist
The following camera views are available in the
multimedia system:
250 Driving and parking
2 Red guide line at a distance of approximately
1.0 in (0.3 m) from the ball head of the
trailer hitch
3 Ball head of the trailer hitch
Vehicles with Active Parking Assist
The following camera views are available in the
multimedia system:
Normal view
1 Yellow guide line, vehicle width (driven sur‐
2
3
4
5
face) depending on the current steering
angle (dynamic)
Yellow guide line at a distance of approx‐
imately 3.3 ft (1.0 m) from the rear area
Yellow lanes marking the course the tires
will take with the current steering angle
(dynamic)
Bumper
Red guide line at a distance of approximately
1.0 in (0.3 m) from the rear area
Wide-angle view
Normal view
1 Yellow lanes marking the course the tires
Trailer view (vehicles with a trailer hitch)
1 Yellow guide line, locating aid
will take with the current steering angle
(dynamic)
Driving and parking 251
2 Red guide line at a distance of approximately
2 Yellow guide line, vehicle width (driven sur‐
3
4
5
6
face) depending on the current steering
angle (dynamic)
Red guide line at a distance of approximately
1.0 in (0.3 m) from the rear area
Yellow warning indicator of Parking Assist
PARKTRONIC: obstacles at a distance
between approximately 2.0 ft (0.6 m) and
3.3 ft (1.0 m)
Red warning display of Parking Assist
PARKTRONIC: obstacles are very close
(approximately 1.0 ft (0.3 m) or less)
Orange warning display of Parking Assist
PARKTRONIC: obstacles are a medium dis‐
tance away (between approximately 1.0 ft
(0.3 m) and 2.0 ft (0.6 m))
1.0 in (0.3 m) from the ball head of the
trailer hitch
3 Ball head of the trailer hitch
System failure
If the rear view camera is not operational, the
following display appears in the multimedia sys‐
tem.
Wide-angle view
Trailer view (vehicles with a trailer hitch)
1 Yellow guide line, locating aid
System limits
The rear view camera will not function or will
only partially function in the following situations:
R The tailgate is open.
R There is heavy rain, snow or fog.
R The ambient light conditions are poor, e.g. at
night.
R Cameras, or vehicle components in which
the cameras are installed, are damaged, dirty
252 Driving and parking
or covered. Observe the information on vehi‐
cle sensors and cameras (/ page 201).
% Do not use the rear view camera in these
types of situation. You could otherwise injure
others or collide with objects when parking
the vehicle.
For technical reasons, the standard height of the
vehicle may be altered if the vehicle is carrying a
heavy load and can result in inaccuracies in the
guide lines and in the display of the generated
images.
% The contrast of the display may be impaired
by direct sunlight or by other light sources,
e.g. when driving out of a garage. In this
case, pay particular attention.
% Have the display repaired or replaced if, for
example, pixel errors considerably restrict its
use.
360° camera
Function of the surround view camera
The surround view camera is a system that con‐
sists of four cameras. The cameras cover the
immediate vehicle surroundings. The system
assists you, e.g. when parking or at exits with
reduced visibility.
The views of the surround view camera are
always available when driving forwards up to a
speed of approx. 10 mph (16 km/h) and when
backing up.
The surround view camera is only an aid and
may show a distorted view of obstacles, show
them incorrectly or not show them at all. It is not
a substitute for your attention to the surround‐
ings. The responsibility for safe maneuvering and
parking remains with you. Make sure that there
are no persons, animals or objects etc., in the
maneuvering area while maneuvering and park‐
ing.
The system evaluates images from the following
cameras:
R Rear view camera
R Front camera
R Two side cameras in the outside mirrors
% You can open the cover of the rear view cam‐
era manually (/ page 255).
Views of the surround view camera
You can select from different views:
1 Wide-angle view, front
2 Top view with image from the front camera
3 Top view with images from the side cameras
in the outside mirrors
4 Wide-angle view, rear
5 Top view with image from the rear view cam‐
era
6 Top view with trailer view (vehicles with a
trailer hitch)
Driving and parking 253
Top view
R
R
Orange segments: obstacles at a distance
between approx. 1.0 ft (0.3 m) and 2.0 ft
(0.6 m)
Red segments: obstacles at a very short
distance of approx. 1.0 ft (0.3 m) or less
Guide lines
When Parking Assist PARKTRONIC is operational
and no object is detected, the segments of the
warning display are shown in gray.
1 Lane indicating the route the vehicle will
1 Yellow lane marking the course the tires will
The color of the individual segments of warning
display 2 is based on the distance to the detec‐
ted obstacle:
R Yellow segments: obstacles at a distance
between approx. 2.0 ft (0.6 m) and 3.3 ft
(1.0 m)
% When Active Parking Assist is active, lane
markings 1 are displayed in green.
take at the current steering wheel angle
2 Warning display of Parking Assist
PARKTRONIC
3 Your vehicle from above
take at the current steering wheel angle
(dynamic)
2 Yellow guide line, vehicle width (driven sur‐
face) depending on the current steering
wheel angle (dynamic)
3 Red guide line at a distance of approximately
1.0 in (0.3 m) from the rear area
4 Mark at a distance of approx. 3.3 ft (1.0 m)
254 Driving and parking
The guide lines in the media display show
the distances to your vehicle. The distances
apply to road level.
In trailer mode, the guide lines are shown at
the level of the trailer hitch.
Trailer view (vehicles with a trailer hitch)
If you select trailer view and no trailer is coupled
to the vehicle, the following display appears:
When the electrical connection is established
between the vehicle and the trailer, the display
changes to the side camera view.
This view supports maneuvering procedures with
a trailer.
Side view of the mirror cameras
The sides of the vehicle can be seen in this view.
1 Yellow guide line, locating aid
2 Red guide line at a distance of approximately
1.0 in (0.3 m) from the ball head of the
trailer hitch
3 Ball head of the trailer hitch
1 Guide line of external vehicle dimensions
with outside mirrors folded out
2 Marker of the wheel contact points
System failure
If the system is not ready for operation, the fol‐
lowing message appears in the media display:
Driving and parking 255
System limits
The surround view camera will not function or
will only partially function in the following situa‐
tions:
R The doors are open.
R The outside mirrors are folded in.
R The tailgate is open.
R There is heavy rain, snow or fog.
R The ambient light conditions are poor, e.g. at
night.
R Cameras, or vehicle components in which
the cameras are installed, are damaged, dirty
or covered. Observe the information on vehi‐
cle sensors and cameras (/ page 201).
% Do not use the surround view camera under
such circumstances. You could otherwise
injure others or collide with objects when
parking the vehicle.
For technical reasons, the standard height of the
vehicle may be altered if the vehicle is carrying a
heavy load and can result in inaccuracies in the
guide lines and in the display of the generated
images.
% The contrast of the display may be impaired
by abrupt, direct sunlight or by other light
sources, e.g. when driving out of a garage. In
this case, pay particular attention.
% Have the display repaired or replaced if, for
example, pixel errors considerably restrict its
use.
See the notes on cleaning the surround view
camera (/ page 332).
Opening the camera cover of the rear view
camera
Multimedia system:
4 © 5 Settings 5 Assistance
5 Camera & Parking
# Select Open Camera Cover.
% The camera cover closes automatically after
some time or after an ignition cycle.
Selecting a view for the surround view cam‐
era
# Shift to reverse gear.
# Select the desired view in the multimedia
system (/ page 252).
# If, after shifting to reverse gear, the image of
the rear view camera is not shown: switch off
the ignition, press and hold the c button,
switch on the ignition and engage reverse
gear again.
Active Parking Assist
Function of Active Parking Assist
Active Parking Assist is an electronic parking
assistance system that automatically searches
for and measures parking spaces on both sides
of the vehicle when traveling forwards up to
approx. 22 mph (35 km/h).
Active Parking Assist provides assistance when
changing gear, accelerating, braking and steer‐
ing the vehicle.
If all requirements are met, the Ç display
appears in the multifunction display. The system
then independently locates and measures paral‐
256 Driving and parking
lel and perpendicular parking spaces on both
sides of the vehicle.
When Active Parking Assist has detected parking
spaces, the È display appears in the multi‐
function display. The arrows show on which side
of the road detected parking spaces are located.
They are then shown in the media display. The
parking space and, if necessary, the parking
direction can be selected as desired. Active
Parking Assist calculates a suitable vehicle path,
switches on the turn signal indicator and assists
you in parking and exiting the parking space.
Active Parking Assist is only an aid. It is not a
substitute for your attention to the surroundings.
The responsibility for safe maneuvering and
parking remains with you. Make sure that no
persons, animals or objects etc. are in the
maneuvering range.
If one of the following actions is carried out,
Active Parking Assist is canceled:
R Parking Assist PARKTRONIC is deactivated.
R You begin steering.
R You apply the parking brake.
R
R
R
You engage transmission position j.
ESP® intervenes.
You open the doors or the tailgate while driv‐
ing.
System limits
Objects located above or below the detection
range of the sensors, e.g. overhanging loads, tail
sections or loading ramps of goods vehicles, or
the borders of parking spaces, are not detected
during measurement of the parking space. These
are also then not taken into account when calcu‐
lating the parking procedure. In some circum‐
stances, Active Parking Assist may therefore
guide you into the parking space incorrectly.
& WARNING Risk of accident due to
objects located above or below the
detection range of Active Parking Assist
If there are objects above or below the
detection range, the following situations may
arise:
R Active Parking Assist may steer too early.
R
The vehicle may not stop in front of these
objects.
This could cause a collision.
In these situations, do not use Active
Parking Assist.
#
Extreme environmental conditions, such as
snowfall or heavy rain, may lead to a parking
space being measured inaccurately. Parking
spaces that are partially occupied by trailer
drawbars might not be identified as such or be
measured incorrectly. Only use Active Parking
Assist on level, high-grip ground.
Do not use Active Parking Assist in the following
situations:
R In extreme weather conditions such as ice,
packed snow or in heavy rain.
R When transporting a load that protrudes
beyond the vehicle.
R If the parking space is on a steep downhill or
uphill gradient.
R When snow chains are installed.
R When a trailer or bicycle rack is attached.
Driving and parking 257
R
R
R
R
Directly after a tire change or when spare
tires are installed.
If the tire pressure is too low or too high.
If the suspension is out of alignment, e.g.
after bottoming out on a curb.
On steep inclines of more than approx. 15%.
Parking with Active Parking Assist
Active Parking Assist may also display parking
spaces that are not suitable for parking, such as,
e.g.:
R Parking spaces where parking is prohibited.
R Parking spaces on unsuitable surfaces.
#
Press button 1.
The media display shows the view of Active Park‐
ing Assist. Area 2 displays detected parking
spaces 4 and vehicle path 3.
% Vehicle path 3 shown on the media display
may differ from the actual vehicle path.
# If a parking space is displayed: stop the vehi‐
cle.
# Select desired parking space 4 and con‐
firm.
# If necessary, select the parking direction: for‐
wards or reverse, and confirm.
Vehicle path 3 is shown, depending on
selected parking space 4 and the parking
direction.
258 Driving and parking
% The turn signal indicator is switched on auto‐
matically when the parking procedure
begins.
You are responsible for selecting the turn signal
indicator in accordance with the traffic condi‐
tions. If necessary, select the turn signal indica‐
tor accordingly.
& WARNING Risk of accident due to vehi‐
cle swinging out while parking or pulling
out of a parking space
While parking or exiting a parking space, the
vehicle swings out and can drive onto areas
of the oncoming lane.
This could cause you to collide with objects
or other road users.
# Pay attention to objects and other road
users.
# Where necessary, stop the vehicle or
cancel the parking procedure with
Active Parking Assist.
#
If, for example, the Please Engage Reverse
Gear message appears in the media display:
select the corresponding transmission posi‐
tion.
The vehicle drives into the selected parking
space.
% During the parking procedure with Active
Parking Assist, the lane markings are dis‐
played in green in the camera image.
On completion of the parking procedure, the
Ø Parking Assist Finished, Take Control of
Vehicle display message appears. Further
maneuvering may still be necessary.
# After completion of the parking procedure,
safeguard the vehicle against rolling away.
When required by legal requirements or local
conditions: turn the wheels towards the curb.
% You can stop the vehicle and change the
transmission position during the parking pro‐
cedure. The system then calculates a new
vehicle path. If no new vehicle path is availa‐
ble, the system can change the transmission
position again or cancel the parking proce‐
dure.
Exiting a parking space with Active Parking
Assist
Requirements:
R The vehicle has been parked with Active
Parking Assist.
Please note that you are responsible for the vehi‐
cle and surroundings during the entire parking
procedure.
# Start the vehicle.
Driving and parking 259
& WARNING Risk of accident due to vehi‐
cle swinging out while parking or pulling
out of a parking space
#
#
Press button 1.
The media display shows the view of Active
Parking Assist.
If the vehicle has been parked perpendicular
to the direction of travel: in area 2, select
direction of travel 3 Left or Right.
% The vehicle path shown on the media display
may differ from the actual vehicle path.
# Confirm direction of exit 3 to drive out of
the parking space.
% The turn signal indicator is switched on auto‐
matically when the exiting procedure begins.
You are responsible for selecting the turn signal
indicator in accordance with the traffic condi‐
tions. If necessary, select the turn signal indica‐
tor accordingly.
While parking or exiting a parking space, the
vehicle swings out and can drive onto areas
of the oncoming lane.
This could cause you to collide with objects
or other road users.
# Pay attention to objects and other road
users.
# Where necessary, stop the vehicle or
cancel the parking procedure with
Active Parking Assist.
#
If, for example, the Please Engage Forward
Gear message appears in the media display:
select the corresponding transmission posi‐
tion.
The vehicle moves out of the parking space.
The turn signal indicator is switched off auto‐
matically.
After the parking space has been exited, a warn‐
ing tone and the Ø Parking Assist Finished,
260 Driving and parking
Take Control of Vehicle message prompt you to
take control of the vehicle.
The vehicle is not automatically braked and can
roll away. You have to accelerate, brake, steer
and change gear yourself again.
Function of Drive Away Assist
Drive Away Assist can reduce the severity of an
impact when pulling away. If an obstacle is
detected in the direction of travel, the vehicle's
speed is briefly reduced to approx. 1 mph
(2 km/h). If a critical situation is detected, the
É symbol appears in the media display.
% You can cancel an intervention by Drive
Away Assist at any time by pressing the
é button.
& WARNING Risk of accident caused by
limited detection performance of Drive
Away Assist
Drive Away Assist cannot always clearly iden‐
tify objects and traffic situations.
#
#
Always pay careful attention to the traf‐
fic situation; do not rely on Drive Away
Assist alone.
Be prepared to brake or swerve as nec‐
essary, provided the traffic situation
permits and that it is safe to take eva‐
sive action.
Drive Away Assist is only an aid. It is not a sub‐
stitute for your attention to the surroundings.
The responsibility for safe maneuvering and
parking remains with you. Make sure that no
persons, animals or objects etc. are in the
maneuvering range.
A risk of a collision may arise in the following sit‐
uations, for example:
R If the driver mixes up the accelerator and
brake pedals.
R If an incorrect transmission position is
engaged.
Drive Away Assist is active under the following
conditions:
R If Parking Assist PARKTRONIC is activated.
R
R
R
If you shift the transmission position to k or
h when the vehicle is stationary.
If the detected obstacle is less than approx.
3.3 ft (1.0 m) away.
If the maneuvering assistant function is acti‐
vated in the multimedia system.
System limits
The performance of Drive Away Assist is limited
on inclines.
When driving with a trailer, Drive Away Assist is
not available.
% Also observe the system limits of Parking
Assist PARKTRONIC (/ page 244).
Function of Cross Traffic Alert
% Also observe the instructions on Blind Spot
Assist and Active Blind Spot Assist
(/ page 264).
Vehicles with Blind Spot Assist or Active
Blind Spot Assist: Cross Traffic Alert can warn
drivers of any crossing traffic when backing up
and maneuvering out of a parking space. The
radar sensors in the bumper also monitor the
area adjacent to the vehicle. If a critical situation
Driving and parking 261
is detected, the L symbol appears in the
media display. If the driver does not respond to
the warning, the vehicle's brakes can be applied
automatically.
If the radar sensors are obstructed by vehicles
or other objects, detection is not possible.
Cross Traffic Alert is active under the following
conditions:
R If the vehicle is backing up at walking pace.
R If the maneuvering assistant function is acti‐
vated in the multimedia system.
System limits
Cross Traffic Alert is not available on inclines.
Cross Traffic Alert is not available when driving
with a trailer.
Activating/deactivating maneuvering assis‐
tance
Multimedia system:
4 © 5 Settings 5 Assistance
5 Camera & Parking
# Switch Maneuvering Assistance on or off.
% Maneuvering assistance must be active for
the function of Drive Away Assist
(/ page 260).
ATTENTION ASSIST
Function of ATTENTION ASSIST
ATTENTION ASSIST assists you on long, monoto‐
nous journeys, e.g. on highways and trunk roads.
If ATTENTION ASSIST detects indicators of fati‐
gue or increasing lapses in concentration on the
part of the driver, it suggests taking a break.
ATTENTION ASSIST is only an aid. It cannot
always detect fatigue or lapses in concentration
in time. The system is not a substitute for a wellrested and attentive driver. On long journeys,
take regular breaks in good time that allow for
adequate recuperation.
You can choose between two settings:
R Standard: normal system sensitivity.
R Sensitive: higher system sensitivity. The
driver is warned earlier and the attention
level detected by ATTENTION ASSIST is adap‐
ted accordingly.
If drowsiness or increasing lapses in concentra‐
tion are detected, the ATTENTION ASSIST: Take
a Break! warning appears in the Instrument Dis‐
play. You can acknowledge the message and
take a break where necessary. If you do not take
a break and ATTENTION ASSIST continues to
detect increasing lapses in concentration, you
will be warned again after a minimum of
15 minutes.
You can have the following status information for
ATTENTION ASSIST displayed in the assistance
menu of the on-board computer:
R The length of the journey since the last
break.
262 Driving and parking
R
The attention level determined by ATTENTION
ASSIST:
the fuller the circle, the higher the atten‐
tional level determined
as your attention wanes, the circle in the
center of the display becomes smaller
If ATTENTION ASSIST is unable to calculate the
attention level and cannot issue a warning, the
System Suspended message appears.
If a warning is given in the Instrument Display,
the multimedia system offers to search for a rest
area. You can select a rest area and start naviga‐
tion to this rest area. This function can be activa‐
ted and deactivated in the multimedia system.
If ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated, the Û
symbol appears in the assistance graphic in the
Instrument Display when the engine is running.
ATTENTION ASSIST is activated automatically
when the engine is re-started. The last selected
sensitivity level remains stored.
System limits
ATTENTION ASSIST is active in the 37 mph
(60 km/h) to 124 mph (200 km/h) speed range.
The functionality of ATTENTION ASSIST is
restricted, and warnings may be delayed or not
occur at all in the following situations:
R If you have been driving for less than approx‐
imately 30 minutes.
R If the road condition is poor (uneven road
surface or potholes).
R If there is a strong side wind.
R If you adopt a sporty driving style (high cor‐
nering speeds or high rates of acceleration).
R If the Steering Assist function of Active Dis‐
tance Assist DISTRONIC is active.
R If the time has been set incorrectly.
R If you change lanes and vary your speed fre‐
quently In active driving situations.
The ATTENTION ASSIST tiredness or alertness
assessment is deleted and restarted when con‐
tinuing the journey in the following situations:
R If you switch off the engine.
R If you unfasten your seat belt and open the
driver's door (e.g. changing drivers or taking
a break).
Setting ATTENTION ASSIST
Multimedia system:
4 © 5 Settings 5 Assistance
5 Attention Assist
Setting options
Select Standard, Sensitive or Off.
#
Suggesting a rest area
Select Suggest Rest Area.
# Activate or deactivate the function.
If ATTENTION ASSIST detects fatigue or
increasing lack of attention, it suggests a
rest area in the vicinity.
# Select the suggested rest area.
You are guided to the selected rest area.
#
Traffic Sign Assist
Function of Traffic Sign Assist
Traffic Sign Assist detects traffic signs with the
multifunction camera (/ page 201). It assists
you by displaying detected speed limits and
overtaking restrictions in the instrument cluster
Driving and parking 263
and optionally in the Head-up Display or central
display.
Observe the notes on driving systems and your
responsibility; you may otherwise fail to recog‐
nize dangers (/ page 201).
Since Traffic Sign Assist also uses the data
stored in the navigation system, it can update
the display in the following situations without
detecting traffic signs:
R When the vehicle changes roads, e.g. free‐
way entry or exit road.
R When a village or city boundary which is
stored in the digital map is passed.
can specify whether the warning is to be just a
visual warning or an acoustic one as well.
The camera also detects traffic signs with a
restriction indicated by an additional sign (e.g.
when wet).
Instrument Display in the Widescreen Cockpit
1 Permissible speed
2 Permissible speed when there is a restriction
3 Additional sign with restriction
Warning when the maximum permissible
speed is exceeded
The system can warn you if you unintentionally
exceed the maximum permissible speed. To do
this, you can specify in the multimedia system
by how much the maximum permissible speed
can be exceeded before a warning is issued. You
Display in the Instrument Display
% Vehicles with a standard Instrument Dis‐
play: a + symbol next to a traffic sign in the
Instrument Display indicates that additional
traffic signs have been detected. These can
also be displayed in the media display and
optionally in the Head-up Display.
If Traffic Sign Assist cannot determine the cur‐
rent maximum permissible speed (e.g. due to
missing signs), the following display appears in
the Instrument Display:
This is displayed continuously if the vehicle is in
a country where Traffic Sign Assist is not sup‐
ported. Traffic Sign Assist is not available in all
countries.
% Also observe the information on display mes‐
sages in Traffic Sign Assist (/ page 408).
System limits
The system may be impaired or may not function
in the following situations:
R If there is poor visibility, e.g. due to insuffi‐
cient illumination of the road, if there are
highly variable shade conditions or in rain,
snow, fog or heavy spray.
R If there is glare, e.g. from oncoming traffic,
direct sunlight or reflections.
264 Driving and parking
R
R
R
R
R
If the windshield in the area of the multifunc‐
tion camera is dirty, or if the camera is fog‐
ged up, damaged or covered.
If the traffic signs are hard to detect, e.g. due
to dirt or snow, because they are covered, or
due to insufficient lighting.
If the information in the navigation system's
digital map is incorrect or out-of-date.
If the signs are ambiguous, e.g. traffic signs
on construction sites or in adjacent lanes.
If you turn sharply, when passing traffic signs
outside the camera's field of vision.
Setting Traffic Sign Assist
Requirements:
R Only vehicles with Driving Assistance
Package:
Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC must be
activated for the automatic adoption of
speed limits.
Multimedia system:
4 © 5 Settings
5 Traffic Sign Assist
#
5
Assistance
Activating or deactivating automatic adop‐
tion of speed limits (only vehicles with Driv‐
ing Assistance Package)
# Select Limit Adoption.
# Activate or deactivate the function.
The speed limits detected by Traffic Sign
Assist are automatically adopted by Active
Distance Assist DISTRONIC.
% If one of the following systems is activated,
the detected speed can be manually adopted
as the speed limit:
R Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC
R Cruise control
R Variable limiter
Further information (/ page 218).
Displaying detected traffic signs in the
media display
# Select Display in Central Display.
Activate or deactivate the function.
Adjusting the type of warning
Select Visual & Audible, Visual or Off.
#
Adjusting the warning threshold
This value determines the speed at which a
warning is issued when exceeded.
# Select Warning Threshold.
# Set the desired speed.
Blind Spot Assist and Active Blind Spot
Assist with exit warning
Function of Blind Spot Assist and Active
Blind Spot Assist with exit warning
Blind Spot Assist and Active Blind Spot Assist
use two lateral, rear-facing radar sensors to
monitor the area up to 130 ft (40 m) behind and
10 ft (3 m) next to your vehicle.
If a vehicle is detected at speeds above approx‐
imately 8 mph (12 km/h) and this vehicle subse‐
quently enters the monitoring range directly next
to your vehicle, the warning lamp in the outside
mirror lights up red.
Driving and parking 265
Permanent status display in the instrument clus‐
ter:
R ¸ (gray): system is activated but inopera‐
tive
R ¸ (green): system is activated and opera‐
tional
If a vehicle is detected close to your vehicle and
you switch on the turn signal indicator in the cor‐
responding direction, a double warning tone
sounds and the red warning lamp in the outside
mirror flashes. If the turn signal indicator
remains switched on, all other detected vehicles
are indicated only by the flashing of the red
warning lamp.
If you overtake a vehicle quickly, no warning is
given.
& WARNING Risk of accident despite Blind
Spot Assist
Blind Spot Assist does not react to vehicles
approaching and overtaking you at a greatly
different speed.
Blind Spot Assist cannot warn drivers in this
situation.
# Always pay careful attention to the traf‐
fic situation and maintain a safe dis‐
tance at the side of the vehicle.
Observe the notes on driving systems and your
responsibility; you may otherwise fail to recog‐
nize dangers (/ page 201).
Exit warning
The exit warning is an additional function of
Blind Spot Assist and can warn vehicle occu‐
pants about approaching vehicles when leaving
the vehicle when stationary.
& WARNING Risk of accident despite exit
warning
The exit warning neither reacts to stationary
objects nor to vehicles approaching you at a
greatly differing speed.
The exit warning cannot warn drivers in these
situations.
#
Always pay particular attention to the
traffic situation when opening the doors
and make sure there is sufficient clear‐
ance.
If there is a vehicle in the monitoring range, this
is indicated in the outside mirror. If a vehicle
occupant opens the door on the side with the
warning, a warning tone sounds and the warning
lamp in the outside mirror starts to flash.
This additional function is only available when
Blind Spot Assist is active. When the exit warn‐
ing is activated, it can warn vehicle occupants
for up to three minutes after switching the igni‐
tion off. The exit warning is no longer available
once the warning lamp in the outside mirror
flashes three times.
The exit warning is only an aid and not a substi‐
tute for the attention of vehicle occupants. The
responsibility for opening and closing the doors
and for leaving the vehicle remains with the vehi‐
cle occupants.
266 Driving and parking
System limits
Blind Spot Assist and Active Blind Spot Assist
may be limited in the following situations:
R if there is dirt on the sensors or the sensors
are obscured
R in poor visibility, e.g. due to fog, heavy rain or
snow
R if there are narrow vehicles, e.g. bicycles or
motorbikes
R if the road has very wide or narrow lanes
R if vehicles are not driving in the middle of
their lane
Warnings may be issued in error when driving
close to crash barriers or similar continuous lane
borders. Always make sure that there is suffi‐
cient distance to the side for other traffic or
obstacles.
Warnings may be interrupted when driving along‐
side long vehicles, for example trucks, for a pro‐
longed time.
Blind Spot Assist is not operational when reverse
gear is engaged.
Blind Spot Assist and the exit warning are not
operational when a trailer is coupled to the vehi‐
cle and the electrical connection has been cor‐
rectly established.
The exit warning may be limited in the following
situations:
R when the sensors are covered by adjacent
vehicles in narrow parking spaces
R when people approach the vehicle
R in the event of stationary or slowly moving
objects
& WARNING Risk of accident despite
brake application of Active Blind Spot
Assist
A course-correcting brake application cannot
always prevent a collision.
# Always steer, brake or accelerate your‐
self, especially if Active Blind Spot
Assist warns you or makes a coursecorrecting brake application.
# Always maintain a safe distance at the
sides.
Function of brake application (Active Blind
Spot Assist)
If Active Blind Spot Assist detects a risk of a side
impact in the monitoring range, a course-cor‐
recting brake application is carried out. This is
designed to help you avoid a collision.
The course-correcting brake application is availa‐
ble in the speed range between approximately
20 mph (30 km/h) and 125 mph (200 km/h).
If a course-correcting brake application occurs,
the red warning lamp flashes in the outside mir‐
Driving and parking 267
ror and a warning tone sounds. In addition, a dis‐
play 1 indicating the danger of a side collision
appears in the multifunction display.
In rare cases, the system may make an inappro‐
priate brake application. This brake application
may be interrupted at any time if you steer
slightly in the opposite direction or accelerate.
System limits
Note the system limitations of Active Blind Spot
Assist; you may otherwise not recognize the dan‐
gers (/ page 264).
Either a course-correcting brake application
appropriate to the driving situation, or none at
all, may occur in the following situations:
R Vehicles or obstacles, e.g. crash barriers, are
located on both sides of your vehicle.
R A vehicle approaches too closely on the side.
R You have adopted a sporty driving style with
high cornering speeds.
R You brake or accelerate significantly.
R A driving safety system intervenes, e.g. ESP®
or Active Brake Assist.
R
R
R
ESP® is deactivated.
A loss of tire pressure or a faulty tire is
detected.
You are driving with a trailer and the electri‐
cal connection to the trailer hitch has been
correctly established.
Activating/deactivating Blind Spot Assist or
Active Blind Spot Assist
Multimedia system:
4 © 5 Settings 5 Assistance
# Activate or deactivate Blind Spot Assist.
or
# Activate or deactivate Act. Blind Spot Assist.
Active Lane Keeping Assist
Function of Active Lane Keeping Assist
Active Lane Keeping Assist monitors the area in
front of your vehicle by means of the multifunc‐
tion camera (/ page 201). It serves to protect
you against unintentionally leaving your lane.
You will be warned by vibration pulses in the
steering wheel and guided by a course-correct‐
ing brake application back into your lane.
Active Lane Keeping Assist is available in the
speed range between 37 mph (60 km/h) and
124 mph (200 km/h).
Active Lane Keeping Assist can neither reduce
the risk of an accident if you fail to adapt your
driving style nor override the laws of physics. It
cannot take into account road, weather or traffic
conditions. Active Lane Keeping Assist is only an
aid. You are responsible for maintaining a safe
distance to the vehicle in front, for vehicle
speed, for braking in good time and for staying
in lane.
The status of Active Lane Keeping Assist is dis‐
played in the on-board computer:
R Ã (green): Active Lane Keeping Assist is
active and operating.
R Ã (gray): Active Lane Keeping Assist is
active but not operating.
R ·: Active Lane Keeping Assist is deactiva‐
ted or there is a malfunction.
268 Driving and parking
R
If a lane-correcting brake application occurs, dis‐
play 1 appears in the multifunction display.
The system does not intervene if you activate
the turn signal indicator. If the system detects an
obstacle, such as another vehicle in the adjacent
lane, it will intervene regardless of the turn sig‐
nal indicator.
If you leave the lane without using the turn sig‐
nal indicator but an obstacle is detected in your
lane, the system will not intervene.
You are warned by vibrations in the steering
wheel in the following circumstances:
R Active Lane Keeping Assist detects a lane
marking.
A front wheel drives over this lane marking.
Conditions for a course-correcting brake
application (vehicles without Driving Assis‐
tance Package)
Lane markings were detected on both sides of
the lane. The front wheel drives over a continu‐
ous lane marking.
% A brake application may be interrupted at
any time if you steer slightly in the opposite
direction.
Conditions for a course-correcting brake
application (vehicles with Driving Assistance
Package)
R A continuous lane marking was detected and
driven over with the front wheel.
R A lane marking and an approaching vehicle,
an overtaking vehicle or vehicles driving par‐
allel to your vehicle were detected in the
adjacent lane. The front wheel drives over
the lane marking.
% A brake application may be interrupted at
any time if you steer slightly in the opposite
direction.
System limits
No lane-correcting brake application occurs in
the following situations:
R You clearly and actively steer, brake or accel‐
erate.
R If a driving safety system intervenes, such as
ESP®, Active Brake Assist or Active Blind
Spot Assist.
R You have adopted a sporty driving style with
high cornering speeds or high rates of accel‐
eration.
R When ESP® is deactivated.
R When driving with a trailer, the electrical con‐
nection to the trailer has been correctly
established.
R If a loss of tire pressure or a faulty tire has
been detected and displayed.
If you deactivate the Active Lane Keeping Assist
warning and the lane markings cannot be clearly
detected, it is possible that no lane correcting
brake application takes place (/ page 269).
Driving and parking 269
The system may be impaired or may not function
in the following situations:
R If there is poor visibility, e.g. due to insuffi‐
cient illumination of the road, if there are
highly variable shade conditions or in rain,
snow, fog or heavy spray.
R If there is glare, e.g. from oncoming traffic,
the sun or reflections.
R If the windshield in the area of the multifunc‐
tion camera is dirty, or if the camera is fog‐
ged up, damaged or covered.
R If there are no lane markings, or several
unclear lane markings are present for one
lane, e.g. around roadworks.
R If the lane markings are worn, dark or cov‐
ered.
R If the distance from the vehicle in front is too
short and thus the lane markings cannot be
detected.
R If the lane markings change quickly, e.g.
lanes branch off, cross one another or
merge.
R If the road is very narrow and winding.
R
Vehicles with Driving Assistance Pack‐
age: if the radar sensors in the rear bumper
are dirty or covered in snow and an obstacle
is detected in your lane, no lane-correcting
brake application takes place.
Activating/deactivating Active Lane Keeping
Assist
Multimedia system:
4 © 5 Settings 5 Quick Access
5 Active Lane Keeping Assist
# Activate or deactivate the function.
Setting Active Lane Keeping Assist
Multimedia system:
4 © 5 Settings 5 Assistance
5 Active Lane Keeping Assist
Setting the sensitivity
% The availability of this function is dependent
on the country.
# Select Standard, Sensitive or Off.
Activating or deactivating the haptic warning
Select Warning.
Activate or deactivate the function.
#
Trailer hitch
Notes on trailer operation
Mercedes‑AMG vehicles: observe the notes in
the Supplement. You could otherwise fail to rec‐
ognize dangers.
& WARNING Risk of accident due to
unsuitable ball neck
If you install an unsuitable ball neck, this may
result in the trailer hitch and rear axle being
overloaded.
As a consequence, the handling characteris‐
tics may be heavily impaired and the trailer
could become detached. There is a risk of
fatal injury.
# Only install a ball neck that conforms to
the permitted dimensions and has been
270 Driving and parking
#
designed for the requirements of trailer
operation.
Do not change the ball neck or the
trailer hitch.
The values approved by the manufacturer can be
found on the identification plates and in the
"Technical data" section under "Trailer hitch" for
the towing vehicle (/ page 406).
& WARNING Swerving of the vehicle/
trailer combination due to increased
speed
You could lose control of the vehicle/trailer
combination.
The vehicle/trailer combination may even tip
over.
# Under no circumstances should you try
to straighten the vehicle/trailer combi‐
nation by increasing the speed.
# Reduce your speed and do not counter‐
steer.
# If necessary, apply the brakes.
* NOTE Damage to the engine as a result
of overheating
#
If you retrofit a trailer hitch, modifica‐
tions to the engine cooling system may
be necessary, depending on the vehicle
model.
When retrofitting a trailer hitch, observe the
fastening points on the chassis.
Retrofitting a trailer hitch is permissible only if a
trailer load is specified in your vehicle docu‐
ments. If this is not the case, the vehicle is not
approved for trailer operation.
Further information can be obtained at a quali‐
fied specialist workshop.
If the trailer coupling is detachable, it is essen‐
tial to comply with the operating instructions of
the trailer coupling manufacturer.
Couple and uncouple the trailer carefully. If you
do not connect the trailer to the towing vehicle
correctly, the trailer may become detached.
Observe the following notes on the tongue
weight:
R Do not use a tongue weight that exceeds or
falls below the permissible tongue weight
R Use a tongue weight as close as possible to
the maximum tongue weight
Do not exceed the following values:
Permissible towing capacity
R Permissible rear axle load of the towing vehi‐
cle
R Permissible gross mass of the towing vehicle
R Permissible gross mass of the trailer
R Maximum permissible speed of the trailer
R
Ensure the following before starting a journey:
R The tire pressure on the rear axle of the tow‐
ing vehicle is set for a maximum load
R The lighting of the connected trailer is opera‐
tional
In the event of increased rear axle load, the vehi‐
cle/trailer combination may not exceed a maxi‐
mum speed of 62 mph (100 km/h) for reasons
Driving and parking 271
concerning the operating permit. This also
applies in countries in which the permissible
maximum speed for vehicle/trailer combinations
is above 62 mph (100 km/h).
Vehicles with AIRMATIC or E-ACTIVE BODY
CONTROL: if the socket of the trailer hitch is
occupied, e.g. by a trailer or rear bicycle rack,
the vehicle is set to the normal level regardless
of the drive program at speeds greater than
19 mph (30 km/h).
Attaching the ball neck
& WARNING Risk of accident and injury
due to an incorrectly installed ball cou‐
pling
If the ball coupling is not installed and
engaged correctly, it may become detached
during travel and endanger other road users.
There is a risk of fatal injury.
# Install and secure the ball coupling as
described in the ball coupling manufac‐
turer's installation instructions.
#
When the ball coupling has been instal‐
led, ensure that it is correctly secured
before every trip.
Attaching the ball neck
& WARNING Risk of accident due to an
incorrectly installed and secured ball
coupling
If the ball coupling has not been correctly
installed and secured, the trailer can become
detached.
# Install and secure the ball coupling as
described in the ball coupling manufac‐
turer's installation instructions.
# When the ball coupling has been instal‐
led, ensure that it is correctly secured
before every trip.
Requirements:
R The vehicle is secured against rolling away.
#
#
#
Remove cover 1 from the ball neck mount
in the direction of the arrow.
Store cover 1 so that it cannot move
around.
Observe the manufacturer's installation
instructions.
Observe the notes on loading the vehicle.
272 Driving and parking
Coupling or uncoupling a trailer
& WARNING Risk of injury from the vehicle
level being changed
Vehicles with level control system: the
vehicle level may be changed unintentionally,
e.g. by other persons. You may become trap‐
ped if you couple up or uncouple a trailer
while the vehicle level is changing. In addi‐
tion, other people could become trapped if
their limbs are between the vehicle body and
the tires or underneath the vehicle.
When coupling up or uncoupling a trailer,
make sure that:
# The doors or tailgate are not opened or
closed.
# You do not initiate the level control sys‐
tem and do not operate the DYNAMIC
SELECT switch.
# Do not lock or unlock the vehicle.
Requirements:
R The vehicle is secured with the electric park‐
ing brake.
R
The transmission is in position j.
The trailer will be correctly detected by the vehi‐
cle only if the following conditions are met:
R The trailer is connected correctly.
R The trailer lighting system is in working
order.
The functions of the following systems will be
affected by a correctly connected trailer:
R Active Lane Keeping Assist
R ESP® trailer stabilization
R Parking Assist PARKTRONIC
R Active Parking Assist
R Blind Spot Assist or Active Blind Spot Assist
R Drive Away Assist
R Cross Traffic Alert
R Rear view camera
R Surround view camera
R AIR BODY CONTROL
R AIRMATIC
R E-ACTIVE BODY CONTROL
Vehicles without level control: the ball head
height will change depending on the vehicle's
load. In this case, use a trailer with a heightadjustable drawbar.
Coupling up a trailer
* NOTE Damage to the starter battery due
to full discharge
Charging the trailer battery using the power
supply of the trailer can damage the starter
battery.
# Do not use the vehicle's power supply
to charge the trailer battery.
Information about a suitable ball neck for
Mercedes-Benz vehicles can be obtained from a
qualified specialist workshop, e.g. an authorized
Mercedes-Benz Center.
# Remove the cover cap from the ball neck
mount and store it in a safe place
(/ page 271).
# Position the trailer on a level surface behind
the vehicle and couple it up to the vehicle.
Driving and parking 273
Establish the electrical connection between
the vehicle and the trailer.
% Accessories can be connected to the perma‐
nent power supply up to 180 W and to the
power supply that is switched on via the igni‐
tion lock.
#
Uncoupling a trailer
& WARNING Risk of being crushed and
becoming trapped when uncoupling a
trailer
When uncoupling a trailer with an engaged
inertia-activated brake, your hand may
become trapped between the vehicle and the
trailer drawbar.
# Do not uncouple trailers with an
engaged overrun brake.
#
& WARNING Risk of becoming trapped
when disconnecting the trailer cable
Vehicles with level control system: The
vehicle may lower when the trailer cable is
disconnected.
This could result in you or other people
becoming trapped if your or their limbs are
between the vehicle body and the tires or
underneath the vehicle.
# Make sure that nobody is underneath
the vehicle or in the immediate vicinity
of the wheel arches when you discon‐
nect the trailer cable.
#
* NOTE Damage when uncoupling in a
state of overrun
Uncoupling in a state of overrun can damage
the vehicle.
Do not uncouple trailers with an
engaged overrun brake.
#
#
Disconnect the electrical connection
between the vehicle and the trailer.
Uncouple the trailer.
Place the cover cap on the ball neck mount.
Vehicle towing instructions
The vehicle is not suitable for the use of tow bar
systems that are used for flat towing or dinghy
towing, for example. Attaching and using tow bar
systems can lead to damage on the vehicle.
When you are towing a vehicle with tow bar sys‐
tems, safe driving characteristics cannot be
guaranteed for the towing vehicle or the towed
vehicle. The vehicle-trailer combination may
swerve from side to side. Comply with the per‐
mitted towing methods (/ page 349) and the
instructions for towing with both axles on the
ground (/ page 350).
274 Instrument Display and on-board computer
Notes on the Instrument Display and onboard computer
& WARNING Risk of accident due to an
Instrument Display malfunction
If the Instrument Display has failed or mal‐
functioned, the function restrictions applying
to safety relevant systems are not visible.
The operating safety of your vehicle may be
impaired.
# Drive on carefully.
# Have the vehicle checked immediately
at a qualified specialist workshop.
& WARNING Risk of distraction from infor‐
mation systems and communications
equipment
If you operate information and communica‐
tion equipment integrated in the vehicle
when driving, you will be distracted from the
traffic situation. This could also cause you to
lose control of the vehicle.
#
#
Only operate this equipment when the
traffic situation permits.
If you cannot be sure of this, stop the
vehicle whilst paying attention to road
and traffic conditions and operate the
equipment with the vehicle stationary.
You must observe the legal requirements for the
country in which you are currently driving when
operating the on-board computer.
The on-board computer shows only display mes‐
sages and warnings from specific systems on
the multifunction display. You must therefore
ensure that your vehicle is always reliable.
If the operating safety of your vehicle is
impaired, park the vehicle immediately and
safely. Contact a qualified specialist workshop.
Mercedes-AMG vehicles: be sure to observe
the notes in the Supplement. You could other‐
wise fail to recognize dangers.
Instrument Display and on-board computer 275
Instrument Display overview
1 Display content on left (example: speedome‐
ter): speedometer/time /date/trip com‐
puter From Start and From Reset/range/
audio/angle of incline and approach/depar‐
ture
The segments on the speedometer indicate
the status of the following systems: cruise
2
3
4
5
control/limiter/Active Distance Assist
DISTRONIC
Outside temperature
Digital speedometer
Time
Display content on right (example: tachome‐
ter): tachometer/average fuel
consumption/ECO display/navigation/G-
meter/assistant display/4MATIC/suspen‐
sion (equipment-dependent)
The fuel supply will be interrupted to protect
the engine when the red mark on the tach‐
ometer (overrevving range) is reached.
6 Index points
These show the selected display or menu
content.
276 Instrument Display and on-board computer
7 Coolant temperature display
8
9
A
B
The coolant temperature display is permitted
to rise to 248°F during normal operation.
Vehicles with 48 V on-board electrical sys‐
tem: POWER and CHARGE display (electrical
drive support and recuperation power of the
electric motor)
Selected drive program
Selected transmission position
Multifunction display (example: standard dis‐
play for trip): Assistance/Telephone/Naviga‐
tion/Trip/Media/Radio/Styles and dis‐
plays/Service
Fuel level, fuel filler flap location indicator,
range
Overview of the buttons on the steering
wheel
4 Control panel for MBUX multimedia system:
5
6
7
8
1 P Back/Home button, on-board com‐
puter
Press and hold: shows standard display
2 Touch Control, on-board computer
3 Control panel for cruise control or Active
Distance Assist DISTRONIC
£ Voice Control System
ß Displays favorites
VOL: control knob, adjusts the volume or
switches the sound off 8 (press)
6 Makes/accepts a call
~ Rejects/ends a call
ò Calls up the home screen
Touch Control multimedia system
G Back button
Brightness control to adjust the lighting in
the Instrument Display and in the control
elements of the vehicle interior
Operating the on-board computer
Observe the legal requirements for the country
in which you are currently driving when operat‐
ing the on-board computer.
Instrument Display and on-board computer 277
R
R
R
The on-board computer is operated using the
left-hand Touch Control and the left-hand back/
home button.
When the on-board computer is being operated,
different acoustic signals will sound as operating
feedback, e.g. when the end of a list is reached
or when you are scrolling through a list.
The following menus are available:
R Assistance
R Phone
R Navigation
R Trip
R Radio
Media
Designs & Disp.
Service
% You can find information about the possible
settings and selections on the menus in the
Digital Operator's Manual.
# To call up the menu bar: briefly press the
left-hand back button until the menu bar is
displayed.
% Vehicles without Active Distance Assist
DISTRONIC: press the ò button to call
up the menu bar of the on-board computer.
# To scroll in the menu bar: swipe left or
right on the left-hand Touch Control.
# To call up a menu, submenu or possible
settings on the menu, or confirm a selec‐
tion or setting: press the left-hand Touch
Control.
# To scroll through displays or lists on the
menu, or select display content, a func‐
tion, an entry or a display: swipe upwards
#
or downwards on the left-hand Touch Con‐
trol.
To exit a submenu: press the left-hand back
button.
Selecting the Head-up Display
To switch on the Head-up Display: switch
on the Head-up Display via the multimedia
system or activate it in the menu bar by swip‐
ing upwards on the left-hand Touch Control.
The Head-up Display menu has been selec‐
ted on the Head-up Display.
# To switch to the Head-up Display: press
the left-hand Touch Control or swipe
upwards on the left-hand Touch Control.
# To select what the Head-up Display
shows: swipe upwards or downwards on the
left-hand Touch Control.
#
Full-screen menus
You can display the following menus in full on
the Instrument Display:
R Assistance
R Trip
278 Instrument Display and on-board computer
R
Navigation
#
On the corresponding menu, use the lefthand Touch Control to scroll to the end of the
list.
Press the left-hand Touch Control.
The selected menu will be displayed in full.
#
Overview of what is shown on the multi‐
function display
Also shown on the multifunction display:
u
Active Parking Assist (/ page 257)
é
Parking Assist PARKTRONIC deactiva‐
ted (/ page 248)
î
DSR (/ page 214)
h
Cruise control (/ page 212)
ç
Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC
(/ page 216)
ê
Active Brake Assist (/ page 207)
à
Active Steering Assist (/ page 222)
Active Traffic Jam Assist
(/ page 227)
Ã
±
è
ë
_
Active Lane Keeping Assist
(/ page 267)
Active Lane Change Assist
(/ page 224)
ECO start/stop function
(/ page 179)
HOLD function (/ page 228)
Adaptive Highbeam Assist
(/ page 146)
Vehicles with Traffic Sign Assist: Detected
instructions and traffic signs (/ page 262).
For an overview of the indicator and warning
lamps, see (/ page 460).
Head-up Display
Function of the Head-up Display
The Head-up Display projects the following infor‐
mation above the cockpit into the driver's field
of vision:
R Driving speed
R Information from the navigation system
R Information from the driving systems and
driving safety systems
R Some warning messages
Depending on the vehicle's equipment, different
content can be shown in the three display areas
of the Head-up Display (/ page 279).
Instrument Display and on-board computer 279
Display content
R
R
R
Wet road
Objects on the display cover
Polarization in sunglasses
% In extreme sunlight, sections of the display
may appear washed out. You can correct this
by switching the Head-up Display off and on
again.
1
2
3
4
Navigation instructions
Current speed
Detected instructions and traffic signs
Set speed in the driving system (e.g. cruise
control)
System limits
The visibility of the displays will be affected by
the following conditions:
R Seat position
R Image position setting
R Ambient light
R
Voice Control System
#
To choose a setting: swipe to the right on
the left-hand Touch Control.
Settings menu 5 will be selected.
To call up the Settings menu: press the
left-hand Touch Control.
To adjust the position: swipe upwards or
downwards on the left-hand Touch Control.
To adjust the brightness: swipe to the left
or right on the left-hand Touch Control.
To set messages, assistance status, tele‐
phone, audio and the Voice Control Sys‐
tem: press the left-hand Touch Control.
The list of setting options will be displayed.
Swipe upwards or downwards on the lefthand Touch Control and select a setting by
pressing the left-hand Touch Control.
#
#
Setting the Head-up Display using the onboard computer
#
On-board computer:
4 HEAD-UP DISPLAY
The following Head-up Display settings can be
selected:
R Position
R Brightness
R Displays
R Messages
R Assistance status
R Telephone
R Audio
#
#
280 Instrument Display and on-board computer
Selecting what the Head-up Display shows
4 Right display area
Traffic Sign Assist
vehicle level
Differential
Assistant display
5 To adjust the position, brightness and lower
display area
6 Index points
7 Lower display area
(Example)
1 Switches the Head-up Display on/off
2 Left display area
Navigation system
Inclination, gradient and compass
Average consumption
G-meter
3 Central display area
Set speed in the driver assistance system,
e.g. cruise control
Warnings from driver assistance systems,
e.g. distance warning
Display areas 2 to 4 that are not required can
be hidden.
% In audio mode, the station name or track will
be shown temporarily when the audio source
is being actively operated. In addition, the
latest calls will be displayed when the tele‐
phone list on the Instrument Display is
actively operated.
# To select a display: swipe upwards on the
left-hand Touch Control.
# Press the left-hand Touch Control.
Switching the Head-up Display on/off via the
multimedia system
Multimedia system:
4 © 5 Settings 5 Quick Access
# Select HUD.
The Head-up Display is activated.
MBUX multimedia system 281
Overview and operation
Notes on the MBUX multimedia system
Overview of the MBUX multimedia system
& WARNING Risk of distraction from infor‐
mation systems and communications
equipment
If you operate information and communica‐
tion equipment integrated in the vehicle
when driving, you will be distracted from the
traffic situation. This could also cause you to
lose control of the vehicle.
# Only operate this equipment when the
traffic situation permits.
# If you cannot be sure of this, stop the
vehicle whilst paying attention to road
and traffic conditions and operate the
equipment with the vehicle stationary.
You must observe the legal requirements for the
country in which you are currently driving when
operating the multimedia system.
Press briefly: switches the mute function
on/off
Press and hold: switches the multimedia sys‐
tem or media display on or off
5 Buttons for navigation, radio/media and
telephone
6 Buttons for vehicle functions/system set‐
tings and favorites/themes
Further operating options:
Conducting a voice dialog with the Voice
Control System.
R Operating functions contact-free with the
MBUX Interior Assistant.
R
1 Touch Control and control panel for the
MBUX multimedia system
2 Media display with touch functionality
3 Touchpad
4 Controller
Turning: adjusts the volume
% You can find further information about oper‐
ation as well as about applications and serv‐
ices in the Digital Operator's Manual.
Anti-theft protection
This device is equipped with technical provisions
to protect it against theft. Further information on
protection against theft can be obtained from an
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.
282 MBUX multimedia system
Home screen overview
1 Depending on the display, calls up the first
three applications or the home screen
2 Calls up the profile
3 Calls up the global search
4 SOS NOT READY (only when the MercedesBenz emergency call system is not available)
5 Signal strength of the mobile phone network,
6
7
8
9
network display, battery status of the mobile
phone connected, time
Calls up the Notifications Center
Calls up an application using the symbol
Application and current information
Quick-access, e.g. enter home address
A Index points and selected display area
B Calls up the air conditioning menu
C Calls up SUGGESTIONS, THEMES and
FAVORITES
MBUX multimedia system 283
Operating the MBUX multimedia system
ß Pressing the rocker switch down and
holding: adds favorites and themes
VOL: control adjusts the volume or switches
the sound off 8 (press)
6 Pressing the rocker switch up: makes
or accepts a call
~ Pressing the rocker switch down:
rejects or ends a call
Using Touch Control
#
#
To zoom in and out of the map: move two
fingers together or apart.
To call up the global menu: press and hold
on the touchscreen until the OPTIONS menu
appears.
Using the touchpad
Navigation through the menus is carried out with
Touch Control 2 with single-finger swipes.
# To select a menu option: swipe and press.
# To move the digital map: swipe in any
direction.
Using the touchscreen
Select menu options, symbols or characters
by pressing briefly.
# To navigate in menus: swipe up, down, left
or right.
# To use handwriting to enter characters:
write the character with one finger on the
touchscreen.
#
1 © Calls up the home screen
2 Touch Control
3 G Pressing briefly: returns to the previ‐
ous display
4 ß Pressing the rocker switch down
briefly: shows favorites
1 G Returns to the previous display
2 ~ Calls up the audio control menu
284 MBUX multimedia system
Swiping to the left of right: selects the previ‐
ous or next radio station/music track
3 © Calls up the home screen
4 Touchpad
#
#
#
#
To select a menu option: swipe and press.
To use handwriting recognition: write a
character on the touchpad.
To open or close the Notifications Cen‐
ter: swipe down or up with two fingers.
To zoom in and out of the map: move two
fingers together or apart.
Calling up applications using buttons
#
Call up the application (/ page 282).
Functions of the Voice Control System
1
2
3
4
5
y Calls up vehicle functions
z Calls up navigation
| Calls up radio or media
% Calls up the telephone
ß Press briefly: calls up favorites
Press and hold: adds a favorite or theme
#
Alternatively, tap © on the touchscreen.
or
#
Press the © button on the Touch Control
or on the touchpad.
The home screen appears.
With the Voice Control System, various applica‐
tions in the MBUX multimedia system are opera‐
ble using voice input. The Voice Control System
is operational approximately thirty seconds after
the ignition is switched on and is available for
the driver's seat and front passenger seat.
The following multimedia system applications
can be operated:
R Navigation
R Telephone
R Radio and TV
R Media player
R Messages
R Vehicle functions
MBUX multimedia system 285
Starting the Voice Control System
#
Press rocker switch 1 up.
or
#
Say "Hey Mercedes".
Overview of the MBUX Interior Assistant
& WARNING Risk of injury due to laser
beams from the camera
This product uses a class 1 laser system If
the housing is opened or damaged, invisible
laser beams could damage your retina.
# Do not open the housing.
# Always have maintenance work and
repairs carried out by a qualified spe‐
cialist workshop.
This product complies with the requirements of
the FDA 21 CFR 1040.10 and 1040.11 with
exception of the variations according to the FDA
Laser Notice No. 50 from 24. June 2007.
The camera is located in the overhead control
panel.
If the vehicle is equipped with the MBUX Interior
Assistant, selected functions of the multimedia
system can be operated contact-free. The MBUX
Interior Assistant can differentiate between
driver and front passenger interactions and
detects specific hand positions (poses).
For further information on system limits, display
messages and troubleshooting notes, see the
Digital Operator's Manual.
286 MBUX multimedia system
The MBUX Interior Assistant supports the following interactions:
Interaction area
Interaction
Description
In front of the media display or
above the touchpad
Proximity to the control element
The Interior Assistant recognizes the approach of the hand towards a con‐
trol element.
Depending on the active application, the display will be adjusted in the
media display. Some functions differentiate between driver and front
passenger.
No specific hand position is required.
Above the center console
Defined poses
With defined poses a function is triggered depending on the application
active.
Below the inside rearview mirror
Brief up and down movements
With brief vertical up and down movements below the inside rearview mir‐
ror the reading light for the driver or the front passenger is switched on and
off.
Front passenger seat
Stretching out a hand above the
front passenger seat
By stretching out a hand above the front passenger seat the search light is
switched on. If you withdraw a hand from this area, the search light is
switched off again.
Switching the reading light and search light
and on or off
R
Requirements:
R
For the reading light: the function is availa‐
ble when it is dark.
The hand movement takes place in the inter‐
action area below the inside rearview mirror.
R
R
For the search light: the function is availa‐
ble when it is dark.
The hand movement takes place in the inter‐
action area above the front passenger seat.
MBUX multimedia system 287
R
The seat belt on the front passenger seat
must not be inserted in the seat belt buckle.
Switching the search light on and off
Switching the reading light on and off
& WARNING Risk of becoming trapped
during adjustment of the driver's seat
after calling up a driver profile
#
#
Briefly move a hand up or down beneath the
inside rearview mirror.
The reading light is switched on or off for the
driver or front passenger.
Information on profiles, themes, suggestions
and favorites
#
To switch on: reach across the front
passenger seat with a hand.
The search light is switched on for the driver.
To switch off: take a hand back away from
the front passenger seat.
The search light is switched off again.
Selecting a profile may trigger an adjustment
of the driver's seat to the position saved
under the profile. You or other vehicle occu‐
pants could be injured in the process.
# Make sure that when the position of
driver's seat is being adjusted using the
multimedia system, no people or body
parts are in the seat's range of move‐
ment.
If there is a risk of someone becoming trap‐
ped, stop the adjustment process immedi‐
ately:
# a) Tap the warning message on the
media display.
or
288 MBUX multimedia system
#
b) Press a memory position button or a
seat adjustment switch on the driver's
door.
The adjustment process is stopped.
The driver's seat is equipped with an access pre‐
venter.
If the driver's door is open, the driver's seat will
not be set after calling up the driver's profile.
Profiles store your vehicle settings and settings
for the multimedia system. If the vehicle is used
by several drivers, the driver can select their
own profile without needing to change the set‐
tings of other drivers.
% Information on profiles from Mercedes me
connect can be found in the Digital Opera‐
tor's Manual.
Vehicle settings are, for example, driver's seat,
steering wheel and mirror settings, climate con‐
trol and ambient lighting. For the settings of the
multimedia system, you can select, for example,
radio stations, previous destinations as well as
themes, suggestions and favorites.
For recurring driving situations, such as long
drives on the freeway, you can save your prefer‐
red settings in a theme in the vehicle. In a theme
you can save the display of the digital map, your
preferred radio station and preferred drive pro‐
gram, for example.
The vehicle can learn the habits of the driver. It
then offers suggestions for the most probable
navigation destinations, media sources, radio
stations or contacts. The requirements for that
are the selection of a profile, your consent to the
recording of data and sufficient collected data.
Favorites provide quick access to applications
that are used often. You can select favorites
from categories or add them directly to an appli‐
cation.
Configuring profiles, themes and sugges‐
tions
Multimedia system:
4 © 5 f Profiles
Creating a new profile
Select W Create Profile .
# Select an avatar.
# Enter the name and confirm with a.
# Select Continue r .
# Select Current Settings.
# Select Save.
# Activate Bluetooth® and select Connect
Phone, to connect a mobile phone with the
user profile .
# Select Finish.
#
Selecting profile options
# Select Ä for a profile.
The following functions are available:
R Editing, resetting or deleting a profile
R Resetting themes or favorites
MBUX multimedia system 289
R
Configuring suggestions
Configuring suggestions
# Select Ä for a profile.
# Select Suggestion Settings.
# Switch Allow Destination Suggestions, Allow
Music Suggestions and Allow Contact Suggestions on or off.
# To deactivate the learning function for
one day: activate Deactivate 24h Intelligent
Learning.
For 24 hours no new actions will be trained
and no data recorded for the active profile.
Suggestions will continue to be shown.
Example: if the option is switched on and a
route to a new destination has been calcula‐
ted, this destination would not be taken into
account for the learning function.
Creating new themes
Select ©.
# Select THEMES.
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
Select W Create Theme.
The settings which are saved in the theme
are shown.
Select Continue r.
Select Audio and Navigation (Navigation) and
store the active settings in the theme.
Select Continue r.
Select an entry screen.
Select Continue r.
Select an image.
Enter the names into the entry field and con‐
firm with a.
Select Save.
-
R
R
R
R
System settings
Overview of the system settings menu
In the system settings menu, you can make set‐
tings in the following menus and control ele‐
ments:
R Display
Styles
Instrument lighting
Display brightness
Edge lighting
Day/night design
Control elements
Keyboard language and handwriting rec‐
ognition
Touchpad sensitivity
Sensitivity of the Touch Controls
Voice Control System
MBUX Interior Assistant
Sound
Entertainment
Navigation and traffic announcements
Telephone
Voice amplification to the rear passenger
compartment
Connectivity
Wi-Fi, Bluetooth, NFC
MBUX Remote Control
-
R
R
290 MBUX multimedia system
Authorizing and de-authorizing devices
Time & date
Language
Units for distance
Software updates
Data import/export
PIN protection
System Reset
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Information on important system updates
Important system updates may be necessary for
the security of your multimedia system's data.
Install these updates, or else the security of your
multimedia system cannot be ensured.
A system update consists of three steps:
R Downloading or copying of the data required
for installation
R Installation of the downloaded system update
R Activation of the downloaded system update
by restarting the system
% If automatic software updates are activated,
the system updates will be downloaded auto‐
matically.
The multimedia system provides a message
when a system update is available.
You have the following selection options:
R Accept and Install
The system update will be downloaded in the
background.
R Information
Information about the pending system
update is displayed.
R Later
The system update can be downloaded man‐
ually at a later time.
Deep system updates
Deep system updates access vehicle or system
settings and can therefore only be carried out
when the vehicle is stationary and the ignition is
switched off.
If the download of a deep system update is com‐
pleted and the downloaded system update is
ready for installation, you will be informed of this
after the next ignition cycle, for example.
% Park the vehicle safely in a suitable location
before starting the installation.
Requirements for the installation:
R The ignition is switched off.
R Notes and warnings have been read and
accepted.
R The electric parking brake is applied.
If all requirements have been fulfilled, the down‐
loaded system update is installed. The multime‐
dia system cannot be operated while the down‐
loaded system update is being installed and
vehicle functions are restricted.
If errors should occur during the installation, the
multimedia system automatically attempts to
restore the previous version. If restoration of the
previous version is not possible, a symbol
appears on the media display. Consult a quali‐
fied specialist workshop to resolve the problem.
MBUX multimedia system 291
Setting up a Wi-Fi hotspot
#
Requirements:
R To set up the Wi-Fi connection of the mul‐
timedia system with external hotspots:
there is no communication module installed.
R The device to be connected supports at least
one of the types of connection described.
#
Multimedia system:
4 © 5 Settings
5 Wi-Fi & Bluetooth
5
System
Activating/deactivating Wi-Fi
# Select Wi-Fi.
Connecting the multimedia system with an
external hotspot using Wi-Fi
The type of connection established must be
selected on the multimedia system and on the
device to be connected.
% The connection procedure may differ
depending on the device. Follow the instruc‐
tions that are shown in the display. Further
information can be found in the manufactur‐
er's operating instructions.
#
Select Internet Settings.
Select Connect via Wi-Fi.
Select Add Hotspot.
Connecting using a security key
# Select the options r of the desired Wi-Fi
network.
# Select Connect Using Security Key.
# Have the security key displayed on the device
to be connected (see the manufacturer's
operating instructions).
# Enter this security key on the multimedia sys‐
tem.
# Confirm the entry with ¡.
Connecting using a WPS PIN
Select the options r of the desired Wi-Fi
network.
# Select Connect via WPS PIN Input.
The multimedia system generates an eightdigit PIN.
# Enter this PIN on the device to be connected.
# Confirm the entry.
#
Connecting using a button
Select the options r of the desired Wi-Fi
network.
# Select Connect via WPS PBC.
# Select "Connect via WPS PBC" in the options
on the device to be connected (see the man‐
ufacturer's operating instructions).
# Press the WPS button on the device to be
connected.
# Select Continue in the multimedia system.
#
Activating automatic connection
# Select Connect via Wi-Fi.
# Select the options r of the desired Wi-Fi
network.
# Activate Permanent Internet Connection.
Connecting with a known Wi-Fi
Select Connect via Wi-Fi.
# Select a Wi-Fi network.
The connection is established again.
#
292 MBUX multimedia system
Configuring the multimedia system as a WiFi hotspot for external devices
The type of connection established depends on
the device to be connected. The function must
be supported by the multimedia system and by
the device to be connected. The type of connec‐
tion established must be selected on the multi‐
media system and on the device to be connec‐
ted.
# Select Vehicle Hotspot.
# Select Connect Device to Vehicle Hotspot.
Connecting using WPS PIN generation
Select Connect via WPS PIN Generation.
# Enter the PIN shown in the media display on
the device to be connected and confirm.
#
Connecting using WPS PIN entry
Select Connect via WPS PIN Input.
# Enter the PIN that is shown on the external
device's display on the multimedia system.
#
Connecting using a button
# Select Connect via WPS PBC.
#
#
Press the push button on the device to be
connected (see the manufacturer's operating
instructions).
Select Continue.
Connecting using a security key
# Select Connect Device to Vehicle Hotspot.
A security key is displayed.
# Select the vehicle from the device to be con‐
nected. The vehicle is displayed with the MB
Hotspot XXXXX network name.
# Enter the security key which is shown in the
media display on the device to be connected.
# Confirm the entry.
Connecting using NFC
# Select Connect via NFC.
# Activate NFC on the mobile device (see the
manufacturer's operating instructions).
# Bring the mobile device into the NFC inter‐
face of the vehicle.
# Select Finished.
The mobile device is now connected to the
multimedia system hotspot via NFC.
Generating a new security key
# Select Vehicle Hotspot.
# Select Generate Security Key.
A connection will be established with the
newly created security key.
# To save a security key: select Save.
When a new security key is saved, all existing
Wi-Fi connections are then disconnected. If
the Wi-Fi connections are being re-estab‐
lished, the new security key must be entered.
Navigation
Notes on navigation
Route guidance with augmented reality
& WARNING Risk of accident and injury as
a result of distraction, incorrect depic‐
tion or wrong interpretation of the dis‐
play
The camera image of the augmented reality
display is not suitable as a guide for driving.
MBUX multimedia system 293
#
#
Always keep an eye on the actual traffic
situation.
Avoid extended observation of the cam‐
era image.
& WARNING Risk of accident and injury
due to imprecise positioning of addi‐
tional information
The additional information from the augmen‐
ted reality display is not a substitute for
observing the actual driving situation.
# Always keep an eye on the actual traffic
situation when carrying out all driving
maneuvers.
Switching navigation on
Multimedia system:
4 © 5 Navigation (Navigation)
# Alternatively: press the z button.
The map shows the vehicle's current posi‐
tion. The navigation menu is shown.
#
The navigation menu is hidden if route guid‐
ance is active.
To show: tap on the touchscreen.
The menu is hidden automatically.
294 MBUX multimedia system
Navigation overview
Example: digital map with navigation menu
1 To enter a POI or address and additional des‐
tination entry options
2 To cancel active route guidance
3 Repeats a navigation announcement and
switch navigation announcements on or off
4 ON THE WAY menu with Route Overview,
Alternative Routes and Report Traffic Incident (Car-to-X)
TRAFFIC menu with Traffic Announcements,
Area Alerts and Live Traffic Subscription Info
To display Route List
POSITION menu with Save Position and
Compass
5 Quick access for Traffic, Parking and Highway Information as well as options for View,
Announcements and Route via Advanced
MBUX multimedia system 295
Entering a destination
Multimedia system:
4 © 5 Navigation
5
ª Where to?
1 The federal state or province in which the
vehicle is located
2 Enters a POI or address
3 List with additional destination entry options
4 Deletes an entry
5
6
7
8
9
a Confirms an entry
Switches to handwriting recognition
Enters a space
Switches to voice input
Sets the written language
A Switches to digits, special characters and
symbols
B Switches to upper-case or lower-case letters
296 MBUX multimedia system
Enter the destination in 2. The entries can
be made in any order.
The following entries can be made, for exam‐
ple:
R City, street, house number
R Street, city
R ZIP code
R POI name or POI category, e.g. Parking
R Contact name
# Select a search result in list 3.
The route can be calculated.
% You can find further information about desti‐
nation entry, e.g. 3 word addresses, in the
Digital Operator's Manual.
#
Changing country
# Select the indicator for federal state or prov‐
ince 1.
# Select the federal state or the province in
1.
# Enter the country indicator.
# Select the country on list 3.
#
Select the federal state or the province from
list 3.
Using online search
Destination entry uses online map services. If
the on-board search finds no suitable destina‐
tions or if you change countries, the online
search is available.
For the destination you can enter an address, a
POI or a 3 word address.
# Select country indicator 1.
# Select the provider for the online service
from the countries list.
or
# If the on-board search delivers no results,
enter the destination in input line 2.
# Select the destination in the list.
The detailed view for the route is displayed.
Calculating a route and using settings for
route guidance
Requirements:
R The destination has been entered.
R
The destination address is shown.
Multimedia system:
4 © 5 Navigation
1 ¥ No route yet.
¦ A route has been mapped.
#
Select ¥.
The route to the destination is calculated.
Route guidance begins.
or
#
Select ¦.
MBUX multimedia system 297
#
Select Set as Waypoint.
The destination address is set as the next
intermediate destination.
or
#
Select Start New Route Guidance.
The destination address is set as the new
destination. The previous destination and the
intermediate destinations are deleted. Route
guidance to the new destination begins.
Selecting route settings
Select Z.
# Select Advanced.
# Select Route.
# Select the route type.
# Take traffic information into consideration
with Dynamic Route Guidance r.
# Select route options with Avoid Options.
# Activate Suggest Alternative Route.
Alternative routes are calculated for every
route.
#
#
Activate Activate Commuter Route.
If the requirements are met, the multimedia
system automatically detects that the vehicle
is on a commuter route. Route guidance
begins without voice output.
Activating route guidance with augmented
reality
# During route guidance, tap on the camera
symbol on the media display.
The camera image will be shown instead of
the navigation map before a turning maneu‐
ver and will show additional information.
# To return to the navigation map: tap on
the camera symbol again.
Displaying additional information in the cam‐
era image
# Select Z.
# Select Advanced.
# Select Augmented Reality.
# Activate Street Names and House Numbers.
During route guidance, street names and
house numbers are shown in the camera
image.
Using map functions
Multimedia system:
4 © 5 Navigation
Setting the map scale
To zoom in: tap twice quickly with one finger
on the media display.
# To zoom out: tap with two fingers on the
media display.
#
Moving the map
Move one finger in any direction on the
touchscreen.
# To reset the map to the current vehicle
position: press \ briefly.
#
Selecting map orientation
Tap repeatedly on the Ä compass symbol
on the map.
The view changes in the sequence 3D, 2D
Heading Up to 2D North Up.
#
Switching freeway information on/off
Select Z.
#
298 MBUX multimedia system
#
Switch Highway Information on or off.
Using services
Requirements:
R There is an Internet connection.
R Mercedes me connect is available.
R You have set up a user account in the
Mercedes me Portal.
R The vehicle is connected to a user account
and you have accepted the conditions of use
for the service.
Further information can be found at:
https://www.mercedes.me
R The service is available.
R The service has been activated at an author‐
ized Mercedes-Benz Center.
Multimedia system:
4 © 5 Navigation
Displaying the traffic situation with Live Traf‐
fic Information
# Select Z.
# Activate Traffic.
# Select Advanced.
# Select View.
# Select Map Elements.
# Switch on Traffic Incidents, Free Flowing
Traffic and Delay.
If traffic information has been received, then
traffic incidents such as roadworks, road
blocks, local area reports (e.g. fog) and warn‐
ing messages are displayed.
The traffic delay is displayed for the current
route. Traffic delays lasting one minute or
longer are taken into consideration.
Displaying hazard warnings with Car-to-XCommunication
If hazard warnings are available these can be
shown as symbols on the map. The display
depends on the settings for the Traffic and Traffic Incidents options.
# Set the options.
If Traffic is switched off and Traffic Incidents
is switched on, the symbols are shown on
the prospective route.
Displaying weather information and other
map contents
# Select Z.
# Select Advanced.
# Select View.
# Select Map Elements.
# Scroll up and show the ONLINE MAP CONTENT category.
# Switch on a service, e.g. Weather.
Current weather information is displayed on
the navigation map, e.g. temperature or
cloud cover.
MBUX multimedia system 299
Telephone
Telephony
Notes on telephony
& WARNING Risk of distraction from oper‐
ating integrated communication equip‐
ment while the vehicle is in motion
If you operate communication equipment
integrated in the vehicle when driving, you
will be distracted from the traffic situation.
This could also cause you to lose control of
the vehicle.
# Only operate this equipment when the
traffic situation permits.
# If you cannot be sure of this, stop the
vehicle whilst paying attention to road
and traffic conditions and operate the
equipment with the vehicle stationary.
& WARNING Risk of an accident from
operating mobile communication equip‐
ment while the vehicle is in motion
Mobile communications devices distract the
driver from the traffic situation. This could
also cause the driver to lose control of the
vehicle.
# As the driver, only operate mobile com‐
munications devices when the vehicle is
stationary.
# As a vehicle occupant, only use mobile
communications devices in the areas
intended for this purpose, e.g. in the
rear passenger compartment.
You must observe the legal requirements for the
country in which you are currently driving when
operating mobile communication equipment in
the vehicle.
& WARNING Risk of injury due to objects
being stowed incorrectly
If objects in the vehicle interior are stowed
incorrectly, they can slide or be thrown
around and hit vehicle occupants. In addi‐
tion, cup holders, open stowage spaces and
mobile phone receptacles cannot always
retain all objects within.
There is a risk of injury, particularly in the
event of sudden braking or a sudden change
in direction.
# Always stow objects so that they can‐
not be thrown around in such situa‐
tions.
# Always make sure that objects do not
protrude from stowage spaces, parcel
nets or stowage nets.
# Close the lockable stowage spaces
before starting a journey.
# Always stow and secure heavy, hard,
pointed, sharp-edged, fragile or bulky
objects in the trunk/cargo compart‐
ment.
300 MBUX multimedia system
Observe the additional information on stowing
mobile communications devices correctly:
R Loading the vehicle (/ page 119)
Bluetooth® connection:
The menu view and the available functions in the
telephone menu are in part dependent on the
Bluetooth® profile of the connected mobile
phone. Full functionality is only available if the
mobile phone supports both of the following
Bluetooth® profiles:
R PBAP (Phone Book Access Profile)
The contacts on the mobile phone are
shown automatically on the multimedia
system.
R MAP (Message Access Profile)
The mobile phone message functions can
be used on the multimedia system.
Irrespective of this, Bluetooth® audio functional‐
ity can by used with any mobile radio unit.
For information on the range of functions of the
mobile radio unit to be connected, see the man‐
ufacturer's operating instructions.
Network connection:
The following cases can lead to the call being
disconnected while the vehicle is in motion:
R You switch into a transmission/reception
station, in which no communication channel
is free.
R The SIM card used is not compatible with the
network available
R a mobile phone with "Twincard" is logged into
the network with the second SIM card at the
same time
The multimedia system supports calls in HD
Voice® for improved speech quality. A require‐
ment for this is that the mobile phone and the
mobile phone network provider of the person
you are calling support HD Voice® .
Depending on the quality of the connection, the
voice quality may fluctuate.
Further information can be obtained from an
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center or at:
https://www.mercedes-benz.com/connect
MBUX multimedia system 301
Telephone menu overview
1 Bluetooth® device name of the currently
connected mobile phone/of the mobile
phone
2 Bluetooth® device name of the currently
connected mobile phone/of the mobile
phone (two phone mode)
3 Battery status of the connected mobile
phone
4
5
6
7
8
9
Signal strength of the mobile phone network
Options
Device manager
Messages
Numerical pad
Contact search
Telephony operating modes overview
Depending on your equipment, the following tel‐
ephony operating modes are available:
R A mobile phone is connected to the multime‐
dia system via Bluetooth®.
302 MBUX multimedia system
R
Two mobile phones are connected with the
multimedia system via Bluetooth® (two
phone mode).
You can use all the functions of the multi‐
media system with the mobile phone in
the foreground.
You can receive incoming calls and mes‐
sages with the mobile phone in the back‐
ground.
You can interchange the mobile phone in
the foreground and background.
Connecting a mobile phone
Requirements:
R Bluetooth®
R
is activated on the mobile phone
(see the manufacturer's operating instruc‐
tions).
Bluetooth® is activated on the multimedia
system.
Multimedia system:
4 © 5 Phone
Searching for a mobile phone
Select í.
# Select Connect New Device.
R
#
Connecting a mobile phone
Authorization follows using secure simple pair‐
ing.
# Select a mobile phone.
A code is displayed in the multimedia system
and on the mobile phone.
# If both codes match, confirm the code on the
mobile phone.
Functions in the telephony menu
In the telephony menu you have the following
functions, for example:
R Making calls, e.g.:
R Accept a call
k End Call
i Create Conf. Call
Accepting or rejecting a waiting call
R
Managing contacts, e.g.:
Downloading mobile phone contacts
Managing the format of a contact's name
Saving a contact as a favorite
Receiving and sending messages, e.g.:
Using the read-aloud function
Dictating a new message
Mercedes me and apps
Mercedes me connect
Information on Mercedes me connect
Mercedes me connect consists of multiple serv‐
ices.
You can use the following services via the multi‐
media system and the overhead control panel,
for example:
R Accident and Breakdown Management (me
button or situation-dependent display in the
multimedia system)
R Concierge Service (me button), if activated
MBUX multimedia system 303
R
Mercedes-Benz emergency call system (auto‐
matic emergency call and SOS button)
Mercedes me connect Accident and Breakdown
Management, the Mercedes me connect Con‐
cierge Service (if service is activated) and the
Mercedes-Benz emergency call center are availa‐
ble for you around the clock.
The me button and the SOS button can be found
on the vehicle's overhead control panel
(/ page 304).
You can also call the Mercedes-Benz Customer
Center using the multimedia system
(/ page 305).
Please note that Mercedes me connect is a
Mercedes-Benz service. In emergencies, first call
the national emergency services using the
standard national emergency service telephone
numbers. In emergencies, you can also use the
Mercedes-Benz emergency call system
(/ page 310).
Observe the conditions of use for Mercedes me
connect and other services. These can be
obtained in the Mercedes me Portal: https://
me.secure.mercedes-benz.com
Further information about Mercedes me connect
services can be obtained in the Mercedes me
Portal: https://me.secure.mercedes-benz.com
Information on Mercedes me connect Acci‐
dent and Breakdown Management
The Accident and Breakdown Management can
include the following functions:
R Supplement to the Mercedes-Benz emer‐
gency call system (/ page 310)
If necessary, the contact person at the
Mercedes-Benz emergency call center for‐
wards the call to Mercedes me connect Acci‐
dent and Breakdown Management. Forward‐
ing the call is however not possible in all
countries.
R Breakdown assistance by a technician on
location and/or the towing away of the vehi‐
cle to the nearest authorized Mercedes-Benz
Center
You may be charged for these services.
R Addition to the emergency guide after auto‐
matic accident or breakdown detection
(/ page 305)
R
In the event of a breakdown or accident, fur‐
ther vehicle data is sent which enables opti‐
mal support by the Mercedes-Benz Customer
Center and the authorized service partner or
breakdown assistance.
Addition to the Mercedes me connect
service Telediagnostics
With the Telediagnostics function, specific
wear and failure reports are recorded by the
service provider, in so far as these can be
clearly interpreted and are available through
the monitoring of components that are sub‐
ject to diagnostics.
If your vehicle detects a breakdown or threat
of a breakdown, you may be prompted via
the multimedia system to contact the
Mercedes-Benz Customer Center for further
help. This prompt in the multimedia system
only appears when the vehicle is stationary.
304 MBUX multimedia system
% These services are subject to technical
restrictions such as the mobile phone cover‐
age, mobile network quality and the ability of
the processing systems to interpret the
transferred data. In some circumstances,
this can result in delays or the failure of the
information to appear in the multimedia sys‐
tem.
More information about Mercedes me connect
services can be obtained in the Mercedes me
Portal: https://me.secure.mercedes-benz.com
Data transferred during Mercedes me con‐
nect call services
The data transferred during a Mercedes me con‐
nect call depends on:
R The reason for initiation of the call
R The service that is selected in the voice con‐
trol system
R The activated Mercedes me connect services
Which data is transferred for the services can be
taken from the currently valid terms of use.
These can be obtained in the Mercedes me por‐
tal: https://me.secure.mercedes-benz.com
Mercedes me calls
Making a call via the overhead control panel
#
#
#
To make a Mercedes me call: press me
button 1.
To make an emergency call: press SOS
button cover 2 briefly to open.
Press and hold SOS button 3 for at least
one second.
If a Mercedes me call is active, an emergency
call can still be triggered. This has priority over
all other active calls.
1 me button for service, concierge or informa‐
tion calls
2 SOS button cover
3 SOS button (emergency call system)
Information about the Mercedes me call
using the me button
A call to the Mercedes-Benz Customer Center
has been initiated via the me button in the over‐
head control panel or the multimedia system
(/ page 304).
Using the voice dialog system you access the
desired service:
R Concierge Service (if the service is activated)
R Accident and Breakdown Management
R Mercedes-Benz Customer Center for general
information about the vehicle
MBUX multimedia system 305
You can find information on the following topics:
Activation of Mercedes me connect
R Operating the vehicle
R Nearest authorized Mercedes-Benz Center
R Other products and services from MercedesBenz
R
Data is transferred during the connection to the
Mercedes-Benz Customer Center (/ page 306).
Calling the Mercedes-Benz Customer Center
using the multimedia system
Requirements:
R Access to a GSM network is available.
R The contract partner's GSM network cover‐
age is available in the respective region.
R The ignition must be switched on so that
vehicle data can be transferred automati‐
cally.
Multimedia system:
4 © 5 Phone 5 g
# Call Mercedes me connect.
After confirmation, the multimedia system
sends the required vehicle data. The data
transfer is shown in the media display.
Then, you can select a service and be connected
to a specialist at the Mercedes-Benz Customer
Center.
% In some countries, or if the Concierge
Service is active, you will be connected
directly with the Mercedes-Benz Customer
Center.
The Concierge Service is not available in all
countries. More information about Mercedes
me connect services can be obtained in the
Mercedes me Portal: https://
me.secure.mercedes-benz.com
Calling the Mercedes-Benz Customer Center
after automatic accident or breakdown
detection
Requirements:
R
R
R
The vehicle has detected an accident or
breakdown situation.
The vehicle is stationary.
The hazard warning lights are switched on.
% This function is not available in all countries.
The vehicle can detect accident or breakdown
situations under certain circumstances.
In the event an accident or breakdown is detec‐
ted, the emergency guide shows safety notes in
the multimedia system display.
After quitting the emergency guide display on
the multimedia system, a prompt appears asking
whether you wish to get support from the
Mercedes-Benz Customer Center.
# Select Call.
R After your agreement, or if the Mercedes
me connect service "Accident and Break‐
down Management" is active, the vehicle
data is transferred automatically
(/ page 303).
R The Mercedes-Benz Customer Center
takes your call and organizes the break‐
down and accident assistance.
306 MBUX multimedia system
You may be charged for these services.
% Depending on the severity of the accident,
an automatic emergency call can be initi‐
ated. This has priority over all other active
calls.
% In addition, if the Mercedes me connect
service "Telediagnostics" is active, a similar
prompt can appear after a delay in the event
of a breakdown. If you are already in contact
with the Mercedes-Benz Customer Center or
have already received support, this prompt
can be ignored or declined.
% If you answer the prompt for support from
the Mercedes-Benz Customer Center with
Later, the message will be hidden and
appear again later.
The prompt triggered by the Mercedes me
connect service "Telediagnostics", can either
be confirmed or declined. After being
declined, this will not be shown again.
Arranging a service appointment via a
Mercedes me call
If you have activated the maintenance manage‐
ment service, relevant vehicle data is transferred
automatically to the Mercedes-Benz Customer
Center. You will then receive individual recom‐
mendations regarding the maintenance of your
vehicle.
Regardless of whether you have consented to
the maintenance management service, the multi‐
media system reminds you after a certain
amount of time that a service is due. A prompt
appears asking if you would like to make an
appointment.
# To arrange a service appointment: select
Call.
After your agreement, the vehicle data is
transferred and the Mercedes-Benz customer
center takes your preferred appointment
date. The information is then sent to your
desired service outlet.
This will contact you to confirm the appoint‐
ment and if necessary consult about the
details.
% If you select Later after the service message
appears, the message is hidden and reap‐
pears at a later time.
Transferred data during a Mercedes me call
If you initiate a service call using Mercedes me,
data is transferred to enable targeted advice and
an efficient service.
The following requirements must be fulfilled for
the transfer of the data:
R The ignition is switched on.
R The required data transfer technology is sup‐
ported by the mobile service operator.
R The quality of the mobile connection is suffi‐
cient.
Multi-stage transfer depends on the following
factors:
R Reason for the initiation of the call
R The available mobile phone transmission
technology.
R The activated Mercedes me connect serv‐
ices.
R The service selected in the voice control sys‐
tem.
MBUX multimedia system 307
Data transfer if Mercedes me connect serv‐
ices are not activated
If no Mercedes me connect services are activa‐
ted, the following data is transferred:
R Vehicle identification number
R Time of the call
R Reason for the initiation of the call
R Confirmation of the data protection prompt
R Country indicator of the vehicle
R Set language for the multimedia system
R Telephone number of the communication
platform installed in the vehicle
If a call is made for a service appointment via
the service reminder, the following data is also
transmitted:
R Current mileage and maintenance data
If a call is made after automatic accident or
breakdown detection using the multimedia sys‐
tem, the following data is also transmitted:
R Current mileage and maintenance data
R Current vehicle location
If Accident and Breakdown Management is
called via the voice control system, the following
data can also be called up from the vehicle by
the Mercedes-Benz Customer Center:
R Current vehicle location
Data transfer if Mercedes me connect serv‐
ices are activated
Only if the respective service is activated will
additional incident-specific data be transmitted
in the second stage to enable an optimal
service.
An overview of the data transmitted can be
found in the respective terms of use for
Mercedes me connect services. These can be
obtained in the Mercedes me Portal: https://
me.secure.mercedes-benz.com
Data processing
The data transmitted within the scope of the call
is deleted from the processing system after the
call is finished, in so far as this data is not being
used for other activated Mercedes me connect
services.
The incident-specific data is processed and
stored in the Mercedes-Benz Customer Center
and, if required to process the incident, forwar‐
ded to the service partner authorized by the
Mercedes-Benz Customer Center. Please take
note of the data protection information on the
Mercedes me Internet page at https://
www.mercedes.me or in the recorded message
immediately after calling the Mercedes-Benz
Customer Center.
% The recorded message is not available in
every country.
Overview of the Mercedes me & Apps menu
When you log in with a user account to the
Mercedes me Portal, then services and offers
from Mercedes-Benz will be available to you.
For more information consult an authorized
Mercedes-Benz Center or visit the Mercedes me
portal: https://me.secure.mercedes-benz.com
% Make sure you always keep the Mercedes
me apps updated.
You can call up the menu using Mercedes me &
Apps in the multimedia system.
308 MBUX multimedia system
In the Mercedes me & Apps menu, the following
options can be available:
R Connecting the vehicle with the Mercedes
me user account
R Deleting a connection between a Mercedes
me user account and the vehicle
1 URL entry
2 Bookmarks
3 Web page, back
R
R
Calling up the Mercedes me services
Calling up apps such as, In-Car Office or the
web browser depending on availability
4 Web page, forwards
5 To refresh/stop
6 Options
Web browser overview
You can call up websites with the web browser.
The web browser is started using the Mercedes
me & Apps menu.
% Websites cannot be shown while the vehicle
is in motion.
MBUX multimedia system 309
Smartphone integration
With Smartphone Integration, you can use cer‐
tain functions on your mobile phone via the mul‐
timedia system display.
Only one mobile phone at a time can be connec‐
ted via Smartphone Integration to the multime‐
dia system. Also for use with two phone mode
with smartphone integration, only one additional
mobile phone can be connected using Blue‐
tooth® with the multimedia system.
The full range of functions for Smartphone Inte‐
gration is only possible with an Internet connec‐
tion. The appropriate application must be down‐
loaded on the mobile phone to use Smartphone
Integration. The mobile phone must be switched
on and connected to a USB port with the ç
symbol on the multimedia system using a suita‐
ble cable.
Apps for Smartphone Integration
R Mercedes-Benz Link (implementation of the
function using the Mercedes-Benz Link con‐
trol box)
R Apple CarPlay®
R
Android Auto
You can start Smartphone Integration using the
Mercedes me & Apps menu.
You can end Smartphone Integration by discon‐
necting the connecting cable between the
mobile phone and multimedia system.
Overview of transferred vehicle data
When using Smartphone Integration, certain
vehicle data is transferred to the mobile phone.
This enables you to get the best out of selected
mobile phone services. Vehicle data is not
directly accessible.
The following system information is transmitted:
R Software release of the multimedia system
R System ID (anonymized)
The transfer of this data is used to alter how
content is displayed to correspond to the driving
situation.
The following position data is transmitted:
R Coordinates
R Speed
R
R
Compass direction
Acceleration direction
This data is used by the mobile phone to
improve the accuracy of the navigation (e.g. for
continuation in a tunnel).
Mercedes-Benz emergency call system
Information on the Mercedes-Benz emer‐
gency call system
Your vehicle is equipped with the Mercedes-Benz
emergency call system ("eCall"). This feature can
help save lives in the event of an accident. eCall
in no way replaces assistance provided from
dialing 911.
Mercedes-Benz eCall only functions in areas
where mobile phone coverage is available from
the wireless service providers. Insufficient net‐
work coverage from the wireless service provid‐
ers may result in an emergency call not being
transmitted.
eCall is a standard feature in your MercedesBenz vehicle. In order to function as intended,
the system relies on the transmission of data
310 MBUX multimedia system
detailed in the "Mercedes-Benz emergency call
system data transmission" section that follows
(/ page 312).
To disable eCall, a customer must visit an
authorized Mercedes-Benz Service department
to deactivate the vehicle's communication mod‐
ule.
Deactivation of this module prevents the
activation of any and all Mercedes me con‐
nect services. After the deactivation of
eCall, automatic emergency call and manual
emergency call will not be available.
The ignition must be switched on before an auto‐
matic emergency call can be made.
% eCall is activated at the factory.
% eCall can be deactivated by an authorized
Mercedes-Benz dealer. Please note that in
the event ownership of the vehicle is trans‐
ferred to another owner in its deactivated
state, eCall will remain deactivated unless
the new owner visits an authorized
Mercedes-Benz dealership to reactivate the
system.
Overview of the Mercedes-Benz emergency
call system
eCall can help to reduce the time between an
accident and the arrival of emergency services
at the site of the accident. It helps locate an
accident site in places that are difficult to
access. However, even if a vehicle is equipped
with eCall, this does not mean the system is ON.
As such, eCall does not replace dialing 911 in the
event of an accident.
An emergency call can be made automatically
(/ page 310) or manually (/ page 311) Only
make emergency calls if you or others are in
need of rescue.
Only make emergency calls if you or others are
in need of rescue. Do not make an emergency
call in the event of a breakdown or a similar sit‐
uation.
Messages on the display
SOS NOT READY: the ignition is not on or eCall
not available.
During an active emergency call, G appears
in the display.
You can find more information on the regional
availability of eCall at: https://www.mercedesbenz-mobile.com/extra/ecall/
% If there is a malfunction in the MercedesBenz emergency call system (e.g. a fault with
the speaker, microphone, airbag, SOS but‐
ton), a corresponding message appears in
the multifunction display of the instrument
cluster.
Triggering an automatic Mercedes‑Benz
emergency call
Requirements:
R The ignition is switched on.
R The starter battery is sufficiently charged.
The Mercedes‑Benz emergency call system trig‐
gers an emergency call automatically in the fol‐
lowing cases:
R After activation of the restraint systems such
as airbags or Emergency Tensioning Devices
after an accident
R After an automatically initiated emergency
stop by Active Emergency Stop Assist
MBUX multimedia system 311
The emergency call has been made:
A voice connection is made to the
Mercedes‑Benz emergency call center.
R A message with accident data is transmitted
to the Mercedes‑Benz emergency call center.
The Mercedes‑Benz emergency call center
can transmit the vehicle position data to one
of the emergency call centers.
R
R
The SOS button in the overhead control panel
flashes until the emergency call is finished.
It is not possible to immediately end an auto‐
matic emergency call.
If no connection can be made to the emergency
services either, a corresponding message
appears in the media display.
# Dial the local emergency number on your
mobile phone.
If an emergency call has been initiated:
R Remain in the vehicle if the road and traffic
conditions permit you to do so until a voice
connection is established with the emer‐
gency call center operator.
R
Based on the call, the operator decides
whether it is necessary to call rescue teams
and/or the police to the accident site.
If no vehicle occupant answers, an ambu‐
lance is sent to the vehicle immediately.
Triggering a manual Mercedes-Benz emer‐
gency call
To use the SOS button in the overhead
control panel: press and hold the SOS but‐
ton for at least one second (/ page 304).
# To use the voice control system: use the
Voice Control System voice commands .
The emergency call has been made:
R A voice connection is made to the MercedesBenz emergency call center.
R A message with accident data is transmitted
to the Mercedes-Benz emergency call center.
The Mercedes-Benz emergency call center
can transmit the vehicle position data to one
of the emergency call centers.
#
R
R
Remain in the vehicle if the road and traffic
conditions permit you to do so until a voice
connection is established with the emer‐
gency call center operator.
Based on the call, the operator decides
whether it is necessary to call rescue teams
and/or the police to the accident site.
If no connection can be made to the emergency
services either, a corresponding message
appears in the media display.
# Dial the local emergency number on your
mobile phone.
Ending an unintentionally triggered manual
Mercedes-Benz emergency call
# On the multifunction steering wheel:
select ~. Depress the button for several
seconds.
312 MBUX multimedia system
Data transfer of the Mercedes-Benz emer‐
gency call system
In the event of an automatic or manual emer‐
gency call the following data is transmitted, for
example:
R Vehicle's GPS position data
R GPS position data on the route
( (a few hundred meters )before the incident)
R Direction of travel
R Vehicle identification number
R Vehicle drive type
R Number of people determined to be in the
vehicle
R Whether Mercedes me connect is available
or not
R Whether the emergency call was initiated
manually or automatically
R Time of the accident
R Language setting on the multimedia system
Data transmitted is vehicle information. For any
questions about the collection, use and sharing
of the eCall system data, please contact MBU‐
SA's Customer Assistance Center at 800-FORMERC.
For Canada, please contact MBC's Customer
Assistance Center at 1-800-387-0100.
Customer requests for covered information
should be submitted via the same channels.
For accident clarification purposes, the following
measures can be taken up to an hour after the
emergency call has been initiated:
R The current vehicle position can be deter‐
mined.
R A voice connection to the vehicle occupants
can be established.
MBUX multimedia system 313
Radio & media
Overview of the symbols and functions in the media menu
Symbol
Designation
Function
6
Play
Select to start or continue playback.
8
Rest
Select to pause the playback.
:
Repeating a track
Select to repeat the current track or the active playlist.
R Select once: the active playlist is repeated.
R Select twice: the current track is repeated.
R Select three times: the function is deactivated.
9
Random playback
Select to play back tracks in random order.
ûü
Skip forwards/back
Select to skip to the next or to the previous track.
ß
Options
Select to show additional options.
5
Categories
Select to show or search through available categories (e.g. playback lists, albums,
artists, etc.).
ª
Search
Select to search in the active menu. You can search for artists, genres, moods or
videos, for example.
314 MBUX multimedia system
Symbol
Designation
Function
Z
Settings
Select to make settings.
©
Home
Select to return to the home screen.
j
Messaging
Select to call up messaging.
2
Full screen
Select to switch to full screen mode
The following functions and settings are
available in the media menu:
R Connecting external data storage media with
the multimedia system (e.g. using USB or
Bluetooth®)
R Playing back audio or video files
Authorizing a Bluetooth® audio device for
media playback
Requirements:
R
Bluetooth® is activated on the multimedia
system and audio equipment.
R
R
The audio equipment supports the Blue‐
tooth® audio profiles A2DP and AVRCP.
The audio equipment is "visible" for other
devices.
Multimedia system:
4 © 5 Media
Bluetooth®
5
Bluetooth
5
ª
With
audio, you can play back music
files from an external data storage medium, e.g.
your smartphone, using the MBUX multimedia
system.
# To play back audio files using the multimedia
system, authorize the external data storage
medium on the MBUX multimedia system.
Authorizing a new Bluetooth® audio device
# Select Connect New Device.
# Select an audio device.
Authorization starts. A code is displayed on
the multimedia system and on the mobile
phone.
# If the codes are identical, confirm on the
audio equipment.
# Select Only as Bluetooth Audio Device.
The Bluetooth® audio equipment is connec‐
ted with the multimedia system.
MBUX multimedia system 315
Connecting previously authorized Bluetooth®
audio equipment
#
Select a Bluetooth® audio device from the
list.
The connection is being established.
Overview of the symbols and functions in the radio menu
Symbol
Designation
Function
©
Home
Select to return to the home screen.
j
Messaging
Select to call up messaging.
ûü
Skip forwards/back
Select to skip to the next or to the previous station.
Z
Options
Select to have further options shown. Settings can be made to the following addi‐
tional functions, for example:
R Navigation and traffic announcements
R Frequency Fix function
R Radio additional text
R Emergency warnings
The setting options are country-dependent.
316 MBUX multimedia system
Symbol
Designation
Function
HD
HD radio
Select to switch the HD radio function on or off.
This function is not available in all countries.
8
Mute function
Select to switch off the sound
f
Storing radio stations
Select to save a station in the presets
4
Station list
Select to have the station list shown.
ª
Search
Select to search in the active menu. You can search for artists, genres, moods or
videos, for example.
Additional functions of TuneIn Radio
% A relatively large volume of data can be
transmitted when using TuneIn Radio.
MBUX multimedia system 317
Symbol
Designation
Function
Z
Options
The following additional settings are available in
the TuneIn Radio menu:
R Selecting stream
R Logging on to/out of the TuneIn account
ß
Favorites
Select during playback to save the station cur‐
rently set as a favorite.
6
Play/Stop
Select to start, stop or continue playback.
5
Browse
Select to choose a category and then a radio
station.
Additional functions of the satellite radio
SIRIUS XM® satellite radio offers more than 175
digital-quality radio channels providing 100%
commercial-free music, sports, news and enter‐
tainment, for example. SIRIUS XM® satellite
radio employs a fleet of high-performance satel‐
lites to broadcast around the clock throughout
the USA and Canada. The satellite radio program
is available for a monthly fee. Information about
this can be obtained from a Sirius XM® Service
Center and at https://www.siriusxm.com (USA)
or https://www.siriusxm.ca (Canada).
% Sirius, XM and all related marks and logos
are trademarks of Sirius XM Radio Inc. and
its subsidiaries. All other marks, channel
names and logos are the property of their
respective owners. All rights reserved.
318 MBUX multimedia system
Symbol
Designation
Function
Z
Options
The following additional settings are available in
the satellite radio menu:
R Activate parental control to lock channels
with adult content
R Set alarm programming for music and sport
alerts
R Create TuneMix lists to listen to music seam‐
lessly
5
Playback controls
Select to show the timeline.
Tap any point on the timeline to skip forwards or
back.
Navigate to the end of the timeline to return to
live mode.
6
Play
Select to start or continue playback.
8
Rest
Select to pause the playback.
Depending on the frequency band selected, dif‐
ferent functions are available to you.
Select the desired frequency band in the radio
menu head runner.
Calling up TuneIn Radio
Requirements:
MBUX multimedia system 319
R
R
R
The TuneIn Radio service is activated in the
Mercedes me portal.
The data volume is available.
Depending on the country, data volume may
need to be purchased.
A fast Internet connection for data transmis‐
sion free of interference.
% New data volume can be purchased
directly from a mobile phone network
provider via the Mercedes me Portal.
% The functions and services are countrydependent. For more information, consult an
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.
Multimedia system:
4 © 5 Radio
# Select TuneIn Radio.
The TuneIn menu appears. The last station
set starts playing.
% The connection quality depends on the local
mobile phone reception.
Setting up satellite radio
Requirements:
R Satellite radio equipment is available.
R Registration with a satellite radio provider
has been completed.
R If registration is not included when purchas‐
ing the system, your credit card details will
be required to activate your account.
Multimedia system:
4 © 5 Þ Radio 5 SiriusXM
5 Z Options
# Select Service Information.
The service information screen appears
showing the radio ID and the current sub‐
scription status.
# Establish a telephone connection.
# Follow the service staff's instructions.
The activation process may take up to ten
minutes.
% You can also have the satellite service acti‐
vated online. To do so, please visit http://
www.siriusxm.com (USA) or http://
www.siriusxm.ca (Canada).
Music and sport alerts
Multimedia system:
4 © 5 Radio
5 Alerts
5
SiriusXM
5
Z
Setting music and sport alerts
This function enables you to program an alert for
your favorite artists, tracks or sporting events.
Music alerts can be saved whilst a track is being
played and sport alerts can be saved during a
live game. You can also specify sport alerts via
the menu option. The system then continuously
searches through all the channels.
# Set a music or sports alert, to be informed of
matches in the Live program.
Activating the music information function
Activate Music Alerts O.
#
Setting a music alert
Select Add Alert.
#
320 MBUX multimedia system
#
Select Artists or Song in the dialog window.
The alert is set for the current artist or track.
If a match is found, a prompt appears asking
whether you wish to change to the station.
Activating sports information
Activate Activate Sports Alerts O.
#
Setting a sport alert
Select Add Alert.
# Select the team name or league in the dialog
window.
#
Deleting individual sports and music alerts
Select Manage Music Alerts.
or
# Select Manage Sports Alerts.
# Select an artist or track.
or
# Select a team.
# Select Delete Selected Entries.
All highlighted alerts are deleted.
#
Deleting all sports and music alerts
# Select Manage Music Alerts.
or
# Select Manage Sports Alerts.
# Select Delete All Entries.
All alerts are deleted.
Sound settings
Overview of functions in the sound menu
The setting options and functions available
depend on the sound system installed. You can
find out which sound system is installed in your
vehicle in the Digital Operator's Manual.
Standard sound system and Advanced sound
system
The following functions are available:
R Equalizer
Treble, mid-range and bass
R Balance and fader
R Volume
Automatic adjustment
Burmester® surround sound system and
Burmester® high-end 3D surround sound
system
The following functions are available:
R Equalizer
Treble, mid-range and bass
R Balance and fader
R Sound focus
R VIP seats (Burmester® high-end 3D surround
sound system)
R Sound profiles
R Volume
Automatic adjustment
Maintenance and care 321
ASSYST PLUS service interval display
Function of the ASSYST PLUS service interval
display
The ASSYST PLUS service interval display on the
Instrument Display provides information on the
remaining time or distance before the next
service due date.
You can hide this service display using the back
button on the left-hand side of the steering
wheel.
Depending on how the vehicle is used, the
ASSYST PLUS service interval display may
shorten the service interval, e.g. in the following
cases:
R Mainly short-distance driving
R When the engine is often left idling for long
periods
R In the event of frequent cold start phases
Mercedes-Benz recommends avoiding such
operating conditions.
You can obtain information concerning the serv‐
icing of your vehicle from a qualified specialist
workshop, e.g. an authorized Mercedes-Benz
Center.
Displaying the service due date
On-board computer:
4 Service 5 ASSYST PLUS
The next service due date is displayed.
# To exit the display: press the back button
on the left-hand side of the steering wheel.
Bear in mind the following related topic:
R Operating the on-board computer
(/ page 276).
Information on regular maintenance work
* NOTE Premature wear through failure to
observe service due dates
Service work which is not carried out at the
right time or incompletely can lead to
increased wear and damage to the vehicle.
#
#
Always observe the prescribed service
intervals.
Always have the prescribed service
work carried out at a qualified specialist
workshop.
Special service requirements
The prescribed service interval is based on nor‐
mal operation of the vehicle. Maintenance work
will need to be performed more often if the vehi‐
cle is operated under arduous conditions or
increased loads.
The ASSYST PLUS service interval display is only
an aid. The driver of the vehicle bears responsi‐
bility as regards to whether maintenance work
needs to be performed more often than speci‐
fied based on the actual operating conditions
and/or loads.
Examples of arduous operating conditions:
R regular city driving with frequent intermedi‐
ate stops
R mainly short-distance driving
322 Maintenance and care
R
R
R
frequent operation in mountainous terrain or
on poor road surfaces
when the engine is often left idling for long
periods
operation in particularly dusty conditions
and/or if air-recirculation mode is frequently
used
In these or similar operating conditions, have the
interior air filter, engine air cleaner, engine oil
and oil filter etc. changed more frequently. The
tires must be checked more frequently if the
vehicle is operated under increased loads. Fur‐
ther information can be obtained at a qualified
specialist workshop.
Battery disconnection periods
The ASSYST PLUS service interval display
can only calculate the service due date when
the battery is connected.
# Note down the service due date displayed on
the instrument display before disconnecting
the battery (/ page 321).
Engine compartment
Opening/closing the hood
& WARNING Risk of accident due to driv‐
ing with the hood unlocked
The hood may open and block your view.
# Never release the hood when driving.
# Before every trip, ensure that the hood
is locked.
& WARNING Risk of accident and injury
when opening and closing the hood
The hood may suddenly drop into the end
position.
There is a risk of injury for anyone in the
hood's range of movement.
# Open or close the hood only when there
is nobody in the hood's range of move‐
ment.
& WARNING Danger of burns when open‐
ing the hood
If you open the hood when the engine has
overheated or during a fire in the engine
compartment, you could come into contact
with hot gases or other escaping operating
fluids.
# Before opening the hood, allow the
engine to cool down.
# In the event of a fire in the engine com‐
partment, keep the hood closed and
call the fire service.
& WARNING Risk of injury due to moving
parts
Components in the engine compartment may
continue running or start up suddenly, even if
the ignition is switched off.
Make sure of the following before performing
tasks in the engine compartment:
# Switch the ignition off.
Maintenance and care 323
#
#
#
Never reach into the danger zone sur‐
rounding moving components, e.g. the
rotation area of the fan.
Remove jewelery and watches.
Keep items of clothing and hair away
from moving parts.
& WARNING Risk of injury from touching
components under voltage
The ignition system and the fuel injection
system work under high voltage. You could
receive an electric shock.
# Never touch components of the ignition
system or the fuel injection system
when the ignition is switched on.
& WARNING Risk of burns from hot com‐
ponent parts in the engine compartment
Certain components in the engine compart‐
ment can be very hot, e.g. the engine, the
radiator and parts of the exhaust system.
#
Allow the engine to cool down and only
touch component parts described in
the following.
Opens the hood
& WARNING Risk of injury from using the
windshield wipers while the engine hood
is open
When the engine hood is open and the wind‐
shield wipers are set in motion, you can be
trapped by the wiper linkage.
# Always switch off the windshield wipers
and ignition before opening the engine
hood.
#
To release the hood, pull on handle 1.
324 Maintenance and care
#
#
#
#
Push handle 1 of the hood catch upwards
and lift the hood by approximately 15 in
(40 cm).
Closing the hood
* NOTE Damage to the hood
If the hood is closed manually, there is a risk
of dents.
Do not close the hood manually.
Lower the hood to a height of around 8 in
(20 cm) and then allow it to fall, applying a
little force as you let it go.
If the hood can still be lifted slightly, open
the hood again and close it with a little more
force until it engages correctly.
On-board computer:
4 Service 5 Engine Oil Level
You will see one of the following messages on
the multifunction display:
R Measuring Engine Oil Level...: measurement
of the oil level is not yet possible.
#
Repeat the request after a maximum of
30 minutes' driving.
Engine Oil Level OK and the bar display for
indicating the oil level on the multifunction
display is green and is between "min" and
"max": the oil level is correct.
Engine oil
R
Checking the engine oil level using the onboard computer
Requirements:
R The engine has been warmed up.
R The vehicle is parked on a level surface.
R The engine is running at idle speed.
R
Engine Oil Level Add 1,1 qts. and the bar dis‐
play for indicating the oil level on the multi‐
function display is orange and is below "min":
#
Add 1.1 US qt (1 l) of engine oil.
Reduce Engine Oil Level and the bar display
for indicating the oil level on the multifunc‐
tion display is orange and is above "max":
The engine oil level is determined during driving.
Determining the engine oil level can take up to
30 minutes with a normal driving style and even
longer with an active driving style.
R
Maintenance and care 325
#
R
#
R
Drain off any excess engine oil that has been
added. To do so, consult a qualified specialist
workshop.
For Engine Oil Level Switch Ignition On
Switch on the ignition to check the engine oil
level.
Engine Oil Level System Inoperative: The oil
level sensor is defective or not connected.
R
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Engine Oil Level System Currently Unavail.
#
Close the hood.
#
Refilling engine oil
& WARNING Risk of burns from hot com‐
ponent parts in the engine compartment
Certain components in the engine compart‐
ment can be very hot, e.g. the engine, the
radiator and parts of the exhaust system.
# Allow the engine to cool down and only
touch component parts described in
the following.
& WARNING Risk of fire and injury from
engine oil
If engine oil comes into contact with hot
component parts in the engine compart‐
ment, it may ignite.
# Make sure that no engine oil is spilled
next to the filler opening.
# Allow the engine to cool off and thor‐
oughly clean the engine oil from compo‐
nent parts before starting the vehicle.
* NOTE Engine damage caused by an
incorrect oil filter, incorrect oil or addi‐
tives
#
#
#
Do not use engine oils or oil filters
which do not correspond to the specifi‐
cations explicitly prescribed for the
service intervals.
Do not alter the engine oil or oil filter in
order to achieve longer change intervals
than prescribed.
Do not use additives.
#
Follow the instructions in the service
interval display regarding the oil
change.
* NOTE Damage caused by refilling too
much engine oil
Too much engine oil can damage the engine
or the catalytic converter.
# Have excess engine oil removed at a
qualified specialist workshop.
% Depending on the engine, the cap may be
installed in the engine compartment in dif‐
ferent locations.
326 Maintenance and care
Checking coolant level
& WARNING Risk of burns from hot com‐
ponent parts in the engine compartment
Certain components in the engine compart‐
ment can be very hot, e.g. the engine, the
radiator and parts of the exhaust system.
# Allow the engine to cool down and only
touch component parts described in
the following.
& WARNING Risk of scalding from hot
coolant
#
#
#
#
Turn cap 1 counter-clockwise and remove
it.
Add engine oil.
Replace cap 1 and turn it clockwise until it
engages.
Check the oil level again (/ page 324).
If you open the cap, you could be scalded.
# Let the motor cool down before opening
the cap.
# When opening the cap, wear protective
gloves and safety glasses.
# Open the cap slowly to release pres‐
sure.
#
#
#
Park the vehicle on a level surface.
Check the coolant temperature display in the
instrument cluster.
The coolant temperature must be in the bot‐
tom quarter of the temperature display.
Slowly turn cap 1 counter-clockwise to
release overpressure.
Maintenance and care 327
#
Continue turning cap 1 counter-clockwise
and remove it.
The coolant level is correct in the following
cases:
R if the engine is cold, the coolant is up to
marker bar 2.
R if the engine is warm, the coolant is up to
0.6 in (1.5 cm) over marker bar 2.
If necessary, add coolant that has been
approved for Mercedes-Benz.
% Further information on coolant
(/ page 398)
#
Adding washer fluid to the windshield
washer system
& WARNING Risk of burns from hot com‐
ponent parts in the engine compartment
Certain components in the engine compart‐
ment can be very hot, e.g. the engine, the
radiator and parts of the exhaust system.
#
Allow the engine to cool down and only
touch component parts described in
the following.
#
Make sure that no windshield washer
concentrate spills out next to the filler
opening.
& WARNING Danger of burns when open‐
ing the hood
If you open the hood when the engine has
overheated or during a fire in the engine
compartment, you could come into contact
with hot gases or other escaping operating
fluids.
# Before opening the hood, allow the
engine to cool down.
# In the event of a fire in the engine com‐
partment, keep the hood closed and
call the fire service.
& WARNING ‑ Risk of fire and injury from
windshield washer concentrate
Windshield washer concentrate is highly
flammable. It could ignite if it comes into
contact with hot engine component parts or
the exhaust system.
#
#
R
Remove cap 1 by the tab.
Add washer fluid.
Further information about the washer fluid
(/ page 399)
328 Maintenance and care
Keeping the air-water duct free
#
Keep the area between the hood and the
windshield free of deposits, e.g. ice, snow
and leaves.
Cleaning and care
Notes on washing the vehicle in a car wash
& WARNING Risk of accident due to
reduced braking effect after washing the
vehicle
The braking effect is reduced after washing
the vehicle.
# After the vehicle has been washed,
brake carefully while paying attention to
the traffic conditions until the braking
effect has been fully restored.
* NOTE Damage from automatic braking
If one of the following functions is switched
on, the vehicle brakes automatically in cer‐
tain situations:
R Active Brake Assist
R Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC
R HOLD function
R Active Parking Assist
To avoid damage to the vehicle, deactivate
these systems in the following or similar sit‐
uations:
# During towing
# In a car wash
* NOTE Damage due to unsuitable car
wash
#
Before driving into a car wash make
sure that the car wash is suitable for
the vehicle dimensions.
#
#
Ensure there is sufficient ground clear‐
ance between the underbody and the
guide rails of the car wash.
Ensure that the clearance width of the
car wash, in particular the width of the
guide rails, is sufficient.
To avoid damage to your vehicle when using a
car wash, ensure the following beforehand:
R Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC and the
HOLD function are deactivated.
R The surround view camera or the rear view
camera is switched off.
R The side windows and sliding sunroof are
completely closed.
R The outside mirrors are folded in.
R The blower for the ventilation/heating is
switched off.
R The windshield wiper switch is in position
g.
R The SmartKey is at a minimum distance of
10 ft (3 m) away from the vehicle, otherwise
the tailgate could open unintentionally.
Maintenance and care 329
R
In car washes with a conveyor system: neu‐
tral i is engaged.
% Drive straight and in to the center of the
guide rails of the car wash to prevent dam‐
age to the tires and rims.
% In car washes with a conveyor system: if you
would like to leave the vehicle while it is
being washed, make sure the SmartKey is
located in the vehicle. The park position j
is otherwise automatically engaged.
% If, after the car wash, you remove the wax
from the windshield and wiper rubbers, this
will prevent smearing and reduce wiper
noise.
Automatic car wash mode
In car wash mode, the vehicle is prepared for
driving into the automatic car wash. Car wash
mode can be activated at a speed of up to
12 mph (20 km/h) (/ page 330).
The following settings are made when car wash
mode is activated:
R The outside mirrors are folded in.
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
The rain sensor is deactivated to prevent the
windshield washer system from starting up
automatically.
The rear window wiper is deactivated.
Mercedes-Maybach vehicles: the running
boards are retracted.
The air conditioning system is set to air-recir‐
culation mode.
Parking Assist PARKTRONIC is deactivated.
Vehicles with surround view camera: the
front image is activated after approx. eight
seconds.
Vehicles with AIRMATIC: the vehicle is
raised to the maximum possible chassis
level(/ page 231).
If rising takes longer than 25 seconds, the
following message appears on the multifunc‐
tion display:
Preparation for Automatic Car Wash Incomplete See Media Display. After some time,
the vehicle automatically continues rising.
R
Vehicles with E-ACTIVE BODY CONTROL:
the vehicle is raised to the maximum possi‐
ble chassis level(/ page 240).
If rising takes longer than 25 seconds, the
following message appears on the multifunc‐
tion display:
Preparation for Automatic Car Wash Incomplete See Media Display. After some time,
the vehicle automatically continues rising.
If one of the settings cannot be selected, this is
displayed by a % behind the respective set‐
ting.
Above a speed of 12 mph (20 km/h) car wash
mode is automatically deactivated.
The following settings are reset when car wash
mode is deactivated:
R The outside mirrors are folded out.
R The rain sensor is activated.
R The rear window wiper is activated.
R The air conditioning system is set to fresh air
mode.
330 Maintenance and care
R
R
R
R
R
Parking Assist PARKTRONIC is reset to the
previously selected setting.
Mercedes-Maybach vehicles: the running
boards remain retracted.
Vehicles with surround view camera: the
front image is deactivated at speeds above
11 mph (18 km/h).
Vehicles with AIRMATIC: the vehicle is low‐
ered to the previously set chassis level.
Vehicles with E-ACTIVE BODY CONTROL:
the vehicle is lowered to the previously set
chassis level.
Activating/deactivating automatic car wash
mode
Requirements:
R The vehicle is stationary.
R The engine is running.
Multimedia system:
4 © 5 Settings
Notes on using a power washer
5
Quick Access
Activating automatic car wash mode
# Select Automatic Car Wash Mode.
# Select Start.
If one of the settings cannot be selected, this is
displayed by a % behind the respective set‐
ting.
% For an overview of the settings made when
activating automatic car wash mode
(/ page 328).
Deactivating automatic car wash mode
Select Stop.
The automatic car wash settings are reset.
% The automatic car wash mode is automati‐
cally deactivated as soon as a speed of
12 mph (20 km/h) is exceeded.
#
& WARNING Risk of an accident when
using power washers with round-spray
nozzles
The water jet can cause externally invisible
damage.
Components damaged in this way may unex‐
pectedly fail.
# Do not use a power washer with roundspray nozzles.
# Have damaged tires or chassis parts
replaced immediately.
To avoid damage to your vehicle, observe the fol‐
lowing when using a power washer:
R Keep the SmartKey at least 10 ft (3 m) away
from the vehicle. Otherwise the tailgate
could open unintentionally.
R Maintain a distance of at least 11.8 in
(30 cm) to the vehicle.
R Vehicles with decorative foil: parts of your
vehicle are covered with a decorative foil.
Maintenance and care 331
R
R
Maintain a distance of at least 27.6 in
(70 cm) between the foil-covered parts of the
vehicle and the nozzle of the power washer.
Move the power washer nozzle around whilst
cleaning. The water temperature of the
power washer must not exceed 140 °F
(60 °C).
Observe the information on the correct dis‐
tance in the equipment manufacturer's oper‐
ating instructions.
Do not point the nozzle of the power washer
directly at sensitive parts such as tires, gaps,
electrical components, batteries, light sour‐
ces and ventilation slots.
Washing the vehicle by hand
Observe the legal requirements, e.g. in a number
of countries, washing by hand is only permitted
in specially designated wash bays.
# Use a mild cleaning agent, e.g. car shampoo.
# Wash the vehicle with lukewarm water using
a soft car sponge. When doing so, do not
expose the vehicle to direct sunlight.
#
Carefully hose the vehicle off with water and
dry using a chamois. Take care not to point
the water jet directly towards the air inlet
grille below the hood.
Notes on paintwork/matte finish paintwork
care
Observe the notes on cleaning and care to avoid
damaging the paintwork and interfering with the
driver assistance systems.
Paint
R Insect remains: soak with insect remover and
rinse off the treated areas afterwards.
R Bird droppings: soak with water and rinse off
afterwards.
R Tree resin, oils, fuels and greases: remove by
rubbing gently with a cloth soaked in petro‐
leum ether or lighter fluid.
R Coolant and brake fluid: remove with a damp
cloth and clean water.
R Tar stains: use tar remover.
R Wax: use silicone remover.
R
R
Do not attach stickers, films or similar mate‐
rials. Only have film attached to the bumper
at a qualified specialist workshop.
Remove dirt immediately, where possible.
Matte finish
Only use care products approved for
Mercedes-Benz.
R Do not attach stickers, films or similar mate‐
rials. Only have film attached to the bumper
at a qualified specialist workshop.
R Do not polish the vehicle and alloy wheels.
R Only use car washes that correspond to the
latest engineering standards.
R Do not use car wash programs with a final
hot wax treatment.
R Do not use paint cleaners, buffing or polish‐
ing products, gloss preservers, e.g. wax.
R
In the event of paintwork damage:
R Always have paintwork repairs carried out at
a qualified specialist workshop.
R Make sure the radar sensors function
(/ page 201).
332 Maintenance and care
Notes on cleaning decorative foils
Observe the notes on matte finish care in the
chapter "Notes on paintwork/matte finish paint‐
work care" (/ page 331). They also apply to
matte decorative foils.
Observe the notes on cleaning decorative foils to
avoid vehicle damage.
Cleaning
For cleaning, use plenty of water and a mild
cleaning agent without additives or abrasive
substances, e.g. a car shampoo approved for
Mercedes-Benz.
R Remove dirt immediately, where possible,
whilst avoiding rubbing too hard. There is
otherwise a risk of damaging the decorative
foil irreparably.
R If there is dirt on the finish or if the decora‐
tive foil is dull: use the Paint Cleaner recom‐
mended and approved for Mercedes-Benz.
R Insect remains: soak with insect remover and
rinse off the treated areas afterwards.
R Bird droppings: soak with water and rinse off
afterwards.
R
R
To prevent water stains, dry a foil-wrapped
vehicle with a soft, absorbent cloth after
every car wash.
Avoiding damage to the decorative foil
The service life and color of decorative foils
are impaired by:
Sunlight
Temperature, e.g. hot air blower
Weather conditions
Stone chippings and dirt
Chemical cleaning agents
Oily products
R Do not use polish on matte decorative foil.
Polishing will have the effect of shining the
foil-wrapped surface.
R Do not treat matte or structured decorative
foils with wax. Permanent stains may occur.
R
Scratches, corrosive deposits, areas affected by
corrosion and damage caused by incorrect care
cannot always be completely repaired. In such
cases, visit a qualified specialist workshop.
You can obtain more information on care and
cleaning products from the manufacturer.
In the case of foil-wrapped surfaces, optical dif‐
ferences may occur between the surfaces that
were not protected by a decorative foil after
removing a decorative foil.
% Have work or repairs to decorative foils car‐
ried out at a qualified specialist workshop,
e.g. at an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.
Notes on care of vehicle parts
& WARNING Risk of entrapment if the
windshield wipers are switched on while
the windshield is being cleaned
If the windshield wipers are set in motion
while you are cleaning the windshield or
wiper blades, you can be trapped by the
wiper arm.
# Always switch off the windshield wipers
and the ignition before cleaning the
windshield or wiper blades.
Maintenance and care 333
& WARNING Risk of burns from the tail‐
pipe and tailpipe trims
The exhaust tailpipe and tailpipe trims can
become very hot. If you come into contact
with these parts of the vehicle, you could
burn yourself.
# Always be particularly careful around
the tailpipe and the tailpipe trims and
supervise children especially closely in
this area.
# Allow vehicle parts to cool down before
touching them.
Observe the notes on cleaning and care of the
following vehicle parts to avoid damage.
Wheels/rims
R Use water and acid-free wheel cleaners.
R Do not use acidic wheel cleaners to remove
brake dust. This could damage wheel bolts
and brake components.
R To avoid corrosion of the brake discs and
brake pads, drive the vehicle for a few
minutes after cleaning before parking it. The
brake discs and brake pads warm up and dry
out.
Windows
Clean windows inside and outside with a
damp cloth and with a cleaning agent recom‐
mended for Mercedes-Benz.
R Do not use dry cloths or abrasive or solventbased cleaning agents to clean the inside of
windows.
R
Wiper blades
Fold out the wiper blades and clean them
using a damp cloth.
R Do not clean the wiper blades too often.
R
Exterior lighting
R Clean the lenses with a wet sponge and mild
cleaning agent, e.g. car shampoo.
R Only use cleaning agents or cleaning cloths
that are suitable for plastic lenses.
Sensors
R Clean the sensors in the front and rear
bumper and in the radiator grill with a soft
cloth and car shampoo.
R
When using a power washer, maintain a mini‐
mum distance of 11.8 in (30 cm).
Running boards
R Use water and acid-free cleaning agents.
R Do not clean the aluminum trim insert of the
running board with alkaline or acidic cleaning
agents such as wheel cleaners. Do not use
acidic wheel cleaners to remove brake dust.
The aluminum trim inserts could otherwise
be damaged.
Rear view camera and surround view camera
R Open the camera cover with the multimedia
system (/ page 255).
R Use clean water and a soft cloth to clean the
camera lens.
R Do not use a power washer.
Tailpipes
Clean with a cleaning agent recommended
for Mercedes-Benz, especially in the winter
and after washing the vehicle.
R Do not use acidic cleaning agents.
R
334 Maintenance and care
Trailer hitch
R Remove traces of rust on the ball, e.g. with a
wire brush.
R Remove dirt with a lint-free cloth.
R After cleaning, oil or grease the ball head
lightly.
R Observe the notes on care in the trailer hitch
manufacturer's operating instructions.
R Do not clean the ball neck with a power
washer or solvent.
Notes on care of the interior
& WARNING Risk of injury from plastic
parts breaking off after the use of sol‐
vent-based care products
Care and cleaning products containing sol‐
vents can cause surfaces in the cockpit to
become porous. When the airbags are
deployed, plastic parts may break away.
# Do not use any care or cleaning prod‐
ucts containing solvents to clean the
cockpit.
& WARNING Risk of injury or death from
bleached seat belts
Bleaching or dyeing seat belts can severely
weaken them.
This can, for example, cause seat belts to
tear or fail in an accident.
# Never bleach or dye seat belts.
Observe the notes on cleaning and care to avoid
vehicle damage.
Seat belts
R Clean with lukewarm and soapy water.
R Do not use chemical cleaning agents.
R Do not dry seat belts by heating them to over
176 °F (80 °C) or exposing them to direct
sunlight.
Display
Switch off the display and let it cool down.
R Clean the surface carefully with a microfiber
cloth and a suitable display care product
(TFT/LCD).
R Do not use any other agents.
R
Plastic trim
Clean with a damp microfiber cloth.
R For heavy soiling: use a care product recom‐
mended for Mercedes-Benz.
R Do not attach stickers, films or similar mate‐
rials.
R Do not allow cosmetics, insect repellent or
sun cream to come in contact with the plas‐
tic trim.
R
Real wood/trim elements
R Clean with a microfiber cloth.
R Black piano-lacquer look: clean with a damp
cloth and soapy water.
R For heavy soiling: use a care product recom‐
mended for Mercedes-Benz.
R Do not use solvent-based cleaning agents,
polishes or waxes.
Headliner
Clean with a brush or dry shampoo.
R
Carpet
Use a carpet and textile cleaning agent rec‐
ommended for Mercedes-Benz.
R
Maintenance and care 335
Genuine leather seat covers
R Clean with a damp cloth and then wipe with a
dry cloth.
R Leather care: use a leather care agent that
has been recommended for Mercedes-Benz.
R Do not allow the leather to become too
damp.
R Do not use a microfiber cloth.
DINAMICA seat covers
Clean with a damp cloth.
R Do not use a microfiber cloth.
R
Imitation leather seat covers
Clean with a damp cloth and 1% soapy water.
R Do not use a microfiber cloth.
R
Cloth seat covers
Clean with a damp microfiber cloth and 1%
soap solution and allow to dry.
R
336 Breakdown assistance
Emergency
Removing the safety vest
The safety vests are located in the safety vest
compartments in the driver's and front
passenger door stowage compartments.
Open safety vest bag 1 and remove the
safety vest.
% Additional safety vests can be stored in the
stowage space of the rear passenger com‐
partment and in the cargo compartment.
#
The requirements defined by the legal standard
are only fulfilled if the safety vest is the correct
size and is fully closed.
Replace the safety vest in the following cases:
R It is damaged or dirt on the reflective strips
can no longer be removed.
R The maximum number of washes is excee‐
ded.
R The fluorescence of the safety vest has
faded.
Warning triangle
Removing the warning triangle
#
To remove: pull out safety vest bag 1 by
loop 2.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
Maximum number of washes
Maximum wash temperature
Do not bleach
Do not iron
Do not tumble dry
Do not dry clean
This is a class 2 vest
Breakdown assistance 337
#
Remove warning triangle 1.
Setting up the warning triangle
#
#
Fold side reflectors 1 upwards to form a tri‐
angle and attach at the top using upper
press-stud 2.
Fold legs 3 down and out to the side.
First-aid kit (soft-sided) overview
All other vehicles
Mercedes‑Maybach vehicles
In the as-delivered state, the first-aid kit (soft
sided) is in the cargo compartment on the righthand side behind service flap 1.
Example: first-aid kit (soft sided)
In the as-delivered state, first-aid kit (soft sided)
1 is in the cargo compartment in the left-hand
or right-hand stowage compartment, depending
on the model.
338 Breakdown assistance
Flat tire
Notes in the event of a flat tire
& WARNING Risk of accident due to a flat
tire
A flat tire severely affects the driving charac‐
teristics as well as the steering and braking
of the vehicle.
Tires without run-flat characteristics:
# Do not drive with a flat tire.
# Change the flat tire immediately with an
emergency spare wheel or spare wheel.
Alternatively, consult a qualified spe‐
cialist workshop.
Tires with run-flat characteristics:
# Observe the information and warning
notes on MOExtended tires (run-flat
tire).
In the event of a flat tire, the following options
are available depending on your vehicle's equip‐
ment:
R Vehicles with MOExtended tires: it is pos‐
sible to continue the journey for a short
period of time. Make sure you observe the
notes on MOExtended tires (run-flat tires)
(/ page 338).
R Vehicles with a TIREFIT kit: you can repair
the tire so that it is possible to continue the
journey for a short period of time. To do this,
use the TIREFIT kit (/ page 339).
R Vehicles with Mercedes me connect: you
can make a call for breakdown assistance via
the overhead control panel in the case of a
breakdown (/ page 304).
R All vehicles: change the wheel
(/ page 379).
% The emergency spare wheel is only available
in certain countries.
Notes on MOExtended tires (run-flat tires)
& WARNING Risk of accident when driving
in limp-home mode
When driving in emergency mode the han‐
dling characteristics are impaired.
# Do not exceed the specified maximum
speed of the MOExtended tires.
# Avoid any abrupt steering and driving
maneuvers as well as driving over
obstacles (curbs, pot holes, off-road).
This applies, in particular, to a loaded
vehicle.
# Stop driving in the emergency mode if
you notice:
R Banging noise
R Vehicle vibration
R Smoke which smells like rubber
R Continuous ESP® intervention
R Cracks in the tire side walls
#
After driving in emergency mode, have
the rims checked by a qualified special‐
Breakdown assistance 339
#
ist workshop with regard to their further
use.
The defective tire must be replaced in
every case.
With MOExtended tires (run-flat tires), you can
continue to drive your vehicle even if there is a
total loss of pressure in one or more tires. How‐
ever, the tire affected must not show any clearly
visible damage.
You can recognize MOExtended tires by the
MOExtended marking which appears on the side
wall of the tire.
Vehicles with tire pressure monitoring sys‐
tem: MOExtended tires may only be used in con‐
junction with an activated tire pressure monitor‐
ing system.
If a pressure loss warning message appears in
the multifunction display, proceed as follows:
R Check the tires for damage.
R If driving on, observe the following notes.
Driving distance possible in emergency
mode after the pressure loss warning:
Load condition
Driving distance pos‐
sible in emergency
mode
Partially laden
50 miles (80 km)
Fully laden
19 miles (30 km)
The driving distance possible in emergency
mode may vary depending on the driving style.
Observe the maximum permissible speed of
50 mph (80 km/h).
If a tire has gone flat and cannot be replaced
with an MOExtended tire, you can use a stand‐
ard tire as a temporary measure.
TIREFIT kit storage location
The TIREFIT kit is located under the cargo com‐
partment floor.
Example: TIREFIT kit
1 Tire sealant bottle
2 Tire inflation compressor
Using the TIREFIT kit
Requirements:
R Tire sealant bottle and tire inflation compres‐
sor (/ page 339).
R TIREFIT sticker
R Gloves (depending on the vehicle equipment)
You can use TIREFIT tire sealant to seal perfora‐
tion damage of up to 0.16 in (4 mm), particularly
340 Breakdown assistance
those in the tire contact surface. You can use
TIREFIT in outside temperatures down to -4 °F
(-20 °C).
& WARNING Risk of accident when using
tire sealant
The tire sealant may be unable to seal the
tire properly, especially in the following
cases:
R There are cuts or punctures in the tire
larger than damage previously men‐
tioned.
R The wheel rim is damaged.
R You have driven at very low tire pressure
or on a flat tire.
#
#
Do not continue driving.
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
& WARNING Risk of injury and poisoning
from tire sealant
The tire sealant is harmful and causes irrita‐
tion. Do not allow it to come into contact
with the skin, eyes or clothing, and do not
swallow it. Do not inhale tire sealant fumes.
Keep the tire sealant away from children.
If you come into contact with the tire sealant,
observe the following:
# Rinse off the tire sealant from your skin
immediately using water.
# If tire sealant gets into your eyes, thor‐
oughly rinse out the eyes using clean
water.
# If tire sealant has been swallowed,
immediately rinse out the mouth thor‐
oughly and drink plenty of water. Do not
induce vomiting and seek medical
attention immediately.
# Change out of any clothes contamina‐
ted with tire sealant immediately.
# If allergic reactions occur, seek medical
attention immediately.
* NOTE Overheating due to the tire infla‐
tion compressor running too long
#
Do not run the tire inflation compressor
for longer than ten minutes without
interruption.
Comply with the manufacturer's safety notes on
the sticker on the tire inflation compressor.
Have the tire sealant bottle replaced in a quali‐
fied specialist workshop every five years.
# Do not remove any foreign objects which
have entered the tire.
Breakdown assistance 341
#
#
Affix part 1 of the TIREFIT sticker to the
instrument cluster within the driver's field of
vision.
Affix part 2 of the TIREFIT sticker near the
valve on the wheel with the faulty tire.
#
#
Push plug of hose 5 into flange 6 of tire
sealant bottle 1 until the plug engages.
Place tire sealant bottle 1 head downwards
into recess 2 of the tire inflation compres‐
sor.
#
Switch on the tire inflation compressor using
On/Off switch 3.
The tire is inflated. First, tire sealant is pum‐
ped into the tire. The pressure may briefly
rise to approximately 500 kPa (5 bar/73 psi).
Do not switch off the tire inflation compres‐
sor during this phase.
# Let the tire inflation compressor run for a
maximum of ten minutes.
The tire should then have attained a tire
pressure of at least 200 kPa (2.0 bar/
29 psi).
#
#
#
#
Pull plug 4 with cable and hose 5 out of
the tire inflation compressor housing.
#
Remove the cap from valve 7 on the faulty
tire.
Screw filling hose 8 onto valve 7.
Insert plug 4 into a 12 V socket in your
vehicle.
Switch on the ignition.
If tire sealant leaks out, make sure you clean the
affected area as quickly as possible. It is prefera‐
ble to use clean water.
If you get tire sealant on your clothing, have it
cleaned as soon as possible with perchloroethy‐
lene.
If, after ten minutes, a tire pressure of
200 kPa (2.0 bar/29 psi) has not been
attained:
# Switch off the tire inflation compressor.
342 Breakdown assistance
#
Unscrew the filling hose from the valve of the
faulty tire.
Please note that tire sealant may leak out when
unscrewing the filling hose.
# Drive forwards or reverse very slowly for
approximately 33 ft (10 m).
# Pump up the tire again.
After a maximum of ten minutes the tire
pressure must be at least 200 kPa (2.0 bar/
29 psi).
& WARNING Risk of accident due to the
specified tire pressure not being attained
If the minimum tire pressure is not reached
after the specified time, the tire is too badly
damaged. The tire sealant cannot repair the
tire in this instance.
The braking and driving characteristics may
be greatly impaired.
# Do not continue driving.
# Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
If, after ten minutes, a tire pressure of
200 kPa (2.0 bar/29 psi) has been attained:
# Switch off the tire inflation compressor.
# Unscrew the filling hose from the valve of the
faulty tire.
& WARNING Risk of accident from driving
with sealed tires
A tire temporarily sealed with tire sealant
impairs the handling characteristics and is
not suitable for higher speeds.
# Adapt your driving style accordingly and
drive carefully.
# Do not exceed the maximum speed
limit with a tire that has been repaired
using tire sealant.
#
Observe the maximum permissible speed for
a tire sealed with tire sealant 50 mph
(80 km/h).
* NOTE Staining caused by leaking tire
sealant
After use, excess tire sealant may leak out
from the filling hose.
# Therefore, place the filling hose in the
plastic bag that contained the TIREFIT
kit.
+ ENVIRONMENTAL NOTE Environmental
pollution caused by environmentally irre‐
sponsible disposal
Tire sealant contains pollutants.
# Have the tire sealant bottle disposed of
professionally, e.g. at an authorized
Mercedes-Benz Center.
#
#
Stow the tire sealant bottle and the tire infla‐
tion compressor.
Pull away immediately.
Breakdown assistance 343
#
Stop driving after approximately ten minutes
and check the tire pressure using the tire
inflation compressor.
The tire pressure must now be at least
130 kPa (1.3 bar/19 psi).
Battery (vehicle)
Notes on the 12 V battery
& WARNING Risk of an accident due to
work carried out incorrectly on the bat‐
tery
& WARNING Risk of accident due to the
specified tire pressure not being attained
If the specified tire pressure is not reached,
the tire is too badly damaged. The tire seal‐
ant cannot repair the tire in this instance.
The braking and driving characteristics may
be greatly impaired.
# Do not continue driving.
# Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
In cases such as the one mentioned above, con‐
tact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. Or
call 1-800-FOR-MERCedes (in the USA) or
1-800-387-0100 (in Canada).
# To increase the tire pressure: switch on
the tire inflation compressor.
#
#
#
#
#
To reduce the tire pressure: press pressure
release button 1 next to manometer 2.
When the tire pressure is correct, unscrew
the filling hose from the valve of the sealed
tire.
Screw the valve cap onto the valve of the
sealed tire.
Pull the tire sealant bottle out of the tire
inflation compressor.
The filling hose stays on the tire sealant bot‐
tle.
Drive to the nearest qualified specialist work‐
shop and have the tire, tire sealant bottle
and filling hose replaced there.
Work carried out incorrectly on the battery
can, for example, lead to a short circuit. This
can restrict functions relevant for safety sys‐
tems and impair the operating safety of your
vehicle.
You could lose control of the vehicle in the
following situations in particular:
R When braking
R In the event of abrupt steering maneuvers
and/or when the vehicle's speed is not
adapted to the road conditions
#
#
In the event of a short circuit or a simi‐
lar incident, contact a qualified special‐
ist workshop immediately.
Do not drive on.
344 Breakdown assistance
#
R
R
Always have work on the battery carried
out at a qualified specialist workshop.
Further information on ABS (/ page 203)
Further information on ESP® (/ page 203)
For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends
that you only use batteries which have been tes‐
ted and approved for your vehicle by MercedesBenz.
All vehicles except vehicles with a lithiumion battery
& WARNING Risk of explosion due to elec‐
trostatic charge
Electrostatic charge can ignite the highly
explosive gas mixture in the battery.
# To discharge any electrostatic charge
that may have built up, touch the metal
vehicle body before handling the bat‐
tery.
The highly flammable gas mixture is created
while the battery is charging and during starting
assistance.
All vehicles
+ ENVIRONMENTAL NOTE Environmental
damage caused by improper disposal of
batteries
& WARNING Danger of chemical burns
from the battery acid
Battery acid is caustic.
# Avoid contact with the skin, eyes or
clothing.
# Do not lean over the battery.
# Do not inhale battery gases.
# Keep children away from the battery.
# Immediately rinse battery acid off thor‐
oughly with plenty of clean water and
seek medical attention immediately.
Batteries contain pollutants. It is
illegal to dispose of them with the household
rubbish.
#
Dispose of batteries in an
environmentally responsible manner.
Take discharged batteries to a qualified
specialist workshop or to a collection
point for used batteries.
If you have to disconnect the 12 V battery, con‐
tact a qualified specialist workshop.
Comply with safety notes and take protective
measures when handling batteries.
Breakdown assistance 345
Risk of explosion.
Fire, open flames and smoking are
prohibited when handling the battery.
Avoid creating sparks.
Electrolyte or battery acid is corro‐
sive. Avoid contact with the skin, eyes
or clothing. Wear suitable protective
clothing, in particular gloves, an
apron and a face mask. Immediately
rinse electrolyte or acid splashes off
with clean water. Consult a doctor if
necessary.
Wear safety glasses.
Keep children away.
Observe this Operator's Manual.
Observe the following if you do not intend to use
the vehicle over an extended period of time:
R Activate standby mode.
R Alternatively: connect the battery to a bat‐
tery charger approved by Mercedes-Benz or
consult a qualified specialist workshop to
disconnect the battery.
Notes on starting assistance and charging
the 12 V battery
Vehicles with a lithium-ion battery
When charging the battery and during starting
assistance, always use the jump-start connec‐
tion point in the engine compartment.
* NOTE Damaging the battery through
overvoltage
When charging using a battery charger with‐
out a maximum charging voltage, the battery
or the vehicle electronics may be damaged.
# Only use battery chargers with a maxi‐
mum charging voltage of 14.8 V.
All other vehicles
When charging the battery and during starting
assistance, always use the jump-start connec‐
tion point in the engine compartment.
* NOTE Damaging the battery through
overvoltage
When charging using a battery charger with‐
out a maximum charging voltage, the battery
or the vehicle electronics may be damaged.
# Only use battery chargers with a maxi‐
mum charging voltage of 14.8 V.
346 Breakdown assistance
& WARNING Risk of explosion from hydro‐
gen gas igniting
& WARNING Risk of explosion during
charging process and starting assistance
There is a danger of hydrogen gas igniting
when charging the battery if there is a short
circuit or sparks start to form.
# Make sure that the positive terminal of
the connected battery does not come
into contact with vehicle parts.
# Never place metal objects or tools on a
battery.
# The described order of the battery
clamps must be observed when con‐
necting and disconnecting the battery.
# When giving starting assistance, always
make sure that you only connect bat‐
tery terminals with identical polarity.
# During starting assistance, you must
observe the described order for con‐
necting and disconnecting the jumper
cable.
# Do not connect or disconnect the bat‐
tery clamps while the engine is running.
During the charging process and starting
assistance, the battery may release an explo‐
sive gas mixture.
# Avoid fire, open flames, creating sparks
and smoking.
# Make sure there is sufficient ventila‐
tion.
# Do not lean over a battery.
& WARNING Risk of explosion from a fro‐
zen battery
A discharged battery may freeze at tempera‐
tures slightly above or below freezing point.
During starting assistance or battery charg‐
ing, battery gas can be released.
# Always allow a battery to thaw before
charging it or performing starting assis‐
tance.
If the indicator/warning lamps in the instrument
cluster do not light up at low temperatures, it is
very likely that the discharged battery has fro‐
zen. In this case you may neither jump-start the
vehicle nor charge the battery.
The service life of a battery that has been
thawed may be dramatically shortened. The
starting characteristics may be impaired, espe‐
cially at low temperatures.
It is recommended that you have a thawed bat‐
tery checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
All vehicles
* NOTE Damage caused by numerous or
extended attempts to start the engine
Numerous or extended attempts to start the
engine may damage the catalytic converter
due to non-combusted fuel.
# Avoid numerous and extended attempts
to start the engine.
Breakdown assistance 347
Observe the following points during starting
assistance and when charging the battery:
R Only use undamaged jumper cables/charg‐
ing cables with a sufficient cross-section and
insulated terminal clamps.
R Non-insulated parts of the terminal clamps
must not come into contact with other metal
parts while the jumper cables/charging
cable is connected to the battery/jump-start
connection point.
R The jumper cable/charging cable must not
come into contact with any parts which may
move when the engine is running.
R Always make sure that neither you nor the
battery is electrostatically charged.
R Keep away from fire and open flames.
R Do not lean over the battery.
Observe the additional following points when
charging the battery:
R Only use battery chargers tested and
approved for Mercedes-Benz.
R Read the battery charger's operating instruc‐
tions before charging the battery.
Observe the additional following points during
starting assistance:
R Starting assistance may only be provided
using vehicles, batteries or other jump start
devices with a nominal voltage of 12 V.
R The vehicles must not touch.
R Vehicles with a gasoline engine: Jumpstart the vehicle only when the engine and
exhaust system are cold.
Starting assistance and charging the 12 V
battery
Requirements:
R The vehicle is secured with the electric park‐
ing brake.
R Vehicles with automatic transmission:
The transmission is in position j.
R The ignition and all electrical consumers are
switched off.
R The hood is open.
Example: engine compartment
#
#
Slide cover 1 of positive clamp 2 on the
jump-starting connection point in the direc‐
tion of the arrow.
Connect positive clamp 2 on your vehicle to
the positive pole of the donor battery using
the jumper cable/charging cable. Always
348 Breakdown assistance
#
#
#
#
#
#
begin with positive clamp 2 on your own
vehicle first.
During starting assistance: start the
engine of the donor vehicle and run at idle
speed.
Connect the negative pole of the donor bat‐
tery and ground point 3 of your own vehicle
by using the jumper cable/charging cable.
Begin with the donor battery first.
During starting assistance: start the
engine of your own vehicle.
During the charging process: start the
charging process.
During starting assistance: let the engines
run for several minutes.
During starting assistance: before discon‐
necting the jumper cable, switch on an elec‐
trical consumer in your own vehicle, e.g. the
rear window heater or lighting.
When the starting assistance/charging process
is complete, perform the following steps:
#
#
First, remove the jumper cable/charging
cable from ground point 3 and the negative
pole of the donor battery, then from positive
clamp 2 and the positive pole of the donor
battery. Begin each time with the contacts
on your own vehicle first.
After removing the jumper cable/charging
cable, close cover 1 of positive clamp 2.
Further information can be obtained at a quali‐
fied specialist workshop.
Replacing the 12 V battery
#
Observe the notes on the 12 V battery
(/ page 343).
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you have the
12 V battery replaced at a qualified specialist
workshop, e.g. at an authorized Mercedes-Benz
Center.
Observe the following notes if you want to
replace the battery yourself:
R Always replace a faulty battery with a battery
which meets the specific vehicle require‐
ments.
The vehicle is equipped with an AGM technol‐
ogy battery (Absorbent Glass Mat) or a lith‐
ium-ion battery. Full vehicle functionality is
only guaranteed with an AGM battery or lith‐
ium-ion battery. For safety reasons,
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only
use batteries which have been tested and
approved for your vehicle by Mercedes-Benz.
R Carry over detachable parts, such as vent
hoses, elbow fitting or terminal covers from
the battery being replaced.
R Make sure that the vent hose is always con‐
nected to the original opening on the side of
the battery.
Install any existing or supplied cell caps.
Otherwise, gases or battery acid could
escape.
R Make sure that detachable parts are recon‐
nected in the same way.
Breakdown assistance 349
Tow starting or towing away
Permitted towing methods
R
R
* NOTE Damage from automatic braking
If one of the following functions is switched
on, the vehicle brakes automatically in cer‐
tain situations:
R Active Brake Assist
R Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC
HOLD function
Active Parking Assist
To avoid damage to the vehicle, deactivate
these systems in the following or similar sit‐
uations:
# During towing
# In a car wash
For towing, use a tow rope or tow bar with both
axles on the ground. Do not use tow bar sys‐
tems.
* NOTE Damage to the vehicle due to tow‐
ing away incorrectly
#
Observe the instructions and notes on
towing away.
Mercedes-Benz recommends transporting your
vehicle in the case of a breakdown, rather than
towing it away.
Permitted towing methods
Vehicle equipment/towing
method
4MATIC vehicles
Both axles on the ground
Front axle raised
Rear axle raised
Yes, maximum 31 miles (50 km) at
31 mph (50 km/h)
No
No
350 Breakdown assistance
Towing away the vehicle with both axles on
the ground
#
#
Observe the notes on the permitted towing
methods (/ page 349).
Make sure that the battery is connected and
charged.
A discharged battery has the following effects:
R The engine cannot be started
R The electric parking brake cannot be
released or applied
R The automatic transmission cannot be shif‐
ted to position i or j
% If the automatic transmission cannot be shif‐
ted to position i, or the multifunction dis‐
play in the instrument cluster does not show
anything, the vehicle must be transported
away (/ page 351). A towing vehicle with
lifting equipment is required for vehicle
transportation.
* NOTE Damage due to towing away at
excessively high speeds or over long dis‐
tances
The drivetrain could be damaged when tow‐
ing at excessively high speeds or over long
distances.
# A towing speed of 30 mph (50 km/h)
must not be exceeded.
# A towing distance of 30 miles (50 km)
must not be exceeded.
& WARNING Risk of accident when towing
a vehicle which is too heavy
If the vehicle being tow-started or towed
away is heavier than the permissible gross
mass of your vehicle, the following situations
can occur:
R The towing eye may become detached.
R The vehicle/trailer combination may
swerve or even overturn.
#
If another vehicle is tow-started or
towed away, its weight must not exceed
the permissible gross mass of your own
vehicle.
#
#
#
#
Information on the permissible gross mass of
the vehicle can be found on the vehicle iden‐
tification plate (/ page 392).
Do not open the driver's door or front
passenger door as the automatic transmis‐
sion may otherwise shift to position j auto‐
matically.
Install the towing eye (/ page 353).
Fasten the tow bar.
* NOTE Damage due to incorrect connec‐
tion of the tow bar
#
Only connect the tow rope or tow bar to
the towing eyes.
% You can also attach the tow bar to the trailer
hitch.
# Deactivate the automatic locking mechanism
(/ page 72).
# Do not activate the HOLD function.
Breakdown assistance 351
#
#
#
#
Deactivate the tow-away alarm (/ page 92).
Deactivate Active Brake Assist (/ page 211).
Shift the automatic transmission to position
i(/ page 186).
Release the electric parking brake.
& WARNING Risk of accident due to limi‐
ted safety-related functions during the
towing process
Safety-related functions are limited or no lon‐
ger available in the following situations:
R the ignition is switched off.
R the brake system or power steering sys‐
tem is malfunctioning.
R the energy supply or the on-board electri‐
cal system is malfunctioning.
When your vehicle is then towed away, signif‐
icantly more effort may be required to steer
and brake than is normally required.
# Use a tow bar.
#
Make sure that the steering wheel can
move freely, before towing the vehicle
away.
* NOTE Damage due to excessive tractive
power
If you pull away sharply, the tractive power
may be too high and the vehicles could be
damaged.
# Pull away slowly and smoothly.
Loading the vehicle for transport
#
#
Observe the notes on towing away
(/ page 350).
Connect the tow bar to the towing eye in
order to load the vehicle.
% You can also attach the tow bar to the trailer
hitch.
# Shift the automatic transmission to position
i.
% The automatic transmission may be locked
in position j in the event of damage to the
electrics. To shift to i, provide the onboard electrical system with power
(/ page 347).
# Load the vehicle onto the transporter.
# Shift the automatic transmission to position
j.
# Use the electric parking brake to secure the
vehicle against rolling away.
# Only secure the vehicle by the wheels.
Vehicles with ADS PLUS (Adaptive Damping
System PLUS)
& WARNING Risk of an accident when
transporting vehicles with Adaptive
Damping System PLUS
The reduced damping forces on the vehicle
being transported can cause the vehicle/
trailer combination to start to swing.
As a result, when transporting vehicles with
the Adaptive Damping System PLUS, the
352 Breakdown assistance
vehicle/trailer combination may start to skid.
Consequently, you could lose control of your
vehicle.
# When transporting, ensure that:
R The vehicle has been loaded onto
the transporter correctly
R The vehicle is secured at all four
wheels with suitable tensioning
straps
R The maximum permissible speed of
35 mph (60 km/h) is not exceeded
when transporting
* NOTE Damage to the vehicle from secur‐
ing it incorrectly
#
#
After loading, the vehicle must be
secured on all four wheels. Otherwise,
the vehicle could be damaged.
A minimum distance of 8 in (20 cm)
upwards and 4 in (10 cm) downwards
must be kept to the transport platform.
#
Secure the vehicle on all four wheels after
loading.
Towing eye storage location
4MATIC vehicles/vehicles with automatic
transmission
Example: towing eye
#
Make sure that the front and rear axles come
to rest on the same transportation vehicle.
* NOTE Damage to the drivetrain due to
incorrect positioning
#
Do not position the vehicle above the
connection point of the transport vehi‐
cle.
Towing eye 1 is located under the cargo com‐
partment floor.
Breakdown assistance 353
Installing the towing eye
towing eye. Fasten the tow bar to the trailer
hitch.
% Make sure that cover 1 engages in the
bumper when you remove the towing eye.
* NOTE Damage to the vehicle due to
incorrect use of the towing eye
When a towing eye is used to recover a vehi‐
cle, the vehicle may be damaged in the proc‐
ess.
# Only use the towing eye to tow away or
tow start the vehicle.
Tow starting the vehicle (emergency engine
start)
#
#
Press the mark on cover 1 inwards and
remove.
Screw in the towing eye clockwise as far as it
will go and tighten.
Vehicles with a trailer hitch: Vehicles with a
trailer hitch do not have a rear bracket for the
Vehicles with automatic transmission
* NOTE Damage to the automatic trans‐
mission due to tow starting
The automatic transmission may be damaged
in the process of tow starting vehicles with
automatic transmission.
#
#
Vehicles with automatic transmission
must not be tow started.
Vehicles with automatic transmission must
not be tow-started.
Electrical fuses
Notes on electrical fuses
& WARNING Risk of accident and injury
due to overloaded lines
If you manipulate or bridge a faulty fuse or if
you replace it with a fuse with a higher
amperage, the electric line could be overloa‐
ded.
This could result in a fire.
# Always replace faulty fuses with speci‐
fied new fuses containing the correct
amperage.
354 Breakdown assistance
* NOTE Damage due to incorrect fuses
Electrical components or systems may be
damaged by incorrect fuses, or their func‐
tionality may be significantly impaired.
# Only use fuses that have been approved
by Mercedes-Benz and which have the
correct fuse rating.
Blown fuses must be replaced with fuses of the
same rating, which you can recognize by the
color and fuse rating. The fuse ratings and fur‐
ther information to be observed can be found in
the fuse assignment diagram.
Fuse assignment diagram: on the fuse box in
the cargo compartment (/ page 355).
* NOTE Damage or malfunctions caused
by moisture
Moisture may cause damage to the electrical
system or cause it to malfunction.
#
#
When the fuse box is open, make sure
that no moisture can enter the fuse
box.
When closing the fuse box, make sure
that the seal of the lid is positioned cor‐
rectly on the fuse box.
If the newly inserted fuse also blows, have the
cause traced and rectified at a qualified special‐
ist workshop.
Ensure the following before replacing a fuse:
R The vehicle is secured against rolling away.
R All electrical consumers are switched off.
R The ignition is switched off.
The electrical fuses are located in various fuse
boxes:
R Fuse box in the engine compartment on the
left-hand side of the vehicle, when viewed in
the direction of travel (/ page 354)
R Fuse box on the driver's side of the cockpit
(/ page 355)
R
R
Fuse box in the front passenger footwell
(/ page 355)
Fuse box in the cargo compartment on the
right-hand side of the vehicle, when viewed
in the direction of travel (/ page 355)
Opening and closing the fuse box in the
engine compartment
Requirement:
R You need a dry cloth and a screwdriver.
Observe the notes on electrical fuses
(/ page 353).
Opening
& WARNING Risk of injury from using the
windshield wipers while the engine hood
is open
When the engine hood is open and the wind‐
shield wipers are set in motion, you can be
trapped by the wiper linkage.
Breakdown assistance 355
#
Always switch off the windshield wipers
and ignition before opening the engine
hood.
Closing
Check whether the seal is positioned cor‐
rectly in the lid.
# Insert the lid into the bracket at the rear of
the fuse box.
# Fold down the lid of the fuse box and tighten
screws 2.
# Close the hood.
#
Opening and closing the fuse box in the
cargo compartment
Observe the notes on electrical fuses
(/ page 353).
# Open the side cover.
Opening and closing the fuse box in the
cockpit
The fuse box is on the side of the dashboard
under a cover.
# Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Cen‐
ter for further information.
#
#
Remove any existing moisture from the fuse
box using a dry cloth.
Loosen screws 2 and remove fuse box lid
1 from the top.
Opening and closing the fuse box in the front
passenger footwell
#
Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Cen‐
ter for further information.
#
Remove cover 1.
The fuse allocation chart is on the side of the
fuse box.
356 Wheels and tires
Notes on noise or unusual handling charac‐
teristics
Make sure there are no vibrations, noises or
unusual handling characteristics when the vehi‐
cle is in motion. This may indicate that the
wheels or tires are damaged. Hidden tire dam‐
age could also be causing the unusual handling
characteristics.
If you suspect that a tire is malfunctioning,
reduce your speed immediately and have the
tires and wheels checked at a qualified specialist
workshop.
Notes on regularly inspecting wheels and
tires
& WARNING Risk of injury through dam‐
aged tires
Damaged tires can cause tire pressure loss.
# Check the tires regularly for signs of
damage and replace any damaged tires
immediately.
& WARNING Risk of hydroplaning due to
insufficient tire tread
R
Insufficient tire tread will result in reduced
tire grip.
In heavy rain or slush the risk of hydroplaning
is increased, in particular where speed is not
adapted to suit the conditions.
# Thus, you should regularly check the
tread depth and the condition of the
tread across the entire width of all tires.
R
R
Visually inspect wheels and tires for damage.
Check the valve caps.
Visual check of the tire tread depth and the
tire contact surface across the entire width.
The minimum tread depth for summer tires is
â in (3 mm) and for winter tires ã in
(4 mm).
Minimum tread depth for:
R Summer tires: â in (3 mm)
R M+S tires: ãin (4 mm)
#
For safety reasons, replace the tires
before the legally-prescribed limit for
the minimum tread depth is reached.
Carry out the following checks on all wheels reg‐
ularly, at least once a month or as required, for
example, prior to a long journey or driving offroad:
R Check the tire pressure (/ page 357).
Six marks 1 show where the bar indicators
(arrow) are integrated into the tire tread. They
are visible once a tread depth of approximately
á in (1.6 mm) has been reached.
Wheels and tires 357
Notes on snow chains
& WARNING Risk of accident due to incor‐
rect mounting of snow chains
If you have mounted snow chains to the front
wheels, the snow chains may drag against
the vehicle body or chassis components.
This could cause damage to the vehicle or
the tires.
# Never mount snow chains on the front
wheels.
# Only mount snow chains on the rear
wheels in pairs.
* NOTE Damage to components of the
vehicle body or chassis due to fitted
snow chains
If you fit snow chains to the front wheels of
4MATIC vehicles, you may damage compo‐
nents of the vehicle body or chassis.
# Only fit snow chains to the rear wheels
of 4MATIC vehicles.
R
R
R
R
R
Snow chains are only permissible for certain
wheel/tire combinations. You can obtain
information about this from an authorized
Mercedes-Benz Center.
For safety reasons, only use snow chains that
have been specifically approved for your
vehicle by Mercedes-Benz, or snow chains
with the same quality standard.
If snow chains are installed, the maximum
permissible speed is 30 mph (50 km/h).
Vehicles with Active Parking Assist: Do
not use Active Parking Assist when snow
chains are installed.
Vehicles with AIRMATIC or E-ACTIVE
BODY CONTROL: If snow chains are instal‐
led, only drive at raised vehicle level .
% You can deactivate ESP® to pull away
(/ page 205). This allows the wheels to
spin, achieving an increased driving force.
Tire pressure
Notes on tire pressure
& WARNING Risk of accident due to insuf‐
ficient or excessive tire pressure
Underinflated or overinflated tires pose the
following risks:
R The tires may burst, especially as the
load and vehicle speed increase.
R The tires may wear excessively and/or
unevenly, which may greatly impair tire
traction.
R The driving characteristics, as well as
steering and braking, may be greatly
impaired.
#
R
R
Comply with the recommended tire
pressure and check the tire pressure of
all tires including the spare wheel regu‐
larly:
at least once a month
when the load changes
358 Wheels and tires
R
before embarking on a longer journey
if operating conditions change, e.g. offroad driving
#
Adjust the tire pressure as necessary.
R
Tire pressure which is too high or too low can:
R Shorten the service life of the tires.
R Cause increased tire damage.
R Adversely affect driving characteristics and
thus driving safety, e.g. due to hydroplaning.
& WARNING Risk of an accident due to
insufficient tire pressure
Tires with pressure that is too low can over‐
heat and burst as a result.
In addition, they also suffer from excessive
and/or irregular wear, which can significantly
impair the braking properties and the han‐
dling characteristics.
# Avoid excessively low tire pressures in
all the tires, including the spare wheel.
Tire pressure which is too low can cause:
Tire malfunctions as a result of overheating
R Impaired handling characteristics
R Irregular wear
R Increased fuel consumption
R
& WARNING Risk of accident from exces‐
sive tire pressure
Tires with excessively high pressure can
burst because they are damaged more easily
by highway fill, pot holes etc.
In addition, they also suffer from irregular
wear, which can significantly impair the brak‐
ing properties and the handling characteris‐
tics.
# Avoid excessively high tire pressures in
all the tires, including the spare wheel.
Tire pressure which is too high can cause:
R Increased braking distance
R Impaired handling characteristics
R Irregular wear
R
R
Impaired driving comfort
Susceptibility to damage
& WARNING Risk of accident caused by
repeated drop in tire pressure
If the tire pressure drops repeatedly, the
wheel, valve or tire may be damaged.
Insufficient tire pressure can cause the tires
to burst.
# Inspect the tire for signs of foreign
objects.
# Check whether the wheel or valve has a
leak.
# If you are unable to rectify the damage,
contact a qualified specialist workshop.
You can find information on tire pressure for the
vehicle's factory-installed tires on the following
labels:
R Tire and Loading Information placard on the
B‑pillar of your vehicle (/ page 363).
R Tire pressure table on the inside of the fuel
filler flap (/ page 359).
Wheels and tires 359
Observe the maximum tire pressure
(/ page 369).
Use a suitable pressure gauge to check the tire
pressure. The outer appearance of a tire does
not permit any reliable conclusion about the tire
pressure.
Only correct tire pressure when the tires are
cold. Conditions for cold tires:
R The vehicle has been parked with the tires
out of direct sunlight for at least three hours.
R The vehicle has traveled less than 1 mile
(1.6 km).
The vehicle's tires heat up when driving. As the
temperature of the tires increases, so too does
the tire pressure.
Vehicles with a tire pressure monitoring sys‐
tem: You can also check the tire pressure using
the on-board computer.
The tire pressure recommended for increased
load/speed in the tire pressure table can affect
the ride comfort.
& WARNING Risk of accident due to
unsuitable accessories on tire valve
If you mount unsuitable accessories onto tire
valves, the tire valves may be overloaded and
malfunction, which can cause a loss of tire
pressure. Aftermarket tire pressure monitor‐
ing systems will cause the tire valve to
remain open, depending on the design. This
can also result in a loss of tire pressure.
# Only screw standard valve caps or valve
caps specifically approved by
Mercedes-Benz for your vehicle onto
the tire valve.
Notes on towing a trailer
Always inflate the rear axle tires to the recom‐
mended tire pressure on the tire pressure table
for increased load.
Tire pressure table
The tire pressure table is on the inside of the
fuel filler flap.
% The data shown in the images is example
data.
If one or more tire sizes precede a tire pressure,
the following tire pressure information is only
valid for those tire sizes and their respective
load condition.
The load conditions "partially laden" and "fully
laden" are defined in the table for different num‐
bers of passengers and amounts of luggage. The
actual number of seats may differ from this.
360 Wheels and tires
Checking tire pressures manually
R
Read the tire pressure for the current operat‐
ing conditions from the Tire and Loading
Information placard or the tire pressure
table. Observe the notes on tire pressure.
# Remove the valve cap of the tire to be
checked.
# Press the tire pressure gauge securely onto
the valve.
# Read the tire pressure.
# If the tire pressure is lower than the recom‐
mended value, increase the tire pressure to
the recommended value.
# If the tire pressure is higher than the recom‐
mended value, release air. To do so, press
down the metal pin in the valve, e.g. using
the tip of a pen for example. Then check the
tire pressure again using the tire pressure
gauge.
# Screw the valve cap onto the valve.
Further related subjects:
R Notes on tire pressure (/ page 357)
R
#
Some tire pressure tables only show the rim
diameter instead of the complete tire size, e.g.
R18. The rim diameter is part of the tire size and
can be found on the tire side wall (/ page 370).
R Tire and Loading Information placard
(/ page 363)
R Maximum tire pressure (/ page 369)
Tire pressure table (/ page 359)
Tire and Loading Information placard
(/ page 363)
Tire pressure monitoring system
Function of the tire pressure monitoring sys‐
tem
& DANGER Risk of accident due to incor‐
rect tire pressure
Each tire, including the spare (if provided),
should be checked monthly when cold and
inflated to the inflation pressure recommen‐
ded by the vehicle manufacturer on the vehi‐
cle placard or tire inflation pressure label. (If
your vehicle has tires of a different size than
the size indicated on the vehicle placard or
tire inflation pressure label, you should deter‐
mine the proper tire inflation pressure for
those tires.)
As an added safety feature, your vehicle has
been equipped with a tire pressure monitor‐
ing system (TPMS) that illuminates a low tire
Wheels and tires 361
pressure telltale when one or more of your
tires is significantly under-inflated. Accord‐
ingly, when the low tire pressure telltale illu‐
minates, you should stop and check your
tires as soon as possible, and inflate them to
the proper pressure. Driving on a signifi‐
cantly under-inflated tire causes the tire to
overheat and can lead to tire failure. Underinflation also reduces fuel efficiency and tire
tread life, and may affect the vehicle's han‐
dling and stopping ability. Please note that
the TPMS is not a substitute for proper tire
maintenance, and it is the driver's responsi‐
bility to maintain correct tire pressure, even
if under-inflation has not reached the level to
trigger illumination of the TPMS low tire pres‐
sure telltale.
Your vehicle has also been equipped with a
TPMS malfunction indicator to indicate that
the system is not operating properly. The
TPMS malfunction indicator is combined with
the low tire pressure telltale. When the sys‐
tem detects a malfunction, the indicator
lamp will flash for approximately one minute
and then remain continuously illuminated.
This sequence will continue upon subsequent
vehicle start-ups as long as the malfunction
exists.
When the malfunction indicator is illumina‐
ted, the system may not be able to detect or
signal low tire pressure as intended. TPMS
malfunctions may occur for a variety of rea‐
sons, including the installation of replace‐
ment or alternate tires or wheels on the vehi‐
cle that prevent the TPMS from functioning
properly.
Always check the TPMS malfunction telltale
after replacing one or more tires or wheels
on your vehicle to ensure that the replace‐
ment or alternate tires and wheels allow the
TPMS to continue to function properly.
The system checks the tire pressure and the tire
temperature of the tires installed to the vehicle
by means of a tire pressure sensor.
The tire pressure and the tire temperature
appear in the multifunction display
(/ page 362).
If there is a substantial pressure loss or if the
tire temperature is excessive, you will be warned
in the following ways:
R via display messages (/ page 455)
R via the h warning lamp in the instrument
cluster (/ page 472)
The tire pressure monitoring system is only an
aid. It is the driver's responsibility to set the tire
pressure to the recommended cold tire pressure
suitable for the operating situation.
In most cases, the tire pressure monitoring sys‐
tem will automatically update the new reference
values after you have changed the tire pressure.
You can, however, also update the reference val‐
ues by restarting the tire pressure monitoring
system manually (/ page 362).
System limits
The system may be impaired or may not function
in the following situations:
R the tire pressure has been set incorrectly
R there is a sudden pressure loss caused, for
example, by a foreign object penetrating the
tire
362 Wheels and tires
there is a malfunction caused by another
radio signal source
R
Checking the tire pressure with the tire pres‐
sure monitoring system
Requirements:
R The ignition is switched on.
R
R
On-board computer:
4 Service 5 Tires
One of the following displays appears:
R Current tire pressure and tire temperature of
the individual wheels:
Tire pressure will be displayed after driving a
few minutes
Tire Pressure Monitor Active: the teach-in
process of the system is not yet complete.
The tire pressures are already being moni‐
tored.
Compare the tire pressure with the recom‐
mended tire pressure for the current operat‐
ing condition (/ page 359). Observe the
notes on tire temperature (/ page 357).
% The values displayed in the multifunction dis‐
play may deviate from those of the tire pres‐
sure gauge as they refer to sea level. At high
altitudes, the tire pressure value indicated by
a pressure gauge are higher than those
shown by the on-board computer. In this
case, do not reduce the tire pressure.
#
Restarting the tire pressure monitoring sys‐
tem
Requirements:
R The recommended tire pressure is correctly
set for the respective operating status on all
of the wheels (/ page 357).
Restart the tire pressure monitoring system in
the following situations:
R The tire pressure has changed.
R The wheels or tires have been changed or
newly installed.
On-board computer:
4 Service 5 Tires
# Swipe downwards on Touch Control on the
left-hand side of the steering wheel.
The Use Current Pressures as New Reference Values message is shown in the multi‐
function display.
# To restart, press Touch Control on the lefthand side of the steering wheel.
The Tire Press. Monitor Restarted message is
shown in the multifunction display.
Current warning messages are deleted and
the yellow h warning lamp goes out.
After you have been driving for a few
minutes, the system checks whether the cur‐
rent tire pressures are within the specified
range. The current tire pressures are then
accepted as reference values and monitored.
Wheels and tires 363
Be sure to also pay attention to the following
related topic:
R Notes on tire pressure (/ page 357)
The Tire and Loading Information placard is on
the B-pillar on the driver's side of the vehicle.
Loading the vehicle
Notes on Tire and Loading Information plac‐
ard
& WARNING Risk of accident from overloa‐
ded tires
Overloaded tires may overheat and burst as a
consequence. Overloaded tires can also
impair the steering and handling characteris‐
tics and lead to brake failure.
# Observe the load-bearing capacity of
the tires.
# The load-bearing capacity must be at
least half the gross axle weight rating of
the vehicle.
# Never overload the tires by exceeding
the maximum load.
1 Tire and Loading Information placard
% The data shown in the illustration is example
data.
The Tire and Loading Information placard shows:
R Maximum number of seats 2 according to
the maximum number of people permitted to
travel in the vehicle.
R Maximum permissible load 3 comprises the
gross weight of all vehicle occupants, load
and luggage.
364 Wheels and tires
R
Recommended tire pressures 1 for cold
tires. The recommended tire pressures are
valid for the maximum permissible load and
up to the maximum permissible vehicle
speed.
Please also note:
R Information on permissible weights and loads
on the vehicle identification plate
(/ page 392).
R Information on tire pressure in the tire pres‐
sure table (/ page 359).
#
#
#
#
Further related subjects:
R Determining the maximum permissible load
(/ page 364)
R Notes on tire pressure (/ page 357).
Steps for Determining Correct Load Limit
The following steps have been developed as
required of all manufacturers under Title 49,
Code of U.S. Federal Regulations, Part 575, pur‐
suant to the "National Traffic and Motor Vehicle
Safety Act of 1966".
#
#
(1): Locate the statement "The combined
weight of occupants and cargo should never
exceed XXX kg or XXX lbs." on your vehicle's
placard.
(2): Determine the combined weight of the
driver and passengers that will be riding in
your vehicle.
(3): Subtract the combined weight of the
driver and passengers from XXX kg or
XXX lbs.
(4): The resulting figure equals the available
amount of cargo and luggage load capacity.
For example, if the "XXX" amount equals
1400 lbs. and there will be five 150 lb pas‐
sengers in your vehicle, the amount of availa‐
ble cargo and luggage load capacity is
650 lbs. (1400 - 750 (5 x 150) = 650 lbs.)
(5): Determine the combined weight of lug‐
gage and cargo being loaded on the vehicle.
The weight may not safely exceed the availa‐
ble cargo and luggage load capacity calcula‐
ted in Step 4.
(6): If your vehicle will be towing a trailer,
load from your trailer will be transferred to
your vehicle. Consult this manual to deter‐
mine how this reduces the available cargo
and luggage load capacity of your vehicle.
% Not all vehicles are permitted to tow a
trailer. Towing a trailer is only permitted if a
trailer-hitch is installed. Please consult an
authorized Mercedes-Benz dealer if you have
any questions about towing a trailer with
your vehicle.
Even if you have calculated the total load care‐
fully, you should still make sure that the maxi‐
mum permissible gross weight and the maxi‐
mum gross axle weight rating of your vehicle are
not exceeded. Details can be found on the vehi‐
cle identification plate.
# Have your loaded vehicle – including driver,
occupants and load – weighed on a vehicle
weighbridge.
The measured values may not exceed the
maximum permissible values stated on the
vehicle identification plate.
Further related subjects:
R Calculation example for determining the max‐
imum load (/ page 365)
Wheels and tires 365
R
R
R
Tire and Loading Information placard
(/ page 363)
Tire pressure table (/ page 359)
Vehicle identification plate
Calculation example for determining the
maximum load
The following table shows examples of how to
calculate total and load capacities with varying
seating configurations and different numbers
and sizes of occupants. The following examples
use a maximum load of 1500 lbs (680 kg). This
is for illustration purposes only. Make sure
you are using the actual load limit for your vehi‐
cle stated on your vehicle's Tire and Loading
Information placard (/ page 363).
The higher the weight of all the occupants, the
smaller the maximum load for luggage.
Step 1
Example 1
Example 2
1500 lbs (680 kg)
1500 lbs (680 kg)
Example 1
Example 2
Number of people in the vehicle (driver and
occupants)
5
1
Distribution of the occupants
Front: 2
Rear: 3
Front: 1
Combined maximum weight of occupants and
load (data from the Tire and Loading Information
placard)
Step 2
366 Wheels and tires
Example 1
Example 2
Weight of occupants
Occupant 1: 150 lbs (68 kg)
Occupant 2: 180 lbs (82 kg)
Occupant 3: 160 lbs (73 kg)
Occupant 4: 140 lbs (63 kg)
Occupant 5: 120 lbs (54 kg)
Occupant 1: 200 lbs (91 kg)
Total weight of all occupants
750 lbs (340 kg)
200 lbs (91 kg)
Example 1
Example 2
1500 lbs (680 kg) Ò 750 lbs (340 kg) = 750 lbs
(340 kg)
1500 lbs (680 kg) Ò 200 lbs (91 kg) = 1300 lbs
(589 kg)
Step 3
Permissible load (maximum gross vehicle weight
rating from the Tire and Loading Information
placard minus the gross weight of all occupants)
Wheels and tires 367
Tire labeling
Overview of tire labeling
5 Manufacturer
6 Characteristics of the tire (/ page 370)
7 Tire size designation, load-bearing capacity,
speed rating and load index (/ page 370)
8 Tire name
% The data shown in the image is example
data.
Tire Quality Grading
In accordance with the US Department of Trans‐
portation's "Uniform Tire Quality Grading Stand‐
ards", tire manufacturers are required to grade
their tires on the basis of the following three per‐
formance factors:
1 Uniform Tire Quality Grading Standard
(/ page 367)
2 DOT, Tire Identification Number
(/ page 368)
3 Maximum tire load (/ page 369)
4 Maximum tire pressure (/ page 369)
1 Tread wear grade
2 Traction grade
3 Temperature grade
% The data shown in the illustration is example
data.
% The classification is not legally stipulated for
Canada, but it is generally stated.
Tread wear grade
The tread wear grade is a comparative rating
based on the wear rate of the tire when tested
under controlled conditions on a specified test
track of the US Department of Transportation.
For example, a tire graded 150 would wear one
368 Wheels and tires
and one-half times as well on the government
test track as a tire graded 100.
The relative performance of tires depends upon
the actual conditions of their use, however, and
may depart significantly from the norm due to
variations in driving habits, service practices and
differences in road characteristics and climate
conditions.
Traction grade
& DANGER Risk of accident due to inade‐
quate traction
The traction grade assigned to this tire is
based on straight-ahead braking traction
tests, and does not include either accelera‐
tion, cornering, hydroplaning or peak traction
characteristics.
# Always adapt your driving style and
drive at a speed to suit the prevailing
traffic and weather conditions.
* NOTE Damage to the drivetrain from
wheelspin
#
Avoid wheelspin.
The traction classes, from highest to lowest, are
AA, A, B and C. Those grades represent the tire's
ability to stop on wet pavement as measured
under controlled conditions on specified govern‐
ment test surfaces of asphalt and concrete. A
tire marked C may have poor traction perform‐
ance.
Temperature grade
& WARNING Risk of accident from tire
overheating and tire failure
The temperature grade for this tire is estab‐
lished for a tire that is properly inflated and
not overloaded. Excessive speed, underinfla‐
tion, or excessive loading, either separately
or in combination, can cause excessive heat
build-up and possible tire failure.
# Observe the recommended tire pres‐
sures and regularly check the tire pres‐
#
sure of all tires including the spare
wheel.
Adjust the tire pressure as necessary.
The temperature grades are A (the highest), B
and C. They represent the tire's resistance to the
generation of heat and its ability to dissipate
heat when tested under controlled conditions on
a specified indoor laboratory test wheel. Sus‐
tained high temperature can cause the material
of the tire to degenerate and reduce tire life, and
excessive temperature can lead to sudden tire
failure. Grade C corresponds to a level of per‐
formance which all passenger car tires must
meet under the Federal Motor Safety Standard
No. 109. Grades B and A represent higher levels
of performance on the laboratory test wheel
than the minimum required by law.
DOT, Tire Identification Number (TIN)
US tire regulations stipulate that every tire man‐
ufacturer or retreader must imprint a TIN in or
on the side wall of each tire produced.
Wheels and tires 369
R
R
R
% The data shown in the image is example
data.
The TIN is a unique identification number to
identify tires and comprises the following:
R DOT (Department of Transportation): tire
symbol marks 1 indicating that the tire
complies with the requirements of the US
Department of Transportation.
R Manufacturer identification code: manu‐
facturer identification code 2 contains
details of the tire manufacturer. New tires
have a code with two symbols. Retreaded
tires have a code with four symbols. Further
information on retreaded tires (/ page 375).
Tire size: identifier 3 describes the tire
size.
Tire type code: tire type code 4 can be
used by the manufacturer as a code to
describe specific characteristics of the tire.
Manufacturing date: manufacturing date
5 provides information about the age of a
tire. The 1st and 2nd positions represent the
calendar week and the 3rd and 4th positions
state the year of manufacture (e.g. "3208"
represents the 32nd week of 2008).
% The data shown in the image is example
data.
Maximum tire load 1 is the maximum permissi‐
ble weight for which the tire is approved.
Do not overload the tires by exceeding the speci‐
fied load limit. The maximum permissible load
can be found on the vehicle's Tire and Loading
Information placard on the B-pillar on the driv‐
er's side (/ page 363).
Specifications for maximum tire pressure
Information on the maximum tire load
% The data shown in the image is example
data.
370 Wheels and tires
Never exceed maximum tire pressure 1 speci‐
fied for the tire.
Information on tire characteristics
Tire size designation, load-bearing capacity,
speed rating and load index
& WARNING Risk of injury through exceed‐
ing the specified tire load rating or the
permissible speed rating
Exceeding the specified tire load rating or
the permissible speed rating may lead to tire
damage and to the tires bursting.
# Therefore, only use tire types and sizes
approved for your vehicle model.
# Observe the tire load rating and speed
rating required for your vehicle.
% The data shown in the image is example
data.
This information describes the type of tire cord
and the number of layers in side wall 1 and
under tire tread 2.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
Preceding letter
Nominal tire width in millimeters
Aspect ratio in %
Tire code
Rim diameter
Load-bearing index
Speed rating
Load index
% The data shown in the image is example
data.
Information about reading tire data can be
obtained from any qualified specialist workshop.
Wheels and tires 371
Preceding letter 1:
Without: passenger vehicle tires according to
European manufacturing standards.
R "P": passenger vehicle tires according to US
manufacturing standards.
R "LT": light truck tires according to US manu‐
facturing standards.
R "T": compact emergency spare wheels with
high tire pressure that are only designed for
temporary use in an emergency.
R
Aspect ratio 3:
Ratio between tire height and tire width in per‐
cent (tire height divided by tire width).
Tire code 4 (tire type):
R "R" radial tire
R "D": bias ply tire
R "B": bias belted tires
R "ZR": radial tire with a maximum speed above
149 mph (240 km/h) (optional)
Rim diameter 5:
The diameter of the bead seat (not the diameter
of the rim flange). The rim diameter is specified
in inches (in).
Load-bearing index 6:
Numerical code that specifies the maximum
load-bearing capacity of a tire (e.g. "91" corre‐
sponds to 1356 lbs (615 kg)).
The load-bearing capacity of the tire must be at
least half the permissible axle load of your vehi‐
cle. Do not overload the tires by exceeding the
specified load limit.
See also:
R Maximum permissible load on the Tire and
Loading Information placard (/ page 363)
R Maximum tire load (/ page 369)
R Load index
Speed rating 7:
Specifies the approved maximum speed of the
tire.
% An electronic speed limiter prevents your
vehicle from exceeding a speed of 130 mph
(210 km/h).
Make sure that your tires have the required
speed rating. You can obtain information on the
required speed rating from an authorized
Mercedes-Benz Center.
Summer tires
Index
Speed rating
Q
up to 100 mph (160 km/h)
R
up to 106 mph (170 km/h)
S
up to 112 mph (180 km/h)
T
up to 118 mph (190 km/h)
H
up to 130 mph (210 km/h)
V
up to 149 mph (240 km/h)
W
up to 168 mph (270 km/h)
Y
up to 186 mph (300 km/h)
372 Wheels and tires
Index
Speed rating
ZR...Y4
up to 186 mph (300 km/h)
ZR...(..Y)4
over 186 mph (300 km/h)
ZR4
over 149 mph (240 km/h)
R
R
R
4
5
Specifying the speed rating as the "ZR" index
in tire code 4 is optional for tires up to
186 mph (300 km/h).
If your tire code 4 includes "ZR" and there
is no speed rating 7, find out what the max‐
imum speed is from the tire manufacturer.
If load-bearing index 6 and speed rating 7
are in brackets, the maximum speed rating of
your tire is above 186 mph (300 km/h). To
find out the maximum speed, ask the tire
manufacturer.
"ZR" stated in the tire code.
Or "M+S i" for winter tires
All-weather tires and winter tires
Index
Speed rating
M+S5
up to 100 mph (160 km/h)
T M+S5
up to 118 mph (190 km/h)
H M+S5
up to 130 mph (210 km/h)
V M+S5
up to 149 mph (240 km/h)
Q
Winter tires bear the i snowflake symbol
and fulfill the requirements of the Rubber Manu‐
facturers Association (RMA) and the Rubber
Association of Canada (RAC) regarding the tire
traction on snow.
Load index 8:
No specification given: standard load (SL)
tire
R "XL" or "Extra Load": extra load tire or rein‐
forced tire
R "Light Load": light load tire
R
R
"C", "D", "E": a load range that depends on
the maximum load that the tire can carry at a
certain pressure
Definition of terms for tires and loading
Tire structure and characteristics: describes
the number of layers or the number of rubbercoated belts in the tire contact surface and the
tire wall. These are made of steel, nylon, poly‐
ester and other materials.
Bar: metric unit for tire pressure.
14.5038 pounds per square inch (psi) and
100 kilopascal (kPa) is the equivalent of one bar.
DOT (Department of Transportation): DOTmarked tires fulfill the requirements of the
US Department of Transportation.
Average weight of the vehicle occupants: the
number of vehicle occupants for which the vehi‐
cle is designed, multiplied by 150 lb (68 kg).
Wheels and tires 373
Uniform Tire Quality Grading Standards: a
uniform standard to grade the quality of tires
with regard to tread quality, tire traction and
temperature characteristics. The quality grading
assessment is made by the manufacturer follow‐
ing specifications from the U.S. government. The
quality grade of a tire is imprinted on the side
wall of the tire.
Recommended tire pressure: the recommen‐
ded tire pressure is the tire pressure specified
for the tires mounted to the vehicle at the fac‐
tory.
The tire and information table contains the rec‐
ommended tire pressures for cold tires, the max‐
imum permissible load and the maximum per‐
missible vehicle speed.
The tire pressure table contains the recommen‐
ded tire pressures for cold tires under various
operating conditions, i.e. loading and/or speed
of the vehicle.
Increased vehicle weight due to optional
equipment: the combined weight of all standard
and optional equipment available for the vehicle,
regardless of whether it is actually installed on
the vehicle or not.
Rim: the part of the wheel on which the tire is
installed.
GAWR (Gross Axle Weight Rating): the GAWR
is the maximum permissible axle load. The
actual load on an axle must never exceed the
gross axle weight rating. The gross axle weight
rating can be found on the vehicle identification
plate on the B‑pillar on the driver's side.
Speed rating: the speed rating is part of the tire
identification. It specifies the speed range for
which a tire is approved.
GVW (Gross Vehicle Weight): the gross vehicle
weight comprises the weight of the vehicle
including fuel, tools, the spare wheel, accesso‐
ries installed, occupants, luggage and the trailer
drawbar noseweight, if applicable. The gross
vehicle weight must not exceed the gross vehicle
weight rating GVWR as specified on the vehicle
identification plate on the B‑pillar on the driver's
side.
GVWR (Gross Vehicle Weight Rating): the
GVWR is the maximum permitted gross weight
of the fully laden vehicle (weight of the vehicle
including all accessories, occupants, fuel, lug‐
gage and the trailer drawbar noseweight if appli‐
cable). The gross vehicle weight rating is speci‐
fied on the vehicle identification plate on the
B‑pillar on the driver's side.
Maximum weight of the laden vehicle: the
maximum weight is the sum of the curb weight
of the vehicle, the weight of the accessories, the
maximum load and the weight of optional equip‐
ment installed at the factory.
Kilopascal (kPa): metric unit for tire pressure.
6.9 kPa corresponds to 1 psi. Another unit for
tire pressure is bar. 100 kilopascal (kPa) equals
1 bar.
Load index: in addition to the load-bearing
index, the load index may also be imprinted on
the side wall of the tire. This specifies the loadbearing capacity of the tire more precisely.
Curb weight: the weight of a vehicle with stand‐
ard equipment including the maximum capacity
of fuel, oil and coolant. It also includes the air
conditioning system and optional equipment if
374 Wheels and tires
these are installed on the vehicle, but does not
include passengers or luggage.
Maximum tire load: the maximum tire load is
the maximum permissible weight in kilograms or
lbs for which a tire is approved.
Maximum permissible tire pressure: maxi‐
mum permissible tire pressure for one tire.
Maximum load on one tire: maximum load on
one tire. This is calculated by dividing the maxi‐
mum axle load of one axle by two.
PSI (pounds per square inch): standard unit of
measurement for tire pressure.
Aspect ratio: ratio between tire height and tire
width in percent.
Tire pressure: pressure inside the tire applying
an outward force to every square inch of the tire.
The tire pressure is specified in pounds per
square inch (psi), in kilopascals (kPa) or in bar.
The tire pressure should only be corrected when
the tires are cold.
Cold tire pressure: the tires are cold when the
vehicle has been parked for at least 3 hours
without direct sunlight on the tires or the vehicle
has been driven for less than 1 mile (1.6 km).
Tire contact surface: the part of the tire that
comes into contact with the road.
Tire bead: the purpose of the tire bead is to
ensure that the tire sits securely on the wheel
rim. There are several wire cores in the tire bead
to prevent the tire from changing length on the
wheel rim.
Side wall: the part of the tire between the tread
and the tire bead.
Weight of optional equipment: the combined
weight of the optional equipment weighing more
than the replaced standard parts and more than
5 lbs (2.3 kg). This optional equipment, such as
high-performance brakes, level control system, a
roof luggage rack or high-performance batteries,
is not included in the curb weight and the weight
of the accessories.
TIN (Tire Identification Number): a unique
identification number which can be used by a
tire manufacturer to identify tires, for example,
in a product recall, and thus identify the pur‐
chasers. The TIN is made up of the manufactur‐
er's identity code, tire size, tire type code and
the manufacturing date.
Load-bearing index: the load-bearing index is a
code that contains the maximum load-bearing
capacity of a tire.
Traction: traction is the grip resulting from fric‐
tion between the tires and the road surface.
Wear indicator: narrow bars (tread wear bars)
that are distributed over the tire contact surface.
If the tire tread is level with the bars, the wear
limit of 1/16 in (1.6 mm) has been reached.
Distribution of vehicle occupants: distribution
of vehicle occupants over designated seat posi‐
tions in a vehicle.
Maximum permissible payload weight: nomi‐
nal load and luggage load plus 150 lb (68 kg)
multiplied by the number of seats in the vehicle.
Wheels and tires 375
Changing a wheel
Notes on selecting, installing and replacing
tires
Mercedes-AMG vehicles: observe the notes in
the Supplement. You could otherwise fail to rec‐
ognize dangers.
& WARNING Risk of accident due to incor‐
rect dimensions of wheels and tires
If wheels and tires of the wrong size are
installed, the wheel brakes or wheel suspen‐
sion components may be damaged.
# Always replace wheels and tires with
those that fulfill the specifications of
the original part.
When replacing wheels, make sure to fit the
correct:
R Designation
R Model
When replacing tires, make sure to install the
correct:
R Designation
R Manufacturer
R Model
& WARNING Risk of injury through exceed‐
ing the specified tire load-bearing capa‐
city or the permissible speed rating
Exceeding the specified tire load rating or
the permissible speed rating may lead to tire
damage and to the tires bursting.
# Therefore, only use tire types and sizes
approved for your vehicle model.
# Observe the tire load rating and speed
rating required for your vehicle.
* NOTE Vehicle and tire damage through
tire types and sizes that have not been
approved
For safety reasons, only use tires, wheels
and accessories which have been specially
approved by Mercedes-Benz for your vehicle.
These tires are specially adapted to the con‐
trol systems, such as ABS, ESP® and
4MATIC, and marked as follows:
R MO = Mercedes-Benz Original
R MOE = Mercedes-Benz Original Extended
(run-flat tire only for certain wheels)
R MO1 = Mercedes-Benz Original (only cer‐
tain AMG tires)
Certain characteristics, such as handling,
vehicle noise emissions, consumption, etc.
may otherwise be adversely affected. Fur‐
thermore, other tire sizes could result in the
tires rubbing against the body and axle com‐
ponents when loaded. This could result in
damage to the tire or the vehicle.
376 Wheels and tires
Only use tires, wheels and accessories that
have been checked and recommended by
Mercedes-Benz.
* NOTE Risk to driving safety from retrea‐
ded tires
Retreaded tires are neither tested nor recom‐
mended by Mercedes-Benz, since previous
damage cannot always be detected on
retreaded tires.
For this reason driving safety cannot be guar‐
anteed.
# Do not use used tires if you have no
information about their previous usage.
* NOTE Possible damage to wheels or tires
when driving over obstacles
Large wheels have a lower tire section width.
The lower the tire section width, the greater
is the risk of damage to wheels or tires when
driving over obstacles.
#
Avoid obstacles or drive particularly
carefully.
* NOTE Possible wheel and tire damage
when parking on curbs or in potholes
Parking on curbs or in potholes may damage
the wheels and tires.
# If possible, park only on flat surfaces.
# Avoid curbs and potholes when parking.
* NOTE Damage to electronic component
parts from the use of tire-mounting tools
Vehicles with a tire pressure monitoring
system: Electronic component parts are
located in the wheel. Tire-mounting tools
should not be used in the area of the valve.
This could otherwise damage the electronic
component parts.
# Have the tires changed at a qualified
specialist workshop only.
* NOTE Damage to summer tires at low
ambient temperatures
At low ambient temperatures, tears could
form when driving with summer tires, caus‐
ing permanent damage to the tires.
# At temperatures below 45 °F (7 °C),
use M+S tires .
Accessory parts that are not approved for your
vehicle by Mercedes-Benz or are not being used
correctly can impair the operating safety.
Before purchasing and using non-approved
accessories, visit a qualified specialist workshop
and inquire about:
R Suitability
R Legal stipulations
R Factory recommendations
& WARNING Risk of accident with high
performance tires
There is an increased risk of skidding and
hydroplaning when using sport tires on wet
roads.
Wheels and tires 377
In addition, the tire grip is greatly reduced at
a low outside temperature and tire running
temperature.
# Activate ESP® and adapt your driving
style accordingly.
# Use M+S tires at outside temperatures
below 50 °F (10 °C).
# Only use the tires for their intended pur‐
pose.
Observe the following when selecting, installing
and replacing tires:
R Furthermore, the use of certain tire types in
certain regions and areas of operation can
be highly beneficial.
R Only use tires and wheels of the same type
(summer tires, winter tires, MOExtended
tires) and the same make.
R Only install wheels of the same size on one
axle (left and right).
It is only permissible to install a different
wheel size in the event of a flat tire in order
to drive to the specialist workshop.
R
R
R
R
R
R
Vehicles with a tire pressure monitoring
system: All installed wheels must be equip‐
ped with functioning sensors for the tire
pressure monitoring system.
At temperatures below 45 °F (7 °C) use win‐
ter tires or all-season tires marked M+S for
all wheels.
Winter tires bearing the i snowflake sym‐
bol in addition to the M+S marking provide
the best possible grip in wintry road condi‐
tions.
For M+S tires, only use tires with the same
tread.
Observe the maximum permissible speed for
the M+S tires installed.
If the tire's maximum speed is below that of
the vehicle, this must be indicated by an
appropriate label in the driver's field of
vision.
Break in new tires at moderate speeds for
the first 60 miles (100 km).
Replace the tires after six years at the latest,
regardless of wear.
R
When replacing with tires that do not fea‐
ture run-flat characteristics: vehicles with
MOExtended tires are not equipped with a
TIREFIT kit at the factory. Equip the vehicle
with a TIREFIT kit after replacing with tires
that do not feature run-flat characteristics,
e.g. winter tires.
For more information on wheels and tires, con‐
tact a qualified specialist workshop.
Be sure to also observe the following further
related subjects:
R Notes on tire pressure (/ page 357)
R Tire and Loading Information placard
(/ page 363)
R Tire size designation, load-bearing capacity,
speed rating and load index (/ page 370)
R Tire pressure table (/ page 359)
R Notes on the emergency spare wheel
(/ page 385)
378 Wheels and tires
Notes on rotating wheels
& WARNING Risk of injury through differ‐
ent wheel sizes
Interchanging the front and rear wheels if the
wheels or tires have different dimensions
may severely impair the driving characteris‐
tics.
The wheel brakes or wheel suspension com‐
ponents may also be damaged.
# Rotate front and rear wheels only if the
wheels and tires are of the same dimen‐
sions.
The wear patterns on the front and rear wheels
differ:
R Front wheels wear more on the shoulder of
the tire
R Rear wheels wear more at the center of the
tire
Do not drive with tires that have too little tread
depth. This significantly reduces traction on wet
roads (hydroplaning).
On vehicles that have the same size front and
rear wheels, rotate the wheels according to the
intervals in the tire manufacturer's warranty
book in your vehicle documents. If this is not
available, rotate the tires every
3,000 to 6,000 miles (5,000 to 10,000 km),
depending on the wear. Ensure that the direction
of rotation is maintained.
Observe the instructions and safety notes on
"Changing a wheel" when doing so
(/ page 379).
Notes on storing wheels
For more information on which tools are
required and approved to perform a wheel
change on your vehicle, consult a qualified spe‐
cialist workshop.
Required tire-change tools may include, for
example:
R Jack
R Chock
R Lug wrench
Tire-change tool kit 1 is located under the
cargo compartment floor.
When storing wheels, observe the following
notes:
R After removing wheels, store them in a cool,
dry and preferably dark place.
R Protect the tires from contact with oil, grease
or fuel.
Overview of the tire-change tool kit
Apart from some country-specific variants, vehi‐
cles are not equipped with a tire-change tool kit.
The tire-change tool kit includes the following:
R Jack
Wheels and tires 379
R
R
R
R
R
Lug wrench
Wheel studs
Extension attachment for wheel studs, if nec‐
essary (depending on vehicle version)
Folding chock
Ratchet wrench
Preparing the vehicle for a wheel change
Requirements:
R The required tire-change tool is available. If
your vehicle is not equipped with the tirechange tool kit, consult a qualified specialist
workshop to find out about suitable tools.
R The vehicle is not on a slope.
R The vehicle is on solid, non-slippery and level
ground.
#
#
#
Apply the electric parking brake manually.
Move the front wheels to the straight-ahead
position.
Shift the transmission to position j.
#
#
#
#
#
Vehicles with level control system: Set the
normal vehicle level (/ page 231).
Switch off the engine.
Make sure that the engine cannot be started.
Place chocks or other suitable items under
the front and rear of the wheel that is diago‐
nally opposite the wheel you wish to change.
Raise the vehicle (/ page 380).
Additionally, for Mercedes-Maybach vehicles:
Retract the running boards (/ page 75)
# To remove stone chipping protective covers
2:
#
#
#
Loosen expansion rivet 1 and pull it out.
Fold down and remove stone chipping pro‐
tective covers 2.
Removing and installing hub caps
Requirements:
R The vehicle is prepared for a wheel change
(/ page 379).
380 Wheels and tires
Plastic hub cap
# To remove: turn the center cover of the hub
cap counter-clockwise and remove the hub
cap.
# To install: make sure that the center cover
of the hub cap is turned counter-clockwise.
# Position the hub cap and turn the center
cover clockwise until the hub cap engages
physically and audibly.
Aluminum hub cap
Position wheel wrench 3 on socket 2.
Using wheel wrench 3, turn hub cap 1
counter-clockwise and remove it.
# To install: follow the instructions above in
reverse order.
% Specified tightening torque: 18 lb-ft
(25 Nm).
#
To remove: position socket 2 from the tirechange tool kit on hub cap 1.
R
The jack must be placed on a firm, flat and
non-slip surface. If necessary, use a large,
flat, load-bearing, non-slip underlay.
The foot of the jack must be positioned verti‐
cally under the jack support point.
Raising the vehicle when changing a wheel
Requirements:
R There are no persons in the vehicle.
R The vehicle has been prepared for a wheel
change (/ page 379).
Important notes on using the jack:
Use only a vehicle-specific jack that has
been approved by Mercedes-Benz to raise
the vehicle.
R The jack is only designed for raising and
holding the vehicle for a short time while a
wheel is being changed and not for mainte‐
nance work under the vehicle.
R
#
R
#
Rules of conduct when the vehicle is raised:
Never place your hands or feet under the
vehicle.
R Never lie under the vehicle.
R Do not start the engine and do not release
the electric parking brake.
R Do not open or close any doors or the tail‐
gate.
R
Wheels and tires 381
* NOTE Vehicle damage from the jack
If you do not position the jack correctly at
the appropriate jack support point of the
vehicle, the jack could tip over with the vehi‐
cle raised.
# The jack is designed exclusively for
jacking up the vehicle at the jack sup‐
port points.
#
Using the lug wrench, loosen the wheel bolts
on the wheel you wish to change by about
one full turn. Do not unscrew the bolts com‐
pletely.
Position of jack support points
& WARNING Risk of injury from incorrect
positioning of the jack
If you do not position the jack correctly at
the appropriate jacking point of the vehicle,
the jack could tip with the vehicle raised.
# Only position the jack at the appropri‐
ate jacking point of the vehicle. The
base of the jack must be positioned
vertically under the jacking point of the
vehicle.
#
Take the ratchet wrench out of the tirechange tool kit and place it on the hexagon
nut of the jack so that the letters "AUF" are
visible.
382 Wheels and tires
Mercedes-Maybach vehicles:
#
#
#
Turn ratchet wrench 3 clockwise until jack
2 sits completely on jack support point 1
and the base of the jack lies evenly on the
ground.
Continue to turn ratchet wrench 3 until the
tire is raised a maximum of 1.2 in (3 cm) off
the ground.
Loosen and remove the wheel (/ page 382).
Removing a wheel
Requirements:
R The vehicle is raised (/ page 380).
#
#
#
#
Position jack 2 at jack support point 1.
Turn ratchet wrench 3 clockwise until jack
2 sits completely on jack support point 1
and the base of the jack lies evenly on the
ground.
Continue to turn ratchet wrench 3 until the
tire is raised a maximum of 1.2 in (3 cm) off
the ground.
Loosen and remove the wheel (/ page 382).
Requirements:
R The running boards are retracted
(/ page 75)
R The stone chipping protective covers are
removed (/ page 379)
#
Position jack 2 at jack support point 1.
Mercedes-AMG vehicles: observe the notes in
the Supplement. You could otherwise fail to rec‐
ognize dangers.
When changing a wheel, avoid applying any force
to the brake discs, since this could impair the
level of comfort when braking.
Wheels and tires 383
* NOTE Damage to threading from dirt on
wheel bolts
#
#
#
Do not place wheel bolts in sand or on
a dirty surface.
Completely unscrew the wheel bolts.
Remove the wheel.
Mounting a new wheel
Requirements:
R The wheel is removed (/ page 382).
Mercedes-AMG vehicles: observe the notes in
the Supplement. Otherwise, you may not recog‐
nize dangers.
& WARNING Risk of accident from losing a
wheel
Oiled, greased or damaged wheel bolt/wheel
nut threads or wheel hub/wheel mounting
bolt threads can cause the wheel bolts/
wheel nuts to come loose.
As a result, you could lose a wheel while driv‐
ing.
# Never oil or grease the threads.
# In the event of damage to the threads,
contact a qualified specialist workshop
immediately.
# Have the damaged wheel bolts or dam‐
aged hub threads replaced.
# Do not continue driving.
#
Observe the information on the choice of
tires (/ page 375).
For tires with a specified direction of rotation, an
arrow on the side wall of the tire indicates the
correct direction of rotation. Observe the direc‐
tion of rotation when installing.
& WARNING Risk of injury from tightening
wheel bolts and nuts
If you tighten the wheel bolts or wheel nuts
when the vehicle is raised, the jack could tip.
#
#
#
Only tighten wheel bolts or wheel nuts
when the vehicle is on the ground.
Be sure to observe the instructions and
safety notes on "Changing a wheel"
(/ page 375).
For safety reasons, only use wheel bolts
which have been approved by MercedesBenz and for the wheel in question.
* NOTE Damage to paintwork of the wheel
rim when screwing on the first wheel bolt
If the wheel has too much play when screw‐
ing in the first wheel bolt, the wheel rim paint
can be damaged.
# Press the wheel firmly against the
wheel hub when screwing on the first
wheel bolt.
#
Tighten the wheel bolts evenly in a diagonal
pattern in the order indicated until they are
finger-tight.
384 Wheels and tires
#
#
If the collapsible spare wheel has been
installed, inflate the collapsible spare wheel
(/ page 388).
Lower the vehicle (/ page 384).
#
#
Lowering the vehicle after a wheel change
Requirements:
R The new wheel has been installed
(/ page 383).
Observe the information on tire pressure
(/ page 357).
# Place the ratchet wrench onto the hexagon
nut of the jack so that the lettering "AB" is
visible.
# To lower the vehicle: turn the ratchet
wrench of the jack counter-clockwise.
#
#
#
Tighten the wheel bolts evenly in a diagonal
pattern in the order indicated 1 to 5 with
a maximum of 59 lb-ft (80 Nm).
Then tighten the wheel bolts evenly in a diag‐
onal pattern in the order indicated 1 to 5
to the specified tightening torque of 111 lb-ft
(150 Nm).
& WARNING Risk of injury through incor‐
rect tightening torque
The wheels could come loose if the wheel
bolts or wheel nuts are not tightened to the
prescribed tightening torque.
#
Make sure the wheel bolts or wheel
nuts are tightened to the prescribed
tightening torque.
If you are not sure, do not move the
vehicle. Consult a qualified specialist
workshop and have the tightening tor‐
que checked immediately.
Check the tire pressure of the newly moun‐
ted wheel and adjust accordingly.
Vehicles with a tire pressure monitoring
system: Restart the tire pressure monitoring
system (/ page 362).
Exception: the new wheel is an emergency
spare wheel.
Wheels and tires 385
Emergency spare wheel
Notes on the emergency spare wheel
& WARNING Risk of accident caused by
incorrect wheel and tire dimensions
The wheel or tire size and the tire type of the
emergency spare wheel or spare wheel and
the wheel to be replaced may differ. The
emergency spare wheel or spare wheel can
significantly impair driving characteristics of
the vehicle.
To prevent hazardous situations:
# Adapt your driving style accordingly and
drive carefully.
# Never install more than one emergency
spare wheel or spare wheel that differs
in size.
# Only use an emergency spare wheel or
spare wheel of a different size briefly.
# Do not switch off ESP®.
# Have the emergency spare wheel or
spare wheel of a different size replaced
at the nearest qualified specialist work‐
shop. The new wheel must have the
correct dimensions.
R
% The emergency spare wheel is fastened in
the cargo compartment under the cargo
compartment floor.
% Not for Mercedes-Maybach vehicles.
Observe the following notes on removing an
emergency spare wheel:
R Before stowing the emergency spare wheel,
make sure there is no air left in the tire.
If necessary, allow the air to escape.
R To release air from the tire: remove the
valve cap of the tire.
R Press down the metal insert in the valve
using a pointed object, e.g. a pen.
R Screw the valve cap onto the valve.
R
Observe the following notes on installing an
emergency spare wheel:
R Check the tire pressure of the emergency
spare wheel installed. Correct the pressure
as necessary.
R
The maximum permissible speed with an
emergency spare wheel installed is 50 mph
(80 km/h).
Do not install snow chains on the emergency
spare wheel.
Replace the emergency spare wheel after six
years at the latest, regardless of wear.
% Vehicles with a tire pressure monitoring
system: If an emergency spare wheel is
installed, the tire pressure monitoring sys‐
tem cannot function reliably. For a few
minutes after an emergency spare wheel is
installed, the system may still display the tire
pressure of the removed wheel. Only restart
the system again when the emergency spare
wheel has been replaced with a new wheel.
Be sure to also observe the following further
related subjects:
R Notes on tire pressure (/ page 357)
R Tire and Loading Information placard
(/ page 363)
R Tire pressure table (/ page 359)
R Notes on installing tires (/ page 375)
386 Wheels and tires
Inflating the emergency spare wheel
* NOTE Overheating due to the tire infla‐
tion compressor running too long
#
Observe the notes on sockets: (/ page 135)
#
Press the start/stop button once to switch
on the power supply. (/ page 168)
Press On/Off switch 4 on the tire inflation
compressor to I.
The tire inflation compressor is switched on.
The tire is inflated. The tire pressure is
shown on manometer 5.
Pump the tire to the specified tire pressure.
#
Do not run the tire inflation compressor
for longer than ten minutes without
interruption.
Requirements:
Comply with the manufacturer's safety notes on
the sticker of the emergency spare wheel and on
the tire inflation compressor.
# Remove sticker with the label 50 mph
(80 km/h )from the tire inflation compressor
housing and affix it to the instrument cluster
within the driver's field of vision.
# Remove the tire inflation compressor from
the storage space under the cargo compart‐
ment floor (/ page 339).
R
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
R
Pull filler hose 1 and plug 3 out of the tire
inflation compressor housing.
Insert plug 7 of filler hose 1 in the socket
on the tire inflation compressor and then
turn it until plug 7 engages.
Unscrew the cap from the valve on the emer‐
gency spare wheel.
Screw union nut 2 of filler hose 1 onto
valve .
Make sure on and off switch 4 of the tire
inflation compressor is set to 0.
Insert plug 3 in a socket in your vehicle.
12 V socket: (/ page 135)
% The specified tire pressure is stated on the
label of the emergency spare wheel.
# When the specified tire pressure has been
reached, press on and off switch 4 on the
tire inflation compressor to 0.
The tire inflation compressor is switched off.
# Press the start/stop button to switch off the
power supply.
# If the tire pressure is higher than the speci‐
fied pressure, press pressure release valve
button 6 until the correct tire pressure has
been reached.
Wheels and tires 387
#
#
#
#
Unscrew union nut 2 of filler hose 1 from
the valve.
Screw the valve cap of the emergency spare
wheel onto the valve again.
Store filler hose 1 and plug 3 in the lower
section of the tire inflation compressor hous‐
ing.
Store the tire inflation compressor in the
vehicle.
Collapsible spare wheel
Notes on the collapsible spare wheel
& WARNING Risk of accident caused by
incorrect wheel and tire dimensions
The wheel or tire size and the tire type of the
emergency spare wheel or spare wheel and
the wheel to be replaced may differ. Mount‐
ing an emergency spare wheel/spare wheel
may severely impair the driving characteris‐
tics.
To prevent hazardous situations:
#
#
#
#
#
Adapt your driving style accordingly and
drive carefully.
Never mount more than one emergency
spare wheel or spare wheel that differs
in size.
Only use an emergency spare wheel or
spare wheel of a different size briefly.
Do not switch off ESP®.
>Have the emergency spare wheel or
spare wheel of a different size replaced
at the nearest qualified specialist work‐
shop. The new wheel must have the
correct dimensions.
The collapsible spare wheel is an emergency
spare wheel which is only suitable for use for a
limited period of time and in a restricted manner
in the event of a flat tire (e.g. until the nearest
workshop).
The tire sidewalls are folded when in transport
mode. Before use, the collapsible spare wheel
has to be inflated with the accompanying com‐
pressor.
Check the tire pressure of the collapsible spare
wheel once installed. Correct the pressure as
necessary.
The maximum permissible speed with a collapsi‐
ble spare wheel installed is 50 mph (80 km/h).
Do not install snow chains on the collapsible
spare wheel.
Replace the collapsible spare wheel after six
years at the latest, regardless of wear.
% Vehicles with a tire pressure monitoring
system: If a collapsible spare wheel is instal‐
led the tire pressure monitoring system can‐
not function reliably. For a few minutes after
an emergency spare wheel is installed, the
system may still display the tire pressure of
the removed wheel. Only restart the system
again when the collapsible spare wheel has
been replaced with a new wheel.
Be sure to also observe the following further
related subjects:
R Notes on tire pressure (/ page 357)
R Tire pressure table (/ page 359)
388 Wheels and tires
Removing the collapsible spare wheel
The collapsible spare wheel is located under the
cargo compartment floor.
# Observe the information on mounting tires
(/ page 375).
# Open the tailgate.
# Open the cargo compartment floor .
# Remove the collapsible spare wheel.
Mercedes‑Maybach vehicles
Without refrigerator box: The collapsible spare
wheel is located in the collapsible spare wheel
bag on the cargo compartment floor.
# Observe the notes on mounting tires
(/ page 375).
# Open the cargo compartment.
# Detach the securing straps.
# Unhook the retaining spring hooks of the
securing straps from the brackets.
# Remove the collapsible spare wheel bag
together with the collapsible spare wheel.
#
Open the collapsible spare wheel bag and
remove the collapsible spare wheel.
With refrigerator box: The collapsible spare
wheel is located in the collapsible spare wheel
bag inside the open cargo compartment floor.
# Observe the information on mounting tires
(/ page 375).
# Open the cargo compartment.
# Detach the securing straps.
# Unhook the retaining spring hooks of the
securing straps from the brackets.
# Remove the collapsible spare wheel bag
together with the collapsible spare wheel.
# Open the collapsible spare wheel bag and
remove the collapsible spare wheel.
Inflating the collapsible spare wheel
Requirements:
R Mount the collapsible spare wheel as descri‐
bed (/ page 383).
R
Remove the tire inflation compressor from
the storage well under the trunk floor
(/ page 339).
* NOTE Damage to the collapsible spare
wheel when lowering the vehicle
Lowering the vehicle without previously
inflating the collapsible spare wheel can
damage its rim.
# Inflate the collapsible spare wheel using
the tire inflation compressor before
lowering the vehicle.
* NOTE Overheating due to the tire infla‐
tion compressor running too long
#
Do not run the tire inflation compressor
for longer than ten minutes without
interruption.
Wheels and tires 389
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
Pull connector 4 and the hose out of the
housing.
Unscrew the cap from the valve on the col‐
lapsible spare wheel.
Screw union nut 1 of the hose onto the
valve.
Make sure on and off switch 3 of the tire
inflation compressor is set to 0.
Insert plug 4 into the cigarette lighter
socket or into a 12 V socket (/ page 135) in
your vehicle.
Switch on the power supply (/ page 168).
Press On/Off switch 3 on the tire inflation
compressor to I.
The tire inflation compressor is switched on.
The tire is inflated. The tire pressure is
shown on manometer 2.
Pump the tire to the specified tire pressure.
% The specified tire pressure is printed on the
yellow label of the collapsible spare wheel.
# When the specified tire pressure has been
reached, press on/off switch 3 on the tire
inflation compressor to 0.
# If the tire pressure is higher than the speci‐
fied pressure, press pressure release valve
button 5 until the correct tire pressure has
been reached.
390 Technical data
Notes on technical data
Mercedes-AMG vehicles: be sure to observe
the notes in the Supplement. Otherwise, you
may fail to recognize dangers.
The data stated only applies to vehicles with
standard equipment. You can obtain further
information from an authorized Mercedes-Benz
Center.
Vehicle electronics
Two-way radios
Notes on installing two-way radios
& WARNING Risk of accident due to
improper work on two-way radios
If two-way radios are manipulated or retrofit‐
ted incorrectly, the electromagnetic radiation
from the two-way radios can interfere with
the vehicle electronics and jeopardize the
operating safety of the vehicle.
#
You should have all work on electrical
and electronic components carried out
at a qualified specialist workshop.
& WARNING Risk of accident from incor‐
rect operation of two-way radios
If you operate two-way radios incorrectly in
the vehicle, the electromagnetic radiation
could interfere with the on-board electronics,
for example, if:
R The tow-way radio is not connected to an
exterior antenna
R If the exterior antenna is not correctly
mounted or is not of low reflection
This could jeopardize the operating safety of
the vehicle.
# Have the low-reflection exterior
antenna installed at a qualified special‐
ist workshop.
# When operating two-way radios in the
vehicle, always connect them to the
low-reflection exterior antenna.
* NOTE Invalidation of the operating per‐
mit due to failure to comply with the
instructions for installation and use
The operating permit may be invalidated if
the instructions for installation and use of
two-way radios are not observed.
# Only use approved frequency bands.
# Observe the maximum permissible out‐
put power in these frequency bands.
# Only use approved antenna positions.
Technical data 391
On the rear fenders, it is recommended that you
install the antenna on the side of the vehicle
closest to the center of the road.
Use Technical Specification ISO/TS 21609 (Road
Vehicles – "EMCs for installation of aftermarket
radio frequency transmitting equipment") when
retrofitting two-way radios. Comply with the
legal requirements for detachable parts.
If your vehicle has installing for two-way radio
equipment, use the power supply and antenna
connectors provided in the pre-installation.
Observe the manufacturer's supplements when
installing.
1 Front roof area
2 Rear roof area
3 Rear fenders
On vehicles with a panoramic sliding sunroof,
installing an antenna to the front or rear roof
area is not permitted.
Two-way radio transmission output
The maximum transmission output (PEAK) at the
base of the antenna must not exceed the values
in the following table.
Frequency band and maximum transmission
output
Frequency band
Maximum transmis‐
sion output
Short wave
3 - 54 MHz
100 W
4 m frequency band
74 - 88 MHz
30 W
2 m frequency band
144 - 174 MHz
50 W
Terrestrial Trunked
Radio (TETRA)
380 - 460 MHz
10 W
70 cm frequency
band
420 - 450 MHz
35 W
Two-way radio
(2G/3G/4G)
10 W
392 Technical data
The following can be used in the vehicle without
restrictions:
R two-way radios with a maximum transmission
output of up to 100 mW
R RF transmitters with transmitter frequencies
in the 380 - 410 MHz frequency band and a
maximum transmission output of up to 2 W
(trunked radio system/Tetra)
R mobile phones (2G/3G/4G)
There are no restrictions when positioning the
antenna on the outside of the vehicle for some
wavebands.
R Terrestrial Trunked Radio (TETRA)
R 70 cm frequency band
R 2G/3G/4G
Vehicle identification plate, VIN and engine
number overview
Vehicle identification plate
1
2
3
4
5
Vehicle identification plate (USA only)
Maximum permissible gross vehicle weight
Maximum permissible front axle load
Maximum permissible rear axle load
Paint code
VIN (vehicle identification number)
Technical data 393
Do not exceed the maximum permissible gross
vehicle weight or the maximum gross axle
weight rating for the front or rear axle.
Additional plates
VIN in front of the front seat
1
2
3
4
5
Vehicle identification plate (Canada only)
Maximum permissible gross vehicle weight
Maximum permissible front axle load
Maximum permissible rear axle load
Paint code
VIN (vehicle identification number)
The maximum permissible gross vehicle weight
is made up of the vehicle weight, all vehicle
occupants, the fuel and the load. The maximum
gross axle weight rating is the maximum weight
that can be carried on one axle (front or rear
axle).
1 Plate with information about emissions test‐
1 VIN (vehicle identification number)
ing, including confirmation of emissions
guidelines at the U.S. federal level as well as
for California
2 Engine number stamped into the crankcase
3 VIN (vehicle identification number) as a label
at the lower edge of the windshield
394 Technical data
Operating fluids
Notes on operating fluids
Mercedes-AMG vehicles: be sure to observe
the notes in the Supplement. You could other‐
wise fail to recognize dangers.
& WARNING Risk of injury from operating
fluids harmful to your health
Operating fluids may be poisonous and harm‐
ful to your health.
# Observe the text on the original con‐
tainers when using, storing or disposing
of operating fluids.
# Always store operating fluids sealed in
their original containers.
# Always keep children away from operat‐
ing fluids.
+ ENVIRONMENTAL NOTE Environmental
pollution caused by environmentally irre‐
sponsible disposal
#
Dispose of operating fluids in an envi‐
ronmentally responsible manner.
Operating fluids include the following:
R Fuels
R Lubricants
R Coolant
R Brake fluid
R Windshield washer fluid
R Climate control system refrigerant
Only use products approved by Mercedes-Benz.
Damage caused by the use of products that have
not been approved is not covered by the
Mercedes-Benz warranty or goodwill gestures.
You can identify operating fluids approved by
Mercedes-Benz by the following inscriptions on
the container:
R MB-Freigabe (e.g. MB-Freigabe 229.51)
R
MB-Approval (e.g. MB-Approval 229.51)
Further information on approved operating fluids
is available at the following locations:
R In the Mercedes-Benz Specifications for
Operating Fluids by entering the designation
At https://bevo.mercedes-benz.com
In the Mercedes-Benz BeVo app
R At a qualified specialist workshop
& WARNING Risk of fire or explosion from
fuel
Fuels are highly flammable.
Fire, open flames, smoking and creation
of sparks must be avoided.
# Switch off the ignition and, if available,
the stationary heater, before and while
refueling the vehicle.
#
& WARNING Risk of injury from fuels
Fuels are poisonous and hazardous to your
health.
Technical data 395
#
#
#
#
Do not swallow fuel or let it come into
contact with skin, eyes or clothing.
Do not inhale fuel vapor.
Keep children away from fuel.
Keep doors and windows closed during
the refueling process.
If you or other people come into contact with
fuel, observe the following:
# Immediately rinse fuel off your skin with
soap and water.
# If fuel comes into contact with your
eyes, immediately rinse them thor‐
oughly with clean water. Seek medical
attention immediately.
# If you swallow fuel, seek medical atten‐
tion immediately. Do not induce vomit‐
ing.
# Change immediately out of clothing that
has come into contact with fuel.
Fuel
Notes on fuel grades for vehicles with a gas‐
oline engine
Observe the notes on operating fluids
(/ page 394).
* NOTE Damage caused by the wrong fuel
Even small amounts of the wrong fuel could
result in damage to the fuel system, the
engine and the emission control system.
# Only refuel with low-sulfur unleaded
fuel.
This fuel may contain up to 10% ethanol by
volume. Your vehicle is suitable for use with
E10 fuel.
Never refuel with one of the following fuels:
R Diesel
R Gasoline with more than 10% ethanol by
volume, e.g. E15, E85, E100
R Gasoline with more than 3% methanol by
volume, e.g. M15, M30, M85, M100
R
Gasoline with additives containing metal
If you have accidentally refueled with the
wrong fuel:
# Do not switch on the ignition.
# Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
If the available fuel is not sufficiently low in sul‐
fur, this can produce unpleasant odors.
Only refuel with fuel that has at least the octane
number specified in the instruction label in the
fuel filler flap (/ page 191). This may reduce
engine output and increase fuel consumption.
If you want maximum engine output: only
refuel with unleaded premium grade gasoline
with an octane number of at least 91 AKI/
95 RON.
As a temporary measure, if the recommended
fuel is not available, you may also refuel with
unleaded regular gasoline with at least 87 AKI/
91 RON. This may reduce engine output and
increase fuel consumption.
Never refuel using gasoline with an even lower
RON.
396 Technical data
* NOTE Premature wear caused by unlea‐
ded regular gasoline
Unleaded regular gasoline can cause the
engine to wear more quickly and impair lon‐
gevity and performance.
If unleaded premium grade gasoline is
unavailable and you have to refuel using
unleaded regular gasoline:
# Only fill the fuel tank to half full with
unleaded regular gasoline and refill as
soon as possible with unleaded pre‐
mium grade gasoline.
# Do not drive at the maximum speed.
# Avoid sudden acceleration and engine
speeds over 3,000 rpm.
Further information on fuel is available at the fol‐
lowing locations:
R At a gas station
R At a qualified specialist workshop
R USA only: at http://www.mbusa.com
Information on additives in gasoline
Observe the notes on operating fluids
(/ page 394).
* NOTE Damage from use of unsuitable
additives
Even small amounts of the wrong additive
may lead to malfunctions occurring.
# Only add cleaning additives recommen‐
ded by Mercedes-Benz to the fuel.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use fuel
brands that have additives.
In some countries, the fuel available may not
have sufficient additives. Residue could build up
in the fuel injection system as a result. In this
case, in consultation with an authorized
Mercedes-Benz Center, the fuel may be mixed
with the cleaning additive recommended by
Mercedes-Benz. Be sure to observe the notes
and mixing ratios specified on the container.
Tank content and reserve fuel
Missing values were not yet available at the time
of going to press.
The total capacity of the fuel tank may vary,
depending on the vehicle equipment.
Capacity
Model
All models
Total capacity
23.8 gal (90.0 liters)
Model
of which reserve
fuel
All models
2.4 gal (9.0 liters)
Mercedes‑Maybach
Total capacity
All models
Mercedes‑Maybach
of which reserve
fuel
All models
Engine oil
Notes on engine oil
Observe the notes on operating fluids
(/ page 394).
Technical data 397
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you have the
oil change carried out at a qualified specialist
workshop.
Quality and capacity of engine oil
MB-Freigabe or MB-Approval
* NOTE Engine damage caused by an
incorrect oil filter, incorrect oil or addi‐
tives
#
#
#
#
Do not use engine oils or oil filters other
than those which meet the specifica‐
tions necessary for the prescribed
service intervals.
Do not alter the engine oil or oil filter in
order to achieve longer change intervals
than prescribed.
Do not use additives.
Have the engine oil changed after the
prescribed intervals.
Gasoline engines
Engine oil specifica‐
tions
GLS 450 4MATIC
229.51, 229.52,
229.61
229.71*
GLS 580 4MATIC
229.52
229.61*
case; observe possible restrictions of the
approved SAE viscosity classes).
To achieve the lowest possible fuel consumption,
it is recommended to use the engine oil specifi‐
cations marked in the table for the lowest SAE
viscosity class. Possible restrictions of the
approved SAE viscosity classes must be
observed.
Mercedes-Maybach GLS 600 4MATIC: only
use SAE 0W-40 or SAE 5W-40 engine oils.
The following values refer to an oil change,
including the oil filter.
Replacement amount
Model
MB-Freigabe or MB-Approval
Mercedes‑Maybach
Engine oil specifica‐
tions
Mercedes-Maybach
GLS 600 4MATIC
229.5
* Recommended for lowest possible fuel con‐
sumption (lowest SAE viscosity class in each
Replacement
amount
GLS 450 4MATIC
8.9 qt (8.5 liters)
GLS 580 4MATIC
10.0 qt (9.5 liters)
Mercedes‑Maybach
Replacement
amount
Mercedes-Maybach
GLS 600 4MATIC
10.0 qt (9.5 liters)
398 Technical data
Notes on brake fluid
Coolant
Observe the notes on operating fluids
(/ page 394).
Notes on coolant
Observe the notes on operating fluids
(/ page 394).
& WARNING Risk of an accident due to
vapor pockets forming in the brake sys‐
tem
The brake fluid constantly absorbs moisture
from the air. This lowers the boiling point of
the brake fluid. If the boiling point is too low,
vapor pockets may form in the brake system
when the brakes are applied hard.
This causes the braking effect to be
impaired.
# Have the brake fluid renewed at the
specified intervals.
Have the brake fluid regularly replaced at a
qualified specialist workshop.
Only use a brake fluid approved by MercedesBenz according to MB-Freigabe or MB-Approval
331.0.
& WARNING ‑ Risk of fire and injury from
antifreeze
If antifreeze comes into contact with hot
component parts in the engine compart‐
ment, it may ignite.
# Allow the engine to cool down before
adding antifreeze.
# Make sure that no antifreeze spills out
next to the filler opening.
# Thoroughly clean off any antifreeze
from component parts before starting
the vehicle.
* NOTE Damage caused by incorrect cool‐
ant
Only add coolant that has been pre‐
mixed with the required antifreeze pro‐
tection.
Information on coolant is available at the fol‐
lowing locations:
R In the Mercedes-Benz Specifications for
Operating Fluids 310.1:
At https://bevo.mercedes-benz.com
In the Mercedes-Benz BeVo app
R At a qualified specialist workshop
#
* NOTE Overheating at high outside tem‐
peratures
If an inappropriate coolant is used, the
engine cooling system is not sufficiently pro‐
tected against overheating and corrosion at
high outside temperatures.
# Always use coolant approved by
Mercedes-Benz.
Technical data 399
#
Observe the instructions in the
Mercedes-Benz Specifications for Oper‐
ating Fluids 310.1.
Have the coolant regularly replaced at a qualified
specialist workshop.
The proportion of corrosion inhibitor/antifreeze
concentrate in the engine cooling system should
be:
R A minimum of 50% (antifreeze protection
down to approximately -35 °F (-37 °C))
R A maximum of 55% (antifreeze protection
down to -49 °F (-45 °C))
Coolant capacity
Model
#
Capacity
GLS 450 4MATIC
20.0 US qt
(18.9 liters)
GLS 580 4MATIC
16.6 US qt
(15.7 liters)
Mercedes‑Maybach
Capacity
Mercedes-Maybach
GLS 600 4MATIC
20.0 US qt
(18.9 liters)
Notes on windshield washer fluid
Observe the notes on operating fluids
(/ page 394).
& WARNING ‑ Risk of fire and injury from
windshield washer concentrate
Windshield washer concentrate is highly
flammable. It could ignite if it comes into
contact with hot engine component parts or
the exhaust system.
Make sure that no windshield washer
concentrate spills out next to the filler
opening.
* NOTE Damage to the exterior lighting
due to unsuitable windshield washer fluid
Unsuitable windshield washer fluid may dam‐
age the plastic surface of the exterior light‐
ing.
# Only use windshield washer fluid which
is also suitable for use on plastic surfa‐
ces, e.g. MB SummerFit or MB Winter‐
Fit.
* NOTE Blocked spray nozzles caused by
mixing windshield washer fluids
#
Do not mix MB SummerFit and MB Win‐
terFit with other windshield washer flu‐
ids.
Do not use distilled or de-ionized water as the fill
level sensor may be triggered erroneously.
400 Technical data
Recommended windshield washer fluid:
R Above freezing point: e.g. MB SummerFit
R Below freezing point: e.g. MB WinterFit
For the correct mixing ratio, refer to the informa‐
tion on the antifreeze container.
Mix the washer fluid with the windshield washer
fluid all year round.
Refrigerant
Notes on refrigerant
Observe the notes on operating fluids
(/ page 394).
* NOTE Damage due to incorrect refriger‐
ant
If a non-approved refrigerant is used, the cli‐
mate control system may be damaged.
# USA/China: Use only R‑134a refriger‐
ant.
# Canada: Use only R‑1234yf refrigerant.
* NOTE Damage to the climate control
system due to incorrect refrigerant com‐
pressor oil
#
#
Only use refrigerant compressor oil that
has been approved by Mercedes-Benz.
Do not mix the approved refrigerant
compressor oil with a different refriger‐
ant compressor oil.
Work on the climate control system may be car‐
ried out only by a qualified specialist workshop.
All applicable regulations, as well as SAE stand‐
ard J639, must be adhered to.
The information label on the climate control sys‐
tem for the refrigerant type and the refrigerant
compressor oil is located on the inside of the
hood.
Information label (example – USA/China)
Hazard and service warning symbols
Refrigerant filling capacity
Applicable standards
PAG oil part number
GWP (Global Warming Potential) of the refrig‐
erant used
6 Refrigerant type
1
2
3
4
5
Technical data 401
Refrigerant filling capacity
Filling capacity for refrigerant and PAG oil
Model
Refrigerant
All models
23.9 ± 0.4 oz
(680 ± 10 g)
Model
All models
1
2
3
4
5
6
Information label (example – Canada)
Hazard and service warning symbols
Refrigerant filling capacity
Applicable standards
PAG oil part number
GWP (Global Warming Potential) of the refrig‐
erant used
Refrigerant type
Symbols 1 indicate the following:
Possible dangers
R The need to have service work carried out at
a qualified specialist workshop only
R
PAG oil
3.8 ± 0.4 oz
(110 ± 10 g)
Vehicle data
Vehicle dimensions
The heights specified may vary as a result of the
following factors:
R Tires
R Load
R Condition of the suspension
R Optional equipment
402 Technical data
Height when opened
Model
Vehicles with AIR‐
MATIC
Vehicles with Offroad package
Mercedes‑Maybach
All models
1
Height
when
opened*
2 Head‐
room*
*When the rear-end lowering is activated, the
values are correspondingly lower.
Vehicle dimensions
All models
84.4 in
75.9 in
(2144 mm) (1929 mm)
- 87.9 in
- 79.4 in
(2234 mm) (2019 mm)
Vehicle length
205.0 in
(5207 mm)
Vehicle length, AMG Styling
205.2 in
(5213 mm)
84.4 in
75.9 in
(2144 mm) (1929 mm)
- 89.5 in
- 81.0 in
(2274 mm) (2059 mm)
Vehicle width including out‐
side mirrors
84.9 in
(2157 mm)
Vehicle width excluding out‐
side mirrors, min. to max.
77.0 in
(1956 mm) 79.9 in
(2030 mm)
Maximum vehicle height (AIR‐
MATIC)
74.3 in
(1888 mm)
Maximum vehicle height (Offroad package)
75.9 in
(1928 mm)
1
Height
when
opened*
2 Head‐
room*
85.0 in
76.5 in
(2159 mm) (1944 mm)
- 87.9 in
- 79.4 in
(2234 mm) (2019 mm)
All models
Minimum vehicle height (high‐
way driving level)
71.7 in
(1823 mm) 72.3 in
(1838 mm)
Wheelbase
123.4 in
(3135 mm)
Maximum ground clearance
(AIRMATIC)
10.1 in
(259 mm)
Maximum ground clearance
(Off-road package)
11.3 in
(289 mm)
Minimum ground clearance
(AIRMATIC/Off-road package)
6.8 in
(174 mm)
Mercedes‑Maybach
Vehicle length
204.9 in
(5205 mm)
Vehicle width including out‐
side mirrors
84.9 in
(2157 mm)
Technical data 403
Roof load
Mercedes‑Maybach
All models
Vehicle width excluding out‐
side mirrors, min. to max.
79.9 in
(2030 mm)
Maximum vehicle height
74.3 in
(1888 mm)
Running board
Minimum vehicle height (high‐
way driving level)
72.3 in
(1838 mm)
Maximum load
Wheelbase
123.4 in
(3135 mm)
Maximum ground clearance
8.2 in
(210 mm)
Weights and loads
Please note that for the specified vehicle data:
R Items of optional equipment increase the
curb weight and reduce the payload.
Maximum roof load
220 lb (100 kg)
All models
440 lb (200 kg)
Off-road driving
Fording depth
* NOTE Damage caused by water when
fording
Water can enter the engine compartment
and vehicle interior if:
R you exceed the maximum permissible
fording depth when driving through stand‐
ing water
R a bow wave forms during fording
R
water accumulates during fording of flow‐
ing water
#
Do not exceed the maximum permissi‐
ble fording depth and drive slowly
through the water.
The specified value indicates the maximum per‐
missible fording depth for:
R vehicles that are ready to drive
R slow driving through standing water
Driving through flowing water reduces the per‐
missible fording depth due to the accumulation
of water.
Observe the notes on off-road driving and ford‐
ing (/ page 176).
404 Technical data
Model
Off-road level 2
19.7 in (50 cm)
Off-road level 3
23.6 in (60 cm)
Mercedes‑Maybach
Raised level
Model
1 Fording
depth
Vehicles with AIRMATIC
Raised level
19.7 in (50 cm)
Vehicles with Off-road
package
Off-road level 1
19.7 in (50 cm)
1 Fording
depth
1 Fording
depth
19.7 in (50 cm)
Angle of approach/departure
The specified values are maximum values for
vehicles that are ready to drive.
Observe the notes on driving in mountainous ter‐
rain .
Angle of approach/departure
All models (vehi‐
cles without
AMG Styling)
1 Front
2 Rear
Normal level
23°
20°
Raised level
27°
24°
23°
20°
Vehicles with
AIRMATIC*
Vehicles with
Off-road package
Normal level
Technical data 405
All models (vehi‐
cles without
AMG Styling)
1 Front
2 Rear
Off-road level 1
25°
22°
Off-road level 2
27°
Off-road level 3
All models (vehi‐
cles with AMG
Styling)
All models (vehi‐
cles with AMG
Styling)
1 Front
2 Rear
Off-road level 2
25°
24°
24°
Off-road level 3
27° - 28°
25° - 26°
29°
26°
1 Front
2 Rear
1 Front
2 Rear
Mercedes‑May‐
bach
Normal level
24°
21°
Raised level
27°
25°
Vehicles with
AIRMATIC
*Depending on the tire size.
Normal level
21° - 22°
20° - 21°
Raised level
25°
24°
Vehicles with
Off-road package
Normal level
21° - 22°
20° - 21°
Off-road level 1
23° - 24°
22° - 23°
Maximum gradient climbing ability
The vehicle's gradient climbing ability depends
on the weight distribution in the vehicle, the ter‐
rain conditions and the road surface conditions.
The specified value applies when:
R the vehicle is ready to drive
R the LOW RANGE off-road gear of the trans‐
fer case is engaged
R
the road surfaces conditions and thus the
traction are good
A gradient climbing ability of 100% corresponds
to an incline of 45°.
Observe the notes on driving in mountainous ter‐
rain .
Model
Maximum gra‐
dient climbing
ability
Vehicles without Offroad package
80%
Vehicles with Off-road
package
When LOW RANGE offroad gear is engaged
100%
Mercedes‑Maybach
All models
Maximum gra‐
dient climbing
ability
80%
406 Technical data
Trailer hitch
General notes on the trailer hitch
Modifications to the engine cooling system may
be necessary, depending on the vehicle model.
The retrofitting of a trailer hitch is only permissi‐
ble if a towing capacity is specified in your vehi‐
cle documents.
Further information can be obtained at a quali‐
fied specialist workshop.
Towing capacity
The tongue weight is not included in the towing
capacity.
Model
All models
Mercedes‑Maybach
All models
Towing capacity,
braked
7716.2 lbs (3500 kg)
Towing capacity,
braked
7716.2 lbs (3500 kg)
Maximum tongue weight and load capacity
* NOTE Damage caused by the trailer
coming loose
If the tongue weight used is too low, the
trailer may come loose.
# The tongue weight must not be below
110.2 lb (50 kg).
# Use a tongue weight that is as close as
possible to the maximum permissible
tongue weight.
* NOTE Damage caused by the bicycle
rack coming loose
When using a bicycle rack, both the maximal
tongue weight and the maximal load capacity
should be observed.
# Do not exceed the permissible load
capacity.
Observe the additional notes on load capacity .
Tongue weight
Model
Maximum tongue
weight
All models
617.3 lbs (280 kg)
Mercedes‑Maybach
Maximum tongue
weight
All models
617.3 lbs (280 kg)
Missing values were not yet available at the time
of going to press.
Load capacity
Model
Maximum load
All models
Mercedes‑Maybach
Maximum load
All models
Permissible rear axle load (trailer operation)
Missing values were not available at the time of
going to press.
Technical data 407
Axle load
Model
All models
Mercedes‑Maybach
All models
Axle load
4078.5 lbs (1850 kg)
Axle load
408 Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
Display messages
Introduction
Notes about display messages
Display messages appear on the multifunction
display.
Display messages with graphic symbols are sim‐
plified in the Operator's Manual and may differ
from the symbols on the multifunction display.
The multifunction display shows high-priority dis‐
play messages in red. Certain display messages
are accompanied by a warning tone.
Please act in accordance with the display mes‐
sages and follow the additional notes in the
Operator's Manual.
For some display messages, a symbol will also
be shown:
R Õ Further information
R ¨ Hide display message
With the left-hand Touch Control, you can select
the respective symbol by swiping to the left or
right. Press the Õ symbol to show further infor‐
mation on the multifunction display. Press the
¨ symbol to hide the display message.
You can hide low-priority display messages by
pressing the P button or the left-hand Touch
Control. The display messages will then be
stored in the message memory.
Rectify the cause of a display message as
quickly as possible.
High-priority display messages cannot be hid‐
den. The multifunction display shows these dis‐
play messages continuously until the cause of
the display message has been rectified.
Calling up saved display messages
On-board computer:
4 Service 5 1 Message
If there are no display messages, No Messages
will appear on the multifunction display.
# Scroll through the display messages by swip‐
ing upwards or downwards on the left-hand
Touch Control.
# To exit the message memory: press the
P button.
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps 409
Occupant safety
Display messages
6
SRS Malfunction Service
Required
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
* The restraint system is malfunctioning (/ page 37).
& WARNING Risk of injury due to malfunctions in the restraint system
Components in the restraint system may be activated unintentionally or not deploy as planned in an accident.
# Have the restraint system checked and repaired immediately at a qualified specialist workshop.
6
* The corresponding restraint system is malfunctioning (/ page 37).
6
* The corresponding window curtain airbag is malfunctioning (/ page 37).
Front Left Malfunction
Service Required (example)
Left Side Curtain Airbag
Malfunction Service
Required (example)
& WARNING Risk of injury due to malfunctions in the restraint system
Components in the restraint system may be activated unintentionally or not deploy as planned in an accident.
# Have the restraint system checked and repaired immediately at a qualified specialist workshop.
& WARNING Risk of injury or fatal injury due to a malfunction in the window curtain airbag
The window curtain airbag might be triggered unintentionally or might not be triggered at all in the event of an
accident.
# Have the window curtain airbag checked and repaired immediately at a qualified specialist workshop.
410 Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
Display messages
Front Passenger Airbag Disabled See Operator's Manual
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
* The front passenger airbag has been disabled even though an adult or a person of adult stature is on the front
passenger seat. If additional forces are applied to the seat, the weight the system detects may be too low.
& WARNING Risk of injury or fatal injury due to a disabled front passenger airbag
If the front passenger airbag is disabled, the front passenger airbag will not be deployed in the event of an acci‐
dent and cannot perform its intended protective function.
A person in the front passenger seat could then, for example, come into contact with the vehicle's interior,
especially if the person is sitting too close to the cockpit.
# Make sure, both before and during the journey, that the status of the front passenger airbag is correct.
#
#
#
Front Passenger Airbag
Enabled See Operator's
Manual
Stop the vehicle immediately in accordance with the traffic conditions.
Check the status of the automatic front passenger airbag actuation (/ page 47).
If necessary, consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
* The front passenger airbag is enabled while the vehicle is in motion:
R even when a child, a person of smaller stature or an object weighing less than the system weight threshold is
located on the front passenger seat
R even when the front passenger seat is not occupied
The system may detect objects or forces that are adding to the weight applied to the seat.
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps 411
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
& WARNING Risk of injury or fatal injury when using a child restraint system while the front passenger airbag
is enabled
If you secure a child in a child restraint system on the front passenger seat and the front passenger airbag is
enabled, the front passenger airbag may deploy in the event of an accident.
The child could be struck by the airbag.
# Both before and during the journey, ensure that the status of the front passenger airbag is correct.
NEVER use a child restraint system facing to the rear on a seat with an ACTIVATED FRONT AIRBAG. DEATH or
SERIOUS INJURY to the child can occur.
#
#
#
Stop the vehicle immediately in accordance with the traffic conditions.
Check the status of the automatic front passenger airbag actuation (/ page 47).
If necessary, consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
PRE-SAFE Inoperative See
Operator's Manual
* The PRE‑SAFE® functions are malfunctioning.
# Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
PRE-SAFE Impulse Side
Inoperative See Operator's
Manual
* The PRE‑SAFE® Impulse Side system is malfunctioning or inoperative after having already been triggered.
# Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
412 Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
SmartKey
Display messages
Á
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
* The SmartKey needs to be replaced.
# Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Obtain a New Key
Á
* The SmartKey battery is discharged.
# Replace the battery (/ page 69).
Replace Key Battery
Á
Key Not Detected (white
display message)
* The SmartKey is currently undetected.
# Change the location of the SmartKey in the vehicle.
# If the SmartKey is still not recognized, place it in the marked space for starting with the SmartKey
(/ page 169).
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps 413
Display messages
Á
Key Not Detected (red dis‐
play message)
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
* The SmartKey cannot be detected and may no longer be in the vehicle.
The SmartKey is no longer in the vehicle and you switch off the engine:
R You can no longer start the engine.
R You cannot centrally lock the vehicle.
#
Ensure that the SmartKey is in the vehicle.
If the SmartKey detection function has a malfunction due to a strong radio signal source:
Stop the vehicle immediately in accordance with the traffic conditions.
# Place the SmartKey in the marked space for starting the engine with the SmartKey (/ page 169).
#
Place the Key in the
Marked Space See Operator's Manual
Á
Don't Forget Your Key
* SmartKey detection is malfunctioning.
# Change the location of the SmartKey in the vehicle.
# Place the SmartKey in the marked space for starting the engine with the SmartKey (/ page 169).
* A warning tone will also sound. This message reminds you to take your SmartKey with you when you leave the
vehicle.
414 Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
Lights
Display messages
:
Check Left Low
Beam (example)
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
* The corresponding light source is faulty.
# Drive on carefully.
# Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
% LED light sources: the display message for the corresponding light appears only when all the light-emitting
diodes in the light are faulty.
:
* The exterior lighting is malfunctioning.
# Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
:
* The light sensor is malfunctioning.
# Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Malfunction See Operator’s Manual
Automatic Headlamp Mode
Inoperative
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps 415
Display messages
:
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
* The active headlamps are malfunctioning.
# Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Active Headlamps Inoperative
:
* You are driving without low-beam headlamps.
# Turn the light switch to the L or à position.
:
* You are leaving the vehicle and the lights are still switched on.
# Turn the light switch to the à position.
:
* The Intelligent Light System is malfunctioning. The lighting system continues to function properly without the func‐
tions of the Intelligent Light System.
# Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Switch On Headlamps
Switch Off Lights
Intell. Light System Inoperative
416 Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Adaptive Highbeam Assist
Currently Unavailable See
Operator's Manual
* Adaptive Highbeam Assist is temporarily unavailable.
The system limits have been reached (/ page 146).
# Drive on.
Once the cause of the problem is no longer present, the system will be available again. The Adaptive Highbeam
Assist Now Available display message will appear.
Adaptive Highbeam Assist
Inoperative
* Adaptive Highbeam Assist is malfunctioning.
# Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Hazard Warning Flashers
Malfunctioning
* The hazard warning lamp switch is malfunctioning.
# Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Vehicle
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Update Successfully Completed
* Installation of the software update has been successfully completed (/ page 290).
Update Failed Software
Remains Unchanged
* An error occurred during installation of the software update (/ page 290).
The previous software version remains in place.
Update Failed
* An error occurred during installation of the software update (/ page 290).
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps 417
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Make a Mercedes me call via the overhead control panel (/ page 304).
d
* You are leaving the vehicle when it is in a ready-to-drive state.
# When you leave the vehicle, switch off the ignition, secure the vehicle against rolling away and take the Smart‐
Key with you.
# If you do not leave the vehicle, switch off the electrical consumers, e.g. the seat heating. Otherwise, the 12 V
battery may discharge and it will then be possible to start the vehicle only with the aid of a second battery
(starting assistance).
Running Boards Not Retracted Pay Attention to
Excess Width of Vehicle
* Mercedes-Maybach vehicles: the running boards are not retracted.
R The running boards can be retracted via the multimedia system only when the vehicle is stationary
(/ page 75).
R The running boards and the side skirt must be free of dirt, ice and snow. Otherwise, they are unable to retract.
Vehicle Ready to Drive
Switch the Ignition Off
Before Exiting
#
#
#
Clean the running boards (/ page 332).
Repeat the retraction of the running boards (/ page 74).
If the running boards cannot be retracted again, consult a qualified specialist workshop.
If the running boards are not retracted, check the excess width of the vehicle.
418 Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
Display messages
y
Running Board Not Extended
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
* Mercedes-Maybach vehicles: the running boards are not extended.
R The running boards extend only when the vehicle is stationary.
R The running boards and the side skirt must be free of dirt, ice and snow. Otherwise, they are unable to extend.
#
#
#
Clean the running boards (/ page 332).
Repeat the extension of the running boards (/ page 74).
If the running boards fail to extend again, consult a qualified specialist workshop.
If the running boards are not extended, be particularly careful when getting in or out.
Ù
* The power steering assistance is malfunctioning.
Ù
* The steering is malfunctioning. Steering capability is significantly impaired.
Steering Malfunction
Increased Physical Effort
See Operator's Manual
Steering Malfunction Stop
Immediately See Operator's Manual
& WARNING Risk of an accident due to altered steering characteristics
If the power assistance of the steering fails partially or completely, you will need to use more force to steer.
# If safe steering is possible, drive on carefully.
# Visit or consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
& WARNING Risk of accident if steering capability is impaired
If the steering does not function as intended, the vehicle's operating safety is jeopardized.
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps 419
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
#
#
C
?
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying attention to road and traffic conditions.
Do not continue driving under any circumstances.
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
* At least one door is open.
# Close all doors.
* The hood is open.
& WARNING Risk of accident due to driving with the hood unlocked
The hood may open and block your view.
Never release the hood when driving.
# Before every trip, ensure that the hood is locked.
#
#
#
A
Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic conditions.
Close the hood.
* The tailgate is open.
420 Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
& DANGER Risk of exhaust gas poisoning
Combustion engines emit poisonous exhaust gases such as carbon monoxide. Exhaust gases can enter the
vehicle interior if the tailgate is open when the engine is running, especially if the vehicle is in motion.
# Always switch off the engine before opening the tailgate.
# Never drive with the tailgate open.
#
Close the tailgate.
LOW RANGE Only When
Vehicle Is Stationary
* One or more shifting conditions have not been met.
# Stop the vehicle.
# Engage neutral i.
# Repeat the gear change.
LOW RANGE Shift to Position N Briefly
* One or more shifting conditions have not been met.
# Engage neutral i.
# Repeat the gear change.
LOW RANGE Not in Drive
Program "Sport"
* You will not be able to select the LOW RANGE off-road gear if the drive program C or B is switched on.
The drive program therefore automatically switches to A.
# Select the LOW RANGE off-road gear (/ page 190).
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps 421
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
LOW RANGE Malfunction
To Park, Apply Brake
* The transfer case is malfunctioning.
# Do not shift the transfer case.
# Use the electric parking brake to secure the vehicle against rolling away.
# Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
LOW RANGE Shifting Canceled Please Reactivate
* The transfer case did not perform the gear change.
# Repeat the gear change.
# Ensure all shifting conditions are met (/ page 190).
LOW RANGE Malfunction
* The transfer case is malfunctioning.
# Do not shift the transfer case!
# Use the electric parking brake to secure the vehicle against rolling away.
# Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
LOW RANGE Stop Apply
Parking Brake
* The transfer case is malfunctioning.
# Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying attention to road and traffic conditions.
# Apply the electric parking brake.
# Where necessary, also secure the vehicle against rolling away.
# Engage park position j.
LOW RANGE Max. Speed 6
mph
* The maximum speed of 6 mph (10 km/h) for the gear change has been exceeded.
422 Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
#
#
Drive more slowly.
Repeat the gear change.
LOW RANGE Max. Speed
25 mph
* The maximum speed of 25 mph (40 km/h) for the gear change has been exceeded.
# Drive more slowly.
# Repeat the gear change.
Gearbox Protection Limit
18 mph Disable LOW
RANGE
* The oil temperature in the transfer case is too high.
# In the on-road position, shift to HIGH RANGE.
¥
* The washer fluid level in the washer fluid reservoir has dropped below the minimum.
# Add washer fluid (/ page 327).
Check Washer Fluid
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps 423
Engine
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
To switch engine off, press
and hold Start/Stop button for at least 3 seconds
or press 3 times.
* You have pressed the start/stop button while the vehicle is in motion.
# Information about switching off the engine while driving (/ page 169).
+
* The coolant level is too low.
Check Coolant Level See
Operator's Manual
* NOTE Engine damage due to insufficient coolant
#
#
#
ÿ
Coolant Too Hot Stop Vehicle Turn Engine Off
Avoid long journeys with insufficient coolant.
Add coolant (/ page 326).
Have the engine cooling system checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
* The coolant is too hot.
# Pull over and stop the vehicle safely and switch off the engine, paying attention to road and traffic conditions.
& WARNING Danger of burns when opening the hood
If you open the hood when the engine has overheated or during a fire in the engine compartment, you could
come into contact with hot gases or other escaping operating fluids.
# Before opening the hood, allow the engine to cool down.
424 Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
#
#
#
#
ÿ
8
In the event of a fire in the engine compartment, keep the hood closed and call the fire service.
Wait until the engine has cooled down.
Make sure that the air supply to the radiator is not obstructed.
Avoiding high loads on the engine, drive to the nearest qualified specialist workshop. In doing so, ensure that
the coolant temperature display remains below the red marking.
* The fan motor is faulty.
# Avoiding high loads on the engine, drive to the nearest qualified specialist workshop. In doing so, ensure that
the coolant temperature display remains below the red marking.
* The fuel supply has dropped into the reserve range.
# Refuel.
Fuel Level Low
8
Gas Cap Loose
* The fuel filler cap is not closed correctly or the fuel system is leaking.
# Close the fuel filler cap.
# If the fuel filler cap was already properly closed: consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps 425
Transmission
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Only Shift to 'P' when Vehicle is Stationary
* Park position j can be engaged only when the vehicle is stationary.
# To stop, depress the brake pedal.
# Shift the transmission to park position j while the vehicle is stationary.
Apply Brake to Shift from
'P'
* You have attempted to shift the transmission out of park position j and into another transmission position.
# Depress the brake pedal.
# Select transmission position h, k or neutral i.
To Deselect P or N,
Depress Brake and Start
Engine
* You have attempted to shift the transmission out of park position j or neutral i and into another transmission
position.
# Depress the brake pedal.
# Change the transmission position.
# Start the engine.
Apply Brake to Shift to D or
R
* You have attempted to select transmission position h or k.
# Depress the brake pedal.
# Select transmission position h or k.
Apply Brake to Shift to 'R'
* You have attempted to select transmission position k.
# Depress the brake pedal.
# Select transmission position k.
426 Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Driver's Door Open &
Transmission Not in P Risk
of Vehicle Rolling Away
* The driver's door is not fully closed and transmission position h, k or neutral i is selected.
# Select park position j when switching off the vehicle.
N Permanently Active Risk
of Rolling Away
* While the vehicle is rolling or while you are driving, neutral i has been engaged.
# To stop, depress the brake pedal.
# Shift the transmission to park position j while the vehicle is stationary.
# To continue driving, select transmission position h or k.
Service Required Do Not
Shift Gears Visit Dealer
* The transmission is malfunctioning. The transmission position can no longer be changed.
# When transmission position h is selected, consult a qualified specialist workshop and do not change the trans‐
mission position.
# For all other transmission positions, park the vehicle safely.
# Consult a qualified specialist workshop or breakdown service.
Reversing Not Possible
Service Required
* The transmission is malfunctioning. The transmission position k cannot be selected.
# Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Transmission Malfunction
Stop
* The transmission is malfunctioning. The transmission shifts to neutral i automatically.
# Stop the vehicle immediately in accordance with the traffic conditions.
# Depress the brake pedal.
# Engage park position j.
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps 427
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
#
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Stop Vehicle Leave Engine
Running Wait Transmission
Cooling
* The transmission is overheating. Pulling away may be temporarily impaired or not possible.
# Stop the vehicle immediately in accordance with the traffic conditions. Do not continue driving.
# Leave the engine running.
# Wait until the display message disappears before pulling away.
Auxiliary Battery Malfunction
* The auxiliary battery for the transmission is no longer being charged.
# Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
# Until then, always select park position j manually before you switch off the engine.
# Before leaving the vehicle, apply the electric parking brake.
428 Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
Brakes
Display messages
F
(USA only)
!
(Canada only)
Parking Brake See Operator's Manual
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
* The yellow ! indicator lamp is lit. The electric parking brake is malfunctioning.
To apply:
# Switch the ignition off and switch it back on.
# Apply the electric parking brake manually (/ page 199).
If it is not possible to apply the electric parking brake:
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
# Where necessary, also secure the parked vehicle against rolling away.
* The yellow ! indicator lamp and the red F (USA only) or ! (Canada only) indicator lamp are lit. The elec‐
tric parking brake is malfunctioning.
To release:
# Switch the ignition off and switch it back on.
# Release the electric parking brake manually (/ page 199).
or
# Release the electric parking brake automatically (/ page 199).
If it is still not possible to release the electric parking brake:
# Do not continue driving. Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
#
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps 429
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
* The yellow ! indicator lamp is lit and the red F (USA only) or ! (Canada only) indicator lamp is flashing.
The electric parking brake is malfunctioning.
The electric parking brake could not be applied or released.
# Switch the ignition off and switch it back on.
To apply:
Release and then apply the electric parking brake manually (/ page 199).
#
To release:
Apply and then release the electric parking brake manually.
#
If the electric parking brake cannot be applied or the red F (USA only) or ! (Canada only) indicator lamp
continues to flash:
# Do not continue driving. Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
# Where necessary, also secure the parked vehicle against rolling away.
* The yellow ! indicator lamp is lit and the red F indicator lamp (USA only) or ! indicator lamp (Can‐
ada only) flashes for approximately ten seconds after the electric parking brake has been applied or released. It
then remains lit or goes out. The electric parking brake is malfunctioning.
If the charge level is too low:
# Charge the 12 V battery.
430 Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
To apply:
switch the ignition off.
The electric parking brake will be applied automatically.
#
If the electric parking brake is not to be applied, e.g. at an automatic car wash or when the vehicle is being towed,
leave the ignition switched on. This does not include having the vehicle towed with the rear axle raised.
If the electric parking brake is not applied automatically:
# Switch the ignition off and switch it back on.
# Release and then apply the electric parking brake manually (/ page 199).
If it is still not possible to apply the electric parking brake:
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
# Where necessary, also secure the parked vehicle against rolling away.
#
To release:
If the conditions for automatic release are fulfilled and the electric parking brake is not released automatically,
release the electric parking brake manually (/ page 199).
#
If it is still not possible to release the electric parking brake:
Do not continue driving. Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
#
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps 431
Display messages
F
(USA only)
!
(Canada only)
Please Release Parking
Brake
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
* The red F indicator lamp (USA only) or ! indicator lamp (Canada only) is flashing.
The electric parking brake is applied while you are driving:
R A condition for automatic release of the electric parking brake has not been fulfilled (/ page 199).
R You are performing emergency braking using the electric parking brake (/ page 199).
#
#
Check the conditions for automatic release of the electric parking brake.
Release the electric parking brake manually.
432 Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
Display messages
F
(USA only)
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
* The red F (USA only) or ! indicator lamp (Canada only) is lit.
You have attempted to release the electric parking brake with the ignition switched off.
# Switch on the ignition.
!
(Canada only)
Turn On the Ignition to
Release the Parking Brake
$
(USA only)
J
(Canada only)
Check Brake Fluid Level
* There is insufficient brake fluid in the brake fluid reservoir.
& WARNING Risk of an accident due to low brake fluid level
If the brake fluid level is too low, the braking effect and the braking characteristics may be impaired.
# Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying attention to road and traffic conditions.
Do not continue driving under any circumstances.
# Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
# Do not add brake fluid.
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps 433
Display messages
#
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
* The brakepads have reached the wear limit.
# Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Check Brake Pads See
Operator's Manual
Driving systems
Display messages
é
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
* ATTENTION ASSIST is malfunctioning.
# Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
ATTENTION ASSIST Inoperative
é
ATTENTION ASSIST: Take a
Break!
* ATTENTION ASSIST has detected fatigue or an increasing lack of concentration on the part of the driver
(/ page 261).
# If necessary, take a break.
434 Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
Display messages
ä
Malfunction Drive at Max.
50 mph
E-ACTIVE BODY CONTROL
Function Limited See Operator's Manual
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
* AIRMATIC is functioning only to a limited extent. The vehicle's handling characteristics may be affected.
# Drive in a manner appropriate for the current level, but do not exceed 50 mph (80 km/h).
# Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
* At least one main function of the E-ACTIVE BODY CONTROL system is malfunctioning.
The system is outside the operating temperature range or the on-board electrical system voltage is too low.
* NOTE The vehicle's suspension and damping behavior is restricted. The vehicle body may tilt heavily to the
side during cornering.
#
#
#
#
#
#
Drive on carefully.
Reduce speed considerably before taking a bend.
Avoid sudden steering movements.
Drive on carefully.
Reduce speed considerably before taking a bend.
Avoid sudden steering movements.
Once the cause of the problem is no longer present, the system will be available again.
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps 435
Display messages
Selected Level Not Available When Rear Fog Lamp
On
Â
Lowering
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
* You cannot select off-road level +3.
# Switch off the rear fog lamp.
* The vehicle level may be lowered for the following reasons:
R You have selected a different drive program.
R You have exceeded the speed limit.
R You have changed the vehicle level by pressing the button.
R Operation with a trailer or bicycle rack: if an electrical connection has been correctly made, you have excee‐
ded the speed limit.
R You have switched on the rear fog lamp in the off-road level +3.
Á
* Your vehicle is adjusting to the level you have selected.
ä
* At least one main function of the E-ACTIVE BODY CONTROL system is malfunctioning.
The system is deactivated.
Vehicle Rising
Malfunction Drive at Max.
50 mph
436 Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
* NOTE The vehicle's suspension and damping behavior has changed significantly, the vehicle body may tilt
heavily to the side during cornering.
#
#
#
#
#
#
ä
Reduce vehicle speed. Drive on carefully.
Reduce the vehicle speed considerably before taking a curve.
Avoid sudden steering movements.
Continue driving carefully and do not exceed 50 mph (80 km/h).
If possible, stop the vehicle in accordance with the traffic conditions and switch the ignition off and on again.
If the display message still appears, consult a qualified specialist workshop.
* There is a serious malfunction affecting the hydraulics of the E-ACTIVE BODY CONTROL system.
The system is deactivated.
* NOTE The vehicle's driving characteristics have changed significantly.
Malfunction Stop
#
#
#
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible in accordance with the traffic conditions. Do not
continue driving under any circumstances.
Stop the vehicle immediately in accordance with the traffic conditions. Do not continue driving under any cir‐
cumstances.
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps 437
Display messages
Á
Drive More Slowly
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
* You are driving too fast for the selected vehicle level.
# Drive more slowly and then select the desired vehicle level again.
You are driving too quickly with a trailer or the trailer hitch socket is being used, e.g. for a rear cycle rack.
Read the information on trailer operation.
#
Á
* The vehicle level is too low. The vehicle will be raised to the selected vehicle level.
# Wait until the display message disappears before pulling away.
Á
* Due to frequent level changes within a short space of time, the compressor first needs to cool down in order to set
the selected vehicle level.
# Drive on in a manner appropriate for the current level. Make sure that there is sufficient ground clearance.
When the compressor has cooled down, the vehicle will continue rising to the selected vehicle level.
Active Steering Assist Currently Unavailable See
Operator's Manual
* Active Steering Assist is temporarily unavailable.
The ambient conditions are outside the system limits (/ page 222).
# Drive on.
As soon as the ambient conditions are within the system limits, the system will become available again.
# If necessary, clean the windshield in the camera's field of vision.
# Check the tire pressure if necessary.
Vehicle Rising Please Wait
Compressor Is Cooling
438 Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
Display messages
Active Steering Assist Inoperative
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
* Active Steering Assist is malfunctioning. Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC remains available.
# Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Ø
* Active Steering Assist has reached the system limits (/ page 222).
You have not steered independently for a considerable period of time.
# Take over the steering and drive on in accordance with the traffic conditions.
Beginning Emergency Stop
* Your hands are not on the steering wheel. An emergency stop is being initiated (/ page 226).
# Put your hands back on the steering wheel.
You can cancel the deceleration at any time by performing one of the following actions:
R Steering
R Depressing the brake or accelerator pedal
R Pressing a steering-wheel button
R Operating Touch Control
R Deactivating Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC
Active Steering Asst. Currently Unavailable Due to
Multiple Emergency Stops
* Active Steering Assist is temporarily unavailable due to multiple emergency stops.
# Take over the steering and stop in accordance with the traffic conditions.
# Switch the ignition off and switch it back on.
Active Steering Assist is available once more.
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps 439
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Active Lane Keeping Assist
Currently Unavailable See
Operator's Manual
* Active Lane Keeping Assist is temporarily unavailable.
The ambient conditions are outside the system limits (/ page 267).
# Drive on.
As soon as the ambient conditions are within the system limits, the system will become available again.
Active Lane Keeping Assist
Inoperative
* Active Lane Keeping Assist is malfunctioning.
# Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Active Stop & Go Assist
Currently Unavailable See
Operator's Manual
* Active Stop-and-Go Assist is temporarily unavailable. Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC and Active Steering Assist
are still available.
The ambient conditions are outside the system limits (/ page 227).
# Drive on.
As soon as the ambient conditions are within the system limits, the system will become available again.
Active Stop & Go Assist
Inoperative See Operator's
Manual
* Active Stop-and-Go Assist is malfunctioning.
Active Stop-and-Go Assist is deactivated. Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC and Active Steering Assist are still
available.
# Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Blind Spot Assist Currently
Unavailable See Operator's
Manual
* Blind Spot Assist is temporarily unavailable.
The system limits have been reached (/ page 264).
# Drive on.
Once the cause of the problem is no longer present, the system will be available again.
440 Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
or
#
If the display message does not disappear, stop the vehicle in accordance with the traffic conditions and restart
the engine.
Blind Spot Assist Inoperative
* Blind Spot Assist is malfunctioning.
# Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Blind Spot Assist Not Available When Towing a Trailer
See Operator's Manual
* When you establish the electrical connection to the trailer, Blind Spot Assist is unavailable.
# Press the left-hand Touch Control and acknowledge the display message.
Active Blind Spot Assist
Currently Unavailable See
Operator's Manual
* Active Blind Spot Assist is temporarily unavailable.
The system limits have been reached (/ page 264).
# Drive on.
Once the cause of the problem is no longer present, the system will be available again.
or
# If the display message does not disappear, stop the vehicle in accordance with the traffic conditions and restart
the engine.
Active Blind Spot Assist
Inoperative
* Active Blind Spot Assist is malfunctioning.
# Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps 441
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Active Blind Spot Asst. Not
Available When Towing a
Trailer See Operator's Manual
* When you establish the electrical connection to the trailer, Active Blind Spot Assist is unavailable.
# Press the left-hand Touch Control and acknowledge the display message.
Active Parking Assist and
PARKTRONIC Inoperative
See Operator's Manual
* Active Parking Assist and Parking Assist PARKTRONIC are malfunctioning.
# Stop the vehicle in accordance with the traffic conditions and restart the engine.
# If the display message still appears, consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Traffic Sign Assist Currently Unavailable See
Operator's Manual
* Traffic Sign Assist is temporarily unavailable.
# Drive on.
Once the cause of the problem is no longer present, the system will be available again.
Traffic Sign Assist Inoperative
* Traffic Sign Assist is malfunctioning.
# Stop the vehicle in accordance with the traffic conditions and restart the engine.
# If the display message still appears, consult a qualified specialist workshop.
442 Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
Display messages
ç
Ã
Ä
¸
Currently Unavailable
Radar Sensors Dirty
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
* The radar sensor system is malfunctioning. Possible causes:
R dirt on the sensors
R heavy rain or snow
R extended country driving without other traffic, e.g. in the desert
Driving systems and driving safety systems may be malfunctioning or temporarily unavailable.
Once the cause of the problem is no longer present, the driving systems and driving safety systems will be available
again.
If the display message does not disappear:
# Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying attention to road and traffic conditions.
# Clean all sensors (/ page 332).
# Restart the engine.
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps 443
Display messages
_
Ã
Ä
à
á
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
* The camera view is restricted. Possible causes:
R Dirt on the windshield in the camera's field of vision
R Heavy rain, snow or fog
R Condensation on the windshield in front of the camera
% Condensation detected on the windshield will be automatically removed using a built-in heater within approx‐
imately 12 minutes.
Driving systems and driving safety systems may be malfunctioning or temporarily unavailable.
Once the cause of the problem is no longer present, the driving systems and driving safety systems will be available
again.
If the display message does not disappear:
# Stop the vehicle in accordance with the traffic conditions.
# Clean the windshield if necessary.
Currently Unavailable Camera View Restricted
ë
Off
* The HOLD function is deactivated because the vehicle is slipping or a condition for activation is not fulfilled.
# Reactivate the HOLD function later or check the activation conditions for the HOLD function (/ page 228).
444 Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
Display messages
î
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
* The Downhill Speed Regulation is malfunctioning.
# Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Inoperative
î
* The Downhill Speed Regulation is not available in the currently selected drive program.
# Change the drive program (/ page 182).
î
* The maximum speed of 25 mph (40 km/h) for the Downhill Speed Regulation has been exceeded.
# Drive more slowly.
ç
* Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC cannot be activated as not all activation conditions are fulfilled.
# Comply with the activation conditions of Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC (/ page 218).
Not in Curr. Drive Prog.
Max. Speed 25 mph
- - - mph
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps 445
Display messages
ç
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
* If you depress the accelerator pedal beyond the Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC setting, the system will switch
to passive mode (/ page 216).
Suspended
ç
* Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC was deactivated. If a warning tone also sounds, Active Distance Assist
DISTRONIC has deactivated automatically (/ page 218).
Active Distance Assist Currently Unavailable See
Operator's Manual
* Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC is temporarily unavailable.
The ambient conditions are outside the system limits (/ page 216).
# Drive on.
As soon as the ambient conditions are within the system limits, the system will become available again.
Active Distance Assist Inoperative
* Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC is malfunctioning.
Other driving systems and driving safety systems may also be malfunctioning.
# Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Active Distance Assist Now
Available
* Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC is operational again and can be activated (/ page 218).
Off
446 Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
Display messages
¯
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
* Cruise control cannot be activated as not all activation conditions are fulfilled.
# Observe the activation conditions for cruise control (/ page 213).
- - - mph
Cruise Control Inoperative
* Cruise control is malfunctioning.
# Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Cruise Control Off
* Cruise control has been deactivated.
If there is an additional warning tone, cruise control has been deactivated automatically (/ page 212).
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps 447
Driving safety systems
Display messages
!
÷
Currently Unavailable See
Operator's Manual
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
* ABS and ESP® are temporarily unavailable.
Other driving systems and driving safety systems (e.g. BAS) may also be temporarily unavailable.
The brake system will continue to operate normally. The braking distance in an emergency braking situation can
increase.
& WARNING Risk of skidding if ABS and ESP® are malfunctioning
The wheels may block during braking and ESP® does not perform any vehicle stabilization.
The steerability and braking characteristics are heavily impaired and the braking distance may increase. In addi‐
tion, other driving safety systems are switched off.
# Drive on carefully.
# Have ABS and ESP® checked immediately at a qualified specialist workshop.
#
#
Drive carefully on a suitable stretch of road, making slight steering movements at a speed above 19 mph
(30 km/h).
If the display message does not disappear, consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately. Drive carefully.
448 Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
Display messages
!
÷
Inoperative See Operator's
Manual
÷
Currently Unavailable See
Operator's Manual
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
* ABS and ESP® are malfunctioning.
Other driving systems and driving safety systems (e.g. BAS) may also be malfunctioning.
The brake system will continue to operate normally. The braking distance in an emergency braking situation can
increase.
& WARNING Risk of skidding if ABS and ESP® are malfunctioning
The wheels may block during braking and ESP® does not perform any vehicle stabilization.
The steerability and braking characteristics are heavily impaired and the braking distance may increase. In addi‐
tion, other driving safety systems are switched off.
# Drive on carefully.
# Have ABS and ESP® checked immediately at a qualified specialist workshop.
* ESP® is temporarily unavailable.
Other driving systems and driving safety systems (e.g. BAS) may also be malfunctioning.
& WARNING Risk of skidding if ESP® is malfunctioning
If ESP® is malfunctioning, ESP® cannot carry out vehicle stabilization. In addition, other driving safety systems
are switched off.
# Drive on carefully.
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps 449
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
#
#
#
÷
Inoperative See Operator's
Manual
Have ESP® checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
Drive carefully on a suitable stretch of road, making slight steering movements at a speed above 19 mph
(30 km/h).
If the display message does not disappear, consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately. Drive carefully.
* ESP® is malfunctioning.
Other driving systems and driving safety systems (e.g. BAS) may also be malfunctioning.
The brake system will continue to operate normally. The braking distance in an emergency braking situation can
increase.
& WARNING Risk of skidding if ESP® is malfunctioning
If ESP® is malfunctioning, ESP® cannot carry out vehicle stabilization. In addition, other driving safety systems
are switched off.
# Drive on carefully.
# Have ESP® checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
450 Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
Display messages
T
!
÷
Inoperative See Operator's
Manual
Active Brake Assist Functions Currently Limited See
Operator's Manual
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
* EBD, ABS and ESP® are malfunctioning.
Other driving systems and driving safety systems (e.g. BAS) may also be malfunctioning.
& WARNING Risk of skidding if EBD, ABS and ESP® are malfunctioning
The wheels may block during braking and ESP® does not perform any vehicle stabilization.
The steerability and braking characteristics are heavily impaired and the braking distance may increase. In addi‐
tion, other driving safety systems are switched off.
# Drive on carefully.
# Have the brake system checked immediately at a qualified specialist workshop.
* Vehicles with the Driving Assistance Package: Active Brake Assist with cross-traffic function, Evasive Steering
Assist or PRE‑SAFE® PLUS are temporarily unavailable or only partially available.
Vehicles without the Driving Assistance Package: Active Brake Assist is temporarily unavailable or only partially
available.
The ambient conditions are outside the system limits (/ page 207).
# Drive on.
As soon as the ambient conditions are within the system limits, the system will become available again.
# If the display message does not disappear, stop the vehicle in accordance with the traffic conditions and restart
the engine.
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps 451
Display messages
Active Brake Assist Functions Limited See Operator's Manual
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
* Vehicles with Driving Assistance Package: Active Brake Assist with cross-traffic function, Evasive Steering
Assist or PRE‑SAFE® PLUS is malfunctioning.
Vehicles without Driving Assistance Package: Active Brake Assist is malfunctioning.
# Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Mercedes me connect
Display messages
Mercedes me connect
Services Limited See Operator's Manual
G
Inoperative
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
* The vehicle functions for malfunction detection are restricted.
At least one of the main functions of the Mercedes me connect system is malfunctioning.
# Observe the notes on the diagnostics connection (/ page 27).
# Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
* At least one of the main functions of the Mercedes me connect system or of the SOS emergency call system is
malfunctioning.
# Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
452 Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
Battery
Display messages
#
12 V Battery See Operator's Manual
#
See Operator's Manual
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
* The engine is off and the charge level is too low.
# Switch off electrical consumers that are not required.
To charge the battery:
Leave the engine running for a few minutes, or drive an extended distance.
* If the message appears while the engine is running, this indicates an on-board electrical system malfunction.
# Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
#
* The battery is not being charged.
* NOTE Possible engine damage if you continue driving
#
#
#
#
Do not continue driving under any circumstances.
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely and switch off the engine, paying attention to road and traffic conditions.
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps 453
Display messages
#
Stop Vehicle See Operator's Manual
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
* The battery is no longer being charged and the charge level is too low.
* NOTE Possible engine damage if you continue driving
#
#
#
#
#
#
Stop Vehicle Leave Engine
Running
Do not continue driving under any circumstances.
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Stop the vehicle immediately in accordance with the traffic conditions. Do not continue driving under any cir‐
cumstances.
Switch off the engine.
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
* The battery charge level is too low.
# Stop the vehicle immediately in accordance with the traffic conditions. Do not continue driving.
# Leave the engine running.
# Wait until the display message disappears before pulling away.
# If the display message does not disappear: consult a qualified specialist workshop.
454 Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
Display messages
Û
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
* The 48 V on-board electrical system has function restrictions. Convenience functions may be restricted.
# Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
48 V Battery See Operator's Manual
Ý
Please Wait Charging 48 V
Battery…
* The 48 V battery is discharged. You have switched on the ignition while the 12 V battery was being charged with a
suitable charger or while another vehicle was providing starting assistance.
The discharged 48 V battery is charged automatically via the voltage converter. After a few minutes, the Engine
Can Now Be Started display message will be shown on the multifunction display.
# Start the engine.
# Drive the vehicle for a while to charge the 12 V battery and the 48 V battery after disconnecting the charger
from the vehicle.
If the Engine Can Now Be Started display message does not appear after a few minutes:
Try to start the engine again.
# If the engine does not start, consult a qualified specialist workshop.
#
Cannot Start Engine See
Operator's Manual
* The charge level of the 48 V battery is too low. You can no longer start the engine.
# Switch off electrical consumers that are not required.
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps 455
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
#
Engine Can Now Be Started
Connect a suitable charger approved for Mercedes-Benz with sufficient charge output to the jump-start connec‐
tion point of the 12 V battery (/ page 347).
The 48 V battery is charged via the voltage converter in the vehicle.
* The 48 V battery has been charged automatically via the voltage converter.
# Start the engine and drive the vehicle for a while to charge the 12 V battery and the 48 V battery.
Tire pressure monitor
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Tire Press. Monitor Currently Unavailable
* There is interference from a powerful radio signal source. As a result, no signals from the tire pressure sensor are
being received. The tire pressure monitor is temporarily unavailable.
# Drive on.
The tire pressure monitor will restart automatically as soon as the cause has been rectified.
Tire Press. Monitor Inoperative
* The tire pressure monitor is malfunctioning.
& WARNING There is a risk of an accident if the tire pressure monitoring system is malfunctioning
The tire pressure monitoring system cannot issue a warning if there is pressure loss in one or more of the tires.
Tires with insufficient tire pressure may impair the driving characteristics as well as steering and braking.
# Have the tire pressure monitoring system checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
456 Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
Display messages
Tire Pressure Monitor Inoperative No Wheel Sensors
h
Wheel Sensor(s) Missing
h
Check Tires
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
* The wheels installed do not have suitable tire pressure sensors. The tire pressure monitor is deactivated.
# Install wheels with suitable tire pressure sensors.
* There is no signal from the tire pressure sensor of one or more wheels. No pressure value is displayed for the affec‐
ted tire.
# Have the faulty tire pressure sensor replaced at a qualified specialist workshop.
* The tire pressure in one or more tires has dropped significantly. The wheel position will be displayed.
& WARNING Risk of an accident due to insufficient tire pressure
R
R
R
The tires can burst.
The tires can wear excessively and/or unevenly.
The driving characteristics as well as the steering and braking may be greatly impaired.
You could then lose control of the vehicle.
# Observe the recommended tire pressures.
# Adjust the tire pressure if necessary.
#
#
Stop the vehicle in accordance with the traffic conditions.
Check the tire pressure (/ page 357) and the tires.
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps 457
Display messages
h
Please Correct Tire Pressure
h
Warning Tire Malfunction
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
* The tire pressure is too low in at least one of the tires, or the difference in tire pressure between the individual
wheels is too great.
# Check the tire pressure and add air, if necessary.
# When the tire pressure is correct, restart the tire pressure monitoring system (/ page 362).
* The tire pressure in one or more tires has dropped suddenly. The wheel position will be displayed.
& WARNING Risk of an accident from driving with a flat tire
R
R
The tires can overheat and cause a fire.
The driving characteristics as well as the steering and braking may be greatly impaired.
You could then lose control of the vehicle.
Do not drive on with a flat tire.
# Observe the notes on flat tires.
#
Notes on flat tires (/ page 338).
Stop the vehicle in accordance with the traffic conditions.
# Check the tires.
#
Tires Overheated
* At least one tire is overheating. The affected tires are displayed in red. At temperatures close to the limit value, the
tires are displayed in yellow.
458 Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
& WARNING Risk of an accident from driving with overheated tires
Overheated tires can burst.
# Reduce speed so that the tires cool down.
Decrease Speed
* At least one tire is overheating. The affected tires are displayed in red. At temperatures close to the limit value, the
tires are displayed in yellow.
& WARNING Risk of an accident from driving with overheated tires
Overheated tires can burst.
# Reduce speed so that the tires cool down.
Engine oil
Display messages
5
Check Engine Oil Level
(Add 1 quart)
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
* Display message only for certain engines:
The engine oil level has dropped to the minimum level.
* NOTE Engine damage caused by driving with insufficient engine oil
#
Avoid long journeys with insufficient engine oil.
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps 459
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
#
5
When next refueling, add 1.1 US qt (1 l) of engine oil (/ page 325).
Notes on engine oil (/ page 396).
* Display message only for certain engines:
The engine oil level is too high.
* NOTE Engine damage caused by driving with excess engine oil
Engine Oil Reduce Oil Level
#
#
5
Engine Oil Level Low Stop
Vehicle Turn Engine Off
Avoid long journeys with excess engine oil.
Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately and have the engine oil level reduced.
* Display message only for certain engines:
The engine oil level is too low.
* NOTE Engine damage caused by driving with insufficient engine oil
#
#
#
#
#
Avoid long journeys with insufficient engine oil.
Stop the vehicle immediately in accordance with the traffic conditions. Do not continue driving.
Switch off the engine.
Add 1.1 US qt (1 l) of engine oil (/ page 325).
Check the engine oil level.
460 Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
Display messages
5
Engine Oil Pressure Stop
Switch Off Engine
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Notes on engine oil (/ page 396).
* Display message only for certain engines:
The oil pressure is too low.
* NOTE Engine damage caused by driving with insufficient oil pressure
#
#
#
5
Avoid driving with insufficient oil pressure.
Stop the vehicle immediately in accordance with the traffic conditions. Do not continue driving.
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
* The electrical connection to the oil level sensor has been interrupted or the oil level sensor is faulty.
# Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Engine Oil Level Cannot Be
Measured
Warning and indicator lamps
Overview of indicator and warning lamps
Some systems will perform a self-test when the
ignition is switched on. Some indicator and
warning lamps may briefly light up or flash. This
behavior is non-critical. These indicator and
warning lamps indicate a malfunction only if they
light up or flash after the engine has been star‐
ted or during a journey.
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps 461
Instrument Display
8
F
!
!
Depending on the display setting, the positions
of the indicator lamps on the Instrument Display
may differ from the example shown.
Indicator and warning lamps:
Restraint system (/ page 462)
6
Seat belt (/ page 462)
ü
Ù
Electric power steering
(/ page 463)
ÿ
Coolant temperature (/ page 464)
Check
Engine (/ page 464)
;
Electrical malfunction (/ page 464)
#
$
J
L
ä
!
÷
å
h
T
L
K
Reserve fuel with fuel filler flap loca‐
tion indicator (/ page 464)
USA: electric parking brake (red)
(/ page 467)
Canada: electric parking brake (red)
(/ page 467)
Electric parking brake (yellow)
(/ page 467)
USA: brakes (red) (/ page 467)
Canada: brakes (red) (/ page 467)
Distance warning (/ page 469)
AIRMATIC/E-ACTIVE BODY CON‐
TROL (/ page 469)
ABS (/ page 470)
ESP® (/ page 470)
ESP® OFF (/ page 470)
Tire pressure monitoring system
(/ page 472)
Parking lamps (/ page 143)
Low beam (/ page 143)
High beam (/ page 144)
#! Turn signal lights (/ page 144)
Rear fog lamp (/ page 143)
R
462 Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
Occupant safety
Warning/indicator lamp
6
Restraint system warning
lamp
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The red restraint system warning lamp is lit while the engine is running.
*The restraint system is malfunctioning (/ page 37).
& WARNING Risk of injury due to malfunctions in the restraint system
Components in the restraint system may be activated unintentionally or not deploy as planned in an accident.
# Have the restraint system checked and repaired immediately at a qualified specialist workshop.
#
#
#
7
Seat belt warning lamp
flashes
Drive on carefully.
Note the messages on the multifunction display.
Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
The red seat belt warning lamp flashes and an intermittent warning tone sounds.
* The driver or front passenger has not fastened their seat belt while the vehicle is in motion.
# Fasten your seat belt(/ page 41).
* There are objects on the front passenger seat.
# Remove the objects from the front passenger seat.
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps 463
Warning/indicator lamp
7
Seat belt warning lamp
lights up
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The red seat belt warning lamp will light up for six seconds once the engine has started.
In addition, a warning tone may sound.
*The seat belt warning lamp reminds the driver and front passenger to fasten their seat belts.
# Fasten your seat belt (/ page 41).
If you have placed objects on the front passenger seat, the seat belt warning lamp may remain lit.
Vehicle
Warning/indicator lamp
Ù
Electric power steering
warning lamp (red)
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The red electric power steering warning lamp is lit while the engine is running.
*The power assistance or the steering itself is malfunctioning.
& WARNING Risk of accident if steering capability is impaired
If the steering does not function as intended, the vehicle's operating safety is jeopardized.
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying attention to road and traffic conditions. Do
not continue driving under any circumstances.
# Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
#
#
Note the messages on the multifunction display.
464 Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
Engine
Warning/indicator lamp
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Coolant warning lamp
The red coolant warning lamp is lit while the engine is running.
*Possible causes:
R The temperature sensor is malfunctioning
R The coolant level is too low
R The air supply to the radiator is obstructed
R The radiator fan is faulty
ÿ
If there is an additional warning tone, the coolant temperature has exceeded the maximum permissible temperature.
& WARNING Danger of burns when opening the hood
If you open the hood when the engine has overheated or during a fire in the engine compartment, you could
come into contact with hot gases or other escaping operating fluids.
# Before opening the hood, allow the engine to cool down.
# In the event of a fire in the engine compartment, keep the hood closed and call the fire service.
#
#
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely and switch off the engine, paying attention to road and traffic conditions. Do
not continue driving.
Note the messages on the multifunction display.
If the coolant temperature display is at the lower end of the temperature scale:
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps 465
Warning/indicator lamp
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
#
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
or
#
#
#
#
;
Engine diagnosis warning
lamp
#
Electrical malfunction warn‐
ing lamp
Exit the vehicle and keep a safe distance from it until the engine has cooled down.
Check the coolant level (/ page 326).
Make sure that the air supply to the radiator is not obstructed.
Avoiding high loads on the engine, drive to the nearest qualified specialist workshop. In doing so, ensure that the
coolant temperature display remains below the red area.
The yellow Check Engine warning lamp is lit while the engine is running.
*A malfunction has occurred in the engine, the exhaust system or the fuel system.
The emission limit values may be exceeded and the engine may be in emergency mode.
In some states, legal requirements stipulate that you must immediately consult a qualified specialist workshop as
soon as the yellow Check Engine warning lamp lights up.
# Have the vehicle checked as soon as possible at a qualified specialist workshop.
The red electrical fault warning lamp is lit.
* There is a fault in the electrics.
# Note the messages on the multifunction display.
466 Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
Warning/indicator lamp
8
Fuel reserve warning lamp
flashes
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The yellow fuel reserve warning lamp lights up while you are driving.
*There has been pressure loss in the fuel system. The fuel filler cap is not closed correctly or the fuel system is leak‐
ing.
# Close the fuel filler cap.
If the fuel filler cap has already been closed correctly:
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
#
8
Fuel reserve warning lamp
lights up
The yellow fuel reserve warning lamp lights up while the engine is running.
* The fuel supply has dropped into the reserve range.
# Refuel.
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps 467
Brakes
Warning/indicator lamp
F
Electric parking brake indi‐
cator lamp (red) (USA only)
!
Electric parking brake indi‐
cator lamp (red) (Canada
only)
!
The electric parking brake
(yellow) indicator lamp
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The red electric parking brake indicator lamp flashes or is lit.
The yellow electric parking brake indicator lamp also lights up in the event of a malfunction.
* # Note the messages on the multifunction display.
468 Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
Warning/indicator lamp
$
Brake warning lamp (USA
only)
J
Brake system warning lamp
(Canada only)
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The red brake system warning lamp is lit while the engine is running.
*Possible causes:
R The brake force boosting is malfunctioning and the braking characteristics may be affected.
R There is insufficient brake fluid in the brake fluid reservoir.
#
Note the messages on the multifunction display.
& WARNING Risk of accident and injury if brake force boosting is malfunctioning
If brake force boosting is malfunctioning, increased brake pedal force may be necessary for braking. The braking
characteristics may be impaired. The braking distance can increase in emergency braking situations.
# Stop in a safe location immediately. Do not continue driving.
# Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
& WARNING Risk of an accident due to low brake fluid level
If the brake fluid level is too low, the braking effect and the braking characteristics may be impaired.
# Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying attention to road and traffic conditions. Do
not continue driving under any circumstances.
# Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
# Do not add brake fluid.
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps 469
Driving systems
Warning/indicator lamp
L
Warning lamp for distance
warning function
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The red distance warning lamp lights up while the vehicle is in motion.
* The distance to the vehicle in front is too small for the speed selected.
If there is an additional warning tone, you are approaching an obstacle at too high a speed.
# Be prepared to brake immediately.
# Increase the distance.
Function of Active Brake Assist (/ page 207).
ä
The yellow AIRMATIC/E-ACTIVE BODY CONTROL warning lamp is lit.
* A fault has occurred in the AIRMATIC/E-ACTIVE BODY CONTROL.
# Note the messages on the multifunction display.
ä
The red E-ACTIVE BODY CONTROL warning lamp is lit.
*There is a fault in the E-ACTIVE BODY CONTROL.
Suspension warning lamp
(yellow)
Suspension warning lamp
(red)
* NOTE The vehicle's driving characteristics have changed significantly.
#
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible in accordance with the traffic conditions. Do not
continue driving under any circumstances.
470 Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
Warning/indicator lamp
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
#
#
#
Note the messages on the multifunction display.
Stop the vehicle immediately in accordance with the traffic conditions. Do not continue driving.
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Driving safety systems
Warning/indicator lamp
!
ABS warning lamp
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The yellow ABS warning lamp is lit while the engine is running.
*ABS is malfunctioning.
If there is an additional warning tone, EBD is malfunctioning.
Other driving systems and driving safety systems may also be malfunctioning.
# Note the messages on the multifunction display.
& WARNING There is a risk of skidding if EBD or ABS is malfunctioning
The wheels may lock during braking.
The steerability and braking characteristics are heavily impaired and the braking distance may increase. In addi‐
tion, other driving safety systems are switched off.
# Drive on carefully.
# Have the brake system checked immediately at a qualified specialist workshop.
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps 471
Warning/indicator lamp
÷
ESP® warning lamp flashes
÷
ESP® warning lamp lights
up
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The yellow ESP® warning lamp flashes while the vehicle is in motion.
* One or more wheels has reached its grip limit (/ page 203).
# Adapt your driving style to suit the road and weather conditions.
The yellow ESP® warning lamp is lit while the engine is running.
*ESP® is malfunctioning.
Other driving systems and driving safety systems (e.g. BAS) may also be malfunctioning.
# Note the messages on the multifunction display.
& WARNING Risk of skidding if ESP® is malfunctioning
If ESP® is malfunctioning, ESP® cannot carry out vehicle stabilization. In addition, other driving safety systems
are switched off.
# Drive on carefully.
# Have ESP® checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
å
ESP® OFF warning lamp
The yellow ESP® OFF warning lamp is lit while the engine is running.
*ESP® is deactivated.
Other driving systems and driving safety systems may also be inoperative.
472 Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
Warning/indicator lamp
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
& WARNING Risk of skidding when driving with ESP® deactivated
ESP® does not act to stabilize the vehicle. The availability of further driving safety systems is also limited.
Drive on carefully.
# Deactivate ESP® only for as long as the situation requires.
#
If ESP® cannot be activated, ESP® is malfunctioning.
# Have ESP® checked immediately at a qualified specialist workshop.
#
Observe the notes on deactivating ESP® (/ page 203).
Tire pressure monitor
Warning/indicator lamp
h
Tire pressure monitoring
system warning lamp
flashes
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The yellow tire pressure monitor warning lamp (pressure loss/malfunction) flashes for approximately one minute and
then remains lit.
*The tire pressure monitor is malfunctioning.
& WARNING There is a risk of an accident if the tire pressure monitoring system is malfunctioning
The tire pressure monitoring system cannot issue a warning if there is pressure loss in one or more of the tires.
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps 473
Warning/indicator lamp
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Tires with insufficient tire pressure may impair the driving characteristics as well as steering and braking.
# Have the tire pressure monitoring system checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
h
Tire pressure monitoring
system warning lamp lights
up
The yellow tire pressure monitoring system warning lamp (pressure loss/malfunction) is lit.
*The tire pressure monitoring system has detected tire pressure loss in at least one of the tires.
& WARNING Risk of an accident due to insufficient tire pressure
R
R
R
The tires can burst.
The tires can wear excessively and/or unevenly.
The driving characteristics as well as the steering and braking may be greatly impaired.
You could then lose control of the vehicle.
# Observe the recommended tire pressures.
# Adjust the tire pressure if necessary.
#
#
Stop the vehicle in accordance with the traffic conditions.
Check the tire pressure and the tires.
474 Index
1, 2, 3 ...
4MATIC ..................................................... 191
Function ............................................... 191
12 V battery
see Battery (vehicle)
12 V socket
see Socket (12 V)
48 V on-board electrical system
Operating safety .................................... 25
115 V socket
see Socket (115 V)
360° Camera ........................................... 252
Function .............................................. 252
Opening the camera cover (rear view
camera) ............................................... 255
Selecting a view .................................. 255
A
A/C function
Activating/deactivating (MBUX mul‐
timedia system) ................................... 160
Switching on/off (control panel) ......... 160
ABS (Anti-lock Braking System) ............. 203
Acceleration
see Kickdown
Accident and breakdown manage‐
ment
Mercedes me connect ......................... 303
Acoustic locking verification signal
Activating/deactivating ......................... 68
Active Blind Spot Assist ......................... 264
Activating/deactivating ....................... 267
Brake application ................................. 266
Function .............................................. 264
System limitations ............................... 264
Trailer operation .................................. 266
Active Brake Assist
Function/notes ................................... 207
Setting ................................................. 211
Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC ......... 216
Active Emergency Stop Assist ............. 226
Active Lane Change Assist .................. 224
Calling up a speed ............................... 218
Function ............................................... 216
Increasing/decreasing speed .............. 218
Requirements ...................................... 218
Route-based speed adaptation ............ 221
Steering wheel buttons ........................
Storing a speed ....................................
Switching off/deactivating ..................
Switching on/activating .......................
System limitations ...............................
Active Emergency Stop Assist ...............
Active Lane Change Assist .....................
Activating/deactivating .......................
Function ..............................................
Active Lane Keeping Assist ....................
Activating/deactivating .......................
Activating/deactivating the warning ...
Function ..............................................
Setting the sensitivity ..........................
System limits .......................................
Trailer operation ..................................
Active Parking Assist ..............................
Cross Traffic Alert ...............................
Drive Away Assist ................................
Exiting a parking space .......................
Function ..............................................
Maneuvering assistance ......................
Parking ................................................
System limitations ...............................
218
218
218
218
216
226
224
226
224
267
269
269
267
269
267
267
255
260
260
258
255
261
257
255
Index 475
Active Service System PLUS
see ASSYST PLUS
Active Speed Limit Assist .......................
Display ................................................
Function ..............................................
Active Steering Assist .............................
Activating/deactivating .......................
Active Emergency Stop Assist .............
Active Lane Change Assist ..................
Function ..............................................
System limits .......................................
Active Traffic Jam Assist
Activating/deactivating .......................
Function ..............................................
Adaptive cruise control
see Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC
Adaptive Highbeam Assist
Function ..............................................
Switching on/off .................................
Additional cushion
Leg rest ...............................................
Rear passenger compartment head
restraint ...............................................
220
220
220
222
224
226
224
222
222
227
227
146
147
100
106
Additives .................................................. 396
Engine oil ............................................ 396
Fuel ..................................................... 396
Additives (engine oil)
see Additives
Additives (fuel)
see Fuel
ADS PLUS damping system
see AIRMATIC
After-sales service center
see ASSYST PLUS
Air bag
Reduced protection ............................... 44
Air conditioning menu
Calling up ............................................ 160
Air distribution
Setting ................................................. 159
Setting (MBUX multimedia system) ...... 161
Air freshener system
see Perfume atomizer
Air inlet
see Air-water duct
Air pressure
see Tire pressure
Air suspension
see AIRMATIC
Air vents ................................................... 165
Adjusting (front) .................................. 165
Adjusting (rear) .................................... 165
Glove box ............................................. 167
Air vents
see Air vents
Air-conditioning system
see Climate control
Air-recirculation mode ............................ 162
Air-water duct .......................................... 328
Keeping free ........................................ 328
Airbag ......................................................... 42
Activation .............................................. 37
Cushionbag ........................................... 42
Front airbag (driver, front passenger) .... 42
Installation locations ............................. 42
Knee airbag ........................................... 42
Overview ............................................... 42
PASSENGER AIR BAG indicator lamp ..... 47
476 Index
Protection .............................................. 43
Side airbag ............................................ 42
Window curtain airbag ........................... 42
Airflow
Setting ................................................. 159
AIRMATIC ................................................. 229
Setting ................................................. 231
Suspension .......................................... 229
Alarm
see Panic alarm
Alarm system
see ATA (anti-theft alarm system)
All-wheel drive
see 4MATIC
Ambient lighting
Setting (multimedia system) ................ 149
Android Auto
see Smartphone integration®
Animals
Pets in the vehicle ................................. 66
Anti-lock braking system
see ABS (Anti-lock Braking System)
Anti-skid chains
see Snow chains
Anti-theft protection
Immobilizer ............................................ 90
Anticipatory occupant protection
see PRE-SAFE® (anticipatory occu‐
pant protection)
see PRE-SAFE® PLUS (anticipatory
occupant protection plus)
Apple CarPlay
see Smartphone integration®
Assistance systems
see Driving safety system
ASSYST PLUS ........................................... 321
Battery disconnection periods ............. 322
Displaying the service due date ........... 321
Function/notes ................................... 321
Regular maintenance work .................. 321
Special service requirements .............. 321
ATA (anti-theft alarm system) .................. 90
Activating/deactivating the interior
motion sensor ....................................... 92
Arming/disarming the tow-away
alarm ..................................................... 92
Deactivating the alarm ........................... 91
Function ................................................ 90
Function of the interior motion sensor .. 92
The tow-away alarm function ................. 91
ATTENTION ASSIST .......................... 261, 262
Function ............................................... 261
Setting ................................................. 262
System limitations ............................... 261
Attention assistant
see ATTENTION ASSIST
Authorized Mercedes-Benz Center
see Qualified specialist workshop
Authorized workshop
see Qualified specialist workshop
Automatic car wash mode
Activating ............................................ 330
Automatic distance control
see Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC
Automatic driving lights ......................... 144
Automatic engine start (ECO start/
stop function) .......................................... 179
Index 477
Automatic engine stop (ECO start/
stop function) .......................................... 179
Automatic front passenger front air‐
bag shutoff ........................................... 45, 47
Function of the automatic front
passenger front airbag shutoff .............. 45
PASSENGER AIR BAG indicator lamp ..... 47
Automatic front passenger front air‐
bag shutoff
see Automatic front passenger front
airbag shutoff
Automatic measures after an accident ... 51
Automatic mirror folding function
Activating/deactivating ....................... 157
Automatic seat adjustment
Setting ................................................. 107
Automatic transmission
DIRECT SELECT lever ........................... 185
Drive program display .......................... 184
Drive programs .................................... 182
DYNAMIC SELECT switch .................... 182
Engaging drive position ........................ 187
Engaging neutral .................................. 186
Engaging park position ........................ 186
Engaging reverse gear .........................
Kickdown .............................................
Manual gearshifting .............................
Steering wheel paddle shifters ............
Transmission position display ..............
Transmission positions ........................
Axle load
Towing a trailer ....................................
186
188
187
187
185
185
406
B
Back seat
see Third row of seats
Bag hook ................................................... 131
Baidu CarLife
see Smartphone integration®
Ball neck
Installing .............................................. 271
BAS (Brake Assist System) ..................... 203
Battery
SmartKey ............................................... 69
Battery
see Battery (vehicle)
Battery (vehicle) ......................................
Charging ..............................................
Charging (Remote Online) ....................
Notes ..................................................
Notes (starting assistance and
charging) .............................................
Replacing ............................................
Starting assistance ..............................
Belt
see Seat belt
Blind
see Roller sunblind
Blind Spot Assist .....................................
Activating/deactivating .......................
Function ..............................................
System limitations ...............................
Blower
see Climate control
Brake Assist System
see BAS (Brake Assist System)
Brake fluid
Notes ..................................................
348
347
170
343
345
348
347
264
267
264
264
398
478 Index
Brake force distribution
EBD (electronic brake force distribu‐
tion) ..................................................... 207
Brakes
ABS (Anti-lock Braking System) ........... 203
Active Brake Assist .............................. 207
BAS (Brake Assist System) .................. 203
Driving tips .......................................... 173
EBD (electronic brake force distribu‐
tion) ..................................................... 207
HOLD function ..................................... 228
Limited braking effect (salt-treated
roads) .................................................. 173
New/replaced brakepads/brake
discs .................................................... 171
Notes on breaking-in a new vehicle ..... 171
Post-collision brake ................................ 51
Braking assistance
see BAS (Brake Assist System)
Breakdown
Changing a wheel ................................ 379
Overview of the help functions .............. 18
Roadside Assistance .............................. 24
Tow-starting ........................................ 353
Towing away ........................................ 350
Transporting the vehicle ...................... 351
Breakdown
see Flat tire
Buttons
Steering wheel ..................................... 276
C
Calls
Mercedes me ......................................
Camera .....................................................
Camera
see 360° Camera
see Rear view camera
Car key
see SmartKey
Car wash
see Care
Car wash (care) .......................................
Car-to-X-Communication
Displaying hazard warnings .................
Care ..........................................................
Air-water duct ......................................
304
239
328
298
334
328
Automatic car wash .............................
Carpet .................................................
Decorative foil .....................................
Display ................................................
Exterior lighting ...................................
Headliner .............................................
Paintwork ............................................
Plastic trim ..........................................
Power washer ......................................
Real wood/trim elements ...................
Rear view camera ................................
Running boards ...................................
Seat belts ............................................
Seat cover ...........................................
Sensors ...............................................
Surround view camera ........................
Tailpipes ..............................................
Trailer hitch .........................................
Washing by hand .................................
Wheels/rims .......................................
Windows ..............................................
Wiper blades .......................................
Cargo compartment cover
Extending/retracting ...........................
Notes ...................................................
328
334
332
334
332
334
331
334
330
334
332
332
334
334
332
332
332
332
331
332
332
332
128
128
Index 479
Removing/installing ............................ 128
Cargo compartment floor
Locking/unlocking .............................. 132
Cargo tie-down rings ............................... 131
Carpet (Care) ........................................... 334
Change of address .................................... 25
Change of ownership ................................ 25
Changing a wheel
Preparation .......................................... 379
Raising the vehicle .............................. 380
Changing a wheel
see Emergency spare wheel
Changing gears ........................................ 187
Manually .............................................. 187
Changing hub caps .................................. 379
Charging
Battery (vehicle) .................................. 347
Mobile phone (wireless) ....................... 139
USB port .............................................. 137
Child safety lock
Rear doors ............................................. 64
Rear side windows ................................. 65
Child seat
Attaching (notes) ................................... 55
Basic instructions .................................. 51
Front-passenger seat (notes) ................. 62
LATCH-type (ISOFIX) (installing) ............ 57
Notes on risks and dangers ................... 52
Securing on the front passenger seat .... 63
Securing on the rear seat ...................... 61
Top Tether .............................................. 60
Children
Avoiding dangers in the vehicle ............. 52
Basic instructions .................................. 51
Special seat belt retractor ..................... 56
Chock ........................................................ 378
Storage location .................................. 378
Chock
see Chock
Cleaning
see Care
Climate control ........................................ 159
Activating/deactivating ....................... 160
Activating/deactivating (rear operat‐
ing unit) ............................................... 160
Activating/deactivating the A/C
function (control panel) .......................
Activating/deactivating the A/C
function (MBUX multimedia system) ...
Activating/deactivating the synchro‐
nization function (control panel) ..........
Activating/deactivating the synchro‐
nization function (MBUX multimedia
system) ................................................
Air-recirculation mode .........................
Automatic control ................................
Automatically controlling (rear oper‐
ating unit) ............................................
Calling up the air conditioning menu ...
Control panel for 3-zone automatic
climate control ....................................
Control panel for dual-zone auto‐
matic climate control ...........................
Defrosting the windshield ....................
Filling capacity for PAG oil ...................
Front air vents .....................................
Glove box air vent ................................
Inserting/removing the flacon (fra‐
grance system) ....................................
Ionization .............................................
Note ....................................................
160
160
162
162
162
161
161
160
159
159
159
401
165
167
163
163
159
480 Index
Rear air vents ...................................... 165
Rear operating unit .............................. 160
Refrigerant .......................................... 400
Refrigerant filling capacity ................... 401
Removing condensation from the
windows .............................................. 162
Residual heat ....................................... 162
Residual heat (rear operating unit) ...... 163
Setting (MBUX multimedia system) ..... 160
Setting the air distribution ................... 159
Setting the airflow ............................... 159
Setting the fragrance system ............... 163
Setting the temperature ...................... 159
Switching the rear window heater
on/off ................................................. 159
Ventilating the vehicle (convenience
opening) ................................................ 83
Windshield heater ................................ 164
Coat hook ................................................. 132
Cockpit ......................................................... 6
Overview ................................................. 6
Coffee cup symbol
see ATTENTION ASSIST
Collapsible spare wheel .......................... 387
Inflating ............................................... 388
Notes ................................................... 387
Removing ............................................ 388
Collision detection (parked vehicle) ...... 200
Combination switch ................................ 144
Computer
see On-board computer
Consumption indicator
Calling up ............................................ 185
Convenience closing feature .................... 83
Convenience opening ................................ 83
Coolant (engine)
Capacity .............................................. 399
Check level .......................................... 326
Notes .................................................. 398
Cooling
see Climate control
Copyrights
License .................................................. 34
Trademarks ............................................ 35
Cornering light ......................................... 146
Cross Traffic Alert ................................... 260
Crosswind Assist
Function/notes ................................... 206
Cruise control .......................................... 212
Buttons ................................................ 213
Calling up a speed ............................... 213
Function ............................................... 212
Requirements: ..................................... 213
Selecting .............................................. 213
Setting a speed .................................... 213
Storing a speed .................................... 213
Switching off ........................................ 213
Switching on ........................................ 213
System limitations ............................... 212
Cup holder
Switching the cooling/heating func‐
tion on/off .......................................... 133
Cushionbag ................................................ 42
Customer Assistance Center (CAC) ......... 29
Customer Relations Department ............. 29
Index 481
D
Dashboard
see Cockpit
Data acquisition
Vehicle ................................................... 31
Data storage
Electronic control units .......................... 31
Online services ...................................... 33
Vehicle ................................................... 31
Daytime running lamp mode
see Daytime running lights
Daytime running lights ........................... 147
Switching on/off ................................. 147
Deactivating the alarm (ATA) .................... 91
Dealership
see Qualified specialist workshop
Declaration of conformity
Wireless vehicle components ................ 27
Decorative foil (cleaning instructions)
................................................................... 332
Definitions (tires and loading) ................ 372
Destination entry .................................... 295
Entering a POI or address .................... 295
Detecting inattentiveness
see ATTENTION ASSIST
Diagnostics connection ............................ 27
Digital Operator's Manual ........................ 20
Dinghy towing
see Tow-bar system
DIRECT SELECT lever ............................... 185
Engaging drive position ........................ 187
Engaging neutral .................................. 186
Engaging park position ........................ 186
Engaging park position automatically .. 186
Engaging reverse gear ......................... 186
Function .............................................. 185
Display (Care) .......................................... 334
Display (MBUX multimedia system)
Home screen ....................................... 282
Display (multimedia system) ................. 283
Operating ............................................ 283
Display (on-board computer)
Displays on the multifunction display .. 278
Display message .....................................
Calling up (on-board computer) ...........
Notes ..................................................
Display messages
¯ - - - mph .....................................
ç - - - mph .....................................
# 12 V Battery See Operator's
Manual ................................................
Û 48 V Battery See Operator's
Manual ................................................
: Active Headlamps Inoperative ....
é ATTENTION ASSIST Inoperative
.............................................................
é ATTENTION ASSIST: Take a
Break! ..................................................
: Automatic Headlamp Mode
Inoperative ...........................................
$ Check Brake Fluid Level .............
# Check Brake Pads See Opera‐
tor's Manual ........................................
408
408
408
446
444
452
454
415
433
433
414
432
433
482 Index
+ Check Coolant Level See Oper‐
ator's Manual ......................................
5 Check Engine Oil Level (Add 1
quart) ..................................................
: Check Left Low Beam (exam‐
ple) .......................................................
h Check Tires ................................
¥ Check Washer Fluid ...................
Á Compressor Is Cooling ...............
ÿ Coolant Too Hot Stop Vehicle
Turn Engine Off ....................................
_ Currently Unavailable Camera
View Restricted ...................................
ç Currently Unavailable Radar
Sensors Dirty ......................................
! Currently Unavailable See
Operator's Manual ...............................
÷ Currently Unavailable See
Operator's Manual ..............................
Á Don't Forget Your Key .................
423
458
414
456
422
437
423
443
442
447
448
413
Á Drive More Slowly ......................
5 Engine Oil Level Cannot Be
Measured ............................................
5 Engine Oil Level Low Stop Vehi‐
cle Turn Engine Off ..............................
5 Engine Oil Pressure Stop
Switch Off Engine ................................
5 Engine Oil Reduce Oil Level ........
6 Front Left Malfunction Service
Required (example) .............................
8 Fuel Level Low ............................
8 Gas Cap Loose ...........................
! Inoperative See Operator's
Manual ................................................
÷ Inoperative See Operator's
Manual ................................................
T Inoperative See Operator's
Manual ................................................
G Inoperative .................................
î Inoperative .................................
437
460
459
460
459
409
424
424
448
449
450
451
444
: Intell. Light System Inoperative .. 415
Á Key Not Detected (red display
message) ............................................. 413
Á Key Not Detected (white dis‐
play message) ...................................... 412
6 Left Side Curtain Airbag Mal‐
function Service Required (example) ... 409
 Lowering .................................... 435
ä Malfunction Drive at Max. 50
mph ............................................. 434, 435
: Malfunction See Operator’s
Manual ................................................. 414
î Max. Speed 25 mph ................... 444
î Not in Curr. Drive Prog. .............. 444
Á Obtain a New Key ....................... 412
ç Off .............................................. 445
ë Off .............................................. 443
F Parking Brake See Operator's
Manual ................................................ 428
h Please Correct Tire Pressure ...... 457
Index 483
F Please Release Parking Brake .....
Ý Please Wait Charging 48 V Bat‐
tery… ...................................................
Á Replace Key Battery ....................
y Running Board Not Extended ......
# See Operator's Manual ..............
6 SRS Malfunction Service
Required ..............................................
Ù Steering Malfunction Increased
Physical Effort See Operator's Man‐
ual ........................................................
Ù Steering Malfunction Stop
Immediately See Operator's Manual ....
# Stop Vehicle Leave Engine Run‐
ning .....................................................
# Stop Vehicle See Operator's
Manual ................................................
ç Suspended .................................
: Switch Off Lights ........................
: Switch On Headlamps ................
431
454
412
418
452
409
418
418
453
453
445
415
415
F Turn On the Ignition to Release
the Parking Brake ................................
d Vehicle Ready to Drive Switch
the Ignition Off Before Exiting ..............
Á Vehicle Rising Please Wait ..........
Á Vehicle Rising .............................
h Warning Tire Malfunction ...........
h Wheel Sensor(s) Missing ............
Active Blind Spot Assist Currently
Unavailable See Operator's Manual ....
Active Blind Spot Assist Inoperative ....
Active Blind Spot Asst. Not Available
When Towing a Trailer See Opera‐
tor's Manual ........................................
Active Brake Assist Functions Cur‐
rently Limited See Operator's Man‐
ual .......................................................
Active Brake Assist Functions Limi‐
ted See Operator's Manual ..................
432
417
437
435
457
456
440
440
441
450
451
Active Distance Assist Currently
Unavailable See Operator's Manual ....
Active Distance Assist Inoperative ......
Active Distance Assist Now Available
.............................................................
Active Lane Keeping Assist Currently
Unavailable See Operator's Manual .....
Active Lane Keeping Assist Inopera‐
tive ......................................................
Active Parking Assist and
PARKTRONIC Inoperative See Opera‐
tor's Manual ........................................
Active Steering Assist Currently
Unavailable See Operator's Manual .....
Active Steering Assist Inoperative .......
Active Steering Asst. Currently
Unavailable Due to Multiple Emer‐
gency Stops .........................................
Active Stop & Go Assist Currently
Unavailable See Operator's Manual .....
445
445
445
439
439
441
437
438
438
439
484 Index
Active Stop & Go Assist Inoperative
See Operator's Manual ........................
Adaptive Highbeam Assist Currently
Unavailable See Operator's Manual .....
Adaptive Highbeam Assist Inopera‐
tive .......................................................
Apply Brake to Shift from 'P' ...............
Apply Brake to Shift to 'R' ...................
Apply Brake to Shift to D or R ..............
Auxiliary Battery Malfunction ..............
Beginning Emergency Stop ..................
Blind Spot Assist Currently Unavaila‐
ble See Operator's Manual ..................
Blind Spot Assist Inoperative ...............
Blind Spot Assist Not Available When
Towing a Trailer See Operator's Man‐
ual .......................................................
Cannot Start Engine See Operator's
Manual ................................................
Cruise Control Inoperative ..................
439
416
416
425
425
425
427
438
439
440
440
454
446
Cruise Control Off ...............................
Decrease Speed ..................................
Driver's Door Open & Transmission
Not in P Risk of Vehicle Rolling Away ..
Engine Can Now Be Started ................
Front Passenger Airbag Disabled See
Operator's Manual ...............................
Front Passenger Airbag Enabled See
Operator's Manual ...............................
Gearbox Protection Limit 18 mph
Disable LOW RANGE ............................
Hazard Warning Flashers Malfunc‐
tioning ..................................................
LOW RANGE Malfunction .....................
LOW RANGE Malfunction To Park,
Apply Brake .........................................
LOW RANGE Max. Speed 6 mph ..........
LOW RANGE Max. Speed 25 mph ........
LOW RANGE Not in Drive Program
"Sport" ................................................
446
458
426
455
410
410
422
416
421
421
421
422
420
LOW RANGE Only When Vehicle Is
Stationary ............................................
LOW RANGE Shift to Position N
Briefly ..................................................
LOW RANGE Shifting Canceled
Please Reactivate ................................
LOW RANGE Stop Apply Parking
Brake ...................................................
Mercedes me connect Services Limi‐
ted See Operator's Manual ..................
N Permanently Active Risk of Rolling
Away ...................................................
Only Shift to 'P' when Vehicle is Sta‐
tionary .................................................
Place the Key in the Marked Space
See Operator's Manual ........................
PRE-SAFE Impulse Side Inoperative
See Operator's Manual ........................
PRE-SAFE Inoperative See Opera‐
tor's Manual .........................................
420
420
421
421
451
426
425
413
411
411
Index 485
Reversing Not Possible Service
Required ..............................................
Running Boards Not Retracted Pay
Attention to Excess Width of Vehicle ....
Service Required Do Not Shift Gears
Visit Dealer ..........................................
Stop Vehicle Leave Engine Running
Wait Transmission Cooling ...................
Tire Press. Monitor Currently
Unavailable ..........................................
Tire Press. Monitor Inoperative ...........
Tire Pressure Monitor Inoperative No
Wheel Sensors ....................................
Tires Overheated .................................
To Deselect P or N, Depress Brake
and Start Engine ..................................
To switch engine off, press and hold
Start/Stop button for at least 3 sec‐
onds or press 3 times. .........................
426
417
426
427
455
455
456
457
425
423
Traffic Sign Assist Currently Unavail‐
able See Operator's Manual ................ 441
Traffic Sign Assist Inoperative ............. 441
Transmission Malfunction Stop ........... 426
Update Failed ....................................... 416
Update Failed Software Remains
Unchanged ........................................... 416
Update Successfully Completed .......... 416
Display on the windshield
see Head-up Display
Distance control
see Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC
DISTRONIC
see Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC
Door
Child safety lock (rear doors) ................ 64
Locking (emergency key) ....................... 73
Opening (from the inside) ...................... 70
Power closing function .......................... 73
Unlocking (emergency key) .................... 73
Unlocking (from the inside) ................... 70
Door control panel ..................................... 14
Door control panel (rear passenger
compartment) ............................................ 16
DOT, Tire Identification Number (TIN) ... 368
Downhill driving assistance
see DSR
Drawbar
see Tow-bar system
Drinking and driving ................................ 173
Drive Away Assist .................................... 260
Drive Away Assist
see Protection against collision
Drive position
Inserting .............................................. 187
Drive program display ............................. 184
Drive programs
see DYNAMIC SELECT
Driver's seat
see Seat
Driving safety system ............................. 201
ABS (Anti-lock Braking System) ........... 203
Active Brake Assist .............................. 207
BAS (Brake Assist System) .................. 203
486 Index
Cameras ..............................................
EBD (electronic brake force distribu‐
tion) .....................................................
ESP® Crosswind Assist ........................
ESP® trailer stabilization .....................
Off-road ABS .......................................
Overview .............................................
Radar and ultrasonic sensors ..............
Responsibility ......................................
STEER CONTROL .................................
Driving system
see 360° Camera
see Active Blind Spot Assist
see Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC
see Active Emergency Stop Assist
see Active Lane Change Assist
see Active Lane Keeping Assist
see Active Parking Assist
see Active Speed Limit Assist
see Active Steering Assist
see AIRMATIC
see ATTENTION ASSIST
see Blind Spot Assist
see Cruise control
see Driving safety system
201
207
206
206
203
202
201
201
207
see DSR
see E-ACTIVE BODY CONTROL
see HOLD function
see Parking Assist PARKTRONIC
see Rear view camera
see Traffic Sign Assist
Driving tips
Drinking and driving .............................
General driving tips ..............................
Notes on breaking-in a new vehicle .....
Drowsiness detection
see ATTENTION ASSIST
DSR ...........................................................
Activating/deactivating .......................
Changing the target speed ...................
Function ...............................................
Notes ...................................................
Switching on/off .................................
Dynamic handling control system
see ESP® (Electronic Stability Program)
DYNAMIC SELECT ....................................
Configuring drive program I .................
Displaying engine data ........................
Displaying vehicle data ........................
Drive program display ..........................
Drive programs ....................................
Function ..............................................
Operating (DYNAMIC SELECT switch)
.............................................................
Selecting the drive program ................
173
173
171
214
215
216
214
214
215
182
184
185
184
E
E-ACTIVE BODY CONTROL ......................
Individual wheel control .......................
Recovery mode ...................................
Setting the level ...................................
Suspension ..........................................
E10 ............................................................
Easy entry feature
Function/notes ....................................
Easy exit feature
Function/notes ....................................
EBD (electronic brake force distribu‐
tion)
Function/notes ...................................
ECO Assist
Function/notes ....................................
184
182
182
184
184
236
240
239
240
236
395
114
114
207
181
Index 487
ECO display
Function .............................................. 180
ECO start/stop function ......................... 179
Automatic engine start ........................ 179
Automatic engine stop ......................... 179
Method of operation ............................ 179
Switching off/on ................................. 180
Electric parking brake ............................. 198
Applying automatically ........................ 198
Applying or releasing manually ............ 199
Emergency braking .............................. 199
Releasing automatically ....................... 199
Electrohydraulic suspension
see E-ACTIVE BODY CONTROL
Electronic Stability Program
see ESP® (Electronic Stability Program)
Emergency
First-aid kit (soft sided) ....................... 337
Overview of the help functions .............. 18
Reflective safety vest .......................... 336
Removing the warning triangle ............ 336
Setting up the warning triangle ........... 337
Emergency braking ................................. 199
Emergency braking
see BAS (Brake Assist System)
Emergency call system
see Mercedes-Benz emergency call system
Emergency engine start ......................... 353
Emergency key
Locking a door ....................................... 73
Unlocking a door ................................... 73
Emergency operation mode
Starting the vehicle ............................. 169
Emergency release
Tailgate .................................................. 80
Emergency spare wheel ......................... 385
Inflating ............................................... 386
Notes .................................................. 385
Emergency Tensioning Devices
Activation .............................................. 37
Engine
ECO start/stop function ...................... 179
Engine number .................................... 392
Starting (emergency operation
mode) .................................................. 169
Starting (Remote Online) ..................... 171
Starting (start/stop button) ................. 169
Starting assistance .............................. 347
Switching off (start/stop button) ......... 194
Engine data
Displaying ............................................ 185
Engine number ........................................ 392
Engine oil ................................................. 325
Additives ............................................. 396
Capacity .............................................. 397
Checking the oil level using the onboard computer ................................... 324
MB-Freigabe or MB-Approval ............... 397
Quality ................................................. 397
Topping up ........................................... 325
Entering/exiting level
Setting ................................................. 234
EQ boost
Operating safety .................................... 25
ESC (Electronic Stability Control)
see ESP® (Electronic Stability Program)
ESP®
Crosswind Assist ................................. 206
Trailer stabilization .............................. 206
488 Index
ESP® (Electronic Stability Program) ...... 203
Activating/deactivating ....................... 205
Function/notes ................................... 203
Extendable running boards ....................... 74
Extendable step
see Running boards
Exterior lighting
see Lights
Exterior lighting (Care) ........................... 332
Exterior mirrors ............................... 155, 156
Anti-glare mode (automatic) ................ 156
Automatic mirror folding function ........ 157
Folding in/out ..................................... 155
Operating the memory function ........... 115
Parking position ................................... 156
Setting ................................................. 155
F
Fatigue detection
see ATTENTION ASSIST
First-aid kit (soft sided) .......................... 337
Flacon
Inserting/removing ............................. 163
Flat tire ..................................................... 338
Changing a wheel ................................ 379
MOExtended tires ................................ 338
Notes .................................................. 338
TIREFIT kit ........................................... 339
Flat towing
see Tow-bar system
Floor mats ................................................ 141
Foil covering
Radar and ultrasonic sensors .............. 201
Folding table ............................................ 122
Fragrance
see Perfume atomizer
Free driving mode
Starting ............................................... 243
Free software ............................................ 34
Frequencies
Two-way radio ...................................... 391
Front airbag (driver, front passenger) ..... 42
Front passenger seat ................................ 96
Adjusting from the driver's seat ............ 96
Adjusting from the rear passenger
compartment ......................................... 97
Front passenger seat
see Seat
Fuel ........................................................... 396
Additives ............................................. 396
E10 ...................................................... 395
Fuel reserve ........................................ 396
Gasoline .............................................. 395
Quality (gasoline) ................................ 395
Refueling .............................................. 191
Sulfur content ..................................... 395
Tank content ....................................... 396
Function seat
see Door control panel
Function seat (rear passenger com‐
partment)
see Seat (rear passenger compartment)
Fuses ........................................................ 353
Before replacing a fuse ........................ 353
Dashboard fuse box ............................ 355
Fuse assignment diagram ................... 353
Fuse box in the cargo compartment .... 355
Fuse box in the engine compartment .. 354
Index 489
Fuse box in the front-passenger foot‐
well ...................................................... 355
Notes .................................................. 353
Fuses
see Fuses
G
Garage door opener
Clearing the memory ........................... 197
Opening or closing the door ................ 197
Programming buttons .......................... 195
Resolving problems ............................. 197
Synchronizing the rolling code ............. 197
Gasoline ................................................... 395
Gasoline station prices ........................... 298
Gearshift recommendation .................... 188
Genuine parts ............................................ 23
Glide mode ............................................... 189
Glove box
Air vent ................................................ 167
H
Handbrake
see Electric parking brake
Handling characteristics (unusual) ....... 356
HANDS-FREE ACCESS ................................ 78
Handset
Stowage compartment ........................ 123
Hazard warning lights ............................. 145
Hazardous substances
Information ............................................ 25
Head restraint
Attaching/removing the supplemen‐
tary cushion ........................................ 106
EASY ADJUST luxury head restraint
(front) .................................................. 104
Front (adjusting mechanically) ............. 103
Front (luxury head restraint) ................ 104
Rear (installing/removing) ................... 106
Rear passenger compartment
(adjusting) ........................................... 105
Rear passenger compartment (luxury
head restraint) ..................................... 106
Head-up Display ......................................
Adjusting display elements (on-board
computer) ............................................
Adjusting the brightness (on-board
computer) ............................................
Function ..............................................
Menu (on-board computer) ..................
Operating the memory function ...........
Setting the position (on-board com‐
puter) ..................................................
Switching on/off .................................
Headlamps
see Automatic driving lights
Headliner (care) .......................................
Heating
see Climate control
High beam
Activating/deactivating .......................
HIGH RANGE
Shifting ................................................
High-beam flasher ...................................
High-beam headlamps
Adaptive Highbeam Assist ...................
279
279
279
278
279
115
279
280
334
144
190
144
146
490 Index
Hill start assist ........................................
HOLD function .........................................
Function/notes ...................................
Switching on/off .................................
Home screen (media display)
Overview .............................................
Hood
Opening/closing .................................
227
228
228
228
282
322
I
Identification plate
Engine ................................................. 392
Refrigerant .......................................... 400
Vehicle ................................................ 392
Ignition
Switching on (Start/Stop button) ........ 168
Ignition key
see SmartKey
Immobilizer ................................................ 90
Indicator lamps
see Warning/indicator lamps
Individual drive program
Configuring .......................................... 184
Selecting ............................................. 184
Inside rearview mirror
see Exterior mirrors
Inspection
see ASSYST PLUS
Instrument cluster
Function/notes ............................ 274, 275
Instrument Display
Function/notes ................................... 275
Instrument cluster ................................. 10
Warning/indicator lamps .................... 460
Instrument Display and on-board
computer
Function/notes .................................... 274
Intelligent Light System
Adaptive Highbeam Assist ................... 146
Cornering light ..................................... 146
Interior lighting ....................................... 148
Ambient lighting .................................. 149
Reading light ........................................ 148
Setting ................................................. 148
Switch-off delay time ........................... 149
Interior motion sensor
Activating/deactivating ......................... 92
Function ................................................ 92
Internet radio
see TuneIn
Ionization
Activating/deactivating (MBUX mul‐
timedia system) ................................... 163
iPhone®
see Smartphone integration®
J
Jack
Storage location .................................. 378
Jump-start connection ............................ 347
General notes ...................................... 345
K
KEYLESS-GO
Locking the vehicle ................................
Problem .................................................
Unlocking setting ..................................
Unlocking the vehicle ............................
71
72
68
71
Index 491
Kickdown ................................................. 188
Using ................................................... 188
Knee airbag ................................................ 42
L
Labeling (tires)
see Tire labeling
Lamp
see Interior lighting
Lamps (Instrument Display)
see Warning/indicator lamps
Lane detection (automatic)
see Active Lane Keeping Assist
Lane Keeping Assist
see Active Lane Keeping Assist
LATCH-type (ISOFIX) child seat secur‐
ing system
Installing ................................................ 57
Leg rest
Attaching/removing the additional
cushion ................................................ 100
Level control system
see AIRMATIC
see E-ACTIVE BODY CONTROL
Light switch
Overview .............................................
Lighting
see Interior lighting
see Lights
Lights ........................................................
Adaptive Highbeam Assist ...................
Automatic driving lights .......................
Combination switch .............................
Cornering light .....................................
Hazard warning lights ..........................
High beam ...........................................
High-beam flasher ...............................
Light switch .........................................
Low-beam headlamps .........................
Parking lights .......................................
Rear fog lamp ......................................
Responsibility for lighting systems ......
Setting the exterior lighting switchoff delay time .......................................
Standing lights .....................................
Switching the surround lighting
on/off .................................................
Turn signal light ...................................
143
143
146
144
144
146
145
144
144
143
143
143
143
143
147
143
148
144
Limited Warranty
Vehicle ................................................... 31
Limiting the opening angle (tailgate) ...... 80
Live Traffic Information
Switching the traffic information dis‐
play on ................................................ 298
Load index (tires) .................................... 370
Load protection net
Attaching ............................................. 130
Load-bearing capacity (tires) ................. 370
Loading ..................................................... 131
Bag hook .............................................. 131
Cargo tie-down rings ............................ 131
Coat hook ............................................ 132
Definitions ........................................... 372
Notes ................................................... 119
Roof luggage rack ................................ 133
Loading guidelines ................................... 119
Loading information table ...................... 363
Loads
Securing ............................................... 119
492 Index
Locking/unlocking
Activating/deactivating the auto‐
matic locking feature ............................. 72
Emergency key ...................................... 73
KEYLESS-GO .......................................... 71
Opening the tailgate .............................. 75
Unlocking and opening doors from
the inside .............................................. 70
LOW RANGE
Shifting ................................................ 190
Low-beam headlamps
Switching on/off ................................. 143
Lowering the vehicle
Rear of the vehicle .............................. 235
Lubricant additives
see Additives
Luggage
Securing ............................................... 119
Lumbar support
see Lumbar support (4-way)
Lumbar support (4-way) ........................... 98
M
MAGIC VISION CONTROL
Windshield wipers ............................... 153
Maintenance
Vehicle ................................................... 24
Maintenance
see ASSYST PLUS
Malfunction
Restraint system .................................... 37
Malfunction message
see Display message
Map ........................................................... 297
Displaying online map contents .......... 298
Displaying weather information ........... 298
Moving ................................................. 297
Selecting the map orientation ............. 297
Setting the map scale .......................... 297
Switching freeway information
on/off ................................................. 297
Massage program
Overview ............................................. 108
Resetting the settings .......................... 109
Massage programs
Selecting the front seats .....................
Massage settings
Resetting .............................................
Maximum load rating ..............................
Maximum permissible load
Calculation example ............................
Determining ........................................
Maximum tire pressure ..........................
MBUX Interior Assistant
Switching the reading light for the
driver and front passenger on/off
contact-free .........................................
Switching the search light for the
driver on/off .......................................
MBUX Interior Assistant (multimedia
system) ....................................................
Overview .............................................
MBUX multimedia system ......................
Activating/deactivating standby
mode ...................................................
Configuring drive program I .................
Notes ...................................................
109
109
369
365
364
369
286
286
285
285
281
201
184
281
Index 493
Overview .............................................. 281
Setting route-based speed adapta‐
tion ...................................................... 222
Setting the rear climate control ........... 161
Standby mode function ....................... 200
Mechanical key
Inserting/removing ............................... 69
Unlocking the tailgate ........................... 80
Media
Overview of the functions and sym‐
bols ...................................................... 313
Media mode
Connecting Bluetooth® audio equip‐
ment .................................................... 314
Medical aids ............................................... 29
Memory function
Head-up Display — Calling up stored
settings ................................................ 115
Head-up Display — Storing settings ...... 115
Operating ............................................. 115
Outside mirrors — Calling up stored
settings ................................................ 115
Outside mirrors — Storing settings ....... 115
Seat — Calling up stored settings ......... 115
Seat — Storing settings ........................
Memory function in the rear
passenger compartment
Operating rear seats ............................
Operating the front passenger seat
and rear seats ......................................
Menu (on-board computer)
Head-up Display ..................................
Overview ..............................................
Mercedes me app
Information ..........................................
Mercedes me calls
Arranging a service appointment ........
Calling the Mercedes-Benz Customer
Center .................................................
Calling the Mercedes-Benz Customer
Center after automatic accident or
breakdown detection ...........................
Concierge Service ...............................
Information ..........................................
Making a call via the overhead con‐
trol panel .............................................
Transferred data ..................................
115
116
117
279
276
307
306
305
305
304
304
304
306
Mercedes me connect
Accident and breakdown manage‐
ment ....................................................
Information ..........................................
Transferred data ..................................
Mercedes-AMG vehicles
Notes ...................................................
Mercedes-Benz emergency call sys‐
tem ...........................................................
Automatic emergency call ...................
Information ..........................................
Information on data transfer ................
Manual emergency call ........................
Overview ..............................................
Mercedes-Benz Link
see Smartphone integration®
Message (multifunction display)
see Display message
Message memory ....................................
Mirrors
see Exterior mirrors
Mobile phone
Wireless charging ................................
303
302
304
168
309
310
309
312
311
310
408
140
494 Index
Wireless charging (rear passenger
compartment) ...................................... 140
Mobile phone
see Smartphone integration®
see Telephone
Model series
see Vehicle identification plate
MOExtended tires ................................... 338
Multifunction camera
ROAD SURFACE SCAN ........................ 239
Multifunction display
Overview of the displays ...................... 278
Multifunction steering wheel
Overview of buttons ............................. 276
Multifunction steering wheel
see Steering wheel
Multimedia system
Activating/deactivating DSR ................ 215
Collision detection (parked vehicle) ..... 200
Extending/retracting the running
boards ................................................... 75
Multimedia system
see Display (multimedia system)
see MBUX Interior Assistant (multi‐
media system)
see MBUX multimedia system
see Touchpad
N
Navigation
Notes ..................................................
Overview .............................................
Showing/hiding the menu ...................
Switching on .......................................
Navigation
see Destination entry
see Map
see Route
Neutral
Inserting ..............................................
Notes ........................................................
Optimized acceleration ........................
Notes on breaking-in a new vehicle .......
O
Occupant safety
see Airbag
292
294
293
293
186
172
172
171
see Automatic front passenger front
airbag shutoff
see Automatic measures after an accident
see Pets in the vehicle
see Post-collision brake
see PRE-SAFE® (anticipatory occu‐
pant protection)
see PRE-SAFE® Impulse Side
see PRE-SAFE® PLUS (anticipatory
occupant protection plus)
see Restraint system
see Seat belt
Off-road Assist
Setting ................................................. 243
Off-road driving ........................................ 176
Off-road driving
see Off-road driving
Off-road ESP® (Electronic Stability
Program)
Switching on/off ................................. 205
Oil
see Engine oil
Index 495
On-board computer ................................. 276
Displaying the service due date ........... 321
Head-up Display menu ........................ 279
Multifunction display ........................... 278
Operating ............................................. 276
Overview of menus .............................. 276
On-board diagnostics interface
see Diagnostics connection
Online services
Data storage .......................................... 33
Open-source software .............................. 34
Opening the tailgate using your foot
HANDS-FREE ACCESS ........................... 78
Operating fluids
Additives (fuel) .................................... 396
Brake fluid ........................................... 398
Coolant (engine) .................................. 398
Engine oil ............................................ 396
Fuel (gasoline) ..................................... 395
Notes ................................................... 394
Refrigerant (air conditioning system) ... 400
Windshield washer fluid ...................... 399
Operating safety
48 V on-board electrical system ............ 25
Declaration of conformity (wireless
vehicle components) ............................. 27
EQ boost ............................................... 25
Information ............................................ 25
Operating system
see On-board computer
Operator's Manual
Vehicle equipment ................................. 23
Operator's Manual (digital) ...................... 20
Optimized acceleration ........................... 172
Activating ............................................. 172
Overhead control panel
Overview ................................................ 12
P
Paint code ................................................ 392
Paintwork (cleaning instructions) .......... 331
Panel heating
Setting .................................................. 111
Panic alarm ................................................ 68
Activating/deactivating ......................... 68
Panorama roof with power tilt/sliding
panel
see Sliding sunroof
Park position
Inserting ..............................................
Selecting automatically .......................
Parking
see Electric parking brake
Parking aid
see Parking Assist PARKTRONIC
Parking Assist PARKTRONIC ..................
Activating ............................................
Adjusting warning tones ......................
Function ..............................................
Side impact protection ........................
Switching off .......................................
System limitations ...............................
Parking assistance systems
see Active Parking Assist
Parking brake
see Electric parking brake
Parking for an extended period .............
Parking lights ...........................................
186
186
244
248
249
244
247
248
244
200
143
496 Index
Parking position
Exterior mirrors ...................................
Storing the position of the frontpassenger outside mirror using
reverse gear .........................................
PASSENGER AIR BAG status display
see Automatic front passenger front
airbag shutoff
Payload
Calculation example ............................
Determining the maximum ..................
Perfume
see Perfume atomizer
Perfume atomizer ....................................
Inserting/removing the flacon .............
Setting .................................................
Perfume vial
see Perfume atomizer
Period out of use
Activating/deactivating standby
mode ...................................................
Standby mode function .......................
Permitted towing methods .....................
156
157
365
364
163
163
163
201
200
349
Pets in the vehicle ..................................... 66
Plastic trim (Care) ................................... 334
Post-collision brake ................................... 51
Power closing function
Door ...................................................... 73
Power supply
Switching on (Start/Stop button) ........ 168
Power washer (care) ............................... 330
Power windows
see Side windows
PRE-SAFE® (anticipatory occupant
protection) ................................................. 49
Function ................................................ 49
PRE-SAFE® Sound ................................. 49
Reversing measures .............................. 50
PRE-SAFE® Impulse Side ........................... 50
Activation .............................................. 37
Function ................................................ 50
PRE-SAFE® PLUS (anticipatory occu‐
pant protection plus) ................................ 50
Function ................................................ 50
Reversing measures .............................. 50
Preventative occupant protection sys‐
tem
see PRE-SAFE® (anticipatory occu‐
pant protection)
Profile ....................................................... 287
Creating a new profile ......................... 288
Notes ................................................... 287
Selecting profile options ..................... 288
Programs
see DYNAMIC SELECT
Protecting the environment
Notes ..................................................... 22
Protection against collision ................... 260
Pulling away
see Notes
Q
QR code
Rescue card ........................................... 31
Qualified specialist workshop ................. 28
Index 497
R
Radar and ultrasonic sensors
Damage ...............................................
Radio
Overview of the functions and sym‐
bols ......................................................
Rain-closing feature
Sliding sunroof ......................................
Raising the vehicle
Rear of the vehicle ..............................
Reading light
Switching on/off with hand move‐
ments ..................................................
Reading light
see Interior lighting
Real wood (Care) .....................................
Rear climate control
Setting (MBUX multimedia system) ......
Rear doors (child safety lock) ..................
Rear fog lamp
Switching on/off .................................
201
315
88
235
286
334
161
64
144
Rear of the vehicle
Lowering ............................................. 235
Raising ................................................ 235
Rear passenger compartment seat
Seats ..................................................... 98
Rear seat
see Seat
see Third row of seats
Rear view camera .................................... 249
Care .................................................... 332
Function .............................................. 249
Opening the camera cover (360°
Camera) .............................................. 255
Rear window
Changing the wiper blade .................... 154
Rear window heater ................................ 159
Rear window wipers
Activating/deactivating ....................... 150
Reflective safety vest ............................. 336
Refrigerant (air conditioning system)
Notes .................................................. 400
Refrigerator box
Using ................................................... 137
Refueling
Refueling the vehicle ............................ 191
Remote Online
Charging the starter battery ................ 170
Cooling or heating the vehicle inte‐
rior ....................................................... 170
Starting the vehicle .............................. 171
Reporting safety defects .......................... 30
Rescue card ............................................... 31
Reserve
Fuel ..................................................... 396
Residual heat ........................................... 162
Rear operating unit .............................. 163
Restraint system ....................................... 36
Basic instructions for children ............... 51
Function in an accident ......................... 37
Functionality .......................................... 36
Malfunction ........................................... 37
Protection .............................................. 36
Reduced protection ............................... 36
Self-test ................................................. 36
Warning lamp ........................................ 36
498 Index
Reverse gear
Inserting .............................................. 186
Rims (Care) .............................................. 332
ROAD SURFACE SCAN
Multifunction camera .......................... 239
ROAD SURFACE SCAN
see Camera
Roadside Assistance (breakdown) ........... 24
Roll away protection
see HOLD function
Roller sunblind .......................................... 89
Panorama roof with power tilt/slid‐
ing panel ................................................ 84
Side windows (electric) ......................... 89
Rollover crash ............................................ 29
Roof load .................................................. 403
Roof load display
Information .......................................... 183
Roof luggage rack
Loading ................................................ 133
Securing .............................................. 133
Route ........................................................ 296
Calculating .......................................... 296
Selecting options ................................ 296
Route guidance with augmented real‐
ity
Activating ............................................ 296
Displaying street names and house
numbers .............................................. 296
Route-based speed adaptation
Function .............................................. 221
Setting ................................................. 222
Run-flat characteristics
MOExtended tires ................................ 338
Running boards .......................................... 74
Care .................................................... 332
Extending/retracting ............................. 75
Function ................................................. 74
S
Safety systems
see Driving safety system
Satellite radio
Logging in ............................................ 319
Setting music and sport alerts ............. 319
Search light
Switching on/off with hand move‐
ments .................................................. 286
Seat ..................................................... 94, 124
4-way lumbar support ........................... 98
Adjusting (electrically) ........................... 94
Adjusting a reclining rear seat ............... 98
Adjusting the front passenger seat
from the rear passenger compart‐
ment ...................................................... 97
Automatic seat adjustment .................. 107
Configuring the settings ...................... 107
Correct driver's seat position ................ 94
Folding back the backrest on the
third row of seats ................................. 127
Folding the backrest (rear passenger
compartment) back ..................... 100, 125
Folding the backrest (rear passenger
compartment) forwards to get in
(third row of seats) .............................. 100
Folding the backrest (rear) forwards .... 124
Folding the backrest on the third row
of seats forwards ................................. 126
Massage program overview ................. 108
Index 499
Mechanically unlocking the backrest
(rear passenger compartment) ............ 100
Operating the memory function ........... 115
Panel heating ....................................... 111
Rear (seat comfort) ............................... 98
Resetting the settings .......................... 109
Setting options ...................................... 14
Setting the fully reclined position .......... 99
Workout program overview .................. 108
Seat
see Front passenger seat
Seat (rear passenger compartment) ....... 16
Setting options ...................................... 16
Seat belt ..................................................... 38
Protection .............................................. 38
Seat belt adjustment
Activating/deactivating ......................... 41
Function ................................................. 41
Seat belt warning
see Seat belts
Seat belts ................................................... 41
Activating/deactivating seat belt
adjustment ............................................ 41
Adjusting the height ............................... 41
Care .................................................... 334
Fastening ............................................... 41
Reduced protection ............................... 39
Releasing ............................................... 41
Seat belt adjustment (function) ............. 41
Warning lamp ......................................... 41
Seat cover (Care) ..................................... 334
Seat heating
Activating/deactivating ....................... 109
Seat ventilation
Activating/deactivating ........................ 111
Seats
Rear passenger compartment
(adjusting electrically) ........................... 98
Selecting a gear
see Changing gears
Selector lever
see DIRECT SELECT lever
Self-test
Automatic front passenger front air‐
bag shutoff ............................................ 47
Sensors (Care) ......................................... 332
Service center
see Qualified specialist workshop
Service interval display
see ASSYST PLUS
Setting a speed
see Cruise control
Setting the map scale
see Map
Shift paddles
see Steering wheel paddle shifters
Shifting gears
Gearshift recommendation .................. 188
Side airbag ................................................. 42
Side impact protection ............................ 247
Side windows ............................................. 81
Child safety lock in the rear
passenger compartment ....................... 65
Closing .................................................. 81
Closing using the SmartKey ................... 83
Convenience closing feature ................. 83
Convenience opening ............................ 83
Opening ................................................. 81
Opening with the SmartKey ................... 83
500 Index
Problem ................................................. 84
Roller sunblind (electric) ........................ 89
Size designation (tires) ........................... 370
Sliding sunroof .......................................... 84
Automatic features ................................ 88
Closing .................................................. 84
Closing using the SmartKey ................... 83
Opening ................................................. 84
Opening with the SmartKey ................... 83
Problem ................................................. 88
Rain-closing feature ............................... 88
SmartKey .................................................... 67
Acoustic locking verification signal ....... 68
Battery .................................................. 69
Energy consumption .............................. 68
Features ................................................ 67
Key ring attachment .............................. 69
Mechanical key ...................................... 69
Overview ................................................ 67
Panic alarm ........................................... 68
Problem ................................................. 70
Unlocking setting .................................. 68
SmartKey functions
Deactivating .......................................... 68
Smartphone
see Smartphone integration®
see Telephone
Smartphone integration® ....................... 309
Overview ............................................. 309
Snow chains ............................................. 357
Socket (12 V) ............................................ 135
Front center console ........................... 135
Socket (115 V) .......................................... 136
Rear passenger compartment ............. 136
Software update
System updates ................................... 290
Sound
PRE-SAFE® Sound ................................. 49
Wheels and tires .................................. 356
Sound menu
Functions overview .............................. 320
Spare wheel
see Collapsible spare wheel
see Emergency spare wheel
Special seat belt retractor ........................ 56
Specialist workshop .................................. 28
Speed index (tires) .................................. 370
Sport Utility Vehicle .................................. 29
Standby mode
Activating/deactivating ....................... 201
Function .............................................. 200
Standing lights ........................................ 143
Start-off assist
see Optimized acceleration
Start/Stop button
Parking the vehicle .............................. 194
Starting the vehicle ............................. 169
Switching on the power supply or
ignition ................................................ 168
Start/stop function
see ECO start/stop function
Starter battery
Charging (Remote Online) .................... 170
Starting assistance
see Jump-start connection
Starting the engine
see Vehicle
Starting-off aid
see Hill start assist
Index 501
STEER CONTROL
Function/notes ...................................
Steering wheel .........................................
Adjusting (electrically) ..........................
Adjusting (manually) ............................
Buttons ................................................
Steering wheel heater ..........................
Steering wheel heater
Switching on/off ..................................
Steering wheel paddle shifters ..............
Step
see Running boards
Storage areas
see Storage compartment
Storage compartment .............................
Armrest ...............................................
Center console ....................................
Door ....................................................
Glove box .............................................
Storage compartments
see Storage compartment
Storage spaces
USB ports ............................................
207
276
113
112
276
113
113
187
122
122
122
122
122
122
Stowage areas
see Loading
Stowage compartment
Folding table ........................................
Handset (rear passenger compart‐
ment) ...................................................
Rear seat backrest ..............................
Stowage compartments
see Loading
Suggestions
Configuring ..........................................
Sulfur content .........................................
Surround lighting
Switching on/off .................................
Surround View
see 360° Camera
Surround view camera
Care ....................................................
Suspension
Individual wheel control (E-ACTIVE
BODY CONTROL) .................................
Rocking free mode (E-ACTIVE BODY
CONTROL) ...........................................
122
123
123
288
395
148
332
240
239
Setting the suspension level (AIR‐
MATIC) .................................................
Setting the suspension level (EACTIVE BODY CONTROL) .....................
Suspension
see AIRMATIC
see E-ACTIVE BODY CONTROL
Suspension level (AIRMATIC)
Setting .................................................
Suspension level (E-ACTIVE BODY
CONTROL)
Setting .................................................
Switch-off delay time
Exterior ................................................
Interior .................................................
Synchronization function
Activating/deactivating (MBUX mul‐
timedia system) ...................................
Switching on/off (control panel) .........
System settings
Overview of the system settings
menu ...................................................
231
240
231
240
147
149
162
162
289
502 Index
T
Table
see Folding table
Tailgate ....................................................... 75
Closing ................................................... 76
Emergency release ................................ 80
HANDS-FREE ACCESS ........................... 78
Limiting the opening angle .................... 80
Opening ................................................. 75
Opening dimensions ............................ 401
Unlocking (mechanical key) ................... 80
Tailpipes (Care) ........................................ 332
Tank content
Fuel ..................................................... 396
Reserve (fuel) ...................................... 396
Technical data
Axle load (trailer operation) ................. 406
Information .......................................... 390
Notes (trailer hitch) ............................. 406
Tongue weight ..................................... 406
Towing capacity (trailer operation) ...... 406
Vehicle identification plate .................. 392
Telephone ......................................... 299, 301
Connecting a mobile phone (Pass‐
key) ..................................................... 302
Connecting a mobile phone (Secure
Simple Pairing) .................................... 302
Functions in the telephone menu ........ 302
Notes .................................................. 299
Operating modes ................................. 301
Telephone menu overview ................... 301
Wireless charging (mobile phone in
the rear passenger compartment) ....... 140
Wireless charging (mobile phone) ........ 140
Telephony operating modes
Bluetooth® Telephony .......................... 301
Temperature ............................................ 159
Temperature grade .................................. 367
Themes
Fastening ............................................. 288
Third row of seats ................................... 126
Folding back the backrest on the
third row of seats ................................. 127
Folding the backrest on the third row
of seats forwards ................................. 126
Getting in/out ..................................... 100
Through-loading feature
see Seat
see Third row of seats
TIN (Tire Identification Number) ............
Tire and Loading Information placard ...
Tire characteristics .................................
Tire inflation compressor
see TIREFIT kit
Tire information table .............................
Tire labeling .............................................
Characteristics ....................................
DOT, Tire Identification Number (TIN)
.............................................................
Load index ...........................................
Load-bearing capacity .........................
Maximum tire load ..............................
Maximum tire pressure .......................
Overview .............................................
Speed rating ........................................
Temperature grade ..............................
Tire Quality Grading .............................
Tire size designation ............................
Traction grade .....................................
Tread wear grade .................................
368
363
370
363
367
370
368
370
370
369
369
367
370
367
367
370
367
367
Index 503
Tire load (maximum) ............................... 369
Tire pressure ................................... 359, 360
Checking (manually) ............................ 360
Checking (tire pressure monitoring
system) ............................................... 362
Maximum ............................................ 369
Notes ................................................... 357
Restarting the tire pressure monitor‐
ing system ........................................... 362
Tire pressure monitoring system
(function) ............................................. 360
Tire pressure table .............................. 359
TIREFIT kit ........................................... 339
Tire pressure monitor
Function .............................................. 360
Restarting ............................................ 362
Tire pressure monitoring system
Checking the tire pressure .................. 362
Checking the tire temperature ............ 362
Tire pressure table .................................. 359
Tire Quality Grading ................................ 367
Tire temperature
Checking (tire pressure monitoring
system) ............................................... 362
Tire pressure monitoring system
(function) .............................................
Tire tread .................................................
Tire-change tool kit
Overview .............................................
TIREFIT kit ................................................
Storage location ..................................
Using ...................................................
Tires
Changing hub caps ..............................
Characteristics ....................................
Checking .............................................
Checking the tire pressure (man‐
ually) ...................................................
Checking the tire pressure (tire pres‐
sure monitoring system) ......................
Definitions ...........................................
DOT, Tire Identification Number (TIN)
.............................................................
Flat tire ................................................
Installing ..............................................
Load index ...........................................
Load-bearing capacity .........................
Maximum tire load ..............................
360
356
378
339
339
339
379
370
356
360
362
372
368
338
383
370
370
369
Maximum tire pressure ....................... 369
MOExtended tires ................................ 338
Noise ................................................... 356
Notes on installing ............................... 375
Overview of tire labeling ...................... 367
Removing ............................................ 382
Replacing ..................................... 375, 379
Restarting the tire pressure monitor‐
ing system ........................................... 362
Rotating ............................................... 378
Selection ............................................. 375
Snow chains ........................................ 357
Speed rating ........................................ 370
Storing ................................................. 378
Temperature grade .............................. 367
Tire and Loading Information placard
............................................................. 363
Tire pressure (notes) ........................... 357
Tire pressure monitoring system
(function) ............................................. 360
Tire pressure table .............................. 359
Tire Quality Grading ............................. 367
Tire size designation ............................ 370
TIREFIT kit ........................................... 339
Traction grade ..................................... 367
Tread wear grade ................................. 367
504 Index
Unusual handling characteristics ........ 356
Toll system
Windshield ........................................... 158
Tongue weight ......................................... 406
Tool
see Vehicle tool kit
Top Tether .................................................. 60
Touch Control
On-board computer ............................. 276
Operating ............................................ 283
Touchpad .................................................. 283
Operating ............................................ 283
Touchscreen (media display)
Operating ............................................ 283
Tow-away alarm
Activating/deactivating ......................... 92
Function ................................................ 91
Tow-bar system ....................................... 273
Tow-starting ............................................. 353
Towing a trailer
Notes .................................................. 269
Towing away ............................................ 350
Towing eye
Installing ..............................................
Storage location ..................................
Towing methods ......................................
Traction grade ..........................................
Traffic information
Switching on the display ......................
Traffic Sign Assist ...................................
Function/notes ...................................
Setting .................................................
System limitations ...............................
Trailer hitch
Attaching the ball neck ........................
Care ....................................................
Coupling up/uncoupling a trailer .........
Trailer operation
Active Blind Spot Assist .......................
Active Lane Keeping Assist ..................
Attaching the ball neck ........................
Coupling up/uncoupling a trailer .........
Trailer stabilization
Function/notes ...................................
353
352
349
367
298
262
262
264
262
271
332
272
266
267
271
272
206
Trailer tow hitch
Axle load .............................................
General notes ......................................
Notes ..................................................
Tongue weight .....................................
Towing capacity ...................................
Transfer case
HIGH RANGE .......................................
LOW RANGE ........................................
Shifting ................................................
Transmission position display ................
Transporting
Vehicle .................................................
Tread wear grade .....................................
Trim element (Care) ................................
Trunk lid
see Tailgate
TuneIn .......................................................
Calling up .............................................
Turn signal indicator ...............................
Turn signal light
Activating/deactivating .......................
406
406
269
406
406
189
189
190
185
351
367
334
318
318
144
144
Index 505
Two-way radios
Frequencies ......................................... 391
Notes on installation ........................... 390
Transmission output (maximum) .......... 391
U
Unlocking setting ...................................... 68
Updates
Important system updates .................. 290
USB port
Rear passenger compartment ............. 137
V
Vehicle ...................................................... 169
Activating/deactivating standby
mode ................................................... 201
Collision detection (parking) ................ 200
Correct use ........................................... 28
Data acquisition ..................................... 31
Data storage .......................................... 31
Diagnostics connection ......................... 27
Equipment ............................................. 23
Limited Warranty ................................... 31
Locking (automatically) ......................... 72
Locking (from inside) ............................. 71
Locking (KEYLESS-GO) .......................... 71
Locking/unlocking (emergency key) ...... 73
Lowering ............................................. 384
Maintenance .......................................... 24
Medical aids .......................................... 29
Parking for an extended period ........... 200
Problem notification .............................. 29
QR code rescue card ............................. 31
Qualified specialist workshop ................ 28
Raising ................................................ 380
Standby mode function ....................... 200
Starting (emergency operation
mode) .................................................. 169
Starting (Remote Online) ..................... 171
Starting (start/stop button) ................. 169
Switching off (start/stop button) ......... 194
Towing ................................................. 273
Unlocking (from inside) .......................... 71
Unlocking (KEYLESS-GO) ....................... 71
Ventilating (convenience opening) ......... 83
Vehicle data
Angle of approach/departure ............. 403
Displaying (DYNAMIC SELECT) ............ 184
Fording depth ...................................... 403
Maximum gradient-climbing capabil‐
ity ........................................................ 403
Roof load ............................................. 403
Turning circle ....................................... 401
Vehicle height ...................................... 401
Vehicle length ...................................... 401
Vehicle width ....................................... 401
Wheelbase ........................................... 401
Vehicle data storage
Event data recorders ............................. 33
MBUX multimedia system/Mercedes
me connect ........................................... 33
Vehicle dimensions ................................. 401
Vehicle electronics
Notes .................................................. 390
Two-way radios .................................... 390
Vehicle identification number
see VIN
Vehicle identification plate .................... 392
Paint code ........................................... 392
VIN ...................................................... 392
Vehicle interior
Cooling or heating (Remote Online) ..... 170
506 Index
Vehicle key
see SmartKey
Vehicle level
Setting individual wheel control ........... 243
Vehicle maintenance
see ASSYST PLUS
Vehicle operation
Outside the USA or Canada ................... 24
Vehicle tool kit ........................................ 339
TIREFIT kit ........................................... 339
Towing eye .......................................... 352
Vehicle with a high center of gravity ....... 29
Ventilating
Convenience opening ............................ 83
Ventilation
see Climate control
Vents
see Air vents
VIN ............................................................ 392
Identification plate .............................. 392
Seat ..................................................... 392
Windshield ........................................... 392
Vision
Removing condensation from the
windows ..............................................
Windshield heater ................................
Voice Control System
Function ..............................................
Starting ...............................................
W
Warning lamps
see Warning/indicator lamps
Warning system
see ATA (anti-theft alarm system)
Warning triangle
Removing ............................................
Setting up ............................................
Warning/indicator lamp
! ABS warning lamp ......................
J Brake system warning lamp
(Canada only) ......................................
$ Brake warning lamp (USA only) ..
ÿ Coolant warning lamp ................
162
164
284
285
336
337
470
468
468
464
! Electric parking brake indicator
lamp (red) (Canada only) .....................
F Electric parking brake indicator
lamp (red) (USA only) ..........................
Ù Electric power steering warn‐
ing lamp (red) ......................................
# Electrical malfunction warning
lamp ....................................................
; Engine diagnosis warning lamp ..
å ESP® OFF warning lamp .............
÷ ESP® warning lamp flashes ........
÷ ESP® warning lamp lights up ......
8 Fuel reserve warning lamp
flashes .................................................
8 Fuel reserve warning lamp
lights up ..............................................
6 Restraint system warning lamp ..
7 Seat belt warning lamp flashes ..
7 Seat belt warning lamp lights
up ........................................................
467
467
463
465
465
471
471
471
466
466
462
462
463
Index 507
ä Suspension warning lamp (red)
.............................................................
ä Suspension warning lamp (yel‐
low) .....................................................
! The electric parking brake (yel‐
low) indicator lamp ..............................
h Tire pressure monitoring sys‐
tem warning lamp flashes ....................
h Tire pressure monitoring sys‐
tem warning lamp lights up .................
L Warning lamp for distance
warning function .................................
469
469
467
472
473
469
Warning/indicator lamps ....................... 460
Overview ............................................. 460
PASSENGER AIR BAG ............................. 47
Warranty ..................................................... 31
Washer fluid
see Windshield washer fluid
Washing by hand (care) .......................... 331
Water tank
see Air-water duct
Weather information ...............................
Web browser
Overview .............................................
Wheel change
Lowering the vehicle ...........................
Mounting a new wheel ........................
Removing a wheel ...............................
Removing/installing hub caps .............
Wheel rotation .........................................
Wheels
Care ....................................................
Changing hub caps ..............................
Checking .............................................
Checking the tire pressure (man‐
ually) ...................................................
Checking the tire pressure (tire pres‐
sure monitoring system) ......................
Definitions ...........................................
DOT, Tire Identification Number (TIN)
.............................................................
Flat tire ................................................
Installing ..............................................
Load index ...........................................
Load-bearing capacity .........................
298
308
384
383
382
379
378
332
379
356
360
362
372
368
338
383
370
370
Maximum tire load .............................. 369
Maximum tire pressure ....................... 369
MOExtended tires ................................ 338
Noise ................................................... 356
Notes on installing ............................... 375
Overview of tire labeling ...................... 367
Removing ............................................ 382
Replacing ..................................... 375, 379
Restarting the tire pressure monitor‐
ing system ........................................... 362
Rotating ............................................... 378
Selection ............................................. 375
Snow chains ........................................ 357
Speed rating ........................................ 370
Storing ................................................. 378
Temperature grade .............................. 367
Tire and Loading Information placard
............................................................. 363
Tire characteristics .............................. 370
Tire pressure (notes) ........................... 357
Tire pressure monitoring system
(function) ............................................. 360
Tire pressure table .............................. 359
Tire Quality Grading ............................. 367
Tire size designation ............................ 370
TIREFIT kit ........................................... 339
508 Index
Traction grade ..................................... 367
Tread wear grade ................................. 367
Unusual handling characteristics ........ 356
Wi-Fi
Setting ................................................. 291
Window curtain airbag ............................. 42
Windows
see Side windows
Windows (Care) ....................................... 332
Windshield ................................ 151, 153, 159
Defrosting ............................................ 159
Infrared reflective ................................ 158
Radio waves ........................................ 158
Replacing the wiper blades .................. 151
Replacing wiper blades (MAGIC
VISION CONTROL) ............................... 153
Windshield
see Windshield
Windshield heater ................................... 164
Windshield heating
see Windshield heater
Windshield washer fluid ......................... 399
Notes .................................................. 399
Windshield washer system
Topping up ........................................... 327
Windshield wipers
Activating/deactivating ....................... 150
Replacing the wiper blades .................. 151
Replacing wiper blades (MAGIC
VISION CONTROL) ............................... 153
Winter operation
Snow chains ........................................ 357
Wiper blades
Care .................................................... 332
Replacing ............................................. 151
Replacing (MAGIC VISION CONTROL)
............................................................. 153
Wireless charging
Function/notes ................................... 139
Mobile phone ....................................... 140
Mobile phone (rear passenger com‐
partment) ............................................ 140
Wireless vehicle components
Declaration of conformity ...................... 27
Workout program
Overview ............................................. 108
Workshop
see Qualified specialist workshop